Squashed 'yocto-poky/' content from commit ea562de

git-subtree-dir: yocto-poky
git-subtree-split: ea562de57590c966cd5a75fda8defecd397e6436
diff --git a/meta/recipes-bsp/lrzsz/lrzsz-0.12.20/gettext.patch b/meta/recipes-bsp/lrzsz/lrzsz-0.12.20/gettext.patch
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1a24a1f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/meta/recipes-bsp/lrzsz/lrzsz-0.12.20/gettext.patch
@@ -0,0 +1,21884 @@
+Upstream-Status: Inappropriate [configuration]
+
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/ABOUT-NLS	1998-04-26 09:22:30.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/ABOUT-NLS	2004-09-12 14:40:34.323752952 -0400
+@@ -1,14 +1,14 @@
+ Notes on the Free Translation Project
+ *************************************
+ 
+-   Free software is going international!  The Free Translation Project
+-is a way to get maintainers of free software, translators, and users all
++Free software is going international!  The Free Translation Project is
++a way to get maintainers of free software, translators, and users all
+ together, so that will gradually become able to speak many languages.
+ A few packages already provide translations for their messages.
+ 
+    If you found this `ABOUT-NLS' file inside a distribution, you may
+ assume that the distributed package does use GNU `gettext' internally,
+-itself available at your nearest GNU archive site.  But you do *not*
++itself available at your nearest GNU archive site.  But you do _not_
+ need to install GNU `gettext' prior to configuring, installing or using
+ this package with messages translated.
+ 
+@@ -22,10 +22,10 @@
+ `gettext' which is used.  The information can be found in the
+ `intl/VERSION' file, in internationalized packages.
+ 
+-One advise in advance
+-=====================
++Quick configuration advice
++==========================
+ 
+-   If you want to exploit the full power of internationalization, you
++If you want to exploit the full power of internationalization, you
+ should configure it using
+ 
+      ./configure --with-included-gettext
+@@ -34,42 +34,40 @@
+ package, despite the existence of internationalizing capabilities in the
+ operating system where this package is being installed.  So far, only
+ the `gettext' implementation in the GNU C library version 2 provides as
+-many features (such as locale alias or message inheritance) as the
+-implementation here.  It is also not possible to offer this additional
+-functionality on top of a `catgets' implementation.  Future versions of
+-GNU `gettext' will very likely convey even more functionality.  So it
+-might be a good idea to change to GNU `gettext' as soon as possible.
++many features (such as locale alias, message inheritance, automatic
++charset conversion or plural form handling) as the implementation here.
++It is also not possible to offer this additional functionality on top
++of a `catgets' implementation.  Future versions of GNU `gettext' will
++very likely convey even more functionality.  So it might be a good idea
++to change to GNU `gettext' as soon as possible.
+ 
+-   So you need not provide this option if you are using GNU libc 2 or
++   So you need _not_ provide this option if you are using GNU libc 2 or
+ you have installed a recent copy of the GNU gettext package with the
+ included `libintl'.
+ 
+ INSTALL Matters
+ ===============
+ 
+-   Some packages are "localizable" when properly installed; the
+-programs they contain can be made to speak your own native language.
+-Most such packages use GNU `gettext'.  Other packages have their own
+-ways to internationalization, predating GNU `gettext'.
++Some packages are "localizable" when properly installed; the programs
++they contain can be made to speak your own native language.  Most such
++packages use GNU `gettext'.  Other packages have their own ways to
++internationalization, predating GNU `gettext'.
+ 
+    By default, this package will be installed to allow translation of
+-messages.  It will automatically detect whether the system provides
+-usable `catgets' (if using this is selected by the installer) or
+-`gettext' functions.  If neither is available, the GNU `gettext' own
++messages.  It will automatically detect whether the system already
++provides the GNU `gettext' functions.  If not, the GNU `gettext' own
+ library will be used.  This library is wholly contained within this
+ package, usually in the `intl/' subdirectory, so prior installation of
+-the GNU `gettext' package is *not* required.  Installers may use
++the GNU `gettext' package is _not_ required.  Installers may use
+ special options at configuration time for changing the default
+ behaviour.  The commands:
+ 
+      ./configure --with-included-gettext
+-     ./configure --with-catgets
+      ./configure --disable-nls
+ 
+-will respectively bypass any pre-existing `catgets' or `gettext' to use
+-the internationalizing routines provided within this package, enable
+-the use of the `catgets' functions (if found on the locale system), or
+-else, *totally* disable translation of messages.
++will respectively bypass any pre-existing `gettext' to use the
++internationalizing routines provided within this package, or else,
++_totally_ disable translation of messages.
+ 
+    When you already have GNU `gettext' installed on your system and run
+ configure without an option for your new package, `configure' will
+@@ -83,18 +81,10 @@
+ 
+ to prevent auto-detection.
+ 
+-   By default the configuration process will not test for the `catgets'
+-function and therefore they will not be used.  The reasons are already
+-given above: the emulation on top of `catgets' cannot provide all the
+-extensions provided by the GNU `gettext' library.  If you nevertheless
+-want to use the `catgets' functions use
+-
+-     ./configure --with-catgets
+-
+-to enable the test for `catgets' (this causes no harm if `catgets' is
+-not available on your system).  If you really select this option we
+-would like to hear about the reasons because we cannot think of any
+-good one ourself.
++   The configuration process will not test for the `catgets' function
++and therefore it will not be used.  The reason is that even an
++emulation of `gettext' on top of `catgets' could not provide all the
++extensions of the GNU `gettext' library.
+ 
+    Internationalized packages have usually many `po/LL.po' files, where
+ LL gives an ISO 639 two-letter code identifying the language.  Unless
+@@ -108,57 +98,73 @@
+ Using This Package
+ ==================
+ 
+-   As a user, if your language has been installed for this package, you
++As a user, if your language has been installed for this package, you
+ only have to set the `LANG' environment variable to the appropriate
+-ISO 639 `LL' two-letter code prior to using the programs in the
+-package.  For example, let's suppose that you speak German.  At the
+-shell prompt, merely execute `setenv LANG de' (in `csh'),
+-`export LANG; LANG=de' (in `sh') or `export LANG=de' (in `bash').  This
+-can be done from your `.login' or `.profile' file, once and for all.
++`LL_CC' combination.  Here `LL' is an ISO 639 two-letter language code,
++and `CC' is an ISO 3166 two-letter country code.  For example, let's
++suppose that you speak German and live in Germany.  At the shell
++prompt, merely execute `setenv LANG de_DE' (in `csh'),
++`export LANG; LANG=de_DE' (in `sh') or `export LANG=de_DE' (in `bash').
++This can be done from your `.login' or `.profile' file, once and for
++all.
+ 
+-   An operating system might already offer message localization for
+-many of its programs, while other programs have been installed locally
+-with the full capabilities of GNU `gettext'.  Just using `gettext'
+-extended syntax for `LANG' would break proper localization of already
+-available operating system programs.  In this case, users should set
+-both `LANGUAGE' and `LANG' variables in their environment, as programs
+-using GNU `gettext' give preference to `LANGUAGE'.  For example, some
+-Swedish users would rather read translations in German than English for
+-when Swedish is not available.  This is easily accomplished by setting
+-`LANGUAGE' to `sv:de' while leaving `LANG' to `sv'.
++   You might think that the country code specification is redundant.
++But in fact, some languages have dialects in different countries.  For
++example, `de_AT' is used for Austria, and `pt_BR' for Brazil.  The
++country code serves to distinguish the dialects.
++
++   The locale naming convention of `LL_CC', with `LL' denoting the
++language and `CC' denoting the country, is the one use on systems based
++on GNU libc.  On other systems, some variations of this scheme are
++used, such as `LL' or `LL_CC.ENCODING'.  You can get the list of
++locales supported by your system for your country by running the command
++`locale -a | grep '^LL''.
++
++   Not all programs have translations for all languages.  By default, an
++English message is shown in place of a nonexistent translation.  If you
++understand other languages, you can set up a priority list of languages.
++This is done through a different environment variable, called
++`LANGUAGE'.  GNU `gettext' gives preference to `LANGUAGE' over `LANG'
++for the purpose of message handling, but you still need to have `LANG'
++set to the primary language; this is required by other parts of the
++system libraries.  For example, some Swedish users who would rather
++read translations in German than English for when Swedish is not
++available, set `LANGUAGE' to `sv:de' while leaving `LANG' to `sv_SE'.
++
++   Special advice for Norwegian users: The language code for Norwegian
++bokma*l changed from `no' to `nb' recently (in 2003).  During the
++transition period, while some message catalogs for this language are
++installed under `nb' and some older ones under `no', it's recommended
++for Norwegian users to set `LANGUAGE' to `nb:no' so that both newer and
++older translations are used.
++
++   In the `LANGUAGE' environment variable, but not in the `LANG'
++environment variable, `LL_CC' combinations can be abbreviated as `LL'
++to denote the language's main dialect.  For example, `de' is equivalent
++to `de_DE' (German as spoken in Germany), and `pt' to `pt_PT'
++(Portuguese as spoken in Portugal) in this context.
+ 
+ Translating Teams
+ =================
+ 
+-   For the Free Translation Project to be a success, we need interested
++For the Free Translation Project to be a success, we need interested
+ people who like their own language and write it well, and who are also
+ able to synergize with other translators speaking the same language.
+-Each translation team has its own mailing list, courtesy of Linux
+-International.  You may reach your translation team at the address
+-`LL@li.org', replacing LL by the two-letter ISO 639 code for your
+-language.  Language codes are *not* the same as the country codes given
+-in ISO 3166.  The following translation teams exist, as of August 1997:
+-
+-     Chinese `zh', Czech `cs', Danish `da', Dutch `nl', English `en',
+-     Esperanto `eo', Finnish `fi', French `fr', German `de', Hungarian
+-     `hu', Irish `ga', Italian `it', Indonesian `id', Japanese `ja',
+-     Korean `ko', Latin `la', Norwegian `no', Persian `fa', Polish
+-     `pl', Portuguese `pt', Russian `ru', Slovenian `sl', Spanish `es',
+-     Swedish `sv', and Turkish `tr'.
+-
+-For example, you may reach the Chinese translation team by writing to
+-`zh@li.org'.
++Each translation team has its own mailing list.  The up-to-date list of
++teams can be found at the Free Translation Project's homepage,
++`http://www.iro.umontreal.ca/contrib/po/HTML/', in the "National teams"
++area.
+ 
+-   If you'd like to volunteer to *work* at translating messages, you
++   If you'd like to volunteer to _work_ at translating messages, you
+ should become a member of the translating team for your own language.
+-The subscribing address is *not* the same as the list itself, it has
++The subscribing address is _not_ the same as the list itself, it has
+ `-request' appended.  For example, speakers of Swedish can send a
+ message to `sv-request@li.org', having this message body:
+ 
+      subscribe
+ 
+    Keep in mind that team members are expected to participate
+-*actively* in translations, or at solving translational difficulties,
++_actively_ in translations, or at solving translational difficulties,
+ rather than merely lurking around.  If your team does not exist yet and
+ you want to start one, or if you are unsure about what to do or how to
+ get started, please write to `translation@iro.umontreal.ca' to reach the
+@@ -171,43 +177,559 @@
+ Available Packages
+ ==================
+ 
+-   Languages are not equally supported in all packages.  The following
+-matrix shows the current state of internationalization, as of August
+-1997.  The matrix shows, in regard of each package, for which languages
+-PO files have been submitted to translation coordination.
++Languages are not equally supported in all packages.  The following
++matrix shows the current state of internationalization, as of January
++2004.  The matrix shows, in regard of each package, for which languages
++PO files have been submitted to translation coordination, with a
++translation percentage of at least 50%.
+ 
+-     Ready PO files    cs da de en es fi fr it ja ko nl no pl pt sl sv
+-                     .-------------------------------------------------.
+-     bash            |       []          []          []                |  3
+-     bison           |       []          []          []                |  3
+-     clisp           |       [] [] []    []                            |  4
+-     cpio            |       []    []    []          []    []          |  5
+-     diffutils       |       []    []    []                []       [] |  5
+-     enscript        |       []    [] [] []          []          []    |  6
+-     fileutils       | []    []    []    []       [] []    [] [] [] [] | 10
+-     findutils       |       []    []    [] []    [] []    []       [] |  8
+-     flex            |             []    []       []                [] |  4
+-     gcal            |       []          []          []    []       [] |  5
+-     gettext         |       []    []    []       [] [] [] [] [] [] [] | 11
+-     grep            |       []    []    []       [] [] [] []    [] [] |  9
+-     hello           |       []    []    []       [] [] [] [] [] [] [] | 10
+-     id-utils        |       []          []                []          |  3
+-     indent          |    [] []                   []       []          |  4
+-     libc            |       []    []    []       [] []    []       [] |  7
+-     m4              |       []          []    []    []             [] |  5
+-     make            |       []    []    []       [] []    []          |  6
+-     music           |                   []                []          |  2
+-     ptx             |       []    []    []          [] [] [] []    [] |  8
+-     recode          |    [] []    []    []          []    [] [] [] [] |  9
+-     sh-utils        |       []          []          [] [] [] []    [] |  7
+-     sharutils       |       []    []    []          []             [] |  5
+-     tar             |       []          [] []    [] [] [] [] [] [] [] | 10
+-     texinfo         |                   []                            |  1
+-     textutils       | []    []    []    []       [] [] [] []       [] |  9
+-     wdiff           | []    []    []    []          [] [] []       [] |  8
+-                     `-------------------------------------------------'
+-       16 languages    cs da de en es fi fr it ja ko nl no pl pt sl sv
+-       27 packages      3  2 24  1 17  1 26  2  1 11 20  9 19  7  7 17  167
++     Ready PO files       af am ar az be bg bs ca cs da de el en en_GB eo es
++                        +----------------------------------------------------+
++     a2ps               |             []             [] [] []                |
++     aegis              |                               ()                   |
++     ant-phone          |                               ()                   |
++     anubis             |                                                    |
++     ap-utils           |                                                    |
++     aspell             |             []                                     |
++     bash               |                      []       []             [] [] |
++     batchelor          |                                                    |
++     bfd                |                            []                   [] |
++     binutils           |                            []                   [] |
++     bison              |                            [] []                [] |
++     bluez-pin          | []                      []                   []    |
++     clisp              |                                                    |
++     clisp              |                               []    []          [] |
++     console-tools      |                         []    []                   |
++     coreutils          |                      []    [] []                [] |
++     cpio               |                            [] []                [] |
++     darkstat           |                []          ()                   [] |
++     diffutils          |                      [] [] [] [] []          [] [] |
++     e2fsprogs          |                         []    []                [] |
++     enscript           |                      []    [] []        []         |
++     error              |                      []    [] []        []      [] |
++     fetchmail          |                      [] () [] [] []             [] |
++     fileutils          |                            [] []                [] |
++     findutils          |             []       []    [] [] []          [] [] |
++     flex               |                      []    [] []                [] |
++     fslint             |                                                    |
++     gas                |                                                 [] |
++     gawk               |                      []    [] []                [] |
++     gbiff              |                               []                   |
++     gcal               |                      []                            |
++     gcc                |                            []                   [] |
++     gettext            |             []       []    [] []                [] |
++     gettext-examples   | []                   []       []                [] |
++     gettext-runtime    |             []       []    [] []                [] |
++     gettext-tools      |                      []       []                [] |
++     gimp-print         |                         [] [] []        []      [] |
++     gliv               |                                                    |
++     glunarclock        |                            [] []                   |
++     gnubiff            |                               []                   |
++     gnucash            |                         []    ()        []      [] |
++     gnucash-glossary   |                            [] ()                [] |
++     gnupg              |                      [] ()    [] []          [] [] |
++     gpe-aerial         |                         []                         |
++     gpe-beam           |                         []    []                   |
++     gpe-calendar       |                         []    []                   |
++     gpe-clock          |                         []    []                   |
++     gpe-conf           |                         []    []                   |
++     gpe-contacts       |                         []    []                   |
++     gpe-edit           |                         []                         |
++     gpe-go             |                         []                         |
++     gpe-login          |                         []    []                   |
++     gpe-ownerinfo      |                         []    []                   |
++     gpe-sketchbook     |                         []    []                   |
++     gpe-su             |                         []    []                   |
++     gpe-taskmanager    |                         []    []                   |
++     gpe-timesheet      |                         []                         |
++     gpe-today          |                         []    []                   |
++     gpe-todo           |                         []    []                   |
++     gphoto2            |                         [] [] []                [] |
++     gprof              |                            [] []                [] |
++     gpsdrive           |                               ()    ()          () |
++     gramadoir          |                               []                   |
++     grep               |             [] []    []       [] []             [] |
++     gretl              |                                                 [] |
++     gtick              | []                            ()                   |
++     hello              |                      []    [] [] []          [] [] |
++     id-utils           |                            [] []                   |
++     indent             |                      []       []             [] [] |
++     iso_3166           |          []    [] [] [] [] [] [] []          [] [] |
++     iso_3166_1         |                      [] [] [] [] []             [] |
++     iso_3166_2         |                                                    |
++     iso_3166_3         |                               []                   |
++     iso_4217           |                      []    [] []                [] |
++     iso_639            |                                                    |
++     jpilot             |                         [] []                   [] |
++     jtag               |                                                    |
++     jwhois             |                                                 [] |
++     kbd                |                         [] [] [] []             [] |
++     latrine            |                               ()                   |
++     ld                 |                            []                   [] |
++     libc               |                      [] [] [] [] []             [] |
++     libgpewidget       |                         []    []                   |
++     libiconv           |                      []    [] []             [] [] |
++     lifelines          |                            [] ()                   |
++     lilypond           |                               []                   |
++     lingoteach         |                                                    |
++     lingoteach_lessons |                               ()                () |
++     lynx               |                      [] [] [] []                   |
++     m4                 |                         [] [] [] []                |
++     mailutils          |                      []                         [] |
++     make               |                            [] []                [] |
++     man-db             |                      [] () [] []                () |
++     minicom            |                         []    []                [] |
++     mysecretdiary      |                            [] []                [] |
++     nano               |                      [] () [] []                [] |
++     nano_1_0           |                      [] () [] []                [] |
++     opcodes            |                                                 [] |
++     parted             |                      [] [] [] []                [] |
++     ptx                |                      []    [] []             [] [] |
++     python             |                                                    |
++     radius             |                                                 [] |
++     recode             |             []       []    [] [] []          [] [] |
++     rpm                |                         [] []                      |
++     screem             |                                                    |
++     scrollkeeper       |             []       [] [] [] []                [] |
++     sed                | []                   []    [] []             [] [] |
++     sh-utils           |                            [] []                [] |
++     shared-mime-info   |                                                    |
++     sharutils          |                      [] [] [] [] []             [] |
++     silky              |                               ()                   |
++     skencil            |                            [] ()                [] |
++     sketch             |                            [] ()                [] |
++     soundtracker       |                            [] []                [] |
++     sp                 |                               []                   |
++     tar                |                         [] [] []                [] |
++     texinfo            |                            [] []             []    |
++     textutils          |                      []    [] []                [] |
++     tin                |                               ()        ()         |
++     tp-robot           |                                                    |
++     tuxpaint           |                      [] [] [] [] []     []      [] |
++     unicode-han-tra... |                                                    |
++     unicode-transla... |                                                    |
++     util-linux         |                      [] [] [] []                [] |
++     vorbis-tools       |             []          [] []                   [] |
++     wastesedge         |                               ()                   |
++     wdiff              |                      []    [] []                [] |
++     wget               |                []    []    [] [] []             [] |
++     xchat              |                      []       [] []             [] |
++     xfree86_xkb_xml    |                         [] []                      |
++     xpad               |                                                 [] |
++                        +----------------------------------------------------+
++                          af am ar az be bg bs ca cs da de el en en_GB eo es
++                           4  0  0  1  9  4  1 40 41 60 78 17  1   5   13 68
++     
++                          et eu fa fi fr ga gl he hr hu id is it ja ko lg
++                        +-------------------------------------------------+
++     a2ps               | []       [] []                      ()    ()    |
++     aegis              |                                                 |
++     ant-phone          |             []                                  |
++     anubis             |             []                                  |
++     ap-utils           |             []                                  |
++     aspell             |             [] []                               |
++     bash               |             []             []                   |
++     batchelor          |             [] []                               |
++     bfd                |             []                                  |
++     binutils           |             []                         []       |
++     bison              | []          []                []    []          |
++     bluez-pin          |          [] [] []          [] []                |
++     clisp              |                                                 |
++     clisp              |             []                                  |
++     console-tools      |                                                 |
++     coreutils          | []       [] [] []                   [] []       |
++     cpio               |             []    []       []             []    |
++     darkstat           |             () []          [] []                |
++     diffutils          |          [] []    [] []    [] []       []       |
++     e2fsprogs          |                                                 |
++     enscript           |             []          []                      |
++     error              |          [] [] []          []                   |
++     fetchmail          |                                        []       |
++     fileutils          | []          [] []          []       [] []       |
++     findutils          | []       [] [] [] []    [] [] []    [] [] []    |
++     flex               |             [] []                         []    |
++     fslint             |             []                                  |
++     gas                |             []                                  |
++     gawk               |             []       []                []       |
++     gbiff              |             []                                  |
++     gcal               |             []                                  |
++     gcc                |             []                                  |
++     gettext            |             []                         [] []    |
++     gettext-examples   |             []                         []       |
++     gettext-runtime    |          [] []                []       [] []    |
++     gettext-tools      |             []                         [] []    |
++     gimp-print         |             []                         []       |
++     gliv               |             ()                                  |
++     glunarclock        |          []    [] []       []                   |
++     gnubiff            |             []                                  |
++     gnucash            |             ()                      []          |
++     gnucash-glossary   |                                     []          |
++     gnupg              | []       [] []    []          []    [] []       |
++     gpe-aerial         |             []                                  |
++     gpe-beam           |             []                                  |
++     gpe-calendar       |             []             [] []                |
++     gpe-clock          |             []                                  |
++     gpe-conf           |             []                                  |
++     gpe-contacts       |             []             []                   |
++     gpe-edit           |             []                []                |
++     gpe-go             |             []                                  |
++     gpe-login          |             []             []                   |
++     gpe-ownerinfo      |             []             [] []                |
++     gpe-sketchbook     |             []                                  |
++     gpe-su             |             []                                  |
++     gpe-taskmanager    |             []                                  |
++     gpe-timesheet      |             [] []             []                |
++     gpe-today          |             [] []                               |
++     gpe-todo           |             []                []                |
++     gphoto2            |             []             []          []       |
++     gprof              |             []                []                |
++     gpsdrive           |             ()                      () ()       |
++     gramadoir          |             [] []                               |
++     grep               | []       [] [] [] [] [] [] [] []    [] []       |
++     gretl              |             []                      []          |
++     gtick              |          [] [] []                               |
++     hello              | []    [] [] [] [] [] [] [] [] []    [] [] []    |
++     id-utils           |             []             [] []    []          |
++     indent             | []       [] [] [] []       [] []    [] []       |
++     iso_3166           |    []       [] []       [] [] []    []          |
++     iso_3166_1         |    []       [] []          [] []                |
++     iso_3166_2         |                                                 |
++     iso_3166_3         |                                                 |
++     iso_4217           | []          []    []       []       [] []       |
++     iso_639            |                                                 |
++     jpilot             |             []                         ()       |
++     jtag               |             []                                  |
++     jwhois             |             []             [] []    []          |
++     kbd                |             []                                  |
++     latrine            |             []                                  |
++     ld                 |             []                                  |
++     libc               |          [] []    []       []          [] []    |
++     libgpewidget       |             [] []          [] []                |
++     libiconv           | []       [] [] [] []    [] [] []    []          |
++     lifelines          |             ()                                  |
++     lilypond           |             []                                  |
++     lingoteach         |             []                []                |
++     lingoteach_lessons |                                                 |
++     lynx               | []                         []       [] []       |
++     m4                 |             []    []          []       []       |
++     mailutils          |                                                 |
++     make               |             []    [] [] []             [] []    |
++     man-db             |                                     () ()       |
++     minicom            |          [] []             []          []       |
++     mysecretdiary      |             []                []                |
++     nano               |             []    []          []    []          |
++     nano_1_0           |             []    []          []    []          |
++     opcodes            |             []                                  |
++     parted             |             []    []                   []       |
++     ptx                | []       [] [] [] []       [] []                |
++     python             |                                                 |
++     radius             |             []                                  |
++     recode             |             []    [] []    [] []    []          |
++     rpm                |             []                            []    |
++     screem             |                                                 |
++     scrollkeeper       |                            []                   |
++     sed                | []       [] [] [] []       [] []    [] []       |
++     sh-utils           | []       [] [] []          []       [] []       |
++     shared-mime-info   |          [] []             []                   |
++     sharutils          | []          []    []       []          []       |
++     silky              |          () []             ()       ()          |
++     skencil            |             []                                  |
++     sketch             |             []                                  |
++     soundtracker       |             []                      []          |
++     sp                 |             []                         ()       |
++     tar                | []       [] []    []    [] [] []    [] []       |
++     texinfo            |             []       [] []             []       |
++     textutils          |             [] [] []       []          [] []    |
++     tin                | []          ()                                  |
++     tp-robot           |             []                                  |
++     tuxpaint           |          [] []       []    [] [] [] [] [] []    |
++     unicode-han-tra... |                                                 |
++     unicode-transla... |             [] []                               |
++     util-linux         | []       [] []             []       () []       |
++     vorbis-tools       |             []                                  |
++     wastesedge         |             ()                                  |
++     wdiff              | []          [] [] []       [] []                |
++     wget               | []       [] []    []    [] []          []       |
++     xchat              | []       [] []                                  |
++     xfree86_xkb_xml    |             []             []                   |
++     xpad               |             [] []                               |
++                        +-------------------------------------------------+
++                          et eu fa fi fr ga gl he hr hu id is it ja ko lg
++                          22  2  1 26 106 28 24  8 10 41 33  1 26 33 12  0
++     
++                          lt lv mk mn ms mt nb nl nn no nso pl pt pt_BR ro ru
++                        +-----------------------------------------------------+
++     a2ps               |             []       []    ()     ()     []   [] [] |
++     aegis              |                      ()                       () () |
++     ant-phone          |                      []                       []    |
++     anubis             |             []    [] []           []          [] [] |
++     ap-utils           |                      []           ()          []    |
++     aspell             |                      []                             |
++     bash               |                                          []   [] [] |
++     batchelor          |                                               []    |
++     bfd                |                                               []    |
++     binutils           |                                                  [] |
++     bison              |             []       []                  []   [] [] |
++     bluez-pin          |                      []           []          []    |
++     clisp              |                                                     |
++     clisp              |                      []                             |
++     console-tools      |                                                  [] |
++     coreutils          |                                   []             [] |
++     cpio               |                      []           []     []   [] [] |
++     darkstat           |             []       []                  []   []    |
++     diffutils          |             []       []           []     []   [] [] |
++     e2fsprogs          |                                   []                |
++     enscript           |                      []                  []   [] [] |
++     error              |                      []                  []   []    |
++     fetchmail          |                      []           []     ()      [] |
++     fileutils          |                                   []          [] [] |
++     findutils          |                      []           []     []   [] [] |
++     flex               |                                   []     []   [] [] |
++     fslint             |                      []                       []    |
++     gas                |                                                     |
++     gawk               |                                   []     []   []    |
++     gbiff              |                      []                       []    |
++     gcal               |                                                     |
++     gcc                |                                                     |
++     gettext            |                                   []          [] [] |
++     gettext-examples   |                      []           []          []    |
++     gettext-runtime    |                      []           []          [] [] |
++     gettext-tools      |                                   []          []    |
++     gimp-print         |                      []                             |
++     gliv               |                      []                  []   []    |
++     glunarclock        |             []       []                       [] [] |
++     gnubiff            |                      []                             |
++     gnucash            |                      []              []  ()      [] |
++     gnucash-glossary   |                      []              []             |
++     gnupg              |                                               []    |
++     gpe-aerial         |                      []              []       [] [] |
++     gpe-beam           |                      []              []       [] [] |
++     gpe-calendar       |                      []              []       [] [] |
++     gpe-clock          |                      []              []       [] [] |
++     gpe-conf           |                      []              []       [] [] |
++     gpe-contacts       |                      []              []       [] [] |
++     gpe-edit           |                      []              []       [] [] |
++     gpe-go             |                      []                       [] [] |
++     gpe-login          |                      []              []       [] [] |
++     gpe-ownerinfo      |                      []              []       [] [] |
++     gpe-sketchbook     |                      []              []       [] [] |
++     gpe-su             |                      []              []       [] [] |
++     gpe-taskmanager    |                      []              []       [] [] |
++     gpe-timesheet      |                      []              []       [] [] |
++     gpe-today          |                      []              []       [] [] |
++     gpe-todo           |                      []              []       [] [] |
++     gphoto2            |                                               []    |
++     gprof              |                                          []   []    |
++     gpsdrive           |                      ()    ()                 []    |
++     gramadoir          |                      ()                       []    |
++     grep               |                                   [] []  []   [] [] |
++     gretl              |                                                     |
++     gtick              |                      []                       [] [] |
++     hello              |    []       []    [] [] [] []     []     []   [] [] |
++     id-utils           |                      []                  []   [] [] |
++     indent             |                      []                  []   [] [] |
++     iso_3166           |          []                [] []                    |
++     iso_3166_1         |                      []    []                       |
++     iso_3166_2         |                                                     |
++     iso_3166_3         |                      []                             |
++     iso_4217           |          []          [] [] []     [] []  []      [] |
++     iso_639            |          []                                         |
++     jpilot             |                      ()    ()                       |
++     jtag               |                                                     |
++     jwhois             |                      []           []     []   [] () |
++     kbd                |                      []           []          []    |
++     latrine            |                                               []    |
++     ld                 |                                                     |
++     libc               |                   []       []     []     []         |
++     libgpewidget       |                      []              []       []    |
++     libiconv           |                      []           []     []   [] [] |
++     lifelines          |                                                     |
++     lilypond           |                                                     |
++     lingoteach         |                                                     |
++     lingoteach_lessons |                                                     |
++     lynx               |                      []                  []      [] |
++     m4                 |                      []           []     []   [] [] |
++     mailutils          |                                   []          [] [] |
++     make               |                      []           []     []      [] |
++     man-db             |                                               []    |
++     minicom            |                                   []     []   [] [] |
++     mysecretdiary      |                      []                  []   []    |
++     nano               |             []       []           []          [] [] |
++     nano_1_0           |             []    []    []        []          [] [] |
++     opcodes            |                      []                       []    |
++     parted             |                         []        [] []  []         |
++     ptx                |                   [] []    []     [] []  []   [] [] |
++     python             |                                                     |
++     radius             |                                   []             [] |
++     recode             |                                   []     []   [] [] |
++     rpm                |                                   [] []          [] |
++     screem             |                                                     |
++     scrollkeeper       |                   [] []           []          [] [] |
++     sed                |                                   []     []   []    |
++     sh-utils           |                   []                             [] |
++     shared-mime-info   |                      [] []                          |
++     sharutils          |                      []                          [] |
++     silky              |                                                  () |
++     skencil            |                                      []  []         |
++     sketch             |                                      []  []         |
++     soundtracker       |                                                     |
++     sp                 |                                                     |
++     tar                |             []    []       []     []     []   []    |
++     texinfo            |                   []              []          [] [] |
++     textutils          |                   []                             [] |
++     tin                |                                                     |
++     tp-robot           |                      []                             |
++     tuxpaint           | []          []       [] []        [] []  []   []    |
++     unicode-han-tra... |                                                     |
++     unicode-transla... |                                                     |
++     util-linux         |                      []                  []      [] |
++     vorbis-tools       |                      []                       [] [] |
++     wastesedge         |                                                     |
++     wdiff              |             []                    []     []   [] [] |
++     wget               |                                   []          [] [] |
++     xchat              |    []                []                          [] |
++     xfree86_xkb_xml    |                      []                          [] |
++     xpad               |                      []                       []    |
++                        +-----------------------------------------------------+
++                          lt lv mk mn ms mt nb nl nn no nso pl pt pt_BR ro ru
++                           1  2  0  3 12  0 10 69  6  7  1  40 26  36   76 63
++     
++                          sk sl sr sv ta th tr uk ven vi wa xh zh_CN zh_TW zu
++                        +-----------------------------------------------------+
++     a2ps               |    []    []       [] []                             | 16
++     aegis              |                                                     |  0
++     ant-phone          |                                                     |  3
++     anubis             |                   [] []                             |  9
++     ap-utils           |                      ()                             |  3
++     aspell             |                                                     |  4
++     bash               |                                                     |  9
++     batchelor          |                                                     |  3
++     bfd                |          []       []                                |  6
++     binutils           |          []       []                  []            |  8
++     bison              |          []       []                                | 14
++     bluez-pin          | []       []                    []                   | 14
++     clisp              |                                                     |  0
++     clisp              |                                                     |  5
++     console-tools      |                                                     |  3
++     coreutils          |    []    []       []                        []      | 16
++     cpio               |          []                           []            | 14
++     darkstat           | []    [] []                           ()    ()      | 12
++     diffutils          |          []       []                        []      | 23
++     e2fsprogs          |          []       []                                |  6
++     enscript           |          []       []                                | 12
++     error              | []                []                        []      | 15
++     fetchmail          | []                []                                | 11
++     fileutils          |    []    []       []                  []    []      | 17
++     findutils          | [] [] [] []       []                  []            | 29
++     flex               |          []       []                                | 13
++     fslint             |                                                     |  3
++     gas                |                   []                                |  3
++     gawk               |          []       []                                | 12
++     gbiff              |                                                     |  4
++     gcal               |          []       []                                |  4
++     gcc                |                   []                                |  4
++     gettext            | [] []    []       []                        []      | 16
++     gettext-examples   | []    [] []       []                  []            | 14
++     gettext-runtime    | [] [] [] []       [] []               []    []      | 22
++     gettext-tools      | [] [] [] []       []                  []            | 14
++     gimp-print         | []       []                                         | 10
++     gliv               |                                                     |  3
++     glunarclock        |       [] []                    []                   | 13
++     gnubiff            |                                                     |  3
++     gnucash            | []                                          []      |  9
++     gnucash-glossary   | []       []                                 []      |  8
++     gnupg              | []       []       []                        []      | 17
++     gpe-aerial         |          []                                         |  7
++     gpe-beam           |          []                                         |  8
++     gpe-calendar       | []       []                    []           []      | 13
++     gpe-clock          | []    [] []                                         | 10
++     gpe-conf           | []       []                                         |  9
++     gpe-contacts       | []       []                                 []      | 11
++     gpe-edit           | []    [] []                    []           []      | 12
++     gpe-go             |                                                     |  5
++     gpe-login          | []    [] []                    []           []      | 13
++     gpe-ownerinfo      | []    [] []                                 []      | 13
++     gpe-sketchbook     | []       []                                         |  9
++     gpe-su             | []    [] []                                         | 10
++     gpe-taskmanager    | []    [] []                                         | 10
++     gpe-timesheet      | []    [] []                                 []      | 12
++     gpe-today          | []    [] []                    []           []      | 13
++     gpe-todo           | []       []                    []           []      | 12
++     gphoto2            | []       []                           []            | 11
++     gprof              |          []       []                                |  9
++     gpsdrive           | []       []                                         |  3
++     gramadoir          | []                                                  |  5
++     grep               |    [] []          [] []                             | 26
++     gretl              |                                                     |  3
++     gtick              |                                                     |  7
++     hello              | []    [] []       [] []                             | 34
++     id-utils           |          []       []                                | 12
++     indent             | []    [] []       []                                | 21
++     iso_3166           | [] [] [] []       []    []     []                   | 27
++     iso_3166_1         | [] []             []                                | 16
++     iso_3166_2         |                                                     |  0
++     iso_3166_3         |                                                     |  2
++     iso_4217           | [] []    []       [] []               []            | 24
++     iso_639            |                                                     |  1
++     jpilot             |          []       []        []        []    []      |  9
++     jtag               | []                                                  |  2
++     jwhois             |          ()       []                        []      | 11
++     kbd                |          []       []                                | 11
++     latrine            |                                                     |  2
++     ld                 |          []       []                                |  5
++     libc               | []       []       []                  []            | 20
++     libgpewidget       | []    [] []                    []                   | 13
++     libiconv           | [] [] [] []       [] []        []     []            | 27
++     lifelines          |          []                                         |  2
++     lilypond           |          []                                         |  3
++     lingoteach         |                                                     |  2
++     lingoteach_lessons |                                       ()            |  0
++     lynx               |          []       [] []                             | 14
++     m4                 |          []                           []            | 15
++     mailutils          |                                                     |  5
++     make               |          []       []                  []            | 16
++     man-db             |          []                                         |  5
++     minicom            |                                                     | 11
++     mysecretdiary      |          []       []                                | 10
++     nano               |       [] []       [] []                             | 17
++     nano_1_0           |          []       [] []                             | 17
++     opcodes            |          []       []                                |  6
++     parted             |          []       []                  []            | 15
++     ptx                |          []       []                                | 22
++     python             |                                                     |  0
++     radius             |                                                     |  4
++     recode             |    []    []       []                                | 20
++     rpm                |          []       []                                |  9
++     screem             |          []                           []            |  2
++     scrollkeeper       | []    [] []                                         | 15
++     sed                | [] [] [] []       [] []                             | 24
++     sh-utils           |    []             []                                | 14
++     shared-mime-info   |       [] []                                         |  7
++     sharutils          |       [] []       []                        []      | 17
++     silky              | ()                                                  |  3
++     skencil            |          []                                         |  6
++     sketch             |          []                                         |  6
++     soundtracker       | []       []                                         |  7
++     sp                 |                   []                                |  3
++     tar                | [] []    []       []                  []            | 24
++     texinfo            |          []       []                  []            | 14
++     textutils          |    []    []       []                        []      | 16
++     tin                |                                                     |  1
++     tp-robot           |                                                     |  2
++     tuxpaint           | []       []       []           []     []            | 29
++     unicode-han-tra... |                                                     |  0
++     unicode-transla... |                                                     |  2
++     util-linux         |          []       []                                | 15
++     vorbis-tools       |                                                     |  8
++     wastesedge         |                                                     |  0
++     wdiff              | []       []       []                                | 18
++     wget               | [] [] [] []       [] []               []    []      | 24
++     xchat              | [] [] [] []                           []            | 15
++     xfree86_xkb_xml    | []    []          [] []               []            | 11
++     xpad               |                                                     |  5
++                        +-----------------------------------------------------+
++       63 teams           sk sl sr sv ta th tr uk ven vi wa xh zh_CN zh_TW zu
++      131 domains         47 19 28 83  0  0 59 13  1   1 11  0  22    22    0  1373
+ 
+    Some counters in the preceding matrix are higher than the number of
+ visible blocks let us expect.  This is because a few extra PO files are
+@@ -220,6 +742,27 @@
+ lag between the mere existence a PO file and its wide availability in a
+ distribution.
+ 
+-   If August 1997 seems to be old, you may fetch a more recent copy of
+-this `ABOUT-NLS' file on most GNU archive sites.
++   If January 2004 seems to be old, you may fetch a more recent copy of
++this `ABOUT-NLS' file on most GNU archive sites.  The most up-to-date
++matrix with full percentage details can be found at
++`http://www.iro.umontreal.ca/contrib/po/HTML/matrix.html'.
++
++Using `gettext' in new packages
++===============================
++
++If you are writing a freely available program and want to
++internationalize it you are welcome to use GNU `gettext' in your
++package.  Of course you have to respect the GNU Library General Public
++License which covers the use of the GNU `gettext' library.  This means
++in particular that even non-free programs can use `libintl' as a shared
++library, whereas only free software can use `libintl' as a static
++library or use modified versions of `libintl'.
++
++   Once the sources are changed appropriately and the setup can handle
++the use of `gettext' the only thing missing are the translations.  The
++Free Translation Project is also available for packages which are not
++developed inside the GNU project.  Therefore the information given above
++applies also for every other Free Software Project.  Contact
++`translation@iro.umontreal.ca' to make the `.pot' files available to
++the translation teams.
+ 
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/ChangeLog	1998-12-29 17:49:56.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/ChangeLog	2004-09-12 14:40:35.846521456 -0400
+@@ -1,3 +1,11 @@
++2004-09-12  gettextize  <bug-gnu-gettext@gnu.org>
++
++	* Makefile.am (ACLOCAL_AMFLAGS): New variable.
++	(EXTRA_DIST): Add config.rpath.
++	* configure.in (AC_OUTPUT): Add m4/Makefile.
++	(AC_OUTPUT): Remove command that created po/Makefile.
++	(AC_LINK_FILES): Remove invocation.
++
+ 1998-12-29	Uwe Ohse  <uwe@ohse.de>
+ 
+ 	* src/lrz.c: removed stpcpy call.
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/config.rpath	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/config.rpath	2004-09-12 14:40:34.329752040 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,548 @@
++#! /bin/sh
++# Output a system dependent set of variables, describing how to set the
++# run time search path of shared libraries in an executable.
++#
++#   Copyright 1996-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++#   Taken from GNU libtool, 2001
++#   Originally by Gordon Matzigkeit <gord@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1996
++#
++#   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
++#   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
++#   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
++#   (at your option) any later version.
++#
++#   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
++#   WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++#   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++#   General Public License for more details.
++#
++#   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
++#   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++#   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
++#
++#   As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
++#   distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
++#   configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under
++#   the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program.
++#
++# The first argument passed to this file is the canonical host specification,
++#    CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-OPERATING_SYSTEM
++# or
++#    CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-KERNEL-OPERATING_SYSTEM
++# The environment variables CC, GCC, LDFLAGS, LD, with_gnu_ld
++# should be set by the caller.
++#
++# The set of defined variables is at the end of this script.
++
++# Known limitations:
++# - On IRIX 6.5 with CC="cc", the run time search patch must not be longer
++#   than 256 bytes, otherwise the compiler driver will dump core. The only
++#   known workaround is to choose shorter directory names for the build
++#   directory and/or the installation directory.
++
++# All known linkers require a `.a' archive for static linking (except M$VC,
++# which needs '.lib').
++libext=a
++shrext=.so
++
++host="$1"
++host_cpu=`echo "$host" | sed 's/^\([^-]*\)-\([^-]*\)-\(.*\)$/\1/'`
++host_vendor=`echo "$host" | sed 's/^\([^-]*\)-\([^-]*\)-\(.*\)$/\2/'`
++host_os=`echo "$host" | sed 's/^\([^-]*\)-\([^-]*\)-\(.*\)$/\3/'`
++
++# Code taken from libtool.m4's AC_LIBTOOL_PROG_COMPILER_PIC.
++
++wl=
++if test "$GCC" = yes; then
++  wl='-Wl,'
++else
++  case "$host_os" in
++    aix*)
++      wl='-Wl,'
++      ;;
++    mingw* | pw32* | os2*)
++      ;;
++    hpux9* | hpux10* | hpux11*)
++      wl='-Wl,'
++      ;;
++    irix5* | irix6* | nonstopux*)
++      wl='-Wl,'
++      ;;
++    newsos6)
++      ;;
++    linux*)
++      case $CC in
++        icc|ecc)
++          wl='-Wl,'
++          ;;
++        ccc)
++          wl='-Wl,'
++          ;;
++      esac
++      ;;
++    osf3* | osf4* | osf5*)
++      wl='-Wl,'
++      ;;
++    sco3.2v5*)
++      ;;
++    solaris*)
++      wl='-Wl,'
++      ;;
++    sunos4*)
++      wl='-Qoption ld '
++      ;;
++    sysv4 | sysv4.2uw2* | sysv4.3* | sysv5*)
++      wl='-Wl,'
++      ;;
++    sysv4*MP*)
++      ;;
++    uts4*)
++      ;;
++  esac
++fi
++
++# Code taken from libtool.m4's AC_LIBTOOL_PROG_LD_SHLIBS.
++
++hardcode_libdir_flag_spec=
++hardcode_libdir_separator=
++hardcode_direct=no
++hardcode_minus_L=no
++
++case "$host_os" in
++  cygwin* | mingw* | pw32*)
++    # FIXME: the MSVC++ port hasn't been tested in a loooong time
++    # When not using gcc, we currently assume that we are using
++    # Microsoft Visual C++.
++    if test "$GCC" != yes; then
++      with_gnu_ld=no
++    fi
++    ;;
++  openbsd*)
++    with_gnu_ld=no
++    ;;
++esac
++
++ld_shlibs=yes
++if test "$with_gnu_ld" = yes; then
++  case "$host_os" in
++    aix3* | aix4* | aix5*)
++      # On AIX/PPC, the GNU linker is very broken
++      if test "$host_cpu" != ia64; then
++        ld_shlibs=no
++      fi
++      ;;
++    amigaos*)
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
++      hardcode_minus_L=yes
++      # Samuel A. Falvo II <kc5tja@dolphin.openprojects.net> reports
++      # that the semantics of dynamic libraries on AmigaOS, at least up
++      # to version 4, is to share data among multiple programs linked
++      # with the same dynamic library.  Since this doesn't match the
++      # behavior of shared libraries on other platforms, we can use
++      # them.
++      ld_shlibs=no
++      ;;
++    beos*)
++      if $LD --help 2>&1 | grep ': supported targets:.* elf' > /dev/null; then
++        :
++      else
++        ld_shlibs=no
++      fi
++      ;;
++    cygwin* | mingw* | pw32*)
++      # hardcode_libdir_flag_spec is actually meaningless, as there is
++      # no search path for DLLs.
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
++      if $LD --help 2>&1 | grep 'auto-import' > /dev/null; then
++        :
++      else
++        ld_shlibs=no
++      fi
++      ;;
++    netbsd*)
++      ;;
++    solaris* | sysv5*)
++      if $LD -v 2>&1 | grep 'BFD 2\.8' > /dev/null; then
++        ld_shlibs=no
++      elif $LD --help 2>&1 | grep ': supported targets:.* elf' > /dev/null; then
++        :
++      else
++        ld_shlibs=no
++      fi
++      ;;
++    sunos4*)
++      hardcode_direct=yes
++      ;;
++    *)
++      if $LD --help 2>&1 | grep ': supported targets:.* elf' > /dev/null; then
++        :
++      else
++        ld_shlibs=no
++      fi
++      ;;
++  esac
++  if test "$ld_shlibs" = yes; then
++    # Unlike libtool, we use -rpath here, not --rpath, since the documented
++    # option of GNU ld is called -rpath, not --rpath.
++    hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath ${wl}$libdir'
++  fi
++else
++  case "$host_os" in
++    aix3*)
++      # Note: this linker hardcodes the directories in LIBPATH if there
++      # are no directories specified by -L.
++      hardcode_minus_L=yes
++      if test "$GCC" = yes; then
++        # Neither direct hardcoding nor static linking is supported with a
++        # broken collect2.
++        hardcode_direct=unsupported
++      fi
++      ;;
++    aix4* | aix5*)
++      if test "$host_cpu" = ia64; then
++        # On IA64, the linker does run time linking by default, so we don't
++        # have to do anything special.
++        aix_use_runtimelinking=no
++      else
++        aix_use_runtimelinking=no
++        # Test if we are trying to use run time linking or normal
++        # AIX style linking. If -brtl is somewhere in LDFLAGS, we
++        # need to do runtime linking.
++        case $host_os in aix4.[23]|aix4.[23].*|aix5*)
++          for ld_flag in $LDFLAGS; do
++            if (test $ld_flag = "-brtl" || test $ld_flag = "-Wl,-brtl"); then
++              aix_use_runtimelinking=yes
++              break
++            fi
++          done
++        esac
++      fi
++      hardcode_direct=yes
++      hardcode_libdir_separator=':'
++      if test "$GCC" = yes; then
++        case $host_os in aix4.[012]|aix4.[012].*)
++          collect2name=`${CC} -print-prog-name=collect2`
++          if test -f "$collect2name" && \
++            strings "$collect2name" | grep resolve_lib_name >/dev/null
++          then
++            # We have reworked collect2
++            hardcode_direct=yes
++          else
++            # We have old collect2
++            hardcode_direct=unsupported
++            hardcode_minus_L=yes
++            hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
++            hardcode_libdir_separator=
++          fi
++        esac
++      fi
++      # Begin _LT_AC_SYS_LIBPATH_AIX.
++      echo 'int main () { return 0; }' > conftest.c
++      ${CC} ${LDFLAGS} conftest.c -o conftest
++      aix_libpath=`dump -H conftest 2>/dev/null | sed -n -e '/Import File Strings/,/^$/ { /^0/ { s/^0  *\(.*\)$/\1/; p; }
++}'`
++      if test -z "$aix_libpath"; then
++        aix_libpath=`dump -HX64 conftest 2>/dev/null | sed -n -e '/Import File Strings/,/^$/ { /^0/ { s/^0  *\(.*\)$/\1/; p; }
++}'`
++      fi
++      if test -z "$aix_libpath"; then
++        aix_libpath="/usr/lib:/lib"
++      fi
++      rm -f conftest.c conftest
++      # End _LT_AC_SYS_LIBPATH_AIX.
++      if test "$aix_use_runtimelinking" = yes; then
++        hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-blibpath:$libdir:'"$aix_libpath"
++      else
++        if test "$host_cpu" = ia64; then
++          hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-R $libdir:/usr/lib:/lib'
++        else
++          hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-blibpath:$libdir:'"$aix_libpath"
++        fi
++      fi
++      ;;
++    amigaos*)
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
++      hardcode_minus_L=yes
++      # see comment about different semantics on the GNU ld section
++      ld_shlibs=no
++      ;;
++    bsdi4*)
++      ;;
++    cygwin* | mingw* | pw32*)
++      # When not using gcc, we currently assume that we are using
++      # Microsoft Visual C++.
++      # hardcode_libdir_flag_spec is actually meaningless, as there is
++      # no search path for DLLs.
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec=' '
++      libext=lib
++      ;;
++    darwin* | rhapsody*)
++      if $CC -v 2>&1 | grep 'Apple' >/dev/null ; then
++        hardcode_direct=no
++      fi
++      ;;
++    dgux*)
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
++      ;;
++    freebsd1*)
++      ld_shlibs=no
++      ;;
++    freebsd2.2*)
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-R$libdir'
++      hardcode_direct=yes
++      ;;
++    freebsd2*)
++      hardcode_direct=yes
++      hardcode_minus_L=yes
++      ;;
++    freebsd*)
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-R$libdir'
++      hardcode_direct=yes
++      ;;
++    hpux9*)
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}+b ${wl}$libdir'
++      hardcode_libdir_separator=:
++      hardcode_direct=yes
++      # hardcode_minus_L: Not really in the search PATH,
++      # but as the default location of the library.
++      hardcode_minus_L=yes
++      ;;
++    hpux10* | hpux11*)
++      if test "$with_gnu_ld" = no; then
++        case "$host_cpu" in
++          hppa*64*)
++            hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}+b ${wl}$libdir'
++            hardcode_libdir_separator=:
++            hardcode_direct=no
++            ;;
++          ia64*)
++            hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
++            hardcode_direct=no
++            # hardcode_minus_L: Not really in the search PATH,
++            # but as the default location of the library.
++            hardcode_minus_L=yes
++            ;;
++          *)
++            hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}+b ${wl}$libdir'
++            hardcode_libdir_separator=:
++            hardcode_direct=yes
++            # hardcode_minus_L: Not really in the search PATH,
++            # but as the default location of the library.
++            hardcode_minus_L=yes
++            ;;
++        esac
++      fi
++      ;;
++    irix5* | irix6* | nonstopux*)
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath ${wl}$libdir'
++      hardcode_libdir_separator=:
++      ;;
++    netbsd*)
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-R$libdir'
++      hardcode_direct=yes
++      ;;
++    newsos6)
++      hardcode_direct=yes
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath ${wl}$libdir'
++      hardcode_libdir_separator=:
++      ;;
++    openbsd*)
++      hardcode_direct=yes
++      if test -z "`echo __ELF__ | $CC -E - | grep __ELF__`" || test "$host_os-$host_cpu" = "openbsd2.8-powerpc"; then
++        hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath,$libdir'
++      else
++        case "$host_os" in
++          openbsd[01].* | openbsd2.[0-7] | openbsd2.[0-7].*)
++            hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-R$libdir'
++            ;;
++          *)
++            hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath,$libdir'
++            ;;
++        esac
++      fi
++      ;;
++    os2*)
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
++      hardcode_minus_L=yes
++      ;;
++    osf3*)
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath ${wl}$libdir'
++      hardcode_libdir_separator=:
++      ;;
++    osf4* | osf5*)
++      if test "$GCC" = yes; then
++        hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath ${wl}$libdir'
++      else
++        # Both cc and cxx compiler support -rpath directly
++        hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-rpath $libdir'
++      fi
++      hardcode_libdir_separator=:
++      ;;
++    sco3.2v5*)
++      ;;
++    solaris*)
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-R$libdir'
++      ;;
++    sunos4*)
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
++      hardcode_direct=yes
++      hardcode_minus_L=yes
++      ;;
++    sysv4)
++      case $host_vendor in
++        sni)
++          hardcode_direct=yes # is this really true???
++          ;;
++        siemens)
++          hardcode_direct=no
++          ;;
++        motorola)
++          hardcode_direct=no #Motorola manual says yes, but my tests say they lie
++          ;;
++      esac
++      ;;
++    sysv4.3*)
++      ;;
++    sysv4*MP*)
++      if test -d /usr/nec; then
++        ld_shlibs=yes
++      fi
++      ;;
++    sysv4.2uw2*)
++      hardcode_direct=yes
++      hardcode_minus_L=no
++      ;;
++    sysv5OpenUNIX8* | sysv5UnixWare7* |  sysv5uw[78]* | unixware7*)
++      ;;
++    sysv5*)
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec=
++      ;;
++    uts4*)
++      hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
++      ;;
++    *)
++      ld_shlibs=no
++      ;;
++  esac
++fi
++
++# Check dynamic linker characteristics
++# Code taken from libtool.m4's AC_LIBTOOL_SYS_DYNAMIC_LINKER.
++libname_spec='lib$name'
++case "$host_os" in
++  aix3*)
++    ;;
++  aix4* | aix5*)
++    ;;
++  amigaos*)
++    ;;
++  beos*)
++    ;;
++  bsdi4*)
++    ;;
++  cygwin* | mingw* | pw32*)
++    shrext=.dll
++    ;;
++  darwin* | rhapsody*)
++    shrext=.dylib
++    ;;
++  dgux*)
++    ;;
++  freebsd1*)
++    ;;
++  freebsd*)
++    ;;
++  gnu*)
++    ;;
++  hpux9* | hpux10* | hpux11*)
++    case "$host_cpu" in
++      ia64*)
++        shrext=.so
++        ;;
++      hppa*64*)
++        shrext=.sl
++        ;;
++      *)
++        shrext=.sl
++        ;;
++    esac
++    ;;
++  irix5* | irix6* | nonstopux*)
++    case "$host_os" in
++      irix5* | nonstopux*)
++        libsuff= shlibsuff=
++        ;;
++      *)
++        case $LD in
++          *-32|*"-32 "|*-melf32bsmip|*"-melf32bsmip ") libsuff= shlibsuff= ;;
++          *-n32|*"-n32 "|*-melf32bmipn32|*"-melf32bmipn32 ") libsuff=32 shlibsuff=N32 ;;
++          *-64|*"-64 "|*-melf64bmip|*"-melf64bmip ") libsuff=64 shlibsuff=64 ;;
++          *) libsuff= shlibsuff= ;;
++        esac
++        ;;
++    esac
++    ;;
++  linux*oldld* | linux*aout* | linux*coff*)
++    ;;
++  linux*)
++    ;;
++  netbsd*)
++    ;;
++  newsos6)
++    ;;
++  nto-qnx)
++    ;;
++  openbsd*)
++    ;;
++  os2*)
++    libname_spec='$name'
++    shrext=.dll
++    ;;
++  osf3* | osf4* | osf5*)
++    ;;
++  sco3.2v5*)
++    ;;
++  solaris*)
++    ;;
++  sunos4*)
++    ;;
++  sysv4 | sysv4.2uw2* | sysv4.3* | sysv5*)
++    ;;
++  sysv4*MP*)
++    ;;
++  uts4*)
++    ;;
++esac
++
++sed_quote_subst='s/\(["`$\\]\)/\\\1/g'
++escaped_wl=`echo "X$wl" | sed -e 's/^X//' -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
++shlibext=`echo "$shrext" | sed -e 's,^\.,,'`
++escaped_hardcode_libdir_flag_spec=`echo "X$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec" | sed -e 's/^X//' -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
++
++sed -e 's/^\([a-zA-Z0-9_]*\)=/acl_cv_\1=/' <<EOF
++
++# How to pass a linker flag through the compiler.
++wl="$escaped_wl"
++
++# Static library suffix (normally "a").
++libext="$libext"
++
++# Shared library suffix (normally "so").
++shlibext="$shlibext"
++
++# Flag to hardcode \$libdir into a binary during linking.
++# This must work even if \$libdir does not exist.
++hardcode_libdir_flag_spec="$escaped_hardcode_libdir_flag_spec"
++
++# Whether we need a single -rpath flag with a separated argument.
++hardcode_libdir_separator="$hardcode_libdir_separator"
++
++# Set to yes if using DIR/libNAME.so during linking hardcodes DIR into the
++# resulting binary.
++hardcode_direct="$hardcode_direct"
++
++# Set to yes if using the -LDIR flag during linking hardcodes DIR into the
++# resulting binary.
++hardcode_minus_L="$hardcode_minus_L"
++
++EOF
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/configure.in	2004-09-12 14:39:55.161706488 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/configure.in	2004-09-12 14:40:35.816526016 -0400
+@@ -260,11 +260,10 @@
+ AM_GNU_GETTEXT
+ 
+ AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(LOCALEDIR,"$prefix/$DATADIRNAME")
+-AC_LINK_FILES($nls_cv_header_libgt, $nls_cv_header_intl)
+ 
+-AC_OUTPUT([Makefile intl/Makefile lib/Makefile testsuite/Makefile \
++AC_OUTPUT([Makefile intl/Makefile lib/Makefile testsuite/Makefile  m4/Makefile \
+ man/Makefile po/Makefile.in src/Makefile debian/rules Specfile systype \
+ src/lrzszbug],
+-[sed -e "/POTFILES =/r po/POTFILES" po/Makefile.in > po/Makefile; 
++[
+ chmod +x debian/rules;
+ test -z "$CONFIG_HEADERS" || echo timestamp > stamp-h])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/bindtextdom.c	1998-04-26 09:22:36.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/bindtextdom.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.343749912 -0400
+@@ -1,59 +1,75 @@
+ /* Implementation of the bindtextdomain(3) function
+-   Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++   Copyright (C) 1995-1998, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ 
+-   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+    any later version.
+ 
+    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-   GNU General Public License for more details.
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
+ 
+-   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+-   Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
+ 
+ #ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+ # include <config.h>
+ #endif
+ 
+-#if defined STDC_HEADERS || defined _LIBC
+-# include <stdlib.h>
+-#else
+-# ifdef HAVE_MALLOC_H
+-#  include <malloc.h>
+-# else
+-void free ();
+-# endif
+-#endif
++#include <stddef.h>
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <string.h>
+ 
+-#if defined HAVE_STRING_H || defined _LIBC
+-# include <string.h>
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# include <libintl.h>
+ #else
+-# include <strings.h>
+-# ifndef memcpy
+-#  define memcpy(Dst, Src, Num) bcopy (Src, Dst, Num)
+-# endif
++# include "libgnuintl.h"
+ #endif
++#include "gettextP.h"
+ 
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+-# include <libintl.h>
++/* We have to handle multi-threaded applications.  */
++# include <bits/libc-lock.h>
+ #else
+-# include "libgettext.h"
++/* Provide dummy implementation if this is outside glibc.  */
++# define __libc_rwlock_define(CLASS, NAME)
++# define __libc_rwlock_wrlock(NAME)
++# define __libc_rwlock_unlock(NAME)
++#endif
++
++/* The internal variables in the standalone libintl.a must have different
++   names than the internal variables in GNU libc, otherwise programs
++   using libintl.a cannot be linked statically.  */
++#if !defined _LIBC
++# define _nl_default_dirname libintl_nl_default_dirname
++# define _nl_domain_bindings libintl_nl_domain_bindings
++#endif
++
++/* Some compilers, like SunOS4 cc, don't have offsetof in <stddef.h>.  */
++#ifndef offsetof
++# define offsetof(type,ident) ((size_t)&(((type*)0)->ident))
+ #endif
+-#include "gettext.h"
+-#include "gettextP.h"
+ 
+ /* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+ 
+ /* Contains the default location of the message catalogs.  */
+ extern const char _nl_default_dirname[];
++#ifdef _LIBC
++extern const char _nl_default_dirname_internal[] attribute_hidden;
++#else
++# define INTUSE(name) name
++#endif
+ 
+ /* List with bindings of specific domains.  */
+ extern struct binding *_nl_domain_bindings;
+ 
++/* Lock variable to protect the global data in the gettext implementation.  */
++__libc_rwlock_define (extern, _nl_state_lock attribute_hidden)
++
+ 
+ /* Names for the libintl functions are a problem.  They must not clash
+    with existing names and they should follow ANSI C.  But this source
+@@ -61,23 +77,41 @@
+    prefix.  So we have to make a difference here.  */
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+ # define BINDTEXTDOMAIN __bindtextdomain
+-# define strdup(str) __strdup (str)
++# define BIND_TEXTDOMAIN_CODESET __bind_textdomain_codeset
++# ifndef strdup
++#  define strdup(str) __strdup (str)
++# endif
+ #else
+-# define BINDTEXTDOMAIN bindtextdomain__
++# define BINDTEXTDOMAIN libintl_bindtextdomain
++# define BIND_TEXTDOMAIN_CODESET libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset
+ #endif
+ 
+-/* Specify that the DOMAINNAME message catalog will be found
+-   in DIRNAME rather than in the system locale data base.  */
+-char *
+-BINDTEXTDOMAIN (domainname, dirname)
+-     const char *domainname;
+-     const char *dirname;
++/* Specifies the directory name *DIRNAMEP and the output codeset *CODESETP
++   to be used for the DOMAINNAME message catalog.
++   If *DIRNAMEP or *CODESETP is NULL, the corresponding attribute is not
++   modified, only the current value is returned.
++   If DIRNAMEP or CODESETP is NULL, the corresponding attribute is neither
++   modified nor returned.  */
++static void
++set_binding_values (const char *domainname,
++		    const char **dirnamep, const char **codesetp)
+ {
+   struct binding *binding;
++  int modified;
+ 
+   /* Some sanity checks.  */
+   if (domainname == NULL || domainname[0] == '\0')
+-    return NULL;
++    {
++      if (dirnamep)
++	*dirnamep = NULL;
++      if (codesetp)
++	*codesetp = NULL;
++      return;
++    }
++
++  __libc_rwlock_wrlock (_nl_state_lock);
++
++  modified = 0;
+ 
+   for (binding = _nl_domain_bindings; binding != NULL; binding = binding->next)
+     {
+@@ -93,81 +127,173 @@
+ 	}
+     }
+ 
+-  if (dirname == NULL)
+-    /* The current binding has be to returned.  */
+-    return binding == NULL ? (char *) _nl_default_dirname : binding->dirname;
+-
+   if (binding != NULL)
+     {
+-      /* The domain is already bound.  If the new value and the old
+-	 one are equal we simply do nothing.  Otherwise replace the
+-	 old binding.  */
+-      if (strcmp (dirname, binding->dirname) != 0)
++      if (dirnamep)
+ 	{
+-	  char *new_dirname;
++	  const char *dirname = *dirnamep;
+ 
+-	  if (strcmp (dirname, _nl_default_dirname) == 0)
+-	    new_dirname = (char *) _nl_default_dirname;
++	  if (dirname == NULL)
++	    /* The current binding has be to returned.  */
++	    *dirnamep = binding->dirname;
+ 	  else
+ 	    {
++	      /* The domain is already bound.  If the new value and the old
++		 one are equal we simply do nothing.  Otherwise replace the
++		 old binding.  */
++	      char *result = binding->dirname;
++	      if (strcmp (dirname, result) != 0)
++		{
++		  if (strcmp (dirname, INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname)) == 0)
++		    result = (char *) INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname);
++		  else
++		    {
+ #if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP
+-	      new_dirname = strdup (dirname);
+-	      if (new_dirname == NULL)
+-		return NULL;
++		      result = strdup (dirname);
+ #else
+-	      size_t len = strlen (dirname) + 1;
+-	      new_dirname = (char *) malloc (len);
+-	      if (new_dirname == NULL)
+-		return NULL;
+-
+-	      memcpy (new_dirname, dirname, len);
++		      size_t len = strlen (dirname) + 1;
++		      result = (char *) malloc (len);
++		      if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1))
++			memcpy (result, dirname, len);
+ #endif
++		    }
++
++		  if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1))
++		    {
++		      if (binding->dirname != INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname))
++			free (binding->dirname);
++
++		      binding->dirname = result;
++		      modified = 1;
++		    }
++		}
++	      *dirnamep = result;
+ 	    }
++	}
+ 
+-	  if (binding->dirname != _nl_default_dirname)
+-	    free (binding->dirname);
++      if (codesetp)
++	{
++	  const char *codeset = *codesetp;
+ 
+-	  binding->dirname = new_dirname;
++	  if (codeset == NULL)
++	    /* The current binding has be to returned.  */
++	    *codesetp = binding->codeset;
++	  else
++	    {
++	      /* The domain is already bound.  If the new value and the old
++		 one are equal we simply do nothing.  Otherwise replace the
++		 old binding.  */
++	      char *result = binding->codeset;
++	      if (result == NULL || strcmp (codeset, result) != 0)
++		{
++#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP
++		  result = strdup (codeset);
++#else
++		  size_t len = strlen (codeset) + 1;
++		  result = (char *) malloc (len);
++		  if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1))
++		    memcpy (result, codeset, len);
++#endif
++
++		  if (__builtin_expect (result != NULL, 1))
++		    {
++		      if (binding->codeset != NULL)
++			free (binding->codeset);
++
++		      binding->codeset = result;
++		      binding->codeset_cntr++;
++		      modified = 1;
++		    }
++		}
++	      *codesetp = result;
++	    }
+ 	}
+     }
++  else if ((dirnamep == NULL || *dirnamep == NULL)
++	   && (codesetp == NULL || *codesetp == NULL))
++    {
++      /* Simply return the default values.  */
++      if (dirnamep)
++	*dirnamep = INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname);
++      if (codesetp)
++	*codesetp = NULL;
++    }
+   else
+     {
+       /* We have to create a new binding.  */
+-      size_t len;
++      size_t len = strlen (domainname) + 1;
+       struct binding *new_binding =
+-	(struct binding *) malloc (sizeof (*new_binding));
++	(struct binding *) malloc (offsetof (struct binding, domainname) + len);
+ 
+-      if (new_binding == NULL)
+-	return NULL;
++      if (__builtin_expect (new_binding == NULL, 0))
++	goto failed;
+ 
++      memcpy (new_binding->domainname, domainname, len);
++
++      if (dirnamep)
++	{
++	  const char *dirname = *dirnamep;
++
++	  if (dirname == NULL)
++	    /* The default value.  */
++	    dirname = INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname);
++	  else
++	    {
++	      if (strcmp (dirname, INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname)) == 0)
++		dirname = INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname);
++	      else
++		{
++		  char *result;
+ #if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP
+-      new_binding->domainname = strdup (domainname);
+-      if (new_binding->domainname == NULL)
+-	return NULL;
++		  result = strdup (dirname);
++		  if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0))
++		    goto failed_dirname;
+ #else
+-      len = strlen (domainname) + 1;
+-      new_binding->domainname = (char *) malloc (len);
+-      if (new_binding->domainname == NULL)
+-	return NULL;
+-      memcpy (new_binding->domainname, domainname, len);
++		  size_t len = strlen (dirname) + 1;
++		  result = (char *) malloc (len);
++		  if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0))
++		    goto failed_dirname;
++		  memcpy (result, dirname, len);
+ #endif
+-
+-      if (strcmp (dirname, _nl_default_dirname) == 0)
+-	new_binding->dirname = (char *) _nl_default_dirname;
++		  dirname = result;
++		}
++	    }
++	  *dirnamep = dirname;
++	  new_binding->dirname = (char *) dirname;
++	}
+       else
++	/* The default value.  */
++	new_binding->dirname = (char *) INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname);
++
++      new_binding->codeset_cntr = 0;
++
++      if (codesetp)
+ 	{
++	  const char *codeset = *codesetp;
++
++	  if (codeset != NULL)
++	    {
++	      char *result;
++
+ #if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP
+-	  new_binding->dirname = strdup (dirname);
+-	  if (new_binding->dirname == NULL)
+-	    return NULL;
++	      result = strdup (codeset);
++	      if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0))
++		goto failed_codeset;
+ #else
+-	  len = strlen (dirname) + 1;
+-	  new_binding->dirname = (char *) malloc (len);
+-	  if (new_binding->dirname == NULL)
+-	    return NULL;
+-	  memcpy (new_binding->dirname, dirname, len);
++	      size_t len = strlen (codeset) + 1;
++	      result = (char *) malloc (len);
++	      if (__builtin_expect (result == NULL, 0))
++		goto failed_codeset;
++	      memcpy (result, codeset, len);
+ #endif
++	      codeset = result;
++	      new_binding->codeset_cntr++;
++	    }
++	  *codesetp = codeset;
++	  new_binding->codeset = (char *) codeset;
+ 	}
++      else
++	new_binding->codeset = NULL;
+ 
+       /* Now enqueue it.  */
+       if (_nl_domain_bindings == NULL
+@@ -187,13 +313,51 @@
+ 	  binding->next = new_binding;
+ 	}
+ 
+-      binding = new_binding;
++      modified = 1;
++
++      /* Here we deal with memory allocation failures.  */
++      if (0)
++	{
++	failed_codeset:
++	  if (new_binding->dirname != INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname))
++	    free (new_binding->dirname);
++	failed_dirname:
++	  free (new_binding);
++	failed:
++	  if (dirnamep)
++	    *dirnamep = NULL;
++	  if (codesetp)
++	    *codesetp = NULL;
++	}
+     }
+ 
+-  return binding->dirname;
++  /* If we modified any binding, we flush the caches.  */
++  if (modified)
++    ++_nl_msg_cat_cntr;
++
++  __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock);
++}
++
++/* Specify that the DOMAINNAME message catalog will be found
++   in DIRNAME rather than in the system locale data base.  */
++char *
++BINDTEXTDOMAIN (const char *domainname, const char *dirname)
++{
++  set_binding_values (domainname, &dirname, NULL);
++  return (char *) dirname;
++}
++
++/* Specify the character encoding in which the messages from the
++   DOMAINNAME message catalog will be returned.  */
++char *
++BIND_TEXTDOMAIN_CODESET (const char *domainname, const char *codeset)
++{
++  set_binding_values (domainname, NULL, &codeset);
++  return (char *) codeset;
+ }
+ 
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+-/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library.  */
++/* Aliases for function names in GNU C Library.  */
+ weak_alias (__bindtextdomain, bindtextdomain);
++weak_alias (__bind_textdomain_codeset, bind_textdomain_codeset);
+ #endif
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/cat-compat.c	1998-04-26 09:22:37.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/cat-compat.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
+@@ -1,262 +0,0 @@
+-/* Compatibility code for gettext-using-catgets interface.
+-   Copyright (C) 1995, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+-
+-   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+-   any later version.
+-
+-   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+-   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-   GNU General Public License for more details.
+-
+-   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+-   Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
+-
+-#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+-# include <config.h>
+-#endif
+-
+-#include <stdio.h>
+-
+-#ifdef STDC_HEADERS
+-# include <stdlib.h>
+-# include <string.h>
+-#else
+-char *getenv ();
+-# ifdef HAVE_MALLOC_H
+-#  include <malloc.h>
+-# endif
+-#endif
+-
+-#ifdef HAVE_NL_TYPES_H
+-# include <nl_types.h>
+-#endif
+-
+-#include "libgettext.h"
+-
+-/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+-
+-/* XPG3 defines the result of `setlocale (category, NULL)' as:
+-   ``Directs `setlocale()' to query `category' and return the current
+-     setting of `local'.''
+-   However it does not specify the exact format.  And even worse: POSIX
+-   defines this not at all.  So we can use this feature only on selected
+-   system (e.g. those using GNU C Library).  */
+-#ifdef _LIBC
+-# define HAVE_LOCALE_NULL
+-#endif
+-
+-/* The catalog descriptor.  */
+-static nl_catd catalog = (nl_catd) -1;
+-
+-/* Name of the default catalog.  */
+-static const char default_catalog_name[] = "messages";
+-
+-/* Name of currently used catalog.  */
+-static const char *catalog_name = default_catalog_name;
+-
+-/* Get ID for given string.  If not found return -1.  */
+-static int msg_to_cat_id PARAMS ((const char *msg));
+-
+-/* Substitution for systems lacking this function in their C library.  */
+-#if !_LIBC && !HAVE_STPCPY
+-static char *stpcpy PARAMS ((char *dest, const char *src));
+-#endif
+-
+-
+-/* Set currently used domain/catalog.  */
+-char *
+-textdomain (domainname)
+-     const char *domainname;
+-{
+-  nl_catd new_catalog;
+-  char *new_name;
+-  size_t new_name_len;
+-  char *lang;
+-
+-#if defined HAVE_SETLOCALE && defined HAVE_LC_MESSAGES \
+-    && defined HAVE_LOCALE_NULL
+-  lang = setlocale (LC_MESSAGES, NULL);
+-#else
+-  lang = getenv ("LC_ALL");
+-  if (lang == NULL || lang[0] == '\0')
+-    {
+-      lang = getenv ("LC_MESSAGES");
+-      if (lang == NULL || lang[0] == '\0')
+-	lang = getenv ("LANG");
+-    }
+-#endif
+-  if (lang == NULL || lang[0] == '\0')
+-    lang = "C";
+-
+-  /* See whether name of currently used domain is asked.  */
+-  if (domainname == NULL)
+-    return (char *) catalog_name;
+-
+-  if (domainname[0] == '\0')
+-    domainname = default_catalog_name;
+-
+-  /* Compute length of added path element.  */
+-  new_name_len = sizeof (LOCALEDIR) - 1 + 1 + strlen (lang)
+-		 + sizeof ("/LC_MESSAGES/") - 1 + sizeof (PACKAGE) - 1
+-		 + sizeof (".cat");
+-
+-  new_name = (char *) malloc (new_name_len);
+-  if (new_name == NULL)
+-    return NULL;
+-
+-  strcpy (new_name, PACKAGE);
+-  new_catalog = catopen (new_name, 0);
+-
+-  if (new_catalog == (nl_catd) -1)
+-    {
+-      /* NLSPATH search didn't work, try absolute path */
+-      sprintf (new_name, "%s/%s/LC_MESSAGES/%s.cat", LOCALEDIR, lang,
+-	       PACKAGE);
+-      new_catalog = catopen (new_name, 0);
+-
+-      if (new_catalog == (nl_catd) -1)
+-	{
+-	  free (new_name);
+-	  return (char *) catalog_name;
+-	}
+-    }
+-
+-  /* Close old catalog.  */
+-  if (catalog != (nl_catd) -1)
+-    catclose (catalog);
+-  if (catalog_name != default_catalog_name)
+-    free ((char *) catalog_name);
+-
+-  catalog = new_catalog;
+-  catalog_name = new_name;
+-
+-  return (char *) catalog_name;
+-}
+-
+-char *
+-bindtextdomain (domainname, dirname)
+-     const char *domainname;
+-     const char *dirname;
+-{
+-#if HAVE_SETENV || HAVE_PUTENV
+-  char *old_val, *new_val, *cp;
+-  size_t new_val_len;
+-
+-  /* This does not make much sense here but to be compatible do it.  */
+-  if (domainname == NULL)
+-    return NULL;
+-
+-  /* Compute length of added path element.  If we use setenv we don't need
+-     the first byts for NLSPATH=, but why complicate the code for this
+-     peanuts.  */
+-  new_val_len = sizeof ("NLSPATH=") - 1 + strlen (dirname)
+-		+ sizeof ("/%L/LC_MESSAGES/%N.cat");
+-
+-  old_val = getenv ("NLSPATH");
+-  if (old_val == NULL || old_val[0] == '\0')
+-    {
+-      old_val = NULL;
+-      new_val_len += 1 + sizeof (LOCALEDIR) - 1
+-	             + sizeof ("/%L/LC_MESSAGES/%N.cat");
+-    }
+-  else
+-    new_val_len += strlen (old_val);
+-
+-  new_val = (char *) malloc (new_val_len);
+-  if (new_val == NULL)
+-    return NULL;
+-
+-# if HAVE_SETENV
+-  cp = new_val;
+-# else
+-  cp = stpcpy (new_val, "NLSPATH=");
+-# endif
+-
+-  cp = stpcpy (cp, dirname);
+-  cp = stpcpy (cp, "/%L/LC_MESSAGES/%N.cat:");
+-
+-  if (old_val == NULL)
+-    {
+-# if __STDC__
+-      stpcpy (cp, LOCALEDIR "/%L/LC_MESSAGES/%N.cat");
+-# else
+-
+-      cp = stpcpy (cp, LOCALEDIR);
+-      stpcpy (cp, "/%L/LC_MESSAGES/%N.cat");
+-# endif
+-    }
+-  else
+-    stpcpy (cp, old_val);
+-
+-# if HAVE_SETENV
+-  setenv ("NLSPATH", new_val, 1);
+-  free (new_val);
+-# else
+-  putenv (new_val);
+-  /* Do *not* free the environment entry we just entered.  It is used
+-     from now on.   */
+-# endif
+-
+-#endif
+-
+-  return (char *) domainname;
+-}
+-
+-#undef gettext
+-char *
+-gettext (msg)
+-     const char *msg;
+-{
+-  int msgid;
+-
+-  if (msg == NULL || catalog == (nl_catd) -1)
+-    return (char *) msg;
+-
+-  /* Get the message from the catalog.  We always use set number 1.
+-     The message ID is computed by the function `msg_to_cat_id'
+-     which works on the table generated by `po-to-tbl'.  */
+-  msgid = msg_to_cat_id (msg);
+-  if (msgid == -1)
+-    return (char *) msg;
+-
+-  return catgets (catalog, 1, msgid, (char *) msg);
+-}
+-
+-/* Look through the table `_msg_tbl' which has `_msg_tbl_length' entries
+-   for the one equal to msg.  If it is found return the ID.  In case when
+-   the string is not found return -1.  */
+-static int
+-msg_to_cat_id (msg)
+-     const char *msg;
+-{
+-  int cnt;
+-
+-  for (cnt = 0; cnt < _msg_tbl_length; ++cnt)
+-    if (strcmp (msg, _msg_tbl[cnt]._msg) == 0)
+-      return _msg_tbl[cnt]._msg_number;
+-
+-  return -1;
+-}
+-
+-
+-/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */
+-
+-/* We don't want libintl.a to depend on any other library.  So we
+-   avoid the non-standard function stpcpy.  In GNU C Library this
+-   function is available, though.  Also allow the symbol HAVE_STPCPY
+-   to be defined.  */
+-#if !_LIBC && !HAVE_STPCPY
+-static char *
+-stpcpy (dest, src)
+-     char *dest;
+-     const char *src;
+-{
+-  while ((*dest++ = *src++) != '\0')
+-    /* Do nothing. */ ;
+-  return dest - 1;
+-}
+-#endif
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/ChangeLog	1998-04-26 09:22:35.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/ChangeLog	2004-09-12 14:40:34.349749000 -0400
+@@ -1,1022 +1,4 @@
+-1997-09-06 02:10  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* intlh.inst.in: Reformat copyright.
+-
+-1997-08-19 15:22  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c (DCGETTEXT): Remove wrong comment.
+-
+-1997-08-16 00:13  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (install-data): Don't change directory to install.
+-
+-1997-08-01 14:30  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* cat-compat.c: Fix copyright.
+-
+-	* localealias.c: Don't define strchr unless !HAVE_STRCHR.
+-
+-	* loadmsgcat.c: Update copyright.  Fix typos.
+-
+-	* l10nflist.c: Don't define strchr unless !HAVE_STRCHR.
+-	(_nl_make_l10nflist): Handle sponsor and revision correctly.
+-
+-	* gettext.c: Update copyright.
+-	* gettext.h: Likewise.
+-	* hash-string.h: Likewise.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c: Remoave dead code.  Define strchr only if
+-	!HAVE_STRCHR.
+-
+-	* explodename.c: Include <sys/types.h>.
+-
+-	* explodename.c: Reformat copyright text.
+-	(_nl_explode_name): Fix typo.
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c: Define and use __set_errno.
+-	(guess_category_value): Don't use setlocale if HAVE_LC_MESSAGES is
+-	not defined.
+-
+-	* bindtextdom.c: Pretty printing.
+-
+-1997-05-01 02:25  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c (guess_category_value): Don't depend on
+-	HAVE_LC_MESSAGES.  We don't need the macro here.
+-	Patch by Bruno Haible <haible@ilog.fr>.
+-
+-	* cat-compat.c (textdomain): DoN't refer to HAVE_SETLOCALE_NULL
+-	macro.  Instead use HAVE_LOCALE_NULL and define it when using
+-	glibc, as in dcgettext.c.
+-	Patch by Bruno Haible <haible@ilog.fr>.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (CPPFLAGS): New variable.  Reported by Franc,ois
+-	Pinard.
+-
+-Mon Mar 10 06:51:17 1997  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in: Implement handling of libtool.
+-
+-	* gettextP.h: Change data structures for use of generic lowlevel
+-	i18n file handling.
+-
+-Wed Dec  4 20:21:18 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* textdomain.c: Put parentheses around arguments of memcpy macro
+-	definition.
+-	* localealias.c: Likewise.
+-	* l10nflist.c: Likewise.
+-	* finddomain.c: Likewise.
+-	* bindtextdom.c: Likewise.
+-	Reported by Thomas Esken.
+-
+-Mon Nov 25 22:57:51 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* textdomain.c: Move definition of `memcpy` macro to right
+-	position.
+-
+-Fri Nov 22 04:01:58 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* finddomain.c [!HAVE_STRING_H && !_LIBC]: Define memcpy using
+- 	bcopy if not already defined.  Reported by Thomas Esken.
+-	* bindtextdom.c: Likewise.
+-	* l10nflist.c: Likewise.
+-	* localealias.c: Likewise.
+-	* textdomain.c: Likewise.
+-
+-Tue Oct 29 11:10:27 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (libdir): Change to use exec_prefix instead of
+- 	prefix.  Reported by Knut-HåvardAksnes <etokna@eto.ericsson.se>.
+-
+-Sat Aug 31 03:07:09 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* l10nflist.c (_nl_normalize_codeset): We convert to lower case,
+-	so don't prepend uppercase `ISO' for only numeric arg.
+-
+-Fri Jul 19 00:15:46 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* l10nflist.c: Move inclusion of argz.h, ctype.h, stdlib.h after
+-	definition of _GNU_SOURCE.  Patch by Roland McGrath.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (uninstall): Fix another bug with `for' loop and
+-	empty arguments.  Patch by Jim Meyering.  Correct name os
+-	uninstalled files: no intl- prefix anymore.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (install-data): Again work around shells which
+-	cannot handle mpty for list.  Reported by Jim Meyering.
+-
+-Sat Jul 13 18:11:35 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (install): Split goal.  Now depend on install-exec
+-        and install-data.
+-	(install-exec, install-data): New goals.  Created from former
+-	install goal.
+-	Reported by Karl Berry.
+-
+-Sat Jun 22 04:58:14 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (MKINSTALLDIRS): New variable.  Path to
+-        mkinstalldirs script.
+-	(install): use MKINSTALLDIRS variable or if the script is not present
+-	try to find it in the $top_scrdir).
+-
+-Wed Jun 19 02:56:56 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* l10nflist.c: Linux libc *partly* includes the argz_* functions.
+-	Grr.  Work around by renaming the static version and use macros
+-	for renaming.
+-
+-Tue Jun 18 20:11:17 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* l10nflist.c: Correct presence test macros of __argz_* functions.
+-
+-	* l10nflist.c: Include <argz.h> based on test of it instead when
+-	__argz_* functions are available.
+-	Reported by Andreas Schwab.
+-
+-Thu Jun 13 15:17:44 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* explodename.c, l10nflist.c: Define NULL for dumb systems.
+-
+-Tue Jun 11 17:05:13 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* intlh.inst.in, libgettext.h (dcgettext): Rename local variable
+-	result to __result to prevent name clash.
+-
+-	* l10nflist.c, localealias.c, dcgettext.c: Define _GNU_SOURCE to
+-        get prototype for stpcpy and strcasecmp.
+-
+-	* intlh.inst.in, libgettext.h: Move declaration of
+-	`_nl_msg_cat_cntr' outside __extension__ block to prevent warning
+-	from gcc's -Wnested-extern option.
+-
+-Fri Jun  7 01:58:00 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (install): Remove comment.
+-
+-Thu Jun  6 17:28:17 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (install): Work around for another Buglix stupidity.
+-	Always use an `else' close for `if's.  Reported by Nelson Beebe.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (intlh.inst): Correct typo in phony rule.
+-	Reported by Nelson Beebe.
+-
+-Thu Jun  6 01:49:52 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c (read_alias_file): Rename variable alloca_list to
+-	block_list as the macro calls assume.
+-	Patch by Eric Backus.
+-
+-	* localealias.c [!HAVE_ALLOCA]: Define alloca as macro using
+-        malloc.
+-	(read_alias_file): Rename varriabe alloca_list to block_list as the
+-	macro calls assume.
+-	Patch by Eric Backus.
+-
+-	* l10nflist.c: Correct conditional for <argz.h> inclusion.
+-	Reported by Roland McGrath.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (all): Depend on all-@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@, not
+-        all-@USE_NLS@.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (install): intlh.inst comes from local dir, not
+-        $(srcdir).
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (intlh.inst): Special handling of this goal.  If
+-	used in gettext, this is really a rul to construct this file.  If
+-	used in any other package it is defined as a .PHONY rule with
+-	empty body.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c: Extract locale file information handling into
+-	l10nfile.c.  Rename local stpcpy__ function to stpcpy.
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c (stpcpy): Add local definition.
+-
+-	* l10nflist.c: Solve some portability problems.  Patches partly by
+-	Thomas Esken.  Add local definition of stpcpy.
+-
+-Tue Jun  4 02:47:49 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* intlh.inst.in: Don't depend including <locale.h> on
+-	HAVE_LOCALE_H.  Instead configure must rewrite this fiile
+-	depending on the result of the configure run.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (install): libintl.inst is now called intlh.inst.
+-	Add rules for updating intlh.inst from intlh.inst.in.
+-
+-	* libintl.inst: Renamed to intlh.inst.in.
+-
+-	* localealias.c, dcgettext.c [__GNUC__]: Define HAVE_ALLOCA to 1
+-        because gcc has __buitlin_alloca.
+-	Reported by Roland McGrath.
+-
+-Mon Jun  3 00:32:16 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (installcheck): New goal to fulfill needs of
+-        automake's distcheck.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (install): Reorder commands so that VERSION is
+-        found.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (gettextsrcdir): Now use subdirectory intl/ in
+-        @datadir@/gettext.
+-	(COMSRCS): Add l10nfile.c.
+-	(OBJECTS): Add l10nfile.o.
+-	(DISTFILES): Rename to DISTFILE.normal.  Remove $(DISTFILES.common).
+-	(DISTFILE.gettext): Remove $(DISTFILES.common).
+-	(all-gettext): Remove goal.
+-	(install): If $(PACKAGE) = gettext install, otherwose do nothing.  No
+-	package but gettext itself should install libintl.h + headers.
+-	(dist): Extend goal to work for gettext, too.
+-	(dist-gettext): Remove goal.
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c [!HAVE_ALLOCA]: Define macro alloca by using malloc.
+-
+-Sun Jun  2 17:33:06 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* loadmsgcat.c (_nl_load_domain): Parameter is now comes from
+-        find_l10nfile.
+-
+-Sat Jun  1 02:23:03 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@cygnus.com>
+-
+-	* l10nflist.c (__argz_next): Add definition.
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c [!HAVE_ALLOCA]: Add code for handling missing alloca
+-	code.  Use new l10nfile handling.
+-
+-	* localealias.c [!HAVE_ALLOCA]: Add code for handling missing
+-        alloca code.
+-
+-	* l10nflist.c: Initial revision.
+-
+-Tue Apr  2 18:51:18 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (all-gettext): New goal.  Same as all-yes.
+-
+-Thu Mar 28 23:01:22 1996  Karl Eichwalder  <ke@ke.central.de>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (gettextsrcdir): Define using @datadir@.
+-
+-Tue Mar 26 12:39:14 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* finddomain.c: Include <ctype.h>.  Reported by Roland McGrath.
+-
+-Sat Mar 23 02:00:35 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* finddomain.c (stpcpy): Rename to stpcpy__ to prevent clashing
+-        with external declaration.
+-
+-Sat Mar  2 00:47:09 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (all-no): Rename from all_no.
+-
+-Sat Feb 17 00:25:59 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* gettextP.h [loaded_domain]: Array `successor' must now contain up
+-        to 63 elements (because of codeset name normalization).
+-
+-	* finddomain.c: Implement codeset name normalization.
+-
+-Thu Feb 15 04:39:09 1996  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (all): Define to `all-@USE_NLS@'.
+-	(all-yes, all_no): New goals.  `all-no' is noop, `all-yes'
+-	is former all.
+-
+-Mon Jan 15 21:46:01 1996  Howard Gayle  <howard@hal.com>
+-
+-	* localealias.c (alias_compare): Increment string pointers in loop
+-        of strcasecmp replacement.
+-
+-Fri Dec 29 21:16:34 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (install-src): Who commented this goal out ? :-)
+-
+-Fri Dec 29 15:08:16 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c (DCGETTEXT): Save `errno'.  Failing system calls
+-	should not effect it because a missing catalog is no error.
+-	Reported by Harald K<o:>nig <koenig@tat.physik.uni-tuebingen.de>.
+-
+-Tue Dec 19 22:09:13 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (Makefile): Explicitly use $(SHELL) for running
+-        shell scripts.
+-
+-Fri Dec 15 17:34:59 1995  Andreas Schwab  <schwab@issan.informatik.uni-dortmund.de>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (install-src): Only install library and header when
+-	we use the own implementation.  Don't do it when using the
+-	system's gettext or catgets functions.
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c (find_msg): Must not swap domain->hash_size here.
+-
+-Sat Dec  9 16:24:37 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* localealias.c, libintl.inst, libgettext.h, hash-string.h,
+-	gettextP.h, finddomain.c, dcgettext.c, cat-compat.c:
+-	Use PARAMS instead of __P.  Suggested by Roland McGrath.
+-
+-Tue Dec  5 11:39:14 1995  Larry Schwimmer  <rosebud@cyclone.stanford.edu>
+-
+-	* libgettext.h: Use `#if !defined (_LIBINTL_H)' instead of `#if
+-	!_LIBINTL_H' because Solaris defines _LIBINTL_H as empty.
+-
+-Mon Dec  4 15:42:07 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (install-src):
+-	Install libintl.inst instead of libintl.h.install.
+-
+-Sat Dec  2 22:51:38 1995  Marcus Daniels  <marcus@sysc.pdx.edu>
+-
+-	* cat-compat.c (textdomain):
+-	Reverse order in which files are tried you load.  First
+-	try local file, when this failed absolute path.
+-
+-Wed Nov 29 02:03:53 1995  Nelson H. F. Beebe  <beebe@math.utah.edu>
+-
+-	* cat-compat.c (bindtextdomain): Add missing { }.
+-
+-Sun Nov 26 18:21:41 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* libintl.inst: Add missing __P definition.  Reported by Nelson Beebe.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in:
+-	Add dummy `all' and `dvi' goals.  Reported by Tom Tromey.
+-
+-Sat Nov 25 16:12:01 1995  Franc,ois Pinard  <pinard@iro.umontreal.ca>
+-
+-	* hash-string.h: Capitalize arguments of macros.
+-
+-Sat Nov 25 12:01:36 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (DISTFILES): Prevent files names longer than 13
+-	characters.  libintl.h.glibc->libintl.glibc,
+-	libintl.h.install->libintl.inst.  Reported by Joshua R. Poulson.
+-
+-Sat Nov 25 11:31:12 1995  Eric Backus  <ericb@lsid.hp.com>
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c: Fix bug in preprocessor conditionals.
+-
+-Sat Nov 25 02:35:27 1995  Nelson H. F. Beebe  <beebe@math.utah.edu>
+-
+-	* libgettext.h: Solaris cc does not understand
+-	 #if !SYMBOL1 && !SYMBOL2.  Sad	but true.
+-
+-Thu Nov 23 16:22:14 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* hash-string.h (hash_string):
+-	Fix for machine with >32 bit `unsigned long's.
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c (DCGETTEXT):
+-	Fix horrible bug in loop for alternative translation.
+-
+-Thu Nov 23 01:45:29 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* po2tbl.sed.in, linux-msg.sed, xopen-msg.sed:
+-	Some further simplifications in message number generation.
+-
+-Mon Nov 20 21:08:43 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* libintl.h.glibc: Use __const instead of const in prototypes.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (install-src):
+-	Install libintl.h.install instead of libintl.h.  This
+-	is a stripped-down version.  Suggested by Peter Miller.
+-
+-	* libintl.h.install, libintl.h.glibc: Initial revision.
+-
+-	* localealias.c (_nl_expand_alias, read_alias_file):
+-	Protect prototypes in type casts by __P.
+-
+-Tue Nov 14 16:43:58 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* hash-string.h: Correct prototype for hash_string.
+-
+-Sun Nov 12 12:42:30 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* hash-string.h (hash_string): Add prototype.
+-
+-	* gettextP.h: Fix copyright.
+-	(SWAP): Add prototype.
+-
+-Wed Nov  8 22:56:33 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* localealias.c (read_alias_file): Forgot sizeof.
+-	Avoid calling *printf function.  This introduces a big overhead.
+-	Patch by Roland McGrath.
+-
+-Tue Nov  7 14:21:08 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* finddomain.c, cat-compat.c: Wrong indentation in #if for stpcpy.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c (stpcpy):
+-	Define substitution function local.  The macro was to flaky.
+-
+-	* cat-compat.c: Fix typo.
+-
+-	* xopen-msg.sed, linux-msg.sed:
+-	While bringing message number to right place only accept digits.
+-
+-	* linux-msg.sed, xopen-msg.sed: Now that the counter does not have
+-	leading 0s we don't need to remove them.  Reported by Marcus
+-	Daniels.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (../po/cat-id-tbl.o): Use $(top_srdir) in
+-	dependency.  Reported by Marcus Daniels.
+-
+-	* cat-compat.c: (stpcpy) [!_LIBC && !HAVE_STPCPY]: Define replacement.
+-	Generally cleanup using #if instead of #ifndef.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in: Correct typos in comment.  By Franc,ois Pinard.
+-
+-Mon Nov  6 00:27:02 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (install-src): Don't install libintl.h and libintl.a
+-	if we use an available gettext implementation.
+-
+-Sun Nov  5 22:02:08 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* libgettext.h: Fix typo: HAVE_CATGETTS -> HAVE_CATGETS.  Reported
+-	by Franc,ois Pinard.
+-
+-	* libgettext.h: Use #if instead of #ifdef/#ifndef.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c:
+-	Comments describing what has to be done should start with FIXME.
+-
+-Sun Nov  5 19:38:01 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (DISTFILES): Split.  Use DISTFILES with normal meaning.
+-	DISTFILES.common names the files common to both dist goals.
+-	DISTFILES.gettext are the files only distributed in GNU gettext.
+-
+-Sun Nov  5 17:32:54 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c (DCGETTEXT): Correct searching in derived locales.
+-	This was necessary since a change in _nl_find_msg several weeks
+-	ago.  I really don't know this is still not fixed.
+-
+-Sun Nov  5 12:43:12 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* loadmsgcat.c (_nl_load_domain): Test for FILENAME == NULL.  This
+-	might mark a special condition.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c (make_entry_rec): Don't make illegal entry as decided.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (dist): Suppress error message when ln failed.
+-	Get files from $(srcdir) explicitly.
+-
+-	* libgettext.h (gettext_const): Rename to gettext_noop.
+-
+-Fri Nov  3 07:36:50 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* finddomain.c (make_entry_rec):
+-	Protect against wrong locale names by testing mask.
+-
+-	* libgettext.h (gettext_const): Add macro definition.
+-	Capitalize macro arguments.
+-
+-Thu Nov  2 23:15:51 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* finddomain.c (_nl_find_domain):
+-	Test for pointer != NULL before accessing value.
+-	Reported by Tom Tromey.
+-
+-	* gettext.c (NULL):
+-	Define as (void*)0 instad of 0.  Reported by Franc,ois Pinard.
+-
+-Mon Oct 30 21:28:52 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* po2tbl.sed.in: Serious typo bug fixed by Jim Meyering.
+-
+-Sat Oct 28 23:20:47 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* libgettext.h: Disable dcgettext optimization for Solaris 2.3.
+-
+-	* localealias.c (alias_compare):
+-	Peter Miller reported that tolower in some systems is
+-	even dumber than I thought.  Protect call by `isupper'.
+-
+-Fri Oct 27 22:22:51 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (libdir, includedir): New variables.
+-	(install-src): Install libintl.a and libintl.h in correct dirs.
+-
+-Fri Oct 27 22:07:29 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (SOURCES): Fix typo: intrl.compat.c -> intl-compat.c.
+-
+-	* po2tbl.sed.in: Patch for buggy SEDs by Christian von Roques.
+-
+-	* localealias.c:
+-	Fix typo and superflous test.  Reported by Christian von Roques.
+-
+-Fri Oct  6 11:52:05 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* finddomain.c (_nl_find_domain):
+-	Correct some remainder from the pre-CEN syntax.  Now
+-	we don't have a constant number of successors anymore.
+-
+-Wed Sep 27 21:41:13 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (DISTFILES): Add libintl.h.glibc.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (dist-libc): Add goal for packing sources for glibc.
+-	(COMSRCS, COMHDRS): Splitted to separate sources shared with glibc.
+-
+-	* loadmsgcat.c: Forget to continue #if line.
+-
+-	* localealias.c:
+-	[_LIBC]: Rename strcasecmp to __strcasecmp to keep ANSI C name
+-	space clean.
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c, finddomain.c: Better comment to last change.
+-
+-	* loadmsgcat.c:
+-	[_LIBC]: Rename fstat, open, close, read, mmap, and munmap to
+-	__fstat, __open, __close, __read, __mmap, and __munmap resp
+-	to keep ANSI C name space clean.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c:
+-	[_LIBC]: Rename stpcpy to __stpcpy to keep ANSI C name space clean.
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c:
+-	[_LIBC]: Rename getced and stpcpy to __getcwd and __stpcpy resp to
+-	keep ANSI C name space clean.
+-
+-	* libgettext.h:
+-	Include sys/types.h for those old SysV systems out there.
+-	Reported by Francesco Potorti`.
+-
+-	* loadmsgcat.c (use_mmap): Define if compiled for glibc.
+-
+-	* bindtextdom.c: Include all those standard headers
+-	unconditionally if _LIBC is defined.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c: Fix 2 times defiend -> defined.
+-
+-	* textdomain.c: Include libintl.h instead of libgettext.h when
+-	compiling for glibc.  Include all those standard headers
+-	unconditionally if _LIBC is defined.
+-
+-	* localealias.c, loadmsgcat.c: Prepare to be compiled in glibc.
+-
+-	* gettext.c:
+-	Include libintl.h instead of libgettext.h when compiling for glibc.
+-	Get NULL from stddef.h if we compile for glibc.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c: Include libintl.h instead of libgettext.h when
+-	compiling for glibc.  Include all those standard headers
+-	unconditionally if _LIBC is defined.
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c: Include all those standard headers unconditionally
+-	if _LIBC is defined.
+-
+-	* dgettext.c: If compiled in glibc include libintl.h instead of
+-	libgettext.h.
+-	(locale.h): Don't rely on HAVE_LOCALE_H when compiling for glibc.
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c: If compiled in glibc include libintl.h instead of
+-	libgettext.h.
+-	(getcwd): Don't rely on HAVE_GETCWD when compiling for glibc.
+-
+-	* bindtextdom.c:
+-	If compiled in glibc include libintl.h instead of libgettext.h.
+-
+-Mon Sep 25 22:23:06 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* localealias.c (_nl_expand_alias): Don't call bsearch if NMAP <= 0.
+-	Reported by Marcus Daniels.
+-
+-	* cat-compat.c (bindtextdomain):
+-	String used in putenv must not be recycled.
+-	Reported by Marcus Daniels.
+-
+-	* libgettext.h (__USE_GNU_GETTEXT):
+-	Additional symbol to signal that we use GNU gettext
+-	library.
+-
+-	* cat-compat.c (bindtextdomain):
+-	Fix bug with the strange stpcpy replacement.
+-	Reported by Nelson Beebe.
+-
+-Sat Sep 23 08:23:51 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* cat-compat.c: Include <string.h> for stpcpy prototype.
+-
+-	* localealias.c (read_alias_file):
+-	While expand strdup code temporary variable `cp' hided
+-	higher level variable with same name.  Rename to `tp'.
+-
+-	* textdomain.c (textdomain):
+-	Avoid warning by using temporary variable in strdup code.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c (_nl_find_domain): Remove unused variable `application'.
+-
+-Thu Sep 21 15:51:44 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* localealias.c (alias_compare):
+-	Use strcasecmp() only if available.  Else use
+-	implementation in place.
+-
+-	* intl-compat.c:
+-	Wrapper functions now call *__ functions instead of __*.
+-
+-	* libgettext.h: Declare prototypes for *__ functions instead for __*.
+-
+-	* cat-compat.c, loadmsgcat.c:
+-	Don't use xmalloc, xstrdup, and stpcpy.  These functions are not part
+-	of the standard libc and so prevent libintl.a from being used
+-	standalone.
+-
+-	* bindtextdom.c:
+-	Don't use xmalloc, xstrdup, and stpcpy.  These functions are not part
+-	of the standard libc and so prevent libintl.a from being used
+-	standalone.
+-	Rename to bindtextdomain__ if not used in GNU C Library.
+-
+-	* dgettext.c:
+-	Rename function to dgettext__ if not used in GNU C Library.
+-
+-	* gettext.c:
+-	Don't use xmalloc, xstrdup, and stpcpy.  These functions are not part
+-	of the standard libc and so prevent libintl.a from being used
+-	standalone.
+-	Functions now called gettext__ if not used in GNU C Library.
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c, localealias.c, textdomain.c, finddomain.c:
+-	Don't use xmalloc, xstrdup, and stpcpy.  These functions are not part
+-	of the standard libc and so prevent libintl.a from being used
+-	standalone.
+-
+-Sun Sep 17 23:14:49 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* finddomain.c: Correct some bugs in handling of CEN standard
+- 	locale definitions.
+-
+-Thu Sep  7 01:49:28 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* finddomain.c: Implement CEN syntax.
+-
+-	* gettextP.h (loaded_domain): Extend number of successors to 31.
+-
+-Sat Aug 19 19:25:29 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (aliaspath): Remove path to X11 locale dir.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in: Make install-src depend on install.  This helps
+- 	gettext to install the sources and other packages can use the
+- 	install goal.
+-
+-Sat Aug 19 15:19:33 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (uninstall): Remove stuff installed by install-src.
+-
+-Tue Aug 15 13:13:53 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* VERSION.in: Initial revision.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (DISTFILES):
+-	Add VERSION file.  This is not necessary for gettext, but
+-	for other packages using this library.
+-
+-Tue Aug 15 06:16:44 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* gettextP.h (_nl_find_domain):
+-	New prototype after changing search strategy.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c (_nl_find_domain):
+-	We now try only to find a specified catalog.  Fall back to other
+-	catalogs listed in the locale list is now done in __dcgettext.
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c (__dcgettext):
+-	Now we provide message fall back even to different languages.
+-	I.e. if a message is not available in one language all the other
+- 	in the locale list a tried.  Formerly fall back was only possible
+- 	within one language.  Implemented by moving one loop from
+- 	_nl_find_domain to here.
+-
+-Mon Aug 14 23:45:50 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (gettextsrcdir):
+-	Directory where source of GNU gettext library are made
+-	available.
+-	(INSTALL, INSTALL_DATA): Programs used for installing sources.
+-	(gettext-src): New.  Rule to install GNU gettext sources for use in
+-	gettextize shell script.
+-
+-Sun Aug 13 14:40:48 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* loadmsgcat.c (_nl_load_domain):
+-	Use mmap for loading only when munmap function is
+-	also available.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (install): Depend on `all' goal.
+-
+-Wed Aug  9 11:04:33 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* localealias.c (read_alias_file):
+-	Do not overwrite '\n' when terminating alias value string.
+-
+-	* localealias.c (read_alias_file):
+-	Handle long lines.  Ignore the rest not fitting in
+-	the buffer after the initial `fgets' call.
+-
+-Wed Aug  9 00:54:29 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* gettextP.h (_nl_load_domain):
+-	Add prototype, replacing prototype for _nl_load_msg_cat.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c (_nl_find_domain):
+-	Remove unneeded variable filename and filename_len.
+-	(expand_alias): Remove prototype because functions does not
+- 	exist anymore.
+-
+-	* localealias.c (read_alias_file):
+-	Change type of fname_len parameter to int.
+-	(xmalloc): Add prototype.
+-
+-	* loadmsgcat.c: Better prototypes for xmalloc.
+-
+-Tue Aug  8 22:30:39 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* finddomain.c (_nl_find_domain):
+-	Allow alias name to be constructed from the four components.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (aliaspath): New variable.  Set to preliminary value.
+-	(SOURCES): Add localealias.c.
+-	(OBJECTS): Add localealias.o.
+-
+-	* gettextP.h: Add prototype for _nl_expand_alias.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c: Aliasing handled in intl/localealias.c.
+-
+-	* localealias.c: Aliasing for locale names.
+-
+-	* bindtextdom.c: Better prototypes for xmalloc and xstrdup.
+-
+-Mon Aug  7 23:47:42 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (DISTFILES): gettext.perl is now found in misc/.
+-
+-	* cat-compat.c (bindtextdomain):
+-	Correct implementation.  dirname parameter was not used.
+-	Reported by Marcus Daniels.
+-
+-	* gettextP.h (loaded_domain):
+-	New fields `successor' and `decided' for oo, lazy
+-	message handling implementation.
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c:
+-	Adopt for oo, lazy message handliing.
+-  	Now we can inherit translations from less specific locales.
+-	(find_msg): New function.
+-
+-	* loadmsgcat.c, finddomain.c:
+-	Complete rewrite.  Implement oo, lazy message handling :-).
+-  	We now have an additional environment variable `LANGUAGE' with
+- 	a higher priority than LC_ALL for the LC_MESSAGE locale.
+-  	Here we can set a colon separated list of specifications each
+- 	of the form `language[_territory[.codeset]][@modifier]'.
+-
+-Sat Aug  5 09:55:42 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* finddomain.c (unistd.h):
+-	Include to get _PC_PATH_MAX defined on system having it.
+-
+-Fri Aug  4 22:42:00 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* finddomain.c (stpcpy): Include prototype.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (dist): Remove `copying instead' message.
+-
+-Wed Aug  2 18:52:03 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (ID, TAGS): Do not use $^.
+-
+-Tue Aug  1 20:07:11 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (TAGS, ID): Use $^ as command argument.
+-	(TAGS): Give etags -o option t write to current directory,
+- 	not $(srcdir).
+-	(ID): Use $(srcdir) instead os $(top_srcdir)/src.
+-	(distclean): Remove ID.
+-
+-Sun Jul 30 11:51:46 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (gnulocaledir):
+-	New variable, always using share/ for data directory.
+-	(DEFS): Add GNULOCALEDIR, used in finddomain.c.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c (_nl_default_dirname):
+-	Set to GNULOCALEDIR, because it always has to point
+-	to the directory where GNU gettext Library writes it to.
+-
+-	* intl-compat.c (textdomain, bindtextdomain):
+-	Undefine macros before function definition.
+-
+-Sat Jul 22 01:10:02 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* libgettext.h (_LIBINTL_H):
+-	Protect definition in case where this file is included as
+-	libgettext.h on Solaris machines.  Add comment about this.
+-
+-Wed Jul 19 02:36:42 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* intl-compat.c (textdomain): Correct typo.
+-
+-Wed Jul 19 01:51:35 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c (dcgettext): Function now called __dcgettext.
+-
+-	* dgettext.c (dgettext): Now called __dgettext and calls
+- 	__dcgettext.
+-
+-	* gettext.c (gettext):
+-	Function now called __gettext and calls __dgettext.
+-
+-	* textdomain.c (textdomain): Function now called __textdomain.
+-
+-	* bindtextdom.c (bindtextdomain): Function now called
+- 	__bindtextdomain.
+-
+-	* intl-compat.c: Initial revision.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (SOURCES): Add intl-compat.c.
+-	(OBJECTS): We always compile the GNU gettext library functions.
+-  	OBJECTS contains all objects but cat-compat.o, ../po/cat-if-tbl.o,
+- 	and intl-compat.o.
+-  	(GETTOBJS): Contains now only intl-compat.o.
+-
+-	* libgettext.h:
+-	Re-include protection matches dualistic character of libgettext.h.
+-	For all functions in GNU gettext library define __ counter part.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c (strchr): Define as index if not found in C library.
+-	(_nl_find_domain): For relative paths paste / in between.
+-
+-Tue Jul 18 16:37:45 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* loadmsgcat.c, finddomain.c: Add inclusion of sys/types.h.
+-
+-	* xopen-msg.sed: Fix bug with `msgstr ""' lines.
+-	A little bit better comments.
+-
+-Tue Jul 18 01:18:27 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in:
+-	po-mode.el, makelinks, combine-sh are now found in ../misc.
+-
+-	* po-mode.el, makelinks, combine-sh, elisp-comp:
+-	Moved to ../misc/.
+-
+-	* libgettext.h, gettextP.h, gettext.h: Uniform test for __STDC__.
+-
+-Sun Jul 16 22:33:02 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (INSTALL, INSTALL_DATA): New variables.
+-	(install-data, uninstall): Install/uninstall .elc file.
+-
+-	* po-mode.el (Installation comment):
+-	Add .pox as possible extension of .po files.
+-
+-Sun Jul 16 13:23:27 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* elisp-comp: Complete new version by Franc,ois: This does not
+- 	fail when not compiling in the source directory.
+-
+-Sun Jul 16 00:12:17 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (../po/cat-id-tbl.o):
+-	Use $(MAKE) instead of make for recursive make.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (.el.elc): Use $(SHELL) instead of /bin/sh.
+-	(install-exec): Add missing dummy goal.
+-	(install-data, uninstall): @ in multi-line shell command at
+- 	beginning, not in front of echo.  Reported by Eric Backus.
+-
+-Sat Jul 15 00:21:28 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (DISTFILES):
+-	Rename libgettext.perl to gettext.perl to fit in 14 chars
+-	file systems.
+-
+-	* gettext.perl:
+- 	Rename to gettext.perl to fit in 14 chars file systems.
+-
+-Thu Jul 13 23:17:20 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* cat-compat.c: If !STDC_HEADERS try to include malloc.h.
+-
+-Thu Jul 13 20:55:02 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* po2tbl.sed.in: Pretty printing.
+-
+-	* linux-msg.sed, xopen-msg.sed:
+-	Correct bugs with handling substitute flags in branches.
+-
+-	* hash-string.h (hash_string):
+-	Old K&R compilers don't under stand `unsigned char'.
+-
+-	* gettext.h (nls_uint32):
+-	Some old K&R compilers (eg HP) don't understand `unsigned int'.
+-
+-	* cat-compat.c (msg_to_cat_id): De-ANSI-fy prototypes.
+-
+-Thu Jul 13 01:34:33 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (ELCFILES): New variable.
+-	(DISTFILES): Add elisp-comp.
+-	Add implicit rule for .el -> .elc compilation.
+-	(install-data): install $ELCFILES
+-	(clean): renamed po-to-tbl and po-to-msg to po2tbl and po2msg resp.
+-
+-	* elisp-comp: Initial revision
+-
+-Wed Jul 12 16:14:52 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in:
+-	cat-id-tbl.c is now found in po/.  This enables us to use an identical
+-	intl/ directory in all packages.
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c (dcgettext): hashing does not work for table size <= 2.
+-
+-	* textdomain.c: fix typo (#if def -> #if defined)
+-
+-Tue Jul 11 18:44:43 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (stamp-cat-id): use top_srcdir to address source files
+-	(DISTFILES,distclean): move tupdate.perl to src/
+-
+-	* po-to-tbl.sed.in:
+-	add additional jump to clear change flag to recognize multiline strings
+-
+-Tue Jul 11 01:32:50 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* textdomain.c: Protect inclusion of stdlib.h and string.h.
+-
+-	* loadmsgcat.c: Protect inclusion of stdlib.h.
+-
+-	* libgettext.h: Protect inclusion of locale.h.
+-	Allow use in C++ programs.
+-	Define NULL is not happened already.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (DISTFILES): ship po-to-tbl.sed.in instead of
+-	po-to-tbl.sed.
+-	(distclean): remove po-to-tbl.sed and tupdate.perl.
+-
+-	* tupdate.perl.in: Substitute Perl path even in exec line.
+-	Don't include entries without translation from old .po file.
+-
+-Tue Jul  4 00:41:51 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* tupdate.perl.in: use "Updated: " in msgid "".
+-
+-	* cat-compat.c: Fix typo (LOCALDIR -> LOCALEDIR).
+- 	Define getenv if !__STDC__.
+-
+-	* bindtextdom.c: Protect stdlib.h and string.h inclusion.
+- 	Define free if !__STDC__.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c: Change DEF_MSG_DOM_DIR to LOCALEDIR.
+- 	Define free if !__STDC__.
+-
+-	* cat-compat.c: Change DEF_MSG_DOM_DIR to LOCALEDIR.
+-
+-Mon Jul  3 23:56:30 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* Makefile.in: Use LOCALEDIR instead of DEF_MSG_DOM_DIR.
+-	Remove unneeded $(srcdir) from Makefile.in dependency.
+-
+-	* makelinks: Add copyright and short description.
+-
+-	* po-mode.el: Last version for 0.7.
+-
+-	* tupdate.perl.in: Fix die message.
+-
+-	* dcgettext.c: Protect include of string.h.
+-
+-	* gettext.c: Protect include of stdlib.h and further tries to get NULL.
+-
+-	* finddomain.c: Some corrections in includes.
+-
+-	* Makefile.in (INCLUDES): Prune list correct path to Makefile.in.
+-
+-	* po-to-tbl.sed: Adopt for new .po file format.
+-
+-	* linux-msg.sed, xopen-msg.sed: Adopt for new .po file format.
+-
+-Sun Jul  2 23:55:03 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
+-
+-	* tupdate.perl.in: Complete rewrite for new .po file format.
++2004-01-29  GNU  <bug-gnu-gettext@gnu.org>
+ 
+-Sun Jul  2 02:06:50 1995  Ulrich Drepper  <drepper@myware>
++	* Version 0.14.1 released.
+ 
+-	* First official release.  This directory contains all the code
+-	needed to internationalize own packages.  It provides functions
+-	which allow to use the X/Open catgets function with an interface
+-	like the Uniforum gettext function.  For system which does not
+-	have neither of those a complete implementation is provided.
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/config.charset	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/config.charset	2004-09-12 14:40:34.354748240 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,608 @@
++#! /bin/sh
++# Output a system dependent table of character encoding aliases.
++#
++#   Copyright (C) 2000-2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++#
++#   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++#   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++#   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++#   any later version.
++#
++#   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++#   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++#   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++#   Library General Public License for more details.
++#
++#   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++#   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++#   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++#   USA.
++#
++# The table consists of lines of the form
++#    ALIAS  CANONICAL
++#
++# ALIAS is the (system dependent) result of "nl_langinfo (CODESET)".
++# ALIAS is compared in a case sensitive way.
++#
++# CANONICAL is the GNU canonical name for this character encoding.
++# It must be an encoding supported by libiconv. Support by GNU libc is
++# also desirable. CANONICAL is case insensitive. Usually an upper case
++# MIME charset name is preferred.
++# The current list of GNU canonical charset names is as follows.
++#
++#       name              MIME?             used by which systems
++#   ASCII, ANSI_X3.4-1968       glibc solaris freebsd darwin
++#   ISO-8859-1              Y   glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd darwin
++#   ISO-8859-2              Y   glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd darwin
++#   ISO-8859-3              Y   glibc solaris
++#   ISO-8859-4              Y   osf solaris freebsd darwin
++#   ISO-8859-5              Y   glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd darwin
++#   ISO-8859-6              Y   glibc aix hpux solaris
++#   ISO-8859-7              Y   glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris
++#   ISO-8859-8              Y   glibc aix hpux osf solaris
++#   ISO-8859-9              Y   glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris
++#   ISO-8859-13                 glibc
++#   ISO-8859-14                 glibc
++#   ISO-8859-15                 glibc aix osf solaris freebsd
++#   KOI8-R                  Y   glibc solaris freebsd darwin
++#   KOI8-U                  Y   glibc freebsd darwin
++#   KOI8-T                      glibc
++#   CP437                       dos
++#   CP775                       dos
++#   CP850                       aix osf dos
++#   CP852                       dos
++#   CP855                       dos
++#   CP856                       aix
++#   CP857                       dos
++#   CP861                       dos
++#   CP862                       dos
++#   CP864                       dos
++#   CP865                       dos
++#   CP866                       freebsd darwin dos
++#   CP869                       dos
++#   CP874                       woe32 dos
++#   CP922                       aix
++#   CP932                       aix woe32 dos
++#   CP943                       aix
++#   CP949                       osf woe32 dos
++#   CP950                       woe32 dos
++#   CP1046                      aix
++#   CP1124                      aix
++#   CP1125                      dos
++#   CP1129                      aix
++#   CP1250                      woe32
++#   CP1251                      glibc solaris darwin woe32
++#   CP1252                      aix woe32
++#   CP1253                      woe32
++#   CP1254                      woe32
++#   CP1255                      glibc woe32
++#   CP1256                      woe32
++#   CP1257                      woe32
++#   GB2312                  Y   glibc aix hpux irix solaris freebsd darwin
++#   EUC-JP                  Y   glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd darwin
++#   EUC-KR                  Y   glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris freebsd darwin
++#   EUC-TW                      glibc aix hpux irix osf solaris
++#   BIG5                    Y   glibc aix hpux osf solaris freebsd darwin
++#   BIG5-HKSCS                  glibc solaris
++#   GBK                         glibc aix osf solaris woe32 dos
++#   GB18030                     glibc solaris
++#   SHIFT_JIS               Y   hpux osf solaris freebsd darwin
++#   JOHAB                       glibc solaris woe32
++#   TIS-620                     glibc aix hpux osf solaris
++#   VISCII                  Y   glibc
++#   TCVN5712-1                  glibc
++#   GEORGIAN-PS                 glibc
++#   HP-ROMAN8                   hpux
++#   HP-ARABIC8                  hpux
++#   HP-GREEK8                   hpux
++#   HP-HEBREW8                  hpux
++#   HP-TURKISH8                 hpux
++#   HP-KANA8                    hpux
++#   DEC-KANJI                   osf
++#   DEC-HANYU                   osf
++#   UTF-8                   Y   glibc aix hpux osf solaris
++#
++# Note: Names which are not marked as being a MIME name should not be used in
++# Internet protocols for information interchange (mail, news, etc.).
++#
++# Note: ASCII and ANSI_X3.4-1968 are synonymous canonical names. Applications
++# must understand both names and treat them as equivalent.
++#
++# The first argument passed to this file is the canonical host specification,
++#    CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-OPERATING_SYSTEM
++# or
++#    CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-KERNEL-OPERATING_SYSTEM
++
++host="$1"
++os=`echo "$host" | sed -e 's/^[^-]*-[^-]*-\(.*\)$/\1/'`
++echo "# This file contains a table of character encoding aliases,"
++echo "# suitable for operating system '${os}'."
++echo "# It was automatically generated from config.charset."
++# List of references, updated during installation:
++echo "# Packages using this file: "
++case "$os" in
++    linux-gnulibc1*)
++	# Linux libc5 doesn't have nl_langinfo(CODESET); therefore
++	# localcharset.c falls back to using the full locale name
++	# from the environment variables.
++	echo "C ASCII"
++	echo "POSIX ASCII"
++	for l in af af_ZA ca ca_ES da da_DK de de_AT de_BE de_CH de_DE de_LU \
++	         en en_AU en_BW en_CA en_DK en_GB en_IE en_NZ en_US en_ZA \
++	         en_ZW es es_AR es_BO es_CL es_CO es_DO es_EC es_ES es_GT \
++	         es_HN es_MX es_PA es_PE es_PY es_SV es_US es_UY es_VE et \
++	         et_EE eu eu_ES fi fi_FI fo fo_FO fr fr_BE fr_CA fr_CH fr_FR \
++	         fr_LU ga ga_IE gl gl_ES id id_ID in in_ID is is_IS it it_CH \
++	         it_IT kl kl_GL nl nl_BE nl_NL no no_NO pt pt_BR pt_PT sv \
++	         sv_FI sv_SE; do
++	  echo "$l ISO-8859-1"
++	  echo "$l.iso-8859-1 ISO-8859-1"
++	  echo "$l.iso-8859-15 ISO-8859-15"
++	  echo "$l.iso-8859-15@euro ISO-8859-15"
++	  echo "$l@euro ISO-8859-15"
++	  echo "$l.cp-437 CP437"
++	  echo "$l.cp-850 CP850"
++	  echo "$l.cp-1252 CP1252"
++	  echo "$l.cp-1252@euro CP1252"
++	  #echo "$l.atari-st ATARI-ST" # not a commonly used encoding
++	  echo "$l.utf-8 UTF-8"
++	  echo "$l.utf-8@euro UTF-8"
++	done
++	for l in cs cs_CZ hr hr_HR hu hu_HU pl pl_PL ro ro_RO sk sk_SK sl \
++	         sl_SI sr sr_CS sr_YU; do
++	  echo "$l ISO-8859-2"
++	  echo "$l.iso-8859-2 ISO-8859-2"
++	  echo "$l.cp-852 CP852"
++	  echo "$l.cp-1250 CP1250"
++	  echo "$l.utf-8 UTF-8"
++	done
++	for l in mk mk_MK ru ru_RU; do
++	  echo "$l ISO-8859-5"
++	  echo "$l.iso-8859-5 ISO-8859-5"
++	  echo "$l.koi8-r KOI8-R"
++	  echo "$l.cp-866 CP866"
++	  echo "$l.cp-1251 CP1251"
++	  echo "$l.utf-8 UTF-8"
++	done
++	for l in ar ar_SA; do
++	  echo "$l ISO-8859-6"
++	  echo "$l.iso-8859-6 ISO-8859-6"
++	  echo "$l.cp-864 CP864"
++	  #echo "$l.cp-868 CP868" # not a commonly used encoding
++	  echo "$l.cp-1256 CP1256"
++	  echo "$l.utf-8 UTF-8"
++	done
++	for l in el el_GR gr gr_GR; do
++	  echo "$l ISO-8859-7"
++	  echo "$l.iso-8859-7 ISO-8859-7"
++	  echo "$l.cp-869 CP869"
++	  echo "$l.cp-1253 CP1253"
++	  echo "$l.cp-1253@euro CP1253"
++	  echo "$l.utf-8 UTF-8"
++	  echo "$l.utf-8@euro UTF-8"
++	done
++	for l in he he_IL iw iw_IL; do
++	  echo "$l ISO-8859-8"
++	  echo "$l.iso-8859-8 ISO-8859-8"
++	  echo "$l.cp-862 CP862"
++	  echo "$l.cp-1255 CP1255"
++	  echo "$l.utf-8 UTF-8"
++	done
++	for l in tr tr_TR; do
++	  echo "$l ISO-8859-9"
++	  echo "$l.iso-8859-9 ISO-8859-9"
++	  echo "$l.cp-857 CP857"
++	  echo "$l.cp-1254 CP1254"
++	  echo "$l.utf-8 UTF-8"
++	done
++	for l in lt lt_LT lv lv_LV; do
++	  #echo "$l BALTIC" # not a commonly used encoding, wrong encoding name
++	  echo "$l ISO-8859-13"
++	done
++	for l in ru_UA uk uk_UA; do
++	  echo "$l KOI8-U"
++	done
++	for l in zh zh_CN; do
++	  #echo "$l GB_2312-80" # not a commonly used encoding, wrong encoding name
++	  echo "$l GB2312"
++	done
++	for l in ja ja_JP ja_JP.EUC; do
++	  echo "$l EUC-JP"
++	done
++	for l in ko ko_KR; do
++	  echo "$l EUC-KR"
++	done
++	for l in th th_TH; do
++	  echo "$l TIS-620"
++	done
++	for l in fa fa_IR; do
++	  #echo "$l ISIRI-3342" # a broken encoding
++	  echo "$l.utf-8 UTF-8"
++	done
++	;;
++    linux* | *-gnu*)
++	# With glibc-2.1 or newer, we don't need any canonicalization,
++	# because glibc has iconv and both glibc and libiconv support all
++	# GNU canonical names directly. Therefore, the Makefile does not
++	# need to install the alias file at all.
++	# The following applies only to glibc-2.0.x and older libcs.
++	echo "ISO_646.IRV:1983 ASCII"
++	;;
++    aix*)
++	echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1"
++	echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2"
++	echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5"
++	echo "ISO8859-6 ISO-8859-6"
++	echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7"
++	echo "ISO8859-8 ISO-8859-8"
++	echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9"
++	echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15"
++	echo "IBM-850 CP850"
++	echo "IBM-856 CP856"
++	echo "IBM-921 ISO-8859-13"
++	echo "IBM-922 CP922"
++	echo "IBM-932 CP932"
++	echo "IBM-943 CP943"
++	echo "IBM-1046 CP1046"
++	echo "IBM-1124 CP1124"
++	echo "IBM-1129 CP1129"
++	echo "IBM-1252 CP1252"
++	echo "IBM-eucCN GB2312"
++	echo "IBM-eucJP EUC-JP"
++	echo "IBM-eucKR EUC-KR"
++	echo "IBM-eucTW EUC-TW"
++	echo "big5 BIG5"
++	echo "GBK GBK"
++	echo "TIS-620 TIS-620"
++	echo "UTF-8 UTF-8"
++	;;
++    hpux*)
++	echo "iso88591 ISO-8859-1"
++	echo "iso88592 ISO-8859-2"
++	echo "iso88595 ISO-8859-5"
++	echo "iso88596 ISO-8859-6"
++	echo "iso88597 ISO-8859-7"
++	echo "iso88598 ISO-8859-8"
++	echo "iso88599 ISO-8859-9"
++	echo "iso885915 ISO-8859-15"
++	echo "roman8 HP-ROMAN8"
++	echo "arabic8 HP-ARABIC8"
++	echo "greek8 HP-GREEK8"
++	echo "hebrew8 HP-HEBREW8"
++	echo "turkish8 HP-TURKISH8"
++	echo "kana8 HP-KANA8"
++	echo "tis620 TIS-620"
++	echo "big5 BIG5"
++	echo "eucJP EUC-JP"
++	echo "eucKR EUC-KR"
++	echo "eucTW EUC-TW"
++	echo "hp15CN GB2312"
++	#echo "ccdc ?" # what is this?
++	echo "SJIS SHIFT_JIS"
++	echo "utf8 UTF-8"
++	;;
++    irix*)
++	echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1"
++	echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2"
++	echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5"
++	echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7"
++	echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9"
++	echo "eucCN GB2312"
++	echo "eucJP EUC-JP"
++	echo "eucKR EUC-KR"
++	echo "eucTW EUC-TW"
++	;;
++    osf*)
++	echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1"
++	echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2"
++	echo "ISO8859-4 ISO-8859-4"
++	echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5"
++	echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7"
++	echo "ISO8859-8 ISO-8859-8"
++	echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9"
++	echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15"
++	echo "cp850 CP850"
++	echo "big5 BIG5"
++	echo "dechanyu DEC-HANYU"
++	echo "dechanzi GB2312"
++	echo "deckanji DEC-KANJI"
++	echo "deckorean EUC-KR"
++	echo "eucJP EUC-JP"
++	echo "eucKR EUC-KR"
++	echo "eucTW EUC-TW"
++	echo "GBK GBK"
++	echo "KSC5601 CP949"
++	echo "sdeckanji EUC-JP"
++	echo "SJIS SHIFT_JIS"
++	echo "TACTIS TIS-620"
++	echo "UTF-8 UTF-8"
++	;;
++    solaris*)
++	echo "646 ASCII"
++	echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1"
++	echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2"
++	echo "ISO8859-3 ISO-8859-3"
++	echo "ISO8859-4 ISO-8859-4"
++	echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5"
++	echo "ISO8859-6 ISO-8859-6"
++	echo "ISO8859-7 ISO-8859-7"
++	echo "ISO8859-8 ISO-8859-8"
++	echo "ISO8859-9 ISO-8859-9"
++	echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15"
++	echo "koi8-r KOI8-R"
++	echo "ansi-1251 CP1251"
++	echo "BIG5 BIG5"
++	echo "Big5-HKSCS BIG5-HKSCS"
++	echo "gb2312 GB2312"
++	echo "GBK GBK"
++	echo "GB18030 GB18030"
++	echo "cns11643 EUC-TW"
++	echo "5601 EUC-KR"
++	echo "ko_KR.johap92 JOHAB"
++	echo "eucJP EUC-JP"
++	echo "PCK SHIFT_JIS"
++	echo "TIS620.2533 TIS-620"
++	#echo "sun_eu_greek ?" # what is this?
++	echo "UTF-8 UTF-8"
++	;;
++    freebsd* | os2*)
++	# FreeBSD 4.2 doesn't have nl_langinfo(CODESET); therefore
++	# localcharset.c falls back to using the full locale name
++	# from the environment variables.
++	# Likewise for OS/2. OS/2 has XFree86 just like FreeBSD. Just
++	# reuse FreeBSD's locale data for OS/2.
++	echo "C ASCII"
++	echo "US-ASCII ASCII"
++	for l in la_LN lt_LN; do
++	  echo "$l.ASCII ASCII"
++	done
++	for l in da_DK de_AT de_CH de_DE en_AU en_CA en_GB en_US es_ES \
++	         fi_FI fr_BE fr_CA fr_CH fr_FR is_IS it_CH it_IT la_LN \
++	         lt_LN nl_BE nl_NL no_NO pt_PT sv_SE; do
++	  echo "$l.ISO_8859-1 ISO-8859-1"
++	  echo "$l.DIS_8859-15 ISO-8859-15"
++	done
++	for l in cs_CZ hr_HR hu_HU la_LN lt_LN pl_PL sl_SI; do
++	  echo "$l.ISO_8859-2 ISO-8859-2"
++	done
++	for l in la_LN lt_LT; do
++	  echo "$l.ISO_8859-4 ISO-8859-4"
++	done
++	for l in ru_RU ru_SU; do
++	  echo "$l.KOI8-R KOI8-R"
++	  echo "$l.ISO_8859-5 ISO-8859-5"
++	  echo "$l.CP866 CP866"
++	done
++	echo "uk_UA.KOI8-U KOI8-U"
++	echo "zh_TW.BIG5 BIG5"
++	echo "zh_TW.Big5 BIG5"
++	echo "zh_CN.EUC GB2312"
++	echo "ja_JP.EUC EUC-JP"
++	echo "ja_JP.SJIS SHIFT_JIS"
++	echo "ja_JP.Shift_JIS SHIFT_JIS"
++	echo "ko_KR.EUC EUC-KR"
++	;;
++    netbsd*)
++	echo "646 ASCII"
++	echo "ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1"
++	echo "ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2"
++	echo "ISO8859-4 ISO-8859-4"
++	echo "ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5"
++	echo "ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15"
++	echo "eucCN GB2312"
++	echo "eucJP EUC-JP"
++	echo "eucKR EUC-KR"
++	echo "eucTW EUC-TW"
++	echo "BIG5 BIG5"
++	echo "SJIS SHIFT_JIS"
++	;;
++    darwin*)
++	# Darwin 6.8 doesn't have nl_langinfo(CODESET); therefore
++	# localcharset.c falls back to using the full locale name
++	# from the environment variables.
++	echo "C ASCII"
++	for l in en_AU en_CA en_GB en_US la_LN; do
++	  echo "$l.US-ASCII ASCII"
++	done
++	for l in da_DK de_AT de_CH de_DE en_AU en_CA en_GB en_US es_ES \
++	         fi_FI fr_BE fr_CA fr_CH fr_FR is_IS it_CH it_IT nl_BE \
++	         nl_NL no_NO pt_PT sv_SE; do
++	  echo "$l ISO-8859-1"
++	  echo "$l.ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1"
++	  echo "$l.ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15"
++	done
++	for l in la_LN; do
++	  echo "$l.ISO8859-1 ISO-8859-1"
++	  echo "$l.ISO8859-15 ISO-8859-15"
++	done
++	for l in cs_CZ hr_HR hu_HU la_LN pl_PL sl_SI; do
++	  echo "$l.ISO8859-2 ISO-8859-2"
++	done
++	for l in la_LN lt_LT; do
++	  echo "$l.ISO8859-4 ISO-8859-4"
++	done
++	for l in ru_RU; do
++	  echo "$l.KOI8-R KOI8-R"
++	  echo "$l.ISO8859-5 ISO-8859-5"
++	  echo "$l.CP866 CP866"
++	done
++	for l in bg_BG; do
++	  echo "$l.CP1251 CP1251"
++	done
++	echo "uk_UA.KOI8-U KOI8-U"
++	echo "zh_TW.BIG5 BIG5"
++	echo "zh_TW.Big5 BIG5"
++	echo "zh_CN.EUC GB2312"
++	echo "ja_JP.EUC EUC-JP"
++	echo "ja_JP.SJIS SHIFT_JIS"
++	echo "ko_KR.EUC EUC-KR"
++	;;
++    beos*)
++	# BeOS has a single locale, and it has UTF-8 encoding.
++	echo "* UTF-8"
++	;;
++    msdosdjgpp*)
++	# DJGPP 2.03 doesn't have nl_langinfo(CODESET); therefore
++	# localcharset.c falls back to using the full locale name
++	# from the environment variables.
++	echo "#"
++	echo "# The encodings given here may not all be correct."
++	echo "# If you find that the encoding given for your language and"
++	echo "# country is not the one your DOS machine actually uses, just"
++	echo "# correct it in this file, and send a mail to"
++	echo "# Juan Manuel Guerrero <st001906@hrz1.hrz.tu-darmstadt.de>"
++	echo "# and Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>."
++	echo "#"
++	echo "C ASCII"
++	# ISO-8859-1 languages
++	echo "ca CP850"
++	echo "ca_ES CP850"
++	echo "da CP865"    # not CP850 ??
++	echo "da_DK CP865" # not CP850 ??
++	echo "de CP850"
++	echo "de_AT CP850"
++	echo "de_CH CP850"
++	echo "de_DE CP850"
++	echo "en CP850"
++	echo "en_AU CP850" # not CP437 ??
++	echo "en_CA CP850"
++	echo "en_GB CP850"
++	echo "en_NZ CP437"
++	echo "en_US CP437"
++	echo "en_ZA CP850" # not CP437 ??
++	echo "es CP850"
++	echo "es_AR CP850"
++	echo "es_BO CP850"
++	echo "es_CL CP850"
++	echo "es_CO CP850"
++	echo "es_CR CP850"
++	echo "es_CU CP850"
++	echo "es_DO CP850"
++	echo "es_EC CP850"
++	echo "es_ES CP850"
++	echo "es_GT CP850"
++	echo "es_HN CP850"
++	echo "es_MX CP850"
++	echo "es_NI CP850"
++	echo "es_PA CP850"
++	echo "es_PY CP850"
++	echo "es_PE CP850"
++	echo "es_SV CP850"
++	echo "es_UY CP850"
++	echo "es_VE CP850"
++	echo "et CP850"
++	echo "et_EE CP850"
++	echo "eu CP850"
++	echo "eu_ES CP850"
++	echo "fi CP850"
++	echo "fi_FI CP850"
++	echo "fr CP850"
++	echo "fr_BE CP850"
++	echo "fr_CA CP850"
++	echo "fr_CH CP850"
++	echo "fr_FR CP850"
++	echo "ga CP850"
++	echo "ga_IE CP850"
++	echo "gd CP850"
++	echo "gd_GB CP850"
++	echo "gl CP850"
++	echo "gl_ES CP850"
++	echo "id CP850"    # not CP437 ??
++	echo "id_ID CP850" # not CP437 ??
++	echo "is CP861"    # not CP850 ??
++	echo "is_IS CP861" # not CP850 ??
++	echo "it CP850"
++	echo "it_CH CP850"
++	echo "it_IT CP850"
++	echo "lt CP775"
++	echo "lt_LT CP775"
++	echo "lv CP775"
++	echo "lv_LV CP775"
++	echo "nb CP865"    # not CP850 ??
++	echo "nb_NO CP865" # not CP850 ??
++	echo "nl CP850"
++	echo "nl_BE CP850"
++	echo "nl_NL CP850"
++	echo "nn CP865"    # not CP850 ??
++	echo "nn_NO CP865" # not CP850 ??
++	echo "no CP865"    # not CP850 ??
++	echo "no_NO CP865" # not CP850 ??
++	echo "pt CP850"
++	echo "pt_BR CP850"
++	echo "pt_PT CP850"
++	echo "sv CP850"
++	echo "sv_SE CP850"
++	# ISO-8859-2 languages
++	echo "cs CP852"
++	echo "cs_CZ CP852"
++	echo "hr CP852"
++	echo "hr_HR CP852"
++	echo "hu CP852"
++	echo "hu_HU CP852"
++	echo "pl CP852"
++	echo "pl_PL CP852"
++	echo "ro CP852"
++	echo "ro_RO CP852"
++	echo "sk CP852"
++	echo "sk_SK CP852"
++	echo "sl CP852"
++	echo "sl_SI CP852"
++	echo "sq CP852"
++	echo "sq_AL CP852"
++	echo "sr CP852"    # CP852 or CP866 or CP855 ??
++	echo "sr_CS CP852" # CP852 or CP866 or CP855 ??
++	echo "sr_YU CP852" # CP852 or CP866 or CP855 ??
++	# ISO-8859-3 languages
++	echo "mt CP850"
++	echo "mt_MT CP850"
++	# ISO-8859-5 languages
++	echo "be CP866"
++	echo "be_BE CP866"
++	echo "bg CP866"    # not CP855 ??
++	echo "bg_BG CP866" # not CP855 ??
++	echo "mk CP866"    # not CP855 ??
++	echo "mk_MK CP866" # not CP855 ??
++	echo "ru CP866"
++	echo "ru_RU CP866"
++	echo "uk CP1125"
++	echo "uk_UA CP1125"
++	# ISO-8859-6 languages
++	echo "ar CP864"
++	echo "ar_AE CP864"
++	echo "ar_DZ CP864"
++	echo "ar_EG CP864"
++	echo "ar_IQ CP864"
++	echo "ar_IR CP864"
++	echo "ar_JO CP864"
++	echo "ar_KW CP864"
++	echo "ar_MA CP864"
++	echo "ar_OM CP864"
++	echo "ar_QA CP864"
++	echo "ar_SA CP864"
++	echo "ar_SY CP864"
++	# ISO-8859-7 languages
++	echo "el CP869"
++	echo "el_GR CP869"
++	# ISO-8859-8 languages
++	echo "he CP862"
++	echo "he_IL CP862"
++	# ISO-8859-9 languages
++	echo "tr CP857"
++	echo "tr_TR CP857"
++	# Japanese
++	echo "ja CP932"
++	echo "ja_JP CP932"
++	# Chinese
++	echo "zh_CN GBK"
++	echo "zh_TW CP950" # not CP938 ??
++	# Korean
++	echo "kr CP949"    # not CP934 ??
++	echo "kr_KR CP949" # not CP934 ??
++	# Thai
++	echo "th CP874"
++	echo "th_TH CP874"
++	# Other
++	echo "eo CP850"
++	echo "eo_EO CP850"
++	;;
++esac
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/dcgettext.c	1998-04-26 09:22:36.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/dcgettext.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.359747480 -0400
+@@ -1,593 +1,56 @@
+-/* Implementation of the dcgettext(3) function
+-   Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++/* Implementation of the dcgettext(3) function.
++   Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ 
+-   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+    any later version.
+ 
+    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-   GNU General Public License for more details.
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
+ 
+-   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+-   Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
+ 
+ #ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+ # include <config.h>
+ #endif
+ 
+-#include <sys/types.h>
+-
+-#ifdef __GNUC__
+-# define alloca __builtin_alloca
+-# define HAVE_ALLOCA 1
+-#else
+-# if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC
+-#  include <alloca.h>
+-# else
+-#  ifdef _AIX
+- #pragma alloca
+-#  else
+-#   ifndef alloca
+-char *alloca ();
+-#   endif
+-#  endif
+-# endif
+-#endif
+-
+-#include <errno.h>
+-#ifndef errno
+-extern int errno;
+-#endif
+-#ifndef __set_errno
+-# define __set_errno(val) errno = (val)
+-#endif
+-
+-#if defined STDC_HEADERS || defined _LIBC
+-# include <stdlib.h>
+-#else
+-char *getenv ();
+-# ifdef HAVE_MALLOC_H
+-#  include <malloc.h>
+-# else
+-void free ();
+-# endif
+-#endif
+-
+-#if defined HAVE_STRING_H || defined _LIBC
+-# ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
+-#  define _GNU_SOURCE	1
+-# endif
+-# include <string.h>
+-#else
+-# include <strings.h>
+-#endif
+-#if !HAVE_STRCHR && !defined _LIBC
+-# ifndef strchr
+-#  define strchr index
+-# endif
+-#endif
+-
+-#if defined HAVE_UNISTD_H || defined _LIBC
+-# include <unistd.h>
+-#endif
+-
+-#include "gettext.h"
+ #include "gettextP.h"
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+ # include <libintl.h>
+ #else
+-# include "libgettext.h"
++# include "libgnuintl.h"
+ #endif
+-#include "hash-string.h"
+ 
+ /* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+ 
+-#ifdef _LIBC
+-/* Rename the non ANSI C functions.  This is required by the standard
+-   because some ANSI C functions will require linking with this object
+-   file and the name space must not be polluted.  */
+-# define getcwd __getcwd
+-# define stpcpy __stpcpy
+-#else
+-# if !defined HAVE_GETCWD
+-char *getwd ();
+-#  define getcwd(buf, max) getwd (buf)
+-# else
+-char *getcwd ();
+-# endif
+-# ifndef HAVE_STPCPY
+-static char *stpcpy PARAMS ((char *dest, const char *src));
+-# endif
+-#endif
+-
+-/* Amount to increase buffer size by in each try.  */
+-#define PATH_INCR 32
+-
+-/* The following is from pathmax.h.  */
+-/* Non-POSIX BSD systems might have gcc's limits.h, which doesn't define
+-   PATH_MAX but might cause redefinition warnings when sys/param.h is
+-   later included (as on MORE/BSD 4.3).  */
+-#if defined(_POSIX_VERSION) || (defined(HAVE_LIMITS_H) && !defined(__GNUC__))
+-# include <limits.h>
+-#endif
+-
+-#ifndef _POSIX_PATH_MAX
+-# define _POSIX_PATH_MAX 255
+-#endif
+-
+-#if !defined(PATH_MAX) && defined(_PC_PATH_MAX)
+-# define PATH_MAX (pathconf ("/", _PC_PATH_MAX) < 1 ? 1024 : pathconf ("/", _PC_PATH_MAX))
+-#endif
+-
+-/* Don't include sys/param.h if it already has been.  */
+-#if defined(HAVE_SYS_PARAM_H) && !defined(PATH_MAX) && !defined(MAXPATHLEN)
+-# include <sys/param.h>
+-#endif
+-
+-#if !defined(PATH_MAX) && defined(MAXPATHLEN)
+-# define PATH_MAX MAXPATHLEN
+-#endif
+-
+-#ifndef PATH_MAX
+-# define PATH_MAX _POSIX_PATH_MAX
+-#endif
+-
+-/* XPG3 defines the result of `setlocale (category, NULL)' as:
+-   ``Directs `setlocale()' to query `category' and return the current
+-     setting of `local'.''
+-   However it does not specify the exact format.  And even worse: POSIX
+-   defines this not at all.  So we can use this feature only on selected
+-   system (e.g. those using GNU C Library).  */
+-#ifdef _LIBC
+-# define HAVE_LOCALE_NULL
+-#endif
+-
+-/* Name of the default domain used for gettext(3) prior any call to
+-   textdomain(3).  The default value for this is "messages".  */
+-const char _nl_default_default_domain[] = "messages";
+-
+-/* Value used as the default domain for gettext(3).  */
+-const char *_nl_current_default_domain = _nl_default_default_domain;
+-
+-/* Contains the default location of the message catalogs.  */
+-const char _nl_default_dirname[] = GNULOCALEDIR;
+-
+-/* List with bindings of specific domains created by bindtextdomain()
+-   calls.  */
+-struct binding *_nl_domain_bindings;
+-
+-/* Prototypes for local functions.  */
+-static char *find_msg PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file,
+-			       const char *msgid));
+-static const char *category_to_name PARAMS ((int category));
+-static const char *guess_category_value PARAMS ((int category,
+-						 const char *categoryname));
+-
+-
+-/* For those loosing systems which don't have `alloca' we have to add
+-   some additional code emulating it.  */
+-#ifdef HAVE_ALLOCA
+-/* Nothing has to be done.  */
+-# define ADD_BLOCK(list, address) /* nothing */
+-# define FREE_BLOCKS(list) /* nothing */
+-#else
+-struct block_list
+-{
+-  void *address;
+-  struct block_list *next;
+-};
+-# define ADD_BLOCK(list, addr)						      \
+-  do {									      \
+-    struct block_list *newp = (struct block_list *) malloc (sizeof (*newp));  \
+-    /* If we cannot get a free block we cannot add the new element to	      \
+-       the list.  */							      \
+-    if (newp != NULL) {							      \
+-      newp->address = (addr);						      \
+-      newp->next = (list);						      \
+-      (list) = newp;							      \
+-    }									      \
+-  } while (0)
+-# define FREE_BLOCKS(list)						      \
+-  do {									      \
+-    while (list != NULL) {						      \
+-      struct block_list *old = list;					      \
+-      list = list->next;						      \
+-      free (old);							      \
+-    }									      \
+-  } while (0)
+-# undef alloca
+-# define alloca(size) (malloc (size))
+-#endif	/* have alloca */
+-
+-
+ /* Names for the libintl functions are a problem.  They must not clash
+    with existing names and they should follow ANSI C.  But this source
+    code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __
+    prefix.  So we have to make a difference here.  */
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+ # define DCGETTEXT __dcgettext
++# define DCIGETTEXT __dcigettext
+ #else
+-# define DCGETTEXT dcgettext__
++# define DCGETTEXT libintl_dcgettext
++# define DCIGETTEXT libintl_dcigettext
+ #endif
+ 
+ /* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current CATEGORY
+    locale.  */
+ char *
+-DCGETTEXT (domainname, msgid, category)
+-     const char *domainname;
+-     const char *msgid;
+-     int category;
++DCGETTEXT (const char *domainname, const char *msgid, int category)
+ {
+-#ifndef HAVE_ALLOCA
+-  struct block_list *block_list = NULL;
+-#endif
+-  struct loaded_l10nfile *domain;
+-  struct binding *binding;
+-  const char *categoryname;
+-  const char *categoryvalue;
+-  char *dirname, *xdomainname;
+-  char *single_locale;
+-  char *retval;
+-  int saved_errno = errno;
+-
+-  /* If no real MSGID is given return NULL.  */
+-  if (msgid == NULL)
+-    return NULL;
+-
+-  /* If DOMAINNAME is NULL, we are interested in the default domain.  If
+-     CATEGORY is not LC_MESSAGES this might not make much sense but the
+-     defintion left this undefined.  */
+-  if (domainname == NULL)
+-    domainname = _nl_current_default_domain;
+-
+-  /* First find matching binding.  */
+-  for (binding = _nl_domain_bindings; binding != NULL; binding = binding->next)
+-    {
+-      int compare = strcmp (domainname, binding->domainname);
+-      if (compare == 0)
+-	/* We found it!  */
+-	break;
+-      if (compare < 0)
+-	{
+-	  /* It is not in the list.  */
+-	  binding = NULL;
+-	  break;
+-	}
+-    }
+-
+-  if (binding == NULL)
+-    dirname = (char *) _nl_default_dirname;
+-  else if (binding->dirname[0] == '/')
+-    dirname = binding->dirname;
+-  else
+-    {
+-      /* We have a relative path.  Make it absolute now.  */
+-      size_t dirname_len = strlen (binding->dirname) + 1;
+-      size_t path_max;
+-      char *ret;
+-
+-      path_max = (unsigned) PATH_MAX;
+-      path_max += 2;		/* The getcwd docs say to do this.  */
+-
+-      dirname = (char *) alloca (path_max + dirname_len);
+-      ADD_BLOCK (block_list, dirname);
+-
+-      __set_errno (0);
+-      while ((ret = getcwd (dirname, path_max)) == NULL && errno == ERANGE)
+-	{
+-	  path_max += PATH_INCR;
+-	  dirname = (char *) alloca (path_max + dirname_len);
+-	  ADD_BLOCK (block_list, dirname);
+-	  __set_errno (0);
+-	}
+-
+-      if (ret == NULL)
+-	{
+-	  /* We cannot get the current working directory.  Don't signal an
+-	     error but simply return the default string.  */
+-	  FREE_BLOCKS (block_list);
+-	  __set_errno (saved_errno);
+-	  return (char *) msgid;
+-	}
+-
+-      stpcpy (stpcpy (strchr (dirname, '\0'), "/"), binding->dirname);
+-    }
+-
+-  /* Now determine the symbolic name of CATEGORY and its value.  */
+-  categoryname = category_to_name (category);
+-  categoryvalue = guess_category_value (category, categoryname);
+-
+-  xdomainname = (char *) alloca (strlen (categoryname)
+-				 + strlen (domainname) + 5);
+-  ADD_BLOCK (block_list, xdomainname);
+-
+-  stpcpy (stpcpy (stpcpy (stpcpy (xdomainname, categoryname), "/"),
+-		  domainname),
+-	  ".mo");
+-
+-  /* Creating working area.  */
+-  single_locale = (char *) alloca (strlen (categoryvalue) + 1);
+-  ADD_BLOCK (block_list, single_locale);
+-
+-
+-  /* Search for the given string.  This is a loop because we perhaps
+-     got an ordered list of languages to consider for th translation.  */
+-  while (1)
+-    {
+-      /* Make CATEGORYVALUE point to the next element of the list.  */
+-      while (categoryvalue[0] != '\0' && categoryvalue[0] == ':')
+-	++categoryvalue;
+-      if (categoryvalue[0] == '\0')
+-	{
+-	  /* The whole contents of CATEGORYVALUE has been searched but
+-	     no valid entry has been found.  We solve this situation
+-	     by implicitly appending a "C" entry, i.e. no translation
+-	     will take place.  */
+-	  single_locale[0] = 'C';
+-	  single_locale[1] = '\0';
+-	}
+-      else
+-	{
+-	  char *cp = single_locale;
+-	  while (categoryvalue[0] != '\0' && categoryvalue[0] != ':')
+-	    *cp++ = *categoryvalue++;
+-	  *cp = '\0';
+-	}
+-
+-      /* If the current locale value is C (or POSIX) we don't load a
+-	 domain.  Return the MSGID.  */
+-      if (strcmp (single_locale, "C") == 0
+-	  || strcmp (single_locale, "POSIX") == 0)
+-	{
+-	  FREE_BLOCKS (block_list);
+-	  __set_errno (saved_errno);
+-	  return (char *) msgid;
+-	}
+-
+-
+-      /* Find structure describing the message catalog matching the
+-	 DOMAINNAME and CATEGORY.  */
+-      domain = _nl_find_domain (dirname, single_locale, xdomainname);
+-
+-      if (domain != NULL)
+-	{
+-	  retval = find_msg (domain, msgid);
+-
+-	  if (retval == NULL)
+-	    {
+-	      int cnt;
+-
+-	      for (cnt = 0; domain->successor[cnt] != NULL; ++cnt)
+-		{
+-		  retval = find_msg (domain->successor[cnt], msgid);
+-
+-		  if (retval != NULL)
+-		    break;
+-		}
+-	    }
+-
+-	  if (retval != NULL)
+-	    {
+-	      FREE_BLOCKS (block_list);
+-	      __set_errno (saved_errno);
+-	      return retval;
+-	    }
+-	}
+-    }
+-  /* NOTREACHED */
++  return DCIGETTEXT (domainname, msgid, NULL, 0, 0, category);
+ }
+ 
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+ /* Alias for function name in GNU C Library.  */
++INTDEF(__dcgettext)
+ weak_alias (__dcgettext, dcgettext);
+ #endif
+-
+-
+-static char *
+-find_msg (domain_file, msgid)
+-     struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file;
+-     const char *msgid;
+-{
+-  size_t top, act, bottom;
+-  struct loaded_domain *domain;
+-
+-  if (domain_file->decided == 0)
+-    _nl_load_domain (domain_file);
+-
+-  if (domain_file->data == NULL)
+-    return NULL;
+-
+-  domain = (struct loaded_domain *) domain_file->data;
+-
+-  /* Locate the MSGID and its translation.  */
+-  if (domain->hash_size > 2 && domain->hash_tab != NULL)
+-    {
+-      /* Use the hashing table.  */
+-      nls_uint32 len = strlen (msgid);
+-      nls_uint32 hash_val = hash_string (msgid);
+-      nls_uint32 idx = hash_val % domain->hash_size;
+-      nls_uint32 incr = 1 + (hash_val % (domain->hash_size - 2));
+-      nls_uint32 nstr = W (domain->must_swap, domain->hash_tab[idx]);
+-
+-      if (nstr == 0)
+-	/* Hash table entry is empty.  */
+-	return NULL;
+-
+-      if (W (domain->must_swap, domain->orig_tab[nstr - 1].length) == len
+-	  && strcmp (msgid,
+-		     domain->data + W (domain->must_swap,
+-				       domain->orig_tab[nstr - 1].offset)) == 0)
+-	return (char *) domain->data + W (domain->must_swap,
+-					  domain->trans_tab[nstr - 1].offset);
+-
+-      while (1)
+-	{
+-	  if (idx >= domain->hash_size - incr)
+-	    idx -= domain->hash_size - incr;
+-	  else
+-	    idx += incr;
+-
+-	  nstr = W (domain->must_swap, domain->hash_tab[idx]);
+-	  if (nstr == 0)
+-	    /* Hash table entry is empty.  */
+-	    return NULL;
+-
+-	  if (W (domain->must_swap, domain->orig_tab[nstr - 1].length) == len
+-	      && strcmp (msgid,
+-			 domain->data + W (domain->must_swap,
+-					   domain->orig_tab[nstr - 1].offset))
+-	         == 0)
+-	    return (char *) domain->data
+-	      + W (domain->must_swap, domain->trans_tab[nstr - 1].offset);
+-	}
+-      /* NOTREACHED */
+-    }
+-
+-  /* Now we try the default method:  binary search in the sorted
+-     array of messages.  */
+-  bottom = 0;
+-  top = domain->nstrings;
+-  while (bottom < top)
+-    {
+-      int cmp_val;
+-
+-      act = (bottom + top) / 2;
+-      cmp_val = strcmp (msgid, domain->data
+-			       + W (domain->must_swap,
+-				    domain->orig_tab[act].offset));
+-      if (cmp_val < 0)
+-	top = act;
+-      else if (cmp_val > 0)
+-	bottom = act + 1;
+-      else
+-	break;
+-    }
+-
+-  /* If an translation is found return this.  */
+-  return bottom >= top ? NULL : (char *) domain->data
+-                                + W (domain->must_swap,
+-				     domain->trans_tab[act].offset);
+-}
+-
+-
+-/* Return string representation of locale CATEGORY.  */
+-static const char *
+-category_to_name (category)
+-     int category;
+-{
+-  const char *retval;
+-
+-  switch (category)
+-  {
+-#ifdef LC_COLLATE
+-  case LC_COLLATE:
+-    retval = "LC_COLLATE";
+-    break;
+-#endif
+-#ifdef LC_CTYPE
+-  case LC_CTYPE:
+-    retval = "LC_CTYPE";
+-    break;
+-#endif
+-#ifdef LC_MONETARY
+-  case LC_MONETARY:
+-    retval = "LC_MONETARY";
+-    break;
+-#endif
+-#ifdef LC_NUMERIC
+-  case LC_NUMERIC:
+-    retval = "LC_NUMERIC";
+-    break;
+-#endif
+-#ifdef LC_TIME
+-  case LC_TIME:
+-    retval = "LC_TIME";
+-    break;
+-#endif
+-#ifdef LC_MESSAGES
+-  case LC_MESSAGES:
+-    retval = "LC_MESSAGES";
+-    break;
+-#endif
+-#ifdef LC_RESPONSE
+-  case LC_RESPONSE:
+-    retval = "LC_RESPONSE";
+-    break;
+-#endif
+-#ifdef LC_ALL
+-  case LC_ALL:
+-    /* This might not make sense but is perhaps better than any other
+-       value.  */
+-    retval = "LC_ALL";
+-    break;
+-#endif
+-  default:
+-    /* If you have a better idea for a default value let me know.  */
+-    retval = "LC_XXX";
+-  }
+-
+-  return retval;
+-}
+-
+-/* Guess value of current locale from value of the environment variables.  */
+-static const char *
+-guess_category_value (category, categoryname)
+-     int category;
+-     const char *categoryname;
+-{
+-  const char *retval;
+-
+-  /* The highest priority value is the `LANGUAGE' environment
+-     variable.  This is a GNU extension.  */
+-  retval = getenv ("LANGUAGE");
+-  if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0')
+-    return retval;
+-
+-  /* `LANGUAGE' is not set.  So we have to proceed with the POSIX
+-     methods of looking to `LC_ALL', `LC_xxx', and `LANG'.  On some
+-     systems this can be done by the `setlocale' function itself.  */
+-#if defined HAVE_SETLOCALE && defined HAVE_LC_MESSAGES && defined HAVE_LOCALE_NULL
+-  return setlocale (category, NULL);
+-#else
+-  /* Setting of LC_ALL overwrites all other.  */
+-  retval = getenv ("LC_ALL");
+-  if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0')
+-    return retval;
+-
+-  /* Next comes the name of the desired category.  */
+-  retval = getenv (categoryname);
+-  if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0')
+-    return retval;
+-
+-  /* Last possibility is the LANG environment variable.  */
+-  retval = getenv ("LANG");
+-  if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0')
+-    return retval;
+-
+-  /* We use C as the default domain.  POSIX says this is implementation
+-     defined.  */
+-  return "C";
+-#endif
+-}
+-
+-/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */
+-
+-/* We don't want libintl.a to depend on any other library.  So we
+-   avoid the non-standard function stpcpy.  In GNU C Library this
+-   function is available, though.  Also allow the symbol HAVE_STPCPY
+-   to be defined.  */
+-#if !_LIBC && !HAVE_STPCPY
+-static char *
+-stpcpy (dest, src)
+-     char *dest;
+-     const char *src;
+-{
+-  while ((*dest++ = *src++) != '\0')
+-    /* Do nothing. */ ;
+-  return dest - 1;
+-}
+-#endif
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/dcigettext.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/dcigettext.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.369745960 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,1219 @@
++/* Implementation of the internal dcigettext function.
++   Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for mempcpy().
++   This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include
++   <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late.  */
++#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
++# define _GNU_SOURCE	1
++#endif
++
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++# include <config.h>
++#endif
++
++#include <sys/types.h>
++
++#ifdef __GNUC__
++# define alloca __builtin_alloca
++# define HAVE_ALLOCA 1
++#else
++# ifdef _MSC_VER
++#  include <malloc.h>
++#  define alloca _alloca
++# else
++#  if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC
++#   include <alloca.h>
++#  else
++#   ifdef _AIX
++ #pragma alloca
++#   else
++#    ifndef alloca
++char *alloca ();
++#    endif
++#   endif
++#  endif
++# endif
++#endif
++
++#include <errno.h>
++#ifndef errno
++extern int errno;
++#endif
++#ifndef __set_errno
++# define __set_errno(val) errno = (val)
++#endif
++
++#include <stddef.h>
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <string.h>
++
++#if defined HAVE_UNISTD_H || defined _LIBC
++# include <unistd.h>
++#endif
++
++#include <locale.h>
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++  /* Guess whether integer division by zero raises signal SIGFPE.
++     Set to 1 only if you know for sure.  In case of doubt, set to 0.  */
++# if defined __alpha__ || defined __arm__ || defined __i386__ \
++     || defined __m68k__ || defined __s390__
++#  define INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE 1
++# else
++#  define INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE 0
++# endif
++#endif
++#if !INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE
++# include <signal.h>
++#endif
++
++#if defined HAVE_SYS_PARAM_H || defined _LIBC
++# include <sys/param.h>
++#endif
++
++#include "gettextP.h"
++#include "plural-exp.h"
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# include <libintl.h>
++#else
++# include "libgnuintl.h"
++#endif
++#include "hash-string.h"
++
++/* Thread safetyness.  */
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# include <bits/libc-lock.h>
++#else
++/* Provide dummy implementation if this is outside glibc.  */
++# define __libc_lock_define_initialized(CLASS, NAME)
++# define __libc_lock_lock(NAME)
++# define __libc_lock_unlock(NAME)
++# define __libc_rwlock_define_initialized(CLASS, NAME)
++# define __libc_rwlock_rdlock(NAME)
++# define __libc_rwlock_unlock(NAME)
++#endif
++
++/* Alignment of types.  */
++#if defined __GNUC__ && __GNUC__ >= 2
++# define alignof(TYPE) __alignof__ (TYPE)
++#else
++# define alignof(TYPE) \
++    ((int) &((struct { char dummy1; TYPE dummy2; } *) 0)->dummy2)
++#endif
++
++/* The internal variables in the standalone libintl.a must have different
++   names than the internal variables in GNU libc, otherwise programs
++   using libintl.a cannot be linked statically.  */
++#if !defined _LIBC
++# define _nl_default_default_domain libintl_nl_default_default_domain
++# define _nl_current_default_domain libintl_nl_current_default_domain
++# define _nl_default_dirname libintl_nl_default_dirname
++# define _nl_domain_bindings libintl_nl_domain_bindings
++#endif
++
++/* Some compilers, like SunOS4 cc, don't have offsetof in <stddef.h>.  */
++#ifndef offsetof
++# define offsetof(type,ident) ((size_t)&(((type*)0)->ident))
++#endif
++
++/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++/* Rename the non ANSI C functions.  This is required by the standard
++   because some ANSI C functions will require linking with this object
++   file and the name space must not be polluted.  */
++# define getcwd __getcwd
++# ifndef stpcpy
++#  define stpcpy __stpcpy
++# endif
++# define tfind __tfind
++#else
++# if !defined HAVE_GETCWD
++char *getwd ();
++#  define getcwd(buf, max) getwd (buf)
++# else
++#  if VMS
++#   define getcwd(buf, max) (getcwd) (buf, max, 0)
++#  else
++char *getcwd ();
++#  endif
++# endif
++# ifndef HAVE_STPCPY
++static char *stpcpy (char *dest, const char *src);
++# endif
++# ifndef HAVE_MEMPCPY
++static void *mempcpy (void *dest, const void *src, size_t n);
++# endif
++#endif
++
++/* Amount to increase buffer size by in each try.  */
++#define PATH_INCR 32
++
++/* The following is from pathmax.h.  */
++/* Non-POSIX BSD systems might have gcc's limits.h, which doesn't define
++   PATH_MAX but might cause redefinition warnings when sys/param.h is
++   later included (as on MORE/BSD 4.3).  */
++#if defined _POSIX_VERSION || (defined HAVE_LIMITS_H && !defined __GNUC__)
++# include <limits.h>
++#endif
++
++#ifndef _POSIX_PATH_MAX
++# define _POSIX_PATH_MAX 255
++#endif
++
++#if !defined PATH_MAX && defined _PC_PATH_MAX
++# define PATH_MAX (pathconf ("/", _PC_PATH_MAX) < 1 ? 1024 : pathconf ("/", _PC_PATH_MAX))
++#endif
++
++/* Don't include sys/param.h if it already has been.  */
++#if defined HAVE_SYS_PARAM_H && !defined PATH_MAX && !defined MAXPATHLEN
++# include <sys/param.h>
++#endif
++
++#if !defined PATH_MAX && defined MAXPATHLEN
++# define PATH_MAX MAXPATHLEN
++#endif
++
++#ifndef PATH_MAX
++# define PATH_MAX _POSIX_PATH_MAX
++#endif
++
++/* Pathname support.
++   ISSLASH(C)           tests whether C is a directory separator character.
++   IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P)  tests whether P is an absolute path.  If it is not,
++                        it may be concatenated to a directory pathname.
++   IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P)  tests whether P contains a directory specification.
++ */
++#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__
++  /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */
++# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\')
++# define HAS_DEVICE(P) \
++    ((((P)[0] >= 'A' && (P)[0] <= 'Z') || ((P)[0] >= 'a' && (P)[0] <= 'z')) \
++     && (P)[1] == ':')
++# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) (ISSLASH ((P)[0]) || HAS_DEVICE (P))
++# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) \
++    (strchr (P, '/') != NULL || strchr (P, '\\') != NULL || HAS_DEVICE (P))
++#else
++  /* Unix */
++# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/')
++# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) ISSLASH ((P)[0])
++# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) (strchr (P, '/') != NULL)
++#endif
++
++/* This is the type used for the search tree where known translations
++   are stored.  */
++struct known_translation_t
++{
++  /* Domain in which to search.  */
++  char *domainname;
++
++  /* The category.  */
++  int category;
++
++  /* State of the catalog counter at the point the string was found.  */
++  int counter;
++
++  /* Catalog where the string was found.  */
++  struct loaded_l10nfile *domain;
++
++  /* And finally the translation.  */
++  const char *translation;
++  size_t translation_length;
++
++  /* Pointer to the string in question.  */
++  char msgid[ZERO];
++};
++
++/* Root of the search tree with known translations.  We can use this
++   only if the system provides the `tsearch' function family.  */
++#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC
++# include <search.h>
++
++static void *root;
++
++# ifdef _LIBC
++#  define tsearch __tsearch
++# endif
++
++/* Function to compare two entries in the table of known translations.  */
++static int
++transcmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
++{
++  const struct known_translation_t *s1;
++  const struct known_translation_t *s2;
++  int result;
++
++  s1 = (const struct known_translation_t *) p1;
++  s2 = (const struct known_translation_t *) p2;
++
++  result = strcmp (s1->msgid, s2->msgid);
++  if (result == 0)
++    {
++      result = strcmp (s1->domainname, s2->domainname);
++      if (result == 0)
++	/* We compare the category last (though this is the cheapest
++	   operation) since it is hopefully always the same (namely
++	   LC_MESSAGES).  */
++	result = s1->category - s2->category;
++    }
++
++  return result;
++}
++#endif
++
++#ifndef INTVARDEF
++# define INTVARDEF(name)
++#endif
++#ifndef INTUSE
++# define INTUSE(name) name
++#endif
++
++/* Name of the default domain used for gettext(3) prior any call to
++   textdomain(3).  The default value for this is "messages".  */
++const char _nl_default_default_domain[] attribute_hidden = "messages";
++
++/* Value used as the default domain for gettext(3).  */
++const char *_nl_current_default_domain attribute_hidden
++     = _nl_default_default_domain;
++
++/* Contains the default location of the message catalogs.  */
++#if defined __EMX__
++extern const char _nl_default_dirname[];
++#else
++const char _nl_default_dirname[] = LOCALEDIR;
++INTVARDEF (_nl_default_dirname)
++#endif
++
++/* List with bindings of specific domains created by bindtextdomain()
++   calls.  */
++struct binding *_nl_domain_bindings;
++
++/* Prototypes for local functions.  */
++static char *plural_lookup (struct loaded_l10nfile *domain,
++			    unsigned long int n,
++			    const char *translation, size_t translation_len)
++     internal_function;
++static const char *guess_category_value (int category,
++					 const char *categoryname)
++     internal_function;
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
++# define category_to_name(category)	_nl_category_names[category]
++#else
++static const char *category_to_name (int category) internal_function;
++#endif
++
++
++/* For those loosing systems which don't have `alloca' we have to add
++   some additional code emulating it.  */
++#ifdef HAVE_ALLOCA
++/* Nothing has to be done.  */
++# define freea(p) /* nothing */
++# define ADD_BLOCK(list, address) /* nothing */
++# define FREE_BLOCKS(list) /* nothing */
++#else
++struct block_list
++{
++  void *address;
++  struct block_list *next;
++};
++# define ADD_BLOCK(list, addr)						      \
++  do {									      \
++    struct block_list *newp = (struct block_list *) malloc (sizeof (*newp));  \
++    /* If we cannot get a free block we cannot add the new element to	      \
++       the list.  */							      \
++    if (newp != NULL) {							      \
++      newp->address = (addr);						      \
++      newp->next = (list);						      \
++      (list) = newp;							      \
++    }									      \
++  } while (0)
++# define FREE_BLOCKS(list)						      \
++  do {									      \
++    while (list != NULL) {						      \
++      struct block_list *old = list;					      \
++      list = list->next;						      \
++      free (old->address);						      \
++      free (old);							      \
++    }									      \
++  } while (0)
++# undef alloca
++# define alloca(size) (malloc (size))
++# define freea(p) free (p)
++#endif	/* have alloca */
++
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++/* List of blocks allocated for translations.  */
++typedef struct transmem_list
++{
++  struct transmem_list *next;
++  char data[ZERO];
++} transmem_block_t;
++static struct transmem_list *transmem_list;
++#else
++typedef unsigned char transmem_block_t;
++#endif
++
++
++/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem.  They must not clash
++   with existing names and they should follow ANSI C.  But this source
++   code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __
++   prefix.  So we have to make a difference here.  */
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# define DCIGETTEXT __dcigettext
++#else
++# define DCIGETTEXT libintl_dcigettext
++#endif
++
++/* Lock variable to protect the global data in the gettext implementation.  */
++#ifdef _LIBC
++__libc_rwlock_define_initialized (, _nl_state_lock attribute_hidden)
++#endif
++
++/* Checking whether the binaries runs SUID must be done and glibc provides
++   easier methods therefore we make a difference here.  */
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# define ENABLE_SECURE __libc_enable_secure
++# define DETERMINE_SECURE
++#else
++# ifndef HAVE_GETUID
++#  define getuid() 0
++# endif
++# ifndef HAVE_GETGID
++#  define getgid() 0
++# endif
++# ifndef HAVE_GETEUID
++#  define geteuid() getuid()
++# endif
++# ifndef HAVE_GETEGID
++#  define getegid() getgid()
++# endif
++static int enable_secure;
++# define ENABLE_SECURE (enable_secure == 1)
++# define DETERMINE_SECURE \
++  if (enable_secure == 0)						      \
++    {									      \
++      if (getuid () != geteuid () || getgid () != getegid ())		      \
++	enable_secure = 1;						      \
++      else								      \
++	enable_secure = -1;						      \
++    }
++#endif
++
++/* Get the function to evaluate the plural expression.  */
++#include "eval-plural.h"
++
++/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current
++   CATEGORY locale and, if PLURAL is nonzero, search over string
++   depending on the plural form determined by N.  */
++char *
++DCIGETTEXT (const char *domainname, const char *msgid1, const char *msgid2,
++	    int plural, unsigned long int n, int category)
++{
++#ifndef HAVE_ALLOCA
++  struct block_list *block_list = NULL;
++#endif
++  struct loaded_l10nfile *domain;
++  struct binding *binding;
++  const char *categoryname;
++  const char *categoryvalue;
++  char *dirname, *xdomainname;
++  char *single_locale;
++  char *retval;
++  size_t retlen;
++  int saved_errno;
++#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC
++  struct known_translation_t *search;
++  struct known_translation_t **foundp = NULL;
++  size_t msgid_len;
++#endif
++  size_t domainname_len;
++
++  /* If no real MSGID is given return NULL.  */
++  if (msgid1 == NULL)
++    return NULL;
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++  if (category < 0 || category >= __LC_LAST || category == LC_ALL)
++    /* Bogus.  */
++    return (plural == 0
++	    ? (char *) msgid1
++	    /* Use the Germanic plural rule.  */
++	    : n == 1 ? (char *) msgid1 : (char *) msgid2);
++#endif
++
++  __libc_rwlock_rdlock (_nl_state_lock);
++
++  /* If DOMAINNAME is NULL, we are interested in the default domain.  If
++     CATEGORY is not LC_MESSAGES this might not make much sense but the
++     definition left this undefined.  */
++  if (domainname == NULL)
++    domainname = _nl_current_default_domain;
++
++  /* OS/2 specific: backward compatibility with older libintl versions  */
++#ifdef LC_MESSAGES_COMPAT
++  if (category == LC_MESSAGES_COMPAT)
++    category = LC_MESSAGES;
++#endif
++
++#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC
++  msgid_len = strlen (msgid1) + 1;
++
++  /* Try to find the translation among those which we found at
++     some time.  */
++  search = (struct known_translation_t *)
++	   alloca (offsetof (struct known_translation_t, msgid) + msgid_len);
++  memcpy (search->msgid, msgid1, msgid_len);
++  search->domainname = (char *) domainname;
++  search->category = category;
++
++  foundp = (struct known_translation_t **) tfind (search, &root, transcmp);
++  freea (search);
++  if (foundp != NULL && (*foundp)->counter == _nl_msg_cat_cntr)
++    {
++      /* Now deal with plural.  */
++      if (plural)
++	retval = plural_lookup ((*foundp)->domain, n, (*foundp)->translation,
++				(*foundp)->translation_length);
++      else
++	retval = (char *) (*foundp)->translation;
++
++      __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock);
++      return retval;
++    }
++#endif
++
++  /* Preserve the `errno' value.  */
++  saved_errno = errno;
++
++  /* See whether this is a SUID binary or not.  */
++  DETERMINE_SECURE;
++
++  /* First find matching binding.  */
++  for (binding = _nl_domain_bindings; binding != NULL; binding = binding->next)
++    {
++      int compare = strcmp (domainname, binding->domainname);
++      if (compare == 0)
++	/* We found it!  */
++	break;
++      if (compare < 0)
++	{
++	  /* It is not in the list.  */
++	  binding = NULL;
++	  break;
++	}
++    }
++
++  if (binding == NULL)
++    dirname = (char *) INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname);
++  else if (IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (binding->dirname))
++    dirname = binding->dirname;
++  else
++    {
++      /* We have a relative path.  Make it absolute now.  */
++      size_t dirname_len = strlen (binding->dirname) + 1;
++      size_t path_max;
++      char *ret;
++
++      path_max = (unsigned int) PATH_MAX;
++      path_max += 2;		/* The getcwd docs say to do this.  */
++
++      for (;;)
++	{
++	  dirname = (char *) alloca (path_max + dirname_len);
++	  ADD_BLOCK (block_list, dirname);
++
++	  __set_errno (0);
++	  ret = getcwd (dirname, path_max);
++	  if (ret != NULL || errno != ERANGE)
++	    break;
++
++	  path_max += path_max / 2;
++	  path_max += PATH_INCR;
++	}
++
++      if (ret == NULL)
++	/* We cannot get the current working directory.  Don't signal an
++	   error but simply return the default string.  */
++	goto return_untranslated;
++
++      stpcpy (stpcpy (strchr (dirname, '\0'), "/"), binding->dirname);
++    }
++
++  /* Now determine the symbolic name of CATEGORY and its value.  */
++  categoryname = category_to_name (category);
++  categoryvalue = guess_category_value (category, categoryname);
++
++  domainname_len = strlen (domainname);
++  xdomainname = (char *) alloca (strlen (categoryname)
++				 + domainname_len + 5);
++  ADD_BLOCK (block_list, xdomainname);
++
++  stpcpy (mempcpy (stpcpy (stpcpy (xdomainname, categoryname), "/"),
++		  domainname, domainname_len),
++	  ".mo");
++
++  /* Creating working area.  */
++  single_locale = (char *) alloca (strlen (categoryvalue) + 1);
++  ADD_BLOCK (block_list, single_locale);
++
++
++  /* Search for the given string.  This is a loop because we perhaps
++     got an ordered list of languages to consider for the translation.  */
++  while (1)
++    {
++      /* Make CATEGORYVALUE point to the next element of the list.  */
++      while (categoryvalue[0] != '\0' && categoryvalue[0] == ':')
++	++categoryvalue;
++      if (categoryvalue[0] == '\0')
++	{
++	  /* The whole contents of CATEGORYVALUE has been searched but
++	     no valid entry has been found.  We solve this situation
++	     by implicitly appending a "C" entry, i.e. no translation
++	     will take place.  */
++	  single_locale[0] = 'C';
++	  single_locale[1] = '\0';
++	}
++      else
++	{
++	  char *cp = single_locale;
++	  while (categoryvalue[0] != '\0' && categoryvalue[0] != ':')
++	    *cp++ = *categoryvalue++;
++	  *cp = '\0';
++
++	  /* When this is a SUID binary we must not allow accessing files
++	     outside the dedicated directories.  */
++	  if (ENABLE_SECURE && IS_PATH_WITH_DIR (single_locale))
++	    /* Ingore this entry.  */
++	    continue;
++	}
++
++      /* If the current locale value is C (or POSIX) we don't load a
++	 domain.  Return the MSGID.  */
++      if (strcmp (single_locale, "C") == 0
++	  || strcmp (single_locale, "POSIX") == 0)
++	break;
++
++      /* Find structure describing the message catalog matching the
++	 DOMAINNAME and CATEGORY.  */
++      domain = _nl_find_domain (dirname, single_locale, xdomainname, binding);
++
++      if (domain != NULL)
++	{
++	  retval = _nl_find_msg (domain, binding, msgid1, &retlen);
++
++	  if (retval == NULL)
++	    {
++	      int cnt;
++
++	      for (cnt = 0; domain->successor[cnt] != NULL; ++cnt)
++		{
++		  retval = _nl_find_msg (domain->successor[cnt], binding,
++					 msgid1, &retlen);
++
++		  if (retval != NULL)
++		    {
++		      domain = domain->successor[cnt];
++		      break;
++		    }
++		}
++	    }
++
++	  if (retval != NULL)
++	    {
++	      /* Found the translation of MSGID1 in domain DOMAIN:
++		 starting at RETVAL, RETLEN bytes.  */
++	      FREE_BLOCKS (block_list);
++#if defined HAVE_TSEARCH || defined _LIBC
++	      if (foundp == NULL)
++		{
++		  /* Create a new entry and add it to the search tree.  */
++		  struct known_translation_t *newp;
++
++		  newp = (struct known_translation_t *)
++		    malloc (offsetof (struct known_translation_t, msgid)
++			    + msgid_len + domainname_len + 1);
++		  if (newp != NULL)
++		    {
++		      newp->domainname =
++			mempcpy (newp->msgid, msgid1, msgid_len);
++		      memcpy (newp->domainname, domainname, domainname_len + 1);
++		      newp->category = category;
++		      newp->counter = _nl_msg_cat_cntr;
++		      newp->domain = domain;
++		      newp->translation = retval;
++		      newp->translation_length = retlen;
++
++		      /* Insert the entry in the search tree.  */
++		      foundp = (struct known_translation_t **)
++			tsearch (newp, &root, transcmp);
++		      if (foundp == NULL
++			  || __builtin_expect (*foundp != newp, 0))
++			/* The insert failed.  */
++			free (newp);
++		    }
++		}
++	      else
++		{
++		  /* We can update the existing entry.  */
++		  (*foundp)->counter = _nl_msg_cat_cntr;
++		  (*foundp)->domain = domain;
++		  (*foundp)->translation = retval;
++		  (*foundp)->translation_length = retlen;
++		}
++#endif
++	      __set_errno (saved_errno);
++
++	      /* Now deal with plural.  */
++	      if (plural)
++		retval = plural_lookup (domain, n, retval, retlen);
++
++	      __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock);
++	      return retval;
++	    }
++	}
++    }
++
++ return_untranslated:
++  /* Return the untranslated MSGID.  */
++  FREE_BLOCKS (block_list);
++  __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock);
++#ifndef _LIBC
++  if (!ENABLE_SECURE)
++    {
++      extern void _nl_log_untranslated (const char *logfilename,
++					const char *domainname,
++					const char *msgid1, const char *msgid2,
++					int plural);
++      const char *logfilename = getenv ("GETTEXT_LOG_UNTRANSLATED");
++
++      if (logfilename != NULL && logfilename[0] != '\0')
++	_nl_log_untranslated (logfilename, domainname, msgid1, msgid2, plural);
++    }
++#endif
++  __set_errno (saved_errno);
++  return (plural == 0
++	  ? (char *) msgid1
++	  /* Use the Germanic plural rule.  */
++	  : n == 1 ? (char *) msgid1 : (char *) msgid2);
++}
++
++
++char *
++internal_function
++_nl_find_msg (struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file,
++	      struct binding *domainbinding, const char *msgid,
++	      size_t *lengthp)
++{
++  struct loaded_domain *domain;
++  nls_uint32 nstrings;
++  size_t act;
++  char *result;
++  size_t resultlen;
++
++  if (domain_file->decided == 0)
++    _nl_load_domain (domain_file, domainbinding);
++
++  if (domain_file->data == NULL)
++    return NULL;
++
++  domain = (struct loaded_domain *) domain_file->data;
++
++  nstrings = domain->nstrings;
++
++  /* Locate the MSGID and its translation.  */
++  if (domain->hash_tab != NULL)
++    {
++      /* Use the hashing table.  */
++      nls_uint32 len = strlen (msgid);
++      nls_uint32 hash_val = hash_string (msgid);
++      nls_uint32 idx = hash_val % domain->hash_size;
++      nls_uint32 incr = 1 + (hash_val % (domain->hash_size - 2));
++
++      while (1)
++	{
++	  nls_uint32 nstr =
++	    W (domain->must_swap_hash_tab, domain->hash_tab[idx]);
++
++	  if (nstr == 0)
++	    /* Hash table entry is empty.  */
++	    return NULL;
++
++	  nstr--;
++
++	  /* Compare msgid with the original string at index nstr.
++	     We compare the lengths with >=, not ==, because plural entries
++	     are represented by strings with an embedded NUL.  */
++	  if (nstr < nstrings
++	      ? W (domain->must_swap, domain->orig_tab[nstr].length) >= len
++		&& (strcmp (msgid,
++			    domain->data + W (domain->must_swap,
++					      domain->orig_tab[nstr].offset))
++		    == 0)
++	      : domain->orig_sysdep_tab[nstr - nstrings].length > len
++		&& (strcmp (msgid,
++			    domain->orig_sysdep_tab[nstr - nstrings].pointer)
++		    == 0))
++	    {
++	      act = nstr;
++	      goto found;
++	    }
++
++	  if (idx >= domain->hash_size - incr)
++	    idx -= domain->hash_size - incr;
++	  else
++	    idx += incr;
++	}
++      /* NOTREACHED */
++    }
++  else
++    {
++      /* Try the default method:  binary search in the sorted array of
++	 messages.  */
++      size_t top, bottom;
++
++      bottom = 0;
++      top = nstrings;
++      while (bottom < top)
++	{
++	  int cmp_val;
++
++	  act = (bottom + top) / 2;
++	  cmp_val = strcmp (msgid, (domain->data
++				    + W (domain->must_swap,
++					 domain->orig_tab[act].offset)));
++	  if (cmp_val < 0)
++	    top = act;
++	  else if (cmp_val > 0)
++	    bottom = act + 1;
++	  else
++	    goto found;
++	}
++      /* No translation was found.  */
++      return NULL;
++    }
++
++ found:
++  /* The translation was found at index ACT.  If we have to convert the
++     string to use a different character set, this is the time.  */
++  if (act < nstrings)
++    {
++      result = (char *)
++	(domain->data + W (domain->must_swap, domain->trans_tab[act].offset));
++      resultlen = W (domain->must_swap, domain->trans_tab[act].length) + 1;
++    }
++  else
++    {
++      result = (char *) domain->trans_sysdep_tab[act - nstrings].pointer;
++      resultlen = domain->trans_sysdep_tab[act - nstrings].length;
++    }
++
++#if defined _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV
++  if (domain->codeset_cntr
++      != (domainbinding != NULL ? domainbinding->codeset_cntr : 0))
++    {
++      /* The domain's codeset has changed through bind_textdomain_codeset()
++	 since the message catalog was initialized or last accessed.  We
++	 have to reinitialize the converter.  */
++      _nl_free_domain_conv (domain);
++      _nl_init_domain_conv (domain_file, domain, domainbinding);
++    }
++
++  if (
++# ifdef _LIBC
++      domain->conv != (__gconv_t) -1
++# else
++#  if HAVE_ICONV
++      domain->conv != (iconv_t) -1
++#  endif
++# endif
++      )
++    {
++      /* We are supposed to do a conversion.  First allocate an
++	 appropriate table with the same structure as the table
++	 of translations in the file, where we can put the pointers
++	 to the converted strings in.
++	 There is a slight complication with plural entries.  They
++	 are represented by consecutive NUL terminated strings.  We
++	 handle this case by converting RESULTLEN bytes, including
++	 NULs.  */
++
++      if (domain->conv_tab == NULL
++	  && ((domain->conv_tab =
++		 (char **) calloc (nstrings + domain->n_sysdep_strings,
++				   sizeof (char *)))
++	      == NULL))
++	/* Mark that we didn't succeed allocating a table.  */
++	domain->conv_tab = (char **) -1;
++
++      if (__builtin_expect (domain->conv_tab == (char **) -1, 0))
++	/* Nothing we can do, no more memory.  */
++	goto converted;
++
++      if (domain->conv_tab[act] == NULL)
++	{
++	  /* We haven't used this string so far, so it is not
++	     translated yet.  Do this now.  */
++	  /* We use a bit more efficient memory handling.
++	     We allocate always larger blocks which get used over
++	     time.  This is faster than many small allocations.   */
++	  __libc_lock_define_initialized (static, lock)
++# define INITIAL_BLOCK_SIZE	4080
++	  static unsigned char *freemem;
++	  static size_t freemem_size;
++
++	  const unsigned char *inbuf;
++	  unsigned char *outbuf;
++	  int malloc_count;
++# ifndef _LIBC
++	  transmem_block_t *transmem_list = NULL;
++# endif
++
++	  __libc_lock_lock (lock);
++
++	  inbuf = (const unsigned char *) result;
++	  outbuf = freemem + sizeof (size_t);
++
++	  malloc_count = 0;
++	  while (1)
++	    {
++	      transmem_block_t *newmem;
++# ifdef _LIBC
++	      size_t non_reversible;
++	      int res;
++
++	      if (freemem_size < sizeof (size_t))
++		goto resize_freemem;
++
++	      res = __gconv (domain->conv,
++			     &inbuf, inbuf + resultlen,
++			     &outbuf,
++			     outbuf + freemem_size - sizeof (size_t),
++			     &non_reversible);
++
++	      if (res == __GCONV_OK || res == __GCONV_EMPTY_INPUT)
++		break;
++
++	      if (res != __GCONV_FULL_OUTPUT)
++		{
++		  __libc_lock_unlock (lock);
++		  goto converted;
++		}
++
++	      inbuf = result;
++# else
++#  if HAVE_ICONV
++	      const char *inptr = (const char *) inbuf;
++	      size_t inleft = resultlen;
++	      char *outptr = (char *) outbuf;
++	      size_t outleft;
++
++	      if (freemem_size < sizeof (size_t))
++		goto resize_freemem;
++
++	      outleft = freemem_size - sizeof (size_t);
++	      if (iconv (domain->conv,
++			 (ICONV_CONST char **) &inptr, &inleft,
++			 &outptr, &outleft)
++		  != (size_t) (-1))
++		{
++		  outbuf = (unsigned char *) outptr;
++		  break;
++		}
++	      if (errno != E2BIG)
++		{
++		  __libc_lock_unlock (lock);
++		  goto converted;
++		}
++#  endif
++# endif
++
++	    resize_freemem:
++	      /* We must allocate a new buffer or resize the old one.  */
++	      if (malloc_count > 0)
++		{
++		  ++malloc_count;
++		  freemem_size = malloc_count * INITIAL_BLOCK_SIZE;
++		  newmem = (transmem_block_t *) realloc (transmem_list,
++							 freemem_size);
++# ifdef _LIBC
++		  if (newmem != NULL)
++		    transmem_list = transmem_list->next;
++		  else
++		    {
++		      struct transmem_list *old = transmem_list;
++
++		      transmem_list = transmem_list->next;
++		      free (old);
++		    }
++# endif
++		}
++	      else
++		{
++		  malloc_count = 1;
++		  freemem_size = INITIAL_BLOCK_SIZE;
++		  newmem = (transmem_block_t *) malloc (freemem_size);
++		}
++	      if (__builtin_expect (newmem == NULL, 0))
++		{
++		  freemem = NULL;
++		  freemem_size = 0;
++		  __libc_lock_unlock (lock);
++		  goto converted;
++		}
++
++# ifdef _LIBC
++	      /* Add the block to the list of blocks we have to free
++                 at some point.  */
++	      newmem->next = transmem_list;
++	      transmem_list = newmem;
++
++	      freemem = newmem->data;
++	      freemem_size -= offsetof (struct transmem_list, data);
++# else
++	      transmem_list = newmem;
++	      freemem = newmem;
++# endif
++
++	      outbuf = freemem + sizeof (size_t);
++	    }
++
++	  /* We have now in our buffer a converted string.  Put this
++	     into the table of conversions.  */
++	  *(size_t *) freemem = outbuf - freemem - sizeof (size_t);
++	  domain->conv_tab[act] = (char *) freemem;
++	  /* Shrink freemem, but keep it aligned.  */
++	  freemem_size -= outbuf - freemem;
++	  freemem = outbuf;
++	  freemem += freemem_size & (alignof (size_t) - 1);
++	  freemem_size = freemem_size & ~ (alignof (size_t) - 1);
++
++	  __libc_lock_unlock (lock);
++	}
++
++      /* Now domain->conv_tab[act] contains the translation of all
++	 the plural variants.  */
++      result = domain->conv_tab[act] + sizeof (size_t);
++      resultlen = *(size_t *) domain->conv_tab[act];
++    }
++
++ converted:
++  /* The result string is converted.  */
++
++#endif /* _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV */
++
++  *lengthp = resultlen;
++  return result;
++}
++
++
++/* Look up a plural variant.  */
++static char *
++internal_function
++plural_lookup (struct loaded_l10nfile *domain, unsigned long int n,
++	       const char *translation, size_t translation_len)
++{
++  struct loaded_domain *domaindata = (struct loaded_domain *) domain->data;
++  unsigned long int index;
++  const char *p;
++
++  index = plural_eval (domaindata->plural, n);
++  if (index >= domaindata->nplurals)
++    /* This should never happen.  It means the plural expression and the
++       given maximum value do not match.  */
++    index = 0;
++
++  /* Skip INDEX strings at TRANSLATION.  */
++  p = translation;
++  while (index-- > 0)
++    {
++#ifdef _LIBC
++      p = __rawmemchr (p, '\0');
++#else
++      p = strchr (p, '\0');
++#endif
++      /* And skip over the NUL byte.  */
++      p++;
++
++      if (p >= translation + translation_len)
++	/* This should never happen.  It means the plural expression
++	   evaluated to a value larger than the number of variants
++	   available for MSGID1.  */
++	return (char *) translation;
++    }
++  return (char *) p;
++}
++
++#ifndef _LIBC
++/* Return string representation of locale CATEGORY.  */
++static const char *
++internal_function
++category_to_name (int category)
++{
++  const char *retval;
++
++  switch (category)
++  {
++#ifdef LC_COLLATE
++  case LC_COLLATE:
++    retval = "LC_COLLATE";
++    break;
++#endif
++#ifdef LC_CTYPE
++  case LC_CTYPE:
++    retval = "LC_CTYPE";
++    break;
++#endif
++#ifdef LC_MONETARY
++  case LC_MONETARY:
++    retval = "LC_MONETARY";
++    break;
++#endif
++#ifdef LC_NUMERIC
++  case LC_NUMERIC:
++    retval = "LC_NUMERIC";
++    break;
++#endif
++#ifdef LC_TIME
++  case LC_TIME:
++    retval = "LC_TIME";
++    break;
++#endif
++#ifdef LC_MESSAGES
++  case LC_MESSAGES:
++    retval = "LC_MESSAGES";
++    break;
++#endif
++#ifdef LC_RESPONSE
++  case LC_RESPONSE:
++    retval = "LC_RESPONSE";
++    break;
++#endif
++#ifdef LC_ALL
++  case LC_ALL:
++    /* This might not make sense but is perhaps better than any other
++       value.  */
++    retval = "LC_ALL";
++    break;
++#endif
++  default:
++    /* If you have a better idea for a default value let me know.  */
++    retval = "LC_XXX";
++  }
++
++  return retval;
++}
++#endif
++
++/* Guess value of current locale from value of the environment variables.  */
++static const char *
++internal_function
++guess_category_value (int category, const char *categoryname)
++{
++  const char *language;
++  const char *retval;
++
++  /* The highest priority value is the `LANGUAGE' environment
++     variable.  But we don't use the value if the currently selected
++     locale is the C locale.  This is a GNU extension.  */
++  language = getenv ("LANGUAGE");
++  if (language != NULL && language[0] == '\0')
++    language = NULL;
++
++  /* We have to proceed with the POSIX methods of looking to `LC_ALL',
++     `LC_xxx', and `LANG'.  On some systems this can be done by the
++     `setlocale' function itself.  */
++#ifdef _LIBC
++  retval = __current_locale_name (category);
++#else
++  retval = _nl_locale_name (category, categoryname);
++#endif
++
++  /* Ignore LANGUAGE if the locale is set to "C" because
++     1. "C" locale usually uses the ASCII encoding, and most international
++	messages use non-ASCII characters. These characters get displayed
++	as question marks (if using glibc's iconv()) or as invalid 8-bit
++	characters (because other iconv()s refuse to convert most non-ASCII
++	characters to ASCII). In any case, the output is ugly.
++     2. The precise output of some programs in the "C" locale is specified
++	by POSIX and should not depend on environment variables like
++	"LANGUAGE".  We allow such programs to use gettext().  */
++  return language != NULL && strcmp (retval, "C") != 0 ? language : retval;
++}
++
++/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */
++
++/* We don't want libintl.a to depend on any other library.  So we
++   avoid the non-standard function stpcpy.  In GNU C Library this
++   function is available, though.  Also allow the symbol HAVE_STPCPY
++   to be defined.  */
++#if !_LIBC && !HAVE_STPCPY
++static char *
++stpcpy (char *dest, const char *src)
++{
++  while ((*dest++ = *src++) != '\0')
++    /* Do nothing. */ ;
++  return dest - 1;
++}
++#endif
++
++#if !_LIBC && !HAVE_MEMPCPY
++static void *
++mempcpy (void *dest, const void *src, size_t n)
++{
++  return (void *) ((char *) memcpy (dest, src, n) + n);
++}
++#endif
++
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++/* If we want to free all resources we have to do some work at
++   program's end.  */
++libc_freeres_fn (free_mem)
++{
++  void *old;
++
++  while (_nl_domain_bindings != NULL)
++    {
++      struct binding *oldp = _nl_domain_bindings;
++      _nl_domain_bindings = _nl_domain_bindings->next;
++      if (oldp->dirname != INTUSE(_nl_default_dirname))
++	/* Yes, this is a pointer comparison.  */
++	free (oldp->dirname);
++      free (oldp->codeset);
++      free (oldp);
++    }
++
++  if (_nl_current_default_domain != _nl_default_default_domain)
++    /* Yes, again a pointer comparison.  */
++    free ((char *) _nl_current_default_domain);
++
++  /* Remove the search tree with the known translations.  */
++  __tdestroy (root, free);
++  root = NULL;
++
++  while (transmem_list != NULL)
++    {
++      old = transmem_list;
++      transmem_list = transmem_list->next;
++      free (old);
++    }
++}
++#endif
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/dcngettext.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/dcngettext.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.375745048 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,57 @@
++/* Implementation of the dcngettext(3) function.
++   Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++# include <config.h>
++#endif
++
++#include "gettextP.h"
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# include <libintl.h>
++#else
++# include "libgnuintl.h"
++#endif
++
++/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
++
++/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem.  They must not clash
++   with existing names and they should follow ANSI C.  But this source
++   code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __
++   prefix.  So we have to make a difference here.  */
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# define DCNGETTEXT __dcngettext
++# define DCIGETTEXT __dcigettext
++#else
++# define DCNGETTEXT libintl_dcngettext
++# define DCIGETTEXT libintl_dcigettext
++#endif
++
++/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current CATEGORY
++   locale.  */
++char *
++DCNGETTEXT (const char *domainname,
++	    const char *msgid1, const char *msgid2, unsigned long int n,
++	    int category)
++{
++  return DCIGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, 1, n, category);
++}
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library.  */
++weak_alias (__dcngettext, dcngettext);
++#endif
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/dgettext.c	1998-04-26 09:20:52.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/dgettext.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.380744288 -0400
+@@ -1,32 +1,33 @@
+-/* dgettext.c -- implementation of the dgettext(3) function
+-   Copyright (C) 1995 Software Foundation, Inc.
++/* Implementation of the dgettext(3) function.
++   Copyright (C) 1995-1997, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ 
+-This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+-any later version.
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
+ 
+-This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-GNU General Public License for more details.
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
+ 
+-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+-Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
+ 
+ #ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+ # include <config.h>
+ #endif
+ 
+-#if defined HAVE_LOCALE_H || defined _LIBC
+-# include <locale.h>
+-#endif
++#include "gettextP.h"
++
++#include <locale.h>
+ 
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+ # include <libintl.h>
+ #else
+-# include "libgettext.h"
++# include "libgnuintl.h"
+ #endif
+ 
+ /* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+@@ -37,18 +38,16 @@
+    prefix.  So we have to make a difference here.  */
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+ # define DGETTEXT __dgettext
+-# define DCGETTEXT __dcgettext
++# define DCGETTEXT INTUSE(__dcgettext)
+ #else
+-# define DGETTEXT dgettext__
+-# define DCGETTEXT dcgettext__
++# define DGETTEXT libintl_dgettext
++# define DCGETTEXT libintl_dcgettext
+ #endif
+ 
+ /* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog of the current
+    LC_MESSAGES locale.  */
+ char *
+-DGETTEXT (domainname, msgid)
+-     const char *domainname;
+-     const char *msgid;
++DGETTEXT (const char *domainname, const char *msgid)
+ {
+   return DCGETTEXT (domainname, msgid, LC_MESSAGES);
+ }
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/dngettext.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/dngettext.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.385743528 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,59 @@
++/* Implementation of the dngettext(3) function.
++   Copyright (C) 1995-1997, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++# include <config.h>
++#endif
++
++#include "gettextP.h"
++
++#include <locale.h>
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# include <libintl.h>
++#else
++# include "libgnuintl.h"
++#endif
++
++/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
++
++/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem.  They must not clash
++   with existing names and they should follow ANSI C.  But this source
++   code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __
++   prefix.  So we have to make a difference here.  */
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# define DNGETTEXT __dngettext
++# define DCNGETTEXT __dcngettext
++#else
++# define DNGETTEXT libintl_dngettext
++# define DCNGETTEXT libintl_dcngettext
++#endif
++
++/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog of the current
++   LC_MESSAGES locale and skip message according to the plural form.  */
++char *
++DNGETTEXT (const char *domainname,
++	   const char *msgid1, const char *msgid2, unsigned long int n)
++{
++  return DCNGETTEXT (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n, LC_MESSAGES);
++}
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library.  */
++weak_alias (__dngettext, dngettext);
++#endif
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/eval-plural.h	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/eval-plural.h	2004-09-12 14:40:34.390742768 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,108 @@
++/* Plural expression evaluation.
++   Copyright (C) 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifndef STATIC
++#define STATIC static
++#endif
++
++/* Evaluate the plural expression and return an index value.  */
++STATIC
++unsigned long int
++internal_function
++plural_eval (struct expression *pexp, unsigned long int n)
++{
++  switch (pexp->nargs)
++    {
++    case 0:
++      switch (pexp->operation)
++	{
++	case var:
++	  return n;
++	case num:
++	  return pexp->val.num;
++	default:
++	  break;
++	}
++      /* NOTREACHED */
++      break;
++    case 1:
++      {
++	/* pexp->operation must be lnot.  */
++	unsigned long int arg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[0], n);
++	return ! arg;
++      }
++    case 2:
++      {
++	unsigned long int leftarg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[0], n);
++	if (pexp->operation == lor)
++	  return leftarg || plural_eval (pexp->val.args[1], n);
++	else if (pexp->operation == land)
++	  return leftarg && plural_eval (pexp->val.args[1], n);
++	else
++	  {
++	    unsigned long int rightarg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[1], n);
++
++	    switch (pexp->operation)
++	      {
++	      case mult:
++		return leftarg * rightarg;
++	      case divide:
++#if !INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE
++		if (rightarg == 0)
++		  raise (SIGFPE);
++#endif
++		return leftarg / rightarg;
++	      case module:
++#if !INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE
++		if (rightarg == 0)
++		  raise (SIGFPE);
++#endif
++		return leftarg % rightarg;
++	      case plus:
++		return leftarg + rightarg;
++	      case minus:
++		return leftarg - rightarg;
++	      case less_than:
++		return leftarg < rightarg;
++	      case greater_than:
++		return leftarg > rightarg;
++	      case less_or_equal:
++		return leftarg <= rightarg;
++	      case greater_or_equal:
++		return leftarg >= rightarg;
++	      case equal:
++		return leftarg == rightarg;
++	      case not_equal:
++		return leftarg != rightarg;
++	      default:
++		break;
++	      }
++	  }
++	/* NOTREACHED */
++	break;
++      }
++    case 3:
++      {
++	/* pexp->operation must be qmop.  */
++	unsigned long int boolarg = plural_eval (pexp->val.args[0], n);
++	return plural_eval (pexp->val.args[boolarg ? 1 : 2], n);
++      }
++    }
++  /* NOTREACHED */
++  return 0;
++}
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/explodename.c	1998-04-26 09:22:37.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/explodename.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.395742008 -0400
+@@ -1,19 +1,20 @@
+-/* Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++/* Copyright (C) 1995-1998, 2000-2001, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+    Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1995.
+ 
+-   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+    any later version.
+ 
+    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-   GNU General Public License for more details.
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
+ 
+-   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+-   Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
+ 
+ #ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+ # include <config.h>
+@@ -36,18 +37,23 @@
+ 
+ /* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+ 
++char *
++_nl_find_language (const char *name)
++{
++  while (name[0] != '\0' && name[0] != '_' && name[0] != '@'
++	 && name[0] != '+' && name[0] != ',')
++    ++name;
++
++  return (char *) name;
++}
++
++
+ int
+-_nl_explode_name (name, language, modifier, territory, codeset,
+-		  normalized_codeset, special, sponsor, revision)
+-     char *name;
+-     const char **language;
+-     const char **modifier;
+-     const char **territory;
+-     const char **codeset;
+-     const char **normalized_codeset;
+-     const char **special;
+-     const char **sponsor;
+-     const char **revision;
++_nl_explode_name (char *name,
++		  const char **language, const char **modifier,
++		  const char **territory, const char **codeset,
++		  const char **normalized_codeset, const char **special,
++		  const char **sponsor, const char **revision)
+ {
+   enum { undecided, xpg, cen } syntax;
+   char *cp;
+@@ -67,9 +73,7 @@
+   mask = 0;
+   syntax = undecided;
+   *language = cp = name;
+-  while (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '_' && cp[0] != '@'
+-	 && cp[0] != '+' && cp[0] != ',')
+-    ++cp;
++  cp = _nl_find_language (*language);
+ 
+   if (*language == cp)
+     /* This does not make sense: language has to be specified.  Use
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/finddomain.c	1998-04-26 09:22:36.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/finddomain.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.415738968 -0400
+@@ -1,64 +1,40 @@
+ /* Handle list of needed message catalogs
+-   Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+-   Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1995.
++   Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2001, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++   Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.org>, 1995.
+ 
+-   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+    any later version.
+ 
+    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-   GNU General Public License for more details.
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
+ 
+-   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+-   Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
+ 
+ #ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+ # include <config.h>
+ #endif
+ 
+-#include <ctype.h>
+-#include <errno.h>
+ #include <stdio.h>
+ #include <sys/types.h>
+-
+-#if defined STDC_HEADERS || defined _LIBC
+-# include <stdlib.h>
+-#else
+-# ifdef HAVE_MALLOC_H
+-#  include <malloc.h>
+-# else
+-void free ();
+-# endif
+-#endif
+-
+-#if defined HAVE_STRING_H || defined _LIBC
+-# include <string.h>
+-#else
+-# include <strings.h>
+-# ifndef memcpy
+-#  define memcpy(Dst, Src, Num) bcopy (Src, Dst, Num)
+-# endif
+-#endif
+-#if !HAVE_STRCHR && !defined _LIBC
+-# ifndef strchr
+-#  define strchr index
+-# endif
+-#endif
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <string.h>
+ 
+ #if defined HAVE_UNISTD_H || defined _LIBC
+ # include <unistd.h>
+ #endif
+ 
+-#include "gettext.h"
+ #include "gettextP.h"
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+ # include <libintl.h>
+ #else
+-# include "libgettext.h"
++# include "libgnuintl.h"
+ #endif
+ 
+ /* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+@@ -70,10 +46,9 @@
+    the DOMAINNAME and CATEGORY parameters with respect to the currently
+    established bindings.  */
+ struct loaded_l10nfile *
+-_nl_find_domain (dirname, locale, domainname)
+-     const char *dirname;
+-     char *locale;
+-     const char *domainname;
++internal_function
++_nl_find_domain (const char *dirname, char *locale,
++		 const char *domainname, struct binding *domainbinding)
+ {
+   struct loaded_l10nfile *retval;
+   const char *language;
+@@ -95,9 +70,9 @@
+ 
+ 	language[_territory][+audience][+special][,[sponsor][_revision]]
+ 
+-     Beside the first all of them are allowed to be missing.  If the
+-     full specified locale is not found, the less specific one are
+-     looked for.  The various part will be stripped of according to
++     Beside the first part all of them are allowed to be missing.  If
++     the full specified locale is not found, the less specific one are
++     looked for.  The various parts will be stripped off according to
+      the following order:
+ 		(1) revision
+ 		(2) sponsor
+@@ -119,7 +94,7 @@
+       int cnt;
+ 
+       if (retval->decided == 0)
+-	_nl_load_domain (retval);
++	_nl_load_domain (retval, domainbinding);
+ 
+       if (retval->data != NULL)
+ 	return retval;
+@@ -127,7 +102,7 @@
+       for (cnt = 0; retval->successor[cnt] != NULL; ++cnt)
+ 	{
+ 	  if (retval->successor[cnt]->decided == 0)
+-	    _nl_load_domain (retval->successor[cnt]);
++	    _nl_load_domain (retval->successor[cnt], domainbinding);
+ 
+ 	  if (retval->successor[cnt]->data != NULL)
+ 	    break;
+@@ -142,12 +117,18 @@
+   alias_value = _nl_expand_alias (locale);
+   if (alias_value != NULL)
+     {
++#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP
++      locale = strdup (alias_value);
++      if (locale == NULL)
++	return NULL;
++#else
+       size_t len = strlen (alias_value) + 1;
+       locale = (char *) malloc (len);
+       if (locale == NULL)
+ 	return NULL;
+ 
+       memcpy (locale, alias_value, len);
++#endif
+     }
+ 
+   /* Now we determine the single parts of the locale name.  First
+@@ -168,14 +149,14 @@
+     return NULL;
+ 
+   if (retval->decided == 0)
+-    _nl_load_domain (retval);
++    _nl_load_domain (retval, domainbinding);
+   if (retval->data == NULL)
+     {
+       int cnt;
+       for (cnt = 0; retval->successor[cnt] != NULL; ++cnt)
+ 	{
+ 	  if (retval->successor[cnt]->decided == 0)
+-	    _nl_load_domain (retval->successor[cnt]);
++	    _nl_load_domain (retval->successor[cnt], domainbinding);
+ 	  if (retval->successor[cnt]->data != NULL)
+ 	    break;
+ 	}
+@@ -185,5 +166,27 @@
+   if (alias_value != NULL)
+     free (locale);
+ 
++  /* The space for normalized_codeset is dynamically allocated.  Free it.  */
++  if (mask & XPG_NORM_CODESET)
++    free ((void *) normalized_codeset);
++
+   return retval;
+ }
++
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++libc_freeres_fn (free_mem)
++{
++  struct loaded_l10nfile *runp = _nl_loaded_domains;
++
++  while (runp != NULL)
++    {
++      struct loaded_l10nfile *here = runp;
++      if (runp->data != NULL)
++	_nl_unload_domain ((struct loaded_domain *) runp->data);
++      runp = runp->next;
++      free ((char *) here->filename);
++      free (here);
++    }
++}
++#endif
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/gettext.c	1998-04-26 09:22:36.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/gettext.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.420738208 -0400
+@@ -1,19 +1,20 @@
+-/* Implementation of gettext(3) function
+-   Copyright (C) 1995, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++/* Implementation of gettext(3) function.
++   Copyright (C) 1995, 1997, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ 
+-   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+    any later version.
+ 
+    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-   GNU General Public License for more details.
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
+ 
+-   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+-   Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
+ 
+ #ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+ # include <config.h>
+@@ -23,21 +24,14 @@
+ # define __need_NULL
+ # include <stddef.h>
+ #else
+-# ifdef STDC_HEADERS
+-#  include <stdlib.h>		/* Just for NULL.  */
+-# else
+-#  ifdef HAVE_STRING_H
+-#   include <string.h>
+-#  else
+-#   define NULL ((void *) 0)
+-#  endif
+-# endif
++# include <stdlib.h>		/* Just for NULL.  */
+ #endif
+ 
++#include "gettextP.h"
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+ # include <libintl.h>
+ #else
+-# include "libgettext.h"
++# include "libgnuintl.h"
+ #endif
+ 
+ /* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+@@ -48,20 +42,19 @@
+    prefix.  So we have to make a difference here.  */
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+ # define GETTEXT __gettext
+-# define DGETTEXT __dgettext
++# define DCGETTEXT INTUSE(__dcgettext)
+ #else
+-# define GETTEXT gettext__
+-# define DGETTEXT dgettext__
++# define GETTEXT libintl_gettext
++# define DCGETTEXT libintl_dcgettext
+ #endif
+ 
+ /* Look up MSGID in the current default message catalog for the current
+    LC_MESSAGES locale.  If not found, returns MSGID itself (the default
+    text).  */
+ char *
+-GETTEXT (msgid)
+-     const char *msgid;
++GETTEXT (const char *msgid)
+ {
+-  return DGETTEXT (NULL, msgid);
++  return DCGETTEXT (NULL, msgid, LC_MESSAGES);
+ }
+ 
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/gettext.h	1998-04-26 09:22:35.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/gettext.h	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
+@@ -1,105 +0,0 @@
+-/* Internal header for GNU gettext internationalization functions
+-   Copyright (C) 1995, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+-
+-   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+-   any later version.
+-
+-   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+-   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-   GNU General Public License for more details.
+-
+-   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+-   License along with the GNU C Library; see the file COPYING.LIB.  If not,
+-   write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
+-   Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
+-
+-#ifndef _GETTEXT_H
+-#define _GETTEXT_H 1
+-
+-#include <stdio.h>
+-
+-#if HAVE_LIMITS_H || _LIBC
+-# include <limits.h>
+-#endif
+-
+-/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+-
+-/* The magic number of the GNU message catalog format.  */
+-#define _MAGIC 0x950412de
+-#define _MAGIC_SWAPPED 0xde120495
+-
+-/* Revision number of the currently used .mo (binary) file format.  */
+-#define MO_REVISION_NUMBER 0
+-
+-/* The following contortions are an attempt to use the C preprocessor
+-   to determine an unsigned integral type that is 32 bits wide.  An
+-   alternative approach is to use autoconf's AC_CHECK_SIZEOF macro, but
+-   doing that would require that the configure script compile and *run*
+-   the resulting executable.  Locally running cross-compiled executables
+-   is usually not possible.  */
+-
+-#if __STDC__
+-# define UINT_MAX_32_BITS 4294967295U
+-#else
+-# define UINT_MAX_32_BITS 0xFFFFFFFF
+-#endif
+-
+-/* If UINT_MAX isn't defined, assume it's a 32-bit type.
+-   This should be valid for all systems GNU cares about because
+-   that doesn't include 16-bit systems, and only modern systems
+-   (that certainly have <limits.h>) have 64+-bit integral types.  */
+-
+-#ifndef UINT_MAX
+-# define UINT_MAX UINT_MAX_32_BITS
+-#endif
+-
+-#if UINT_MAX == UINT_MAX_32_BITS
+-typedef unsigned nls_uint32;
+-#else
+-# if USHRT_MAX == UINT_MAX_32_BITS
+-typedef unsigned short nls_uint32;
+-# else
+-#  if ULONG_MAX == UINT_MAX_32_BITS
+-typedef unsigned long nls_uint32;
+-#  else
+-  /* The following line is intended to throw an error.  Using #error is
+-     not portable enough.  */
+-  "Cannot determine unsigned 32-bit data type."
+-#  endif
+-# endif
+-#endif
+-
+-
+-/* Header for binary .mo file format.  */
+-struct mo_file_header
+-{
+-  /* The magic number.  */
+-  nls_uint32 magic;
+-  /* The revision number of the file format.  */
+-  nls_uint32 revision;
+-  /* The number of strings pairs.  */
+-  nls_uint32 nstrings;
+-  /* Offset of table with start offsets of original strings.  */
+-  nls_uint32 orig_tab_offset;
+-  /* Offset of table with start offsets of translation strings.  */
+-  nls_uint32 trans_tab_offset;
+-  /* Size of hashing table.  */
+-  nls_uint32 hash_tab_size;
+-  /* Offset of first hashing entry.  */
+-  nls_uint32 hash_tab_offset;
+-};
+-
+-struct string_desc
+-{
+-  /* Length of addressed string.  */
+-  nls_uint32 length;
+-  /* Offset of string in file.  */
+-  nls_uint32 offset;
+-};
+-
+-/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */
+-
+-#endif	/* gettext.h  */
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/gettextP.h	1998-04-26 09:22:35.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/gettextP.h	2004-09-12 14:40:34.426737296 -0400
+@@ -1,33 +1,53 @@
+-/* Header describing internals of gettext library
+-   Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++/* Header describing internals of libintl library.
++   Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++   Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995.
+ 
+-   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+    any later version.
+ 
+    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-   GNU General Public License for more details.
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
+ 
+-   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+-   Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
+ 
+ #ifndef _GETTEXTP_H
+ #define _GETTEXTP_H
+ 
++#include <stddef.h>		/* Get size_t.  */
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# include "../iconv/gconv_int.h"
++#else
++# if HAVE_ICONV
++#  include <iconv.h>
++# endif
++#endif
++
+ #include "loadinfo.h"
+ 
++#include "gmo.h"		/* Get nls_uint32.  */
++
+ /* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+ 
+-#ifndef PARAMS
+-# if __STDC__
+-#  define PARAMS(args) args
+-# else
+-#  define PARAMS(args) ()
+-# endif
++#ifndef internal_function
++# define internal_function
++#endif
++
++#ifndef attribute_hidden
++# define attribute_hidden
++#endif
++
++/* Tell the compiler when a conditional or integer expression is
++   almost always true or almost always false.  */
++#ifndef HAVE_BUILTIN_EXPECT
++# define __builtin_expect(expr, val) (expr)
+ #endif
+ 
+ #ifndef W
+@@ -35,38 +55,160 @@
+ #endif
+ 
+ 
+-static nls_uint32 SWAP PARAMS ((nls_uint32 i));
+-
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# include <byteswap.h>
++# define SWAP(i) bswap_32 (i)
++#else
+ static inline nls_uint32
+ SWAP (i)
+      nls_uint32 i;
+ {
+   return (i << 24) | ((i & 0xff00) << 8) | ((i >> 8) & 0xff00) | (i >> 24);
+ }
++#endif
++
+ 
++/* In-memory representation of system dependent string.  */
++struct sysdep_string_desc
++{
++  /* Length of addressed string, including the trailing NUL.  */
++  size_t length;
++  /* Pointer to addressed string.  */
++  const char *pointer;
++};
+ 
++/* The representation of an opened message catalog.  */
+ struct loaded_domain
+ {
++  /* Pointer to memory containing the .mo file.  */
+   const char *data;
++  /* 1 if the memory is mmap()ed, 0 if the memory is malloc()ed.  */
++  int use_mmap;
++  /* Size of mmap()ed memory.  */
++  size_t mmap_size;
++  /* 1 if the .mo file uses a different endianness than this machine.  */
+   int must_swap;
++  /* Pointer to additional malloc()ed memory.  */
++  void *malloced;
++
++  /* Number of static strings pairs.  */
+   nls_uint32 nstrings;
+-  struct string_desc *orig_tab;
+-  struct string_desc *trans_tab;
++  /* Pointer to descriptors of original strings in the file.  */
++  const struct string_desc *orig_tab;
++  /* Pointer to descriptors of translated strings in the file.  */
++  const struct string_desc *trans_tab;
++
++  /* Number of system dependent strings pairs.  */
++  nls_uint32 n_sysdep_strings;
++  /* Pointer to descriptors of original sysdep strings.  */
++  const struct sysdep_string_desc *orig_sysdep_tab;
++  /* Pointer to descriptors of translated sysdep strings.  */
++  const struct sysdep_string_desc *trans_sysdep_tab;
++
++  /* Size of hash table.  */
+   nls_uint32 hash_size;
+-  nls_uint32 *hash_tab;
++  /* Pointer to hash table.  */
++  const nls_uint32 *hash_tab;
++  /* 1 if the hash table uses a different endianness than this machine.  */
++  int must_swap_hash_tab;
++
++  int codeset_cntr;
++#ifdef _LIBC
++  __gconv_t conv;
++#else
++# if HAVE_ICONV
++  iconv_t conv;
++# endif
++#endif
++  char **conv_tab;
++
++  struct expression *plural;
++  unsigned long int nplurals;
+ };
+ 
++/* We want to allocate a string at the end of the struct.  But ISO C
++   doesn't allow zero sized arrays.  */
++#ifdef __GNUC__
++# define ZERO 0
++#else
++# define ZERO 1
++#endif
++
++/* A set of settings bound to a message domain.  Used to store settings
++   from bindtextdomain() and bind_textdomain_codeset().  */
+ struct binding
+ {
+   struct binding *next;
+-  char *domainname;
+   char *dirname;
++  int codeset_cntr;	/* Incremented each time codeset changes.  */
++  char *codeset;
++  char domainname[ZERO];
+ };
+ 
+-struct loaded_l10nfile *_nl_find_domain PARAMS ((const char *__dirname,
+-						 char *__locale,
+-						 const char *__domainname));
+-void _nl_load_domain PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile *__domain));
++/* A counter which is incremented each time some previous translations
++   become invalid.
++   This variable is part of the external ABI of the GNU libintl.  */
++extern int _nl_msg_cat_cntr;
++
++#ifndef _LIBC
++const char *_nl_locale_name (int category, const char *categoryname);
++#endif
++
++struct loaded_l10nfile *_nl_find_domain (const char *__dirname, char *__locale,
++					 const char *__domainname,
++					 struct binding *__domainbinding)
++     internal_function;
++void _nl_load_domain (struct loaded_l10nfile *__domain,
++		      struct binding *__domainbinding)
++     internal_function;
++void _nl_unload_domain (struct loaded_domain *__domain)
++     internal_function;
++const char *_nl_init_domain_conv (struct loaded_l10nfile *__domain_file,
++				  struct loaded_domain *__domain,
++				  struct binding *__domainbinding)
++     internal_function;
++void _nl_free_domain_conv (struct loaded_domain *__domain)
++     internal_function;
++
++char *_nl_find_msg (struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file,
++		    struct binding *domainbinding, const char *msgid,
++		    size_t *lengthp)
++     internal_function;
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++extern char *__gettext (const char *__msgid);
++extern char *__dgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid);
++extern char *__dcgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid,
++			  int __category);
++extern char *__ngettext (const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
++			 unsigned long int __n);
++extern char *__dngettext (const char *__domainname,
++			  const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
++			  unsigned long int n);
++extern char *__dcngettext (const char *__domainname,
++			   const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
++			   unsigned long int __n, int __category);
++extern char *__dcigettext (const char *__domainname,
++			   const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
++			   int __plural, unsigned long int __n,
++			   int __category);
++extern char *__textdomain (const char *__domainname);
++extern char *__bindtextdomain (const char *__domainname,
++			       const char *__dirname);
++extern char *__bind_textdomain_codeset (const char *__domainname,
++					const char *__codeset);
++#else
++/* Declare the exported libintl_* functions, in a way that allows us to
++   call them under their real name.  */
++# undef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
++# undef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
++# define _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
++# include "libgnuintl.h"
++extern char *libintl_dcigettext (const char *__domainname,
++				 const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
++				 int __plural, unsigned long int __n,
++				 int __category);
++#endif
+ 
+ /* @@ begin of epilog @@ */
+ 
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/gmo.h	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/gmo.h	2004-09-12 14:40:34.431736536 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,149 @@
++/* Description of GNU message catalog format: general file layout.
++   Copyright (C) 1995, 1997, 2000-2002, 2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifndef _GETTEXT_H
++#define _GETTEXT_H 1
++
++#include <limits.h>
++
++/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
++
++/* The magic number of the GNU message catalog format.  */
++#define _MAGIC 0x950412de
++#define _MAGIC_SWAPPED 0xde120495
++
++/* Revision number of the currently used .mo (binary) file format.  */
++#define MO_REVISION_NUMBER 0
++#define MO_REVISION_NUMBER_WITH_SYSDEP_I 1
++
++/* The following contortions are an attempt to use the C preprocessor
++   to determine an unsigned integral type that is 32 bits wide.  An
++   alternative approach is to use autoconf's AC_CHECK_SIZEOF macro, but
++   as of version autoconf-2.13, the AC_CHECK_SIZEOF macro doesn't work
++   when cross-compiling.  */
++
++#if __STDC__
++# define UINT_MAX_32_BITS 4294967295U
++#else
++# define UINT_MAX_32_BITS 0xFFFFFFFF
++#endif
++
++/* If UINT_MAX isn't defined, assume it's a 32-bit type.
++   This should be valid for all systems GNU cares about because
++   that doesn't include 16-bit systems, and only modern systems
++   (that certainly have <limits.h>) have 64+-bit integral types.  */
++
++#ifndef UINT_MAX
++# define UINT_MAX UINT_MAX_32_BITS
++#endif
++
++#if UINT_MAX == UINT_MAX_32_BITS
++typedef unsigned nls_uint32;
++#else
++# if USHRT_MAX == UINT_MAX_32_BITS
++typedef unsigned short nls_uint32;
++# else
++#  if ULONG_MAX == UINT_MAX_32_BITS
++typedef unsigned long nls_uint32;
++#  else
++  /* The following line is intended to throw an error.  Using #error is
++     not portable enough.  */
++  "Cannot determine unsigned 32-bit data type."
++#  endif
++# endif
++#endif
++
++
++/* Header for binary .mo file format.  */
++struct mo_file_header
++{
++  /* The magic number.  */
++  nls_uint32 magic;
++  /* The revision number of the file format.  */
++  nls_uint32 revision;
++
++  /* The following are only used in .mo files with major revision 0 or 1.  */
++
++  /* The number of strings pairs.  */
++  nls_uint32 nstrings;
++  /* Offset of table with start offsets of original strings.  */
++  nls_uint32 orig_tab_offset;
++  /* Offset of table with start offsets of translated strings.  */
++  nls_uint32 trans_tab_offset;
++  /* Size of hash table.  */
++  nls_uint32 hash_tab_size;
++  /* Offset of first hash table entry.  */
++  nls_uint32 hash_tab_offset;
++
++  /* The following are only used in .mo files with minor revision >= 1.  */
++
++  /* The number of system dependent segments.  */
++  nls_uint32 n_sysdep_segments;
++  /* Offset of table describing system dependent segments.  */
++  nls_uint32 sysdep_segments_offset;
++  /* The number of system dependent strings pairs.  */
++  nls_uint32 n_sysdep_strings;
++  /* Offset of table with start offsets of original sysdep strings.  */
++  nls_uint32 orig_sysdep_tab_offset;
++  /* Offset of table with start offsets of translated sysdep strings.  */
++  nls_uint32 trans_sysdep_tab_offset;
++};
++
++/* Descriptor for static string contained in the binary .mo file.  */
++struct string_desc
++{
++  /* Length of addressed string, not including the trailing NUL.  */
++  nls_uint32 length;
++  /* Offset of string in file.  */
++  nls_uint32 offset;
++};
++
++/* The following are only used in .mo files with minor revision >= 1.  */
++
++/* Descriptor for system dependent string segment.  */
++struct sysdep_segment
++{
++  /* Length of addressed string, including the trailing NUL.  */
++  nls_uint32 length;
++  /* Offset of string in file.  */
++  nls_uint32 offset;
++};
++
++/* Descriptor for system dependent string.  */
++struct sysdep_string
++{
++  /* Offset of static string segments in file.  */
++  nls_uint32 offset;
++  /* Alternating sequence of static and system dependent segments.
++     The last segment is a static segment, including the trailing NUL.  */
++  struct segment_pair
++  {
++    /* Size of static segment.  */
++    nls_uint32 segsize;
++    /* Reference to system dependent string segment, or ~0 at the end.  */
++    nls_uint32 sysdepref;
++  } segments[1];
++};
++
++/* Marker for the end of the segments[] array.  This has the value 0xFFFFFFFF,
++   regardless whether 'int' is 16 bit, 32 bit, or 64 bit.  */
++#define SEGMENTS_END ((nls_uint32) ~0)
++
++/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */
++
++#endif	/* gettext.h  */
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/hash-string.h	1998-04-26 09:22:36.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/hash-string.h	2004-09-12 14:40:34.436735776 -0400
+@@ -1,35 +1,23 @@
+-/* Implements a string hashing function.
+-   Copyright (C) 1995, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++/* Description of GNU message catalog format: string hashing function.
++   Copyright (C) 1995, 1997-1998, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ 
+-   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+    any later version.
+ 
+    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-   GNU General Public License for more details.
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
+ 
+    You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
+-   License along with the GNU C Library; see the file COPYING.LIB.  If not,
+-   write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
+-   Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
+-
+-#ifdef HAVE_VALUES_H
+-# include <values.h>
+-#endif
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
+ 
+ /* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+ 
+-#ifndef PARAMS
+-# if __STDC__
+-#  define PARAMS(Args) Args
+-# else
+-#  define PARAMS(Args) ()
+-# endif
+-#endif
+-
+ /* We assume to have `unsigned long int' value with at least 32 bits.  */
+ #define HASHWORDBITS 32
+ 
+@@ -37,11 +25,8 @@
+ /* Defines the so called `hashpjw' function by P.J. Weinberger
+    [see Aho/Sethi/Ullman, COMPILERS: Principles, Techniques and Tools,
+    1986, 1987 Bell Telephone Laboratories, Inc.]  */
+-static unsigned long hash_string PARAMS ((const char *__str_param));
+-
+-static inline unsigned long
+-hash_string (str_param)
+-     const char *str_param;
++static inline unsigned long int
++hash_string (const char *str_param)
+ {
+   unsigned long int hval, g;
+   const char *str = str_param;
+@@ -51,8 +36,8 @@
+   while (*str != '\0')
+     {
+       hval <<= 4;
+-      hval += (unsigned long) *str++;
+-      g = hval & ((unsigned long) 0xf << (HASHWORDBITS - 4));
++      hval += (unsigned char) *str++;
++      g = hval & ((unsigned long int) 0xf << (HASHWORDBITS - 4));
+       if (g != 0)
+ 	{
+ 	  hval ^= g >> (HASHWORDBITS - 8);
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/intl-compat.c	1998-04-26 09:20:52.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/intl-compat.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.441735016 -0400
+@@ -1,76 +1,131 @@
+ /* intl-compat.c - Stub functions to call gettext functions from GNU gettext
+    Library.
+-   Copyright (C) 1995 Software Foundation, Inc.
++   Copyright (C) 1995, 2000-2003 Software Foundation, Inc.
+ 
+-This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+-any later version.
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
+ 
+-This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+-but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-GNU General Public License for more details.
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
+ 
+-You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+-Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
+ 
+ #ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+ # include <config.h>
+ #endif
+ 
+-#include "libgettext.h"
++#include "gettextP.h"
+ 
+ /* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+ 
++/* This file redirects the gettext functions (without prefix) to those
++   defined in the included GNU libintl library (with "libintl_" prefix).
++   It is compiled into libintl in order to make the AM_GNU_GETTEXT test
++   of gettext <= 0.11.2 work with the libintl library >= 0.11.3 which
++   has the redirections primarily in the <libintl.h> include file.
++   It is also compiled into libgnuintl so that libgnuintl.so can be used
++   as LD_PRELOADable library on glibc systems, to provide the extra
++   features that the functions in the libc don't have (namely, logging).  */
++
+ 
+ #undef gettext
+ #undef dgettext
+ #undef dcgettext
++#undef ngettext
++#undef dngettext
++#undef dcngettext
+ #undef textdomain
+ #undef bindtextdomain
++#undef bind_textdomain_codeset
++
++
++/* When building a DLL, we must export some functions.  Note that because
++   the functions are only defined for binary backward compatibility, we
++   don't need to use __declspec(dllimport) in any case.  */
++#if defined _MSC_VER && BUILDING_DLL
++# define DLL_EXPORTED __declspec(dllexport)
++#else
++# define DLL_EXPORTED
++#endif
+ 
+ 
++DLL_EXPORTED
+ char *
+-bindtextdomain (domainname, dirname)
+-     const char *domainname;
+-     const char *dirname;
++gettext (const char *msgid)
+ {
+-  return bindtextdomain__ (domainname, dirname);
++  return libintl_gettext (msgid);
+ }
+ 
+ 
++DLL_EXPORTED
+ char *
+-dcgettext (domainname, msgid, category)
+-     const char *domainname;
+-     const char *msgid;
+-     int category;
++dgettext (const char *domainname, const char *msgid)
+ {
+-  return dcgettext__ (domainname, msgid, category);
++  return libintl_dgettext (domainname, msgid);
+ }
+ 
+ 
++DLL_EXPORTED
+ char *
+-dgettext (domainname, msgid)
+-     const char *domainname;
+-     const char *msgid;
++dcgettext (const char *domainname, const char *msgid, int category)
+ {
+-  return dgettext__ (domainname, msgid);
++  return libintl_dcgettext (domainname, msgid, category);
+ }
+ 
+ 
++DLL_EXPORTED
+ char *
+-gettext (msgid)
+-     const char *msgid;
++ngettext (const char *msgid1, const char *msgid2, unsigned long int n)
+ {
+-  return gettext__ (msgid);
++  return libintl_ngettext (msgid1, msgid2, n);
+ }
+ 
+ 
++DLL_EXPORTED
+ char *
+-textdomain (domainname)
+-     const char *domainname;
++dngettext (const char *domainname,
++	   const char *msgid1, const char *msgid2, unsigned long int n)
+ {
+-  return textdomain__ (domainname);
++  return libintl_dngettext (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n);
++}
++
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++char *
++dcngettext (const char *domainname,
++	    const char *msgid1, const char *msgid2, unsigned long int n,
++	    int category)
++{
++  return libintl_dcngettext (domainname, msgid1, msgid2, n, category);
++}
++
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++char *
++textdomain (const char *domainname)
++{
++  return libintl_textdomain (domainname);
++}
++
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++char *
++bindtextdomain (const char *domainname, const char *dirname)
++{
++  return libintl_bindtextdomain (domainname, dirname);
++}
++
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++char *
++bind_textdomain_codeset (const char *domainname, const char *codeset)
++{
++  return libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset (domainname, codeset);
+ }
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/l10nflist.c	1998-04-26 09:22:37.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/l10nflist.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.457732584 -0400
+@@ -1,52 +1,40 @@
+-/* Handle list of needed message catalogs
+-   Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+-   Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1995.
++/* Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++   Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1995.
+ 
+-   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+    any later version.
+ 
+    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-   GNU General Public License for more details.
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
+ 
+-   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+-   Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for stpcpy().
++   This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include
++   <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late.  */
++#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
++# define _GNU_SOURCE	1
++#endif
+ 
+ #ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+ # include <config.h>
+ #endif
+ 
+-
+-#if defined HAVE_STRING_H || defined _LIBC
+-# ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
+-#  define _GNU_SOURCE	1
+-# endif
+-# include <string.h>
+-#else
+-# include <strings.h>
+-# ifndef memcpy
+-#  define memcpy(Dst, Src, Num) bcopy (Src, Dst, Num)
+-# endif
+-#endif
+-#if !HAVE_STRCHR && !defined _LIBC
+-# ifndef strchr
+-#  define strchr index
+-# endif
+-#endif
++#include <string.h>
+ 
+ #if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_ARGZ_H
+ # include <argz.h>
+ #endif
+ #include <ctype.h>
+ #include <sys/types.h>
+-
+-#if defined STDC_HEADERS || defined _LIBC
+-# include <stdlib.h>
+-#endif
++#include <stdlib.h>
+ 
+ #include "loadinfo.h"
+ 
+@@ -65,23 +53,39 @@
+ /* Rename the non ANSI C functions.  This is required by the standard
+    because some ANSI C functions will require linking with this object
+    file and the name space must not be polluted.  */
+-# define stpcpy(dest, src) __stpcpy(dest, src)
++# ifndef stpcpy
++#  define stpcpy(dest, src) __stpcpy(dest, src)
++# endif
+ #else
+ # ifndef HAVE_STPCPY
+-static char *stpcpy PARAMS ((char *dest, const char *src));
++static char *stpcpy (char *dest, const char *src);
+ # endif
+ #endif
+ 
++/* Pathname support.
++   ISSLASH(C)           tests whether C is a directory separator character.
++   IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P)  tests whether P is an absolute path.  If it is not,
++                        it may be concatenated to a directory pathname.
++ */
++#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__
++  /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */
++# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\')
++# define HAS_DEVICE(P) \
++    ((((P)[0] >= 'A' && (P)[0] <= 'Z') || ((P)[0] >= 'a' && (P)[0] <= 'z')) \
++     && (P)[1] == ':')
++# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) (ISSLASH ((P)[0]) || HAS_DEVICE (P))
++#else
++  /* Unix */
++# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/')
++# define IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH(P) ISSLASH ((P)[0])
++#endif
++
+ /* Define function which are usually not available.  */
+ 
+ #if !defined _LIBC && !defined HAVE___ARGZ_COUNT
+ /* Returns the number of strings in ARGZ.  */
+-static size_t argz_count__ PARAMS ((const char *argz, size_t len));
+-
+ static size_t
+-argz_count__ (argz, len)
+-     const char *argz;
+-     size_t len;
++argz_count__ (const char *argz, size_t len)
+ {
+   size_t count = 0;
+   while (len > 0)
+@@ -95,18 +99,17 @@
+ }
+ # undef __argz_count
+ # define __argz_count(argz, len) argz_count__ (argz, len)
++#else
++# ifdef _LIBC
++#  define __argz_count(argz, len) INTUSE(__argz_count) (argz, len)
++# endif
+ #endif	/* !_LIBC && !HAVE___ARGZ_COUNT */
+ 
+ #if !defined _LIBC && !defined HAVE___ARGZ_STRINGIFY
+ /* Make '\0' separated arg vector ARGZ printable by converting all the '\0's
+    except the last into the character SEP.  */
+-static void argz_stringify__ PARAMS ((char *argz, size_t len, int sep));
+-
+ static void
+-argz_stringify__ (argz, len, sep)
+-     char *argz;
+-     size_t len;
+-     int sep;
++argz_stringify__ (char *argz, size_t len, int sep)
+ {
+   while (len > 0)
+     {
+@@ -119,17 +122,16 @@
+ }
+ # undef __argz_stringify
+ # define __argz_stringify(argz, len, sep) argz_stringify__ (argz, len, sep)
++#else
++# ifdef _LIBC
++#  define __argz_stringify(argz, len, sep) \
++  INTUSE(__argz_stringify) (argz, len, sep)
++# endif
+ #endif	/* !_LIBC && !HAVE___ARGZ_STRINGIFY */
+ 
+ #if !defined _LIBC && !defined HAVE___ARGZ_NEXT
+-static char *argz_next__ PARAMS ((char *argz, size_t argz_len,
+-				  const char *entry));
+-
+ static char *
+-argz_next__ (argz, argz_len, entry)
+-     char *argz;
+-     size_t argz_len;
+-     const char *entry;
++argz_next__ (char *argz, size_t argz_len, const char *entry)
+ {
+   if (entry)
+     {
+@@ -150,11 +152,8 @@
+ 
+ 
+ /* Return number of bits set in X.  */
+-static int pop PARAMS ((int x));
+-
+ static inline int
+-pop (x)
+-     int x;
++pop (int x)
+ {
+   /* We assume that no more than 16 bits are used.  */
+   x = ((x & ~0x5555) >> 1) + (x & 0x5555);
+@@ -167,31 +166,27 @@
+ 
+ 
+ struct loaded_l10nfile *
+-_nl_make_l10nflist (l10nfile_list, dirlist, dirlist_len, mask, language,
+-		    territory, codeset, normalized_codeset, modifier, special,
+-		    sponsor, revision, filename, do_allocate)
+-     struct loaded_l10nfile **l10nfile_list;
+-     const char *dirlist;
+-     size_t dirlist_len;
+-     int mask;
+-     const char *language;
+-     const char *territory;
+-     const char *codeset;
+-     const char *normalized_codeset;
+-     const char *modifier;
+-     const char *special;
+-     const char *sponsor;
+-     const char *revision;
+-     const char *filename;
+-     int do_allocate;
++_nl_make_l10nflist (struct loaded_l10nfile **l10nfile_list,
++		    const char *dirlist, size_t dirlist_len,
++		    int mask, const char *language, const char *territory,
++		    const char *codeset, const char *normalized_codeset,
++		    const char *modifier, const char *special,
++		    const char *sponsor, const char *revision,
++		    const char *filename, int do_allocate)
+ {
+   char *abs_filename;
+-  struct loaded_l10nfile *last = NULL;
++  struct loaded_l10nfile **lastp;
+   struct loaded_l10nfile *retval;
+   char *cp;
++  size_t dirlist_count;
+   size_t entries;
+   int cnt;
+ 
++  /* If LANGUAGE contains an absolute directory specification, we ignore
++     DIRLIST.  */
++  if (IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (language))
++    dirlist_len = 0;
++
+   /* Allocate room for the full file name.  */
+   abs_filename = (char *) malloc (dirlist_len
+ 				  + strlen (language)
+@@ -209,7 +204,7 @@
+ 				  + (((mask & CEN_SPONSOR) != 0
+ 				      || (mask & CEN_REVISION) != 0)
+ 				     ? (1 + ((mask & CEN_SPONSOR) != 0
+-					     ? strlen (sponsor) + 1 : 0)
++					     ? strlen (sponsor) : 0)
+ 					+ ((mask & CEN_REVISION) != 0
+ 					   ? strlen (revision) + 1 : 0)) : 0)
+ 				  + 1 + strlen (filename) + 1);
+@@ -217,14 +212,16 @@
+   if (abs_filename == NULL)
+     return NULL;
+ 
+-  retval = NULL;
+-  last = NULL;
+-
+   /* Construct file name.  */
+-  memcpy (abs_filename, dirlist, dirlist_len);
+-  __argz_stringify (abs_filename, dirlist_len, ':');
+-  cp = abs_filename + (dirlist_len - 1);
+-  *cp++ = '/';
++  cp = abs_filename;
++  if (dirlist_len > 0)
++    {
++      memcpy (cp, dirlist, dirlist_len);
++      __argz_stringify (cp, dirlist_len, PATH_SEPARATOR);
++      cp += dirlist_len;
++      cp[-1] = '/';
++    }
++
+   cp = stpcpy (cp, language);
+ 
+   if ((mask & TERRITORY) != 0)
+@@ -271,7 +268,7 @@
+ 
+   /* Look in list of already loaded domains whether it is already
+      available.  */
+-  last = NULL;
++  lastp = l10nfile_list;
+   for (retval = *l10nfile_list; retval != NULL; retval = retval->next)
+     if (retval->filename != NULL)
+       {
+@@ -286,7 +283,7 @@
+ 	    break;
+ 	  }
+ 
+-	last = retval;
++	lastp = &retval->next;
+       }
+ 
+   if (retval != NULL || do_allocate == 0)
+@@ -295,48 +292,66 @@
+       return retval;
+     }
+ 
+-  retval = (struct loaded_l10nfile *)
+-    malloc (sizeof (*retval) + (__argz_count (dirlist, dirlist_len)
+-				* (1 << pop (mask))
+-				* sizeof (struct loaded_l10nfile *)));
++  dirlist_count = (dirlist_len > 0 ? __argz_count (dirlist, dirlist_len) : 1);
++
++  /* Allocate a new loaded_l10nfile.  */
++  retval =
++    (struct loaded_l10nfile *)
++    malloc (sizeof (*retval)
++	    + (((dirlist_count << pop (mask)) + (dirlist_count > 1 ? 1 : 0))
++	       * sizeof (struct loaded_l10nfile *)));
+   if (retval == NULL)
+     return NULL;
+ 
+   retval->filename = abs_filename;
+-  retval->decided = (__argz_count (dirlist, dirlist_len) != 1
++
++  /* We set retval->data to NULL here; it is filled in later.
++     Setting retval->decided to 1 here means that retval does not
++     correspond to a real file (dirlist_count > 1) or is not worth
++     looking up (if an unnormalized codeset was specified).  */
++  retval->decided = (dirlist_count > 1
+ 		     || ((mask & XPG_CODESET) != 0
+ 			 && (mask & XPG_NORM_CODESET) != 0));
+   retval->data = NULL;
+ 
+-  if (last == NULL)
+-    {
+-      retval->next = *l10nfile_list;
+-      *l10nfile_list = retval;
+-    }
+-  else
+-    {
+-      retval->next = last->next;
+-      last->next = retval;
+-    }
++  retval->next = *lastp;
++  *lastp = retval;
+ 
+   entries = 0;
+-  /* If the DIRLIST is a real list the RETVAL entry corresponds not to
+-     a real file.  So we have to use the DIRLIST separation mechanism
+-     of the inner loop.  */
+-  cnt = __argz_count (dirlist, dirlist_len) == 1 ? mask - 1 : mask;
+-  for (; cnt >= 0; --cnt)
++  /* Recurse to fill the inheritance list of RETVAL.
++     If the DIRLIST is a real list (i.e. DIRLIST_COUNT > 1), the RETVAL
++     entry does not correspond to a real file; retval->filename contains
++     colons.  In this case we loop across all elements of DIRLIST and
++     across all bit patterns dominated by MASK.
++     If the DIRLIST is a single directory or entirely redundant (i.e.
++     DIRLIST_COUNT == 1), we loop across all bit patterns dominated by
++     MASK, excluding MASK itself.
++     In either case, we loop down from MASK to 0.  This has the effect
++     that the extra bits in the locale name are dropped in this order:
++     first the modifier, then the territory, then the codeset, then the
++     normalized_codeset.  */
++  for (cnt = dirlist_count > 1 ? mask : mask - 1; cnt >= 0; --cnt)
+     if ((cnt & ~mask) == 0
+ 	&& ((cnt & CEN_SPECIFIC) == 0 || (cnt & XPG_SPECIFIC) == 0)
+ 	&& ((cnt & XPG_CODESET) == 0 || (cnt & XPG_NORM_CODESET) == 0))
+       {
+-	/* Iterate over all elements of the DIRLIST.  */
+-	char *dir = NULL;
++	if (dirlist_count > 1)
++	  {
++	    /* Iterate over all elements of the DIRLIST.  */
++	    char *dir = NULL;
+ 
+-	while ((dir = __argz_next ((char *) dirlist, dirlist_len, dir))
+-	       != NULL)
++	    while ((dir = __argz_next ((char *) dirlist, dirlist_len, dir))
++		   != NULL)
++	      retval->successor[entries++]
++		= _nl_make_l10nflist (l10nfile_list, dir, strlen (dir) + 1,
++				      cnt, language, territory, codeset,
++				      normalized_codeset, modifier, special,
++				      sponsor, revision, filename, 1);
++	  }
++	else
+ 	  retval->successor[entries++]
+-	    = _nl_make_l10nflist (l10nfile_list, dir, strlen (dir) + 1, cnt,
+-				  language, territory, codeset,
++	    = _nl_make_l10nflist (l10nfile_list, dirlist, dirlist_len,
++				  cnt, language, territory, codeset,
+ 				  normalized_codeset, modifier, special,
+ 				  sponsor, revision, filename, 1);
+       }
+@@ -347,11 +362,10 @@
+ 
+ /* Normalize codeset name.  There is no standard for the codeset
+    names.  Normalization allows the user to use any of the common
+-   names.  */
++   names.  The return value is dynamically allocated and has to be
++   freed by the caller.  */
+ const char *
+-_nl_normalize_codeset (codeset, name_len)
+-     const char *codeset;
+-     size_t name_len;
++_nl_normalize_codeset (const char *codeset, size_t name_len)
+ {
+   int len = 0;
+   int only_digit = 1;
+@@ -360,11 +374,11 @@
+   size_t cnt;
+ 
+   for (cnt = 0; cnt < name_len; ++cnt)
+-    if (isalnum (codeset[cnt]))
++    if (isalnum ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt]))
+       {
+ 	++len;
+ 
+-	if (isalpha (codeset[cnt]))
++	if (isalpha ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt]))
+ 	  only_digit = 0;
+       }
+ 
+@@ -378,9 +392,9 @@
+ 	wp = retval;
+ 
+       for (cnt = 0; cnt < name_len; ++cnt)
+-	if (isalpha (codeset[cnt]))
+-	  *wp++ = tolower (codeset[cnt]);
+-	else if (isdigit (codeset[cnt]))
++	if (isalpha ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt]))
++	  *wp++ = tolower ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt]);
++	else if (isdigit ((unsigned char) codeset[cnt]))
+ 	  *wp++ = codeset[cnt];
+ 
+       *wp = '\0';
+@@ -398,9 +412,7 @@
+    to be defined.  */
+ #if !_LIBC && !HAVE_STPCPY
+ static char *
+-stpcpy (dest, src)
+-     char *dest;
+-     const char *src;
++stpcpy (char *dest, const char *src)
+ {
+   while ((*dest++ = *src++) != '\0')
+     /* Do nothing. */ ;
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/libgettext.h	1998-04-26 09:22:36.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/libgettext.h	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
+@@ -1,182 +0,0 @@
+-/* Message catalogs for internationalization.
+-   Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+-
+-   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+-   any later version.
+-
+-   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+-   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-   GNU General Public License for more details.
+-
+-   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+-   Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
+-
+-/* Because on some systems (e.g. Solaris) we sometimes have to include
+-   the systems libintl.h as well as this file we have more complex
+-   include protection above.  But the systems header might perhaps also
+-   define _LIBINTL_H and therefore we have to protect the definition here.  */
+-
+-#if !defined (_LIBINTL_H) || !defined (_LIBGETTEXT_H)
+-#if !defined (_LIBINTL_H)
+-# define _LIBINTL_H	1
+-#endif
+-#define _LIBGETTEXT_H	1
+-
+-/* We define an additional symbol to signal that we use the GNU
+-   implementation of gettext.  */
+-#define __USE_GNU_GETTEXT 1
+-
+-#include <sys/types.h>
+-
+-#if HAVE_LOCALE_H
+-# include <locale.h>
+-#endif
+-
+-
+-#ifdef __cplusplus
+-extern "C" {
+-#endif
+-
+-/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+-
+-#ifndef PARAMS
+-# if __STDC__
+-#  define PARAMS(args) args
+-# else
+-#  define PARAMS(args) ()
+-# endif
+-#endif
+-
+-#ifndef NULL
+-# if !defined __cplusplus || defined __GNUC__
+-#  define NULL ((void *) 0)
+-# else
+-#  define NULL (0)
+-# endif
+-#endif
+-
+-#if !HAVE_LC_MESSAGES
+-/* This value determines the behaviour of the gettext() and dgettext()
+-   function.  But some system does not have this defined.  Define it
+-   to a default value.  */
+-# define LC_MESSAGES (-1)
+-#endif
+-
+-
+-/* Declarations for gettext-using-catgets interface.  Derived from
+-   Jim Meyering's libintl.h.  */
+-struct _msg_ent
+-{
+-  const char *_msg;
+-  int _msg_number;
+-};
+-
+-
+-#if HAVE_CATGETS
+-/* These two variables are defined in the automatically by po-to-tbl.sed
+-   generated file `cat-id-tbl.c'.  */
+-extern const struct _msg_ent _msg_tbl[];
+-extern int _msg_tbl_length;
+-#endif
+-
+-
+-/* For automatical extraction of messages sometimes no real
+-   translation is needed.  Instead the string itself is the result.  */
+-#define gettext_noop(Str) (Str)
+-
+-/* Look up MSGID in the current default message catalog for the current
+-   LC_MESSAGES locale.  If not found, returns MSGID itself (the default
+-   text).  */
+-extern char *gettext PARAMS ((const char *__msgid));
+-extern char *gettext__ PARAMS ((const char *__msgid));
+-
+-/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current
+-   LC_MESSAGES locale.  */
+-extern char *dgettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid));
+-extern char *dgettext__ PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+-				 const char *__msgid));
+-
+-/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current CATEGORY
+-   locale.  */
+-extern char *dcgettext PARAMS ((const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid,
+-				int __category));
+-extern char *dcgettext__ PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+-				  const char *__msgid, int __category));
+-
+-
+-/* Set the current default message catalog to DOMAINNAME.
+-   If DOMAINNAME is null, return the current default.
+-   If DOMAINNAME is "", reset to the default of "messages".  */
+-extern char *textdomain PARAMS ((const char *__domainname));
+-extern char *textdomain__ PARAMS ((const char *__domainname));
+-
+-/* Specify that the DOMAINNAME message catalog will be found
+-   in DIRNAME rather than in the system locale data base.  */
+-extern char *bindtextdomain PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+-				  const char *__dirname));
+-extern char *bindtextdomain__ PARAMS ((const char *__domainname,
+-				    const char *__dirname));
+-
+-#if ENABLE_NLS
+-
+-/* Solaris 2.3 has the gettext function but dcgettext is missing.
+-   So we omit this optimization for Solaris 2.3.  BTW, Solaris 2.4
+-   has dcgettext.  */
+-# if !HAVE_CATGETS && (!HAVE_GETTEXT || HAVE_DCGETTEXT)
+-
+-#  define gettext(Msgid)						      \
+-     dgettext (NULL, Msgid)
+-
+-#  define dgettext(Domainname, Msgid)					      \
+-     dcgettext (Domainname, Msgid, LC_MESSAGES)
+-
+-#  if defined __GNUC__ && __GNUC__ == 2 && __GNUC_MINOR__ >= 7
+-/* This global variable is defined in loadmsgcat.c.  We need a sign,
+-   whether a new catalog was loaded, which can be associated with all
+-   translations.  */
+-extern int _nl_msg_cat_cntr;
+-
+-#   define dcgettext(Domainname, Msgid, Category)			      \
+-  (__extension__							      \
+-   ({									      \
+-     char *__result;							      \
+-     if (__builtin_constant_p (Msgid))					      \
+-       {								      \
+-	 static char *__translation__;					      \
+-	 static int __catalog_counter__;				      \
+-	 if (! __translation__ || __catalog_counter__ != _nl_msg_cat_cntr)    \
+-	   {								      \
+-	     __translation__ =						      \
+-	       dcgettext__ (Domainname, Msgid, Category);		      \
+-	     __catalog_counter__ = _nl_msg_cat_cntr;			      \
+-	   }								      \
+-	 __result = __translation__;					      \
+-       }								      \
+-     else								      \
+-       __result = dcgettext__ (Domainname, Msgid, Category);		      \
+-     __result;								      \
+-    }))
+-#  endif
+-# endif
+-
+-#else
+-
+-# define gettext(Msgid) (Msgid)
+-# define dgettext(Domainname, Msgid) (Msgid)
+-# define dcgettext(Domainname, Msgid, Category) (Msgid)
+-# define textdomain(Domainname) while (0) /* nothing */
+-# define bindtextdomain(Domainname, Dirname) while (0) /* nothing */
+-
+-#endif
+-
+-/* @@ begin of epilog @@ */
+-
+-#ifdef __cplusplus
+-}
+-#endif
+-
+-#endif
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/libgnuintl.h.in	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/libgnuintl.h.in	2004-09-12 14:40:34.462731824 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,383 @@
++/* Message catalogs for internationalization.
++   Copyright (C) 1995-1997, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifndef _LIBINTL_H
++#define _LIBINTL_H	1
++
++#include <locale.h>
++
++/* The LC_MESSAGES locale category is the category used by the functions
++   gettext() and dgettext().  It is specified in POSIX, but not in ANSI C.
++   On systems that don't define it, use an arbitrary value instead.
++   On Solaris, <locale.h> defines __LOCALE_H (or _LOCALE_H in Solaris 2.5)
++   then includes <libintl.h> (i.e. this file!) and then only defines
++   LC_MESSAGES.  To avoid a redefinition warning, don't define LC_MESSAGES
++   in this case.  */
++#if !defined LC_MESSAGES && !(defined __LOCALE_H || (defined _LOCALE_H && defined __sun))
++# define LC_MESSAGES 1729
++#endif
++
++/* We define an additional symbol to signal that we use the GNU
++   implementation of gettext.  */
++#define __USE_GNU_GETTEXT 1
++
++/* Provide information about the supported file formats.  Returns the
++   maximum minor revision number supported for a given major revision.  */
++#define __GNU_GETTEXT_SUPPORTED_REVISION(major) \
++  ((major) == 0 ? 1 : -1)
++
++/* Resolve a platform specific conflict on DJGPP.  GNU gettext takes
++   precedence over _conio_gettext.  */
++#ifdef __DJGPP__
++# undef gettext
++#endif
++
++#ifdef __cplusplus
++extern "C" {
++#endif
++
++
++/* We redirect the functions to those prefixed with "libintl_".  This is
++   necessary, because some systems define gettext/textdomain/... in the C
++   library (namely, Solaris 2.4 and newer, and GNU libc 2.0 and newer).
++   If we used the unprefixed names, there would be cases where the
++   definition in the C library would override the one in the libintl.so
++   shared library.  Recall that on ELF systems, the symbols are looked
++   up in the following order:
++     1. in the executable,
++     2. in the shared libraries specified on the link command line, in order,
++     3. in the dependencies of the shared libraries specified on the link
++        command line,
++     4. in the dlopen()ed shared libraries, in the order in which they were
++        dlopen()ed.
++   The definition in the C library would override the one in libintl.so if
++   either
++     * -lc is given on the link command line and -lintl isn't, or
++     * -lc is given on the link command line before -lintl, or
++     * libintl.so is a dependency of a dlopen()ed shared library but not
++       linked to the executable at link time.
++   Since Solaris gettext() behaves differently than GNU gettext(), this
++   would be unacceptable.
++
++   The redirection happens by default through macros in C, so that &gettext
++   is independent of the compilation unit, but through inline functions in
++   C++, in order not to interfere with the name mangling of class fields or
++   class methods called 'gettext'.  */
++
++/* The user can define _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE or _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS.
++   If he doesn't, we choose the method.  A third possible method is
++   _INTL_REDIRECT_ASM, supported only by GCC.  */
++#if !(defined _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE || defined _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS)
++# if __GNUC__ >= 2 && !defined __APPLE_CC__ && !defined __MINGW32__ && !(__GNUC__ == 2 && defined _AIX) && (defined __STDC__ || defined __cplusplus)
++#  define _INTL_REDIRECT_ASM
++# else
++#  ifdef __cplusplus
++#   define _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
++#  else
++#   define _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
++#  endif
++# endif
++#endif
++/* Auxiliary macros.  */
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_ASM
++# define _INTL_ASM(cname) __asm__ (_INTL_ASMNAME (__USER_LABEL_PREFIX__, #cname))
++# define _INTL_ASMNAME(prefix,cnamestring) _INTL_STRINGIFY (prefix) cnamestring
++# define _INTL_STRINGIFY(prefix) #prefix
++#else
++# define _INTL_ASM(cname)
++#endif
++
++/* Look up MSGID in the current default message catalog for the current
++   LC_MESSAGES locale.  If not found, returns MSGID itself (the default
++   text).  */
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
++extern char *libintl_gettext (const char *__msgid);
++static inline char *gettext (const char *__msgid)
++{
++  return libintl_gettext (__msgid);
++}
++#else
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
++# define gettext libintl_gettext
++#endif
++extern char *gettext (const char *__msgid)
++       _INTL_ASM (libintl_gettext);
++#endif
++
++/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current
++   LC_MESSAGES locale.  */
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
++extern char *libintl_dgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid);
++static inline char *dgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid)
++{
++  return libintl_dgettext (__domainname, __msgid);
++}
++#else
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
++# define dgettext libintl_dgettext
++#endif
++extern char *dgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid)
++       _INTL_ASM (libintl_dgettext);
++#endif
++
++/* Look up MSGID in the DOMAINNAME message catalog for the current CATEGORY
++   locale.  */
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
++extern char *libintl_dcgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid,
++				int __category);
++static inline char *dcgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid,
++			       int __category)
++{
++  return libintl_dcgettext (__domainname, __msgid, __category);
++}
++#else
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
++# define dcgettext libintl_dcgettext
++#endif
++extern char *dcgettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid,
++			int __category)
++       _INTL_ASM (libintl_dcgettext);
++#endif
++
++
++/* Similar to `gettext' but select the plural form corresponding to the
++   number N.  */
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
++extern char *libintl_ngettext (const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
++			       unsigned long int __n);
++static inline char *ngettext (const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
++			      unsigned long int __n)
++{
++  return libintl_ngettext (__msgid1, __msgid2, __n);
++}
++#else
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
++# define ngettext libintl_ngettext
++#endif
++extern char *ngettext (const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
++		       unsigned long int __n)
++       _INTL_ASM (libintl_ngettext);
++#endif
++
++/* Similar to `dgettext' but select the plural form corresponding to the
++   number N.  */
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
++extern char *libintl_dngettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid1,
++				const char *__msgid2, unsigned long int __n);
++static inline char *dngettext (const char *__domainname, const char *__msgid1,
++			       const char *__msgid2, unsigned long int __n)
++{
++  return libintl_dngettext (__domainname, __msgid1, __msgid2, __n);
++}
++#else
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
++# define dngettext libintl_dngettext
++#endif
++extern char *dngettext (const char *__domainname,
++			const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
++			unsigned long int __n)
++       _INTL_ASM (libintl_dngettext);
++#endif
++
++/* Similar to `dcgettext' but select the plural form corresponding to the
++   number N.  */
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
++extern char *libintl_dcngettext (const char *__domainname,
++				 const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
++				 unsigned long int __n, int __category);
++static inline char *dcngettext (const char *__domainname,
++				const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
++				unsigned long int __n, int __category)
++{
++  return libintl_dcngettext (__domainname, __msgid1, __msgid2, __n, __category);
++}
++#else
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
++# define dcngettext libintl_dcngettext
++#endif
++extern char *dcngettext (const char *__domainname,
++			 const char *__msgid1, const char *__msgid2,
++			 unsigned long int __n, int __category)
++       _INTL_ASM (libintl_dcngettext);
++#endif
++
++
++/* Set the current default message catalog to DOMAINNAME.
++   If DOMAINNAME is null, return the current default.
++   If DOMAINNAME is "", reset to the default of "messages".  */
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
++extern char *libintl_textdomain (const char *__domainname);
++static inline char *textdomain (const char *__domainname)
++{
++  return libintl_textdomain (__domainname);
++}
++#else
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
++# define textdomain libintl_textdomain
++#endif
++extern char *textdomain (const char *__domainname)
++       _INTL_ASM (libintl_textdomain);
++#endif
++
++/* Specify that the DOMAINNAME message catalog will be found
++   in DIRNAME rather than in the system locale data base.  */
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
++extern char *libintl_bindtextdomain (const char *__domainname,
++				     const char *__dirname);
++static inline char *bindtextdomain (const char *__domainname,
++				    const char *__dirname)
++{
++  return libintl_bindtextdomain (__domainname, __dirname);
++}
++#else
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
++# define bindtextdomain libintl_bindtextdomain
++#endif
++extern char *bindtextdomain (const char *__domainname, const char *__dirname)
++       _INTL_ASM (libintl_bindtextdomain);
++#endif
++
++/* Specify the character encoding in which the messages from the
++   DOMAINNAME message catalog will be returned.  */
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_INLINE
++extern char *libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset (const char *__domainname,
++					      const char *__codeset);
++static inline char *bind_textdomain_codeset (const char *__domainname,
++					     const char *__codeset)
++{
++  return libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset (__domainname, __codeset);
++}
++#else
++#ifdef _INTL_REDIRECT_MACROS
++# define bind_textdomain_codeset libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset
++#endif
++extern char *bind_textdomain_codeset (const char *__domainname,
++				      const char *__codeset)
++       _INTL_ASM (libintl_bind_textdomain_codeset);
++#endif
++
++
++/* Support for format strings with positions in *printf(), following the
++   POSIX/XSI specification.
++   Note: These replacements for the *printf() functions are visible only
++   in source files that #include <libintl.h> or #include "gettext.h".
++   Packages that use *printf() in source files that don't refer to _()
++   or gettext() but for which the format string could be the return value
++   of _() or gettext() need to add this #include.  Oh well.  */
++
++#if !@HAVE_POSIX_PRINTF@
++
++#include <stdio.h>
++#include <stddef.h>
++
++/* Get va_list.  */
++#if __STDC__ || defined __cplusplus || defined _MSC_VER
++# include <stdarg.h>
++#else
++# include <varargs.h>
++#endif
++
++#undef fprintf
++#define fprintf libintl_fprintf
++extern int fprintf (FILE *, const char *, ...);
++#undef vfprintf
++#define vfprintf libintl_vfprintf
++extern int vfprintf (FILE *, const char *, va_list);
++
++#undef printf
++#define printf libintl_printf
++extern int printf (const char *, ...);
++#undef vprintf
++#define vprintf libintl_vprintf
++extern int vprintf (const char *, va_list);
++
++#undef sprintf
++#define sprintf libintl_sprintf
++extern int sprintf (char *, const char *, ...);
++#undef vsprintf
++#define vsprintf libintl_vsprintf
++extern int vsprintf (char *, const char *, va_list);
++
++#if @HAVE_SNPRINTF@
++
++#undef snprintf
++#define snprintf libintl_snprintf
++extern int snprintf (char *, size_t, const char *, ...);
++#undef vsnprintf
++#define vsnprintf libintl_vsnprintf
++extern int vsnprintf (char *, size_t, const char *, va_list);
++
++#endif
++
++#if @HAVE_ASPRINTF@
++
++#undef asprintf
++#define asprintf libintl_asprintf
++extern int asprintf (char **, const char *, ...);
++#undef vasprintf
++#define vasprintf libintl_vasprintf
++extern int vasprintf (char **, const char *, va_list);
++
++#endif
++
++#if @HAVE_WPRINTF@
++
++#undef fwprintf
++#define fwprintf libintl_fwprintf
++extern int fwprintf (FILE *, const wchar_t *, ...);
++#undef vfwprintf
++#define vfwprintf libintl_vfwprintf
++extern int vfwprintf (FILE *, const wchar_t *, va_list);
++
++#undef wprintf
++#define wprintf libintl_wprintf
++extern int wprintf (const wchar_t *, ...);
++#undef vwprintf
++#define vwprintf libintl_vwprintf
++extern int vwprintf (const wchar_t *, va_list);
++
++#undef swprintf
++#define swprintf libintl_swprintf
++extern int swprintf (wchar_t *, size_t, const wchar_t *, ...);
++#undef vswprintf
++#define vswprintf libintl_vswprintf
++extern int vswprintf (wchar_t *, size_t, const wchar_t *, va_list);
++
++#endif
++
++#endif
++
++
++/* Support for relocatable packages.  */
++
++/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of the package.
++   Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix
++   by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead.  Both
++   prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use ""
++   instead of "/").  */
++#define libintl_set_relocation_prefix libintl_set_relocation_prefix
++extern void
++       libintl_set_relocation_prefix (const char *orig_prefix,
++				      const char *curr_prefix);
++
++
++#ifdef __cplusplus
++}
++#endif
++
++#endif /* libintl.h */
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/linux-msg.sed	1998-04-26 09:20:52.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/linux-msg.sed	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
+@@ -1,100 +0,0 @@
+-# po2msg.sed - Convert Uniforum style .po file to Linux style .msg file
+-# Copyright (C) 1995 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+-# Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1995.
+-#
+-# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+-# any later version.
+-#
+-# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+-# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-# GNU General Public License for more details.
+-#
+-# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+-# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
+-#
+-#
+-# The first directive in the .msg should be the definition of the
+-# message set number.  We use always set number 1.
+-#
+-1 {
+-  i\
+-$set 1 # Automatically created by po2msg.sed
+-  h
+-  s/.*/0/
+-  x
+-}
+-#
+-# Mitch's old catalog format does not allow comments.
+-#
+-# We copy the original message as a comment into the .msg file.
+-#
+-/^msgid/ {
+-  s/msgid[ 	]*"//
+-#
+-# This does not work now with the new format.
+-# /"$/! {
+-#   s/\\$//
+-#   s/$/ ... (more lines following)"/
+-# }
+-  x
+-# The following nice solution is by
+-# Bruno <Haible@ma2s2.mathematik.uni-karlsruhe.de>
+-  td
+-# Increment a decimal number in pattern space.
+-# First hide trailing `9' digits.
+-  :d
+-  s/9\(_*\)$/_\1/
+-  td
+-# Assure at least one digit is available.
+-  s/^\(_*\)$/0\1/
+-# Increment the last digit.
+-  s/8\(_*\)$/9\1/
+-  s/7\(_*\)$/8\1/
+-  s/6\(_*\)$/7\1/
+-  s/5\(_*\)$/6\1/
+-  s/4\(_*\)$/5\1/
+-  s/3\(_*\)$/4\1/
+-  s/2\(_*\)$/3\1/
+-  s/1\(_*\)$/2\1/
+-  s/0\(_*\)$/1\1/
+-# Convert the hidden `9' digits to `0's.
+-  s/_/0/g
+-  x
+-  G
+-  s/\(.*\)"\n\([0-9]*\)/$ #\2 Original Message:(\1)/p
+-}
+-#
+-# The .msg file contains, other then the .po file, only the translations
+-# but each given a unique ID.  Starting from 1 and incrementing by 1 for
+-# each message we assign them to the messages.
+-# It is important that the .po file used to generate the cat-id-tbl.c file
+-# (with po-to-tbl) is the same as the one used here.  (At least the order
+-# of declarations must not be changed.)
+-#
+-/^msgstr/ {
+-  s/msgstr[ 	]*"\(.*\)"/# \1/
+-# Clear substitution flag.
+-  tb
+-# Append the next line.
+-  :b
+-  N
+-# Look whether second part is continuation line.
+-  s/\(.*\n\)"\(.*\)"/\1\2/
+-# Yes, then branch.
+-  ta
+-  P
+-  D
+-# Note that D includes a jump to the start!!
+-# We found a continuation line.  But before printing insert '\'.
+-  :a
+-  s/\(.*\)\(\n.*\)/\1\\\2/
+-  P
+-# We cannot use D here.
+-  s/.*\n\(.*\)/\1/
+-  tb
+-}
+-d
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/loadinfo.h	1998-04-26 09:20:52.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/loadinfo.h	2004-09-12 14:40:34.468730912 -0400
+@@ -1,9 +1,54 @@
+-#ifndef PARAMS
+-# if __STDC__
+-#  define PARAMS(args) args
+-# else
+-#  define PARAMS(args) ()
+-# endif
++/* Copyright (C) 1996-1999, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++   This file is part of the GNU C Library.
++   Contributed by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1996.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifndef _LOADINFO_H
++#define _LOADINFO_H	1
++
++/* Declarations of locale dependent catalog lookup functions.
++   Implemented in
++
++     localealias.c    Possibly replace a locale name by another.
++     explodename.c    Split a locale name into its various fields.
++     l10nflist.c      Generate a list of filenames of possible message catalogs.
++     finddomain.c     Find and open the relevant message catalogs.
++
++   The main function _nl_find_domain() in finddomain.c is declared
++   in gettextP.h.
++ */
++
++#ifndef internal_function
++# define internal_function
++#endif
++
++/* Tell the compiler when a conditional or integer expression is
++   almost always true or almost always false.  */
++#ifndef HAVE_BUILTIN_EXPECT
++# define __builtin_expect(expr, val) (expr)
++#endif
++
++/* Separator in PATH like lists of pathnames.  */
++#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__
++  /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */
++# define PATH_SEPARATOR ';'
++#else
++  /* Unix */
++# define PATH_SEPARATOR ':'
+ #endif
+ 
+ /* Encoding of locale name parts.  */
+@@ -32,27 +77,69 @@
+ };
+ 
+ 
+-extern const char *_nl_normalize_codeset PARAMS ((const char *codeset,
+-						  size_t name_len));
++/* Normalize codeset name.  There is no standard for the codeset
++   names.  Normalization allows the user to use any of the common
++   names.  The return value is dynamically allocated and has to be
++   freed by the caller.  */
++extern const char *_nl_normalize_codeset (const char *codeset,
++					  size_t name_len);
+ 
++/* Lookup a locale dependent file.
++   *L10NFILE_LIST denotes a pool of lookup results of locale dependent
++   files of the same kind, sorted in decreasing order of ->filename.
++   DIRLIST and DIRLIST_LEN are an argz list of directories in which to
++   look, containing at least one directory (i.e. DIRLIST_LEN > 0).
++   MASK, LANGUAGE, TERRITORY, CODESET, NORMALIZED_CODESET, MODIFIER,
++   SPECIAL, SPONSOR, REVISION are the pieces of the locale name, as
++   produced by _nl_explode_name().  FILENAME is the filename suffix.
++   The return value is the lookup result, either found in *L10NFILE_LIST,
++   or - if DO_ALLOCATE is nonzero - freshly allocated, or possibly NULL.
++   If the return value is non-NULL, it is added to *L10NFILE_LIST, and
++   its ->next field denotes the chaining inside *L10NFILE_LIST, and
++   furthermore its ->successor[] field contains a list of other lookup
++   results from which this lookup result inherits.  */
+ extern struct loaded_l10nfile *
+-_nl_make_l10nflist PARAMS ((struct loaded_l10nfile **l10nfile_list,
+-			    const char *dirlist, size_t dirlist_len, int mask,
+-			    const char *language, const char *territory,
+-			    const char *codeset,
+-			    const char *normalized_codeset,
+-			    const char *modifier, const char *special,
+-			    const char *sponsor, const char *revision,
+-			    const char *filename, int do_allocate));
++_nl_make_l10nflist (struct loaded_l10nfile **l10nfile_list,
++		    const char *dirlist, size_t dirlist_len, int mask,
++		    const char *language, const char *territory,
++		    const char *codeset, const char *normalized_codeset,
++		    const char *modifier, const char *special,
++		    const char *sponsor, const char *revision,
++		    const char *filename, int do_allocate);
+ 
++/* Lookup the real locale name for a locale alias NAME, or NULL if
++   NAME is not a locale alias (but possibly a real locale name).
++   The return value is statically allocated and must not be freed.  */
++extern const char *_nl_expand_alias (const char *name);
+ 
+-extern const char *_nl_expand_alias PARAMS ((const char *name));
++/* Split a locale name NAME into its pieces: language, modifier,
++   territory, codeset, special, sponsor, revision.
++   NAME gets destructively modified: NUL bytes are inserted here and
++   there.  *LANGUAGE gets assigned NAME.  Each of *MODIFIER, *TERRITORY,
++   *CODESET, *SPECIAL, *SPONSOR, *REVISION gets assigned either a
++   pointer into the old NAME string, or NULL.  *NORMALIZED_CODESET
++   gets assigned the expanded *CODESET, if it is different from *CODESET;
++   this one is dynamically allocated and has to be freed by the caller.
++   The return value is a bitmask, where each bit corresponds to one
++   filled-in value:
++     XPG_MODIFIER, CEN_AUDIENCE  for *MODIFIER,
++     TERRITORY                   for *TERRITORY,
++     XPG_CODESET                 for *CODESET,
++     XPG_NORM_CODESET            for *NORMALIZED_CODESET,
++     CEN_SPECIAL                 for *SPECIAL,
++     CEN_SPONSOR                 for *SPONSOR,
++     CEN_REVISION                for *REVISION.
++ */
++extern int _nl_explode_name (char *name, const char **language,
++			     const char **modifier, const char **territory,
++			     const char **codeset,
++			     const char **normalized_codeset,
++			     const char **special, const char **sponsor,
++			     const char **revision);
+ 
+-extern int _nl_explode_name PARAMS ((char *name, const char **language,
+-				     const char **modifier,
+-				     const char **territory,
+-				     const char **codeset,
+-				     const char **normalized_codeset,
+-				     const char **special,
+-				     const char **sponsor,
+-				     const char **revision));
++/* Split a locale name NAME into a leading language part and all the
++   rest.  Return a pointer to the first character after the language,
++   i.e. to the first byte of the rest.  */
++extern char *_nl_find_language (const char *name);
++
++#endif	/* loadinfo.h */
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/loadmsgcat.c	1998-04-26 09:22:37.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/loadmsgcat.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.473730152 -0400
+@@ -1,42 +1,455 @@
+-/* Load needed message catalogs
+-   Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++/* Load needed message catalogs.
++   Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ 
+-   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+    any later version.
+ 
+    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-   GNU General Public License for more details.
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
+ 
+-   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+-   Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for mempcpy().
++   This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include
++   <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late.  */
++#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
++# define _GNU_SOURCE    1
++#endif
+ 
+ #ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+ # include <config.h>
+ #endif
+ 
++#include <ctype.h>
++#include <errno.h>
+ #include <fcntl.h>
+ #include <sys/types.h>
+ #include <sys/stat.h>
+ 
+-#if defined STDC_HEADERS || defined _LIBC
+-# include <stdlib.h>
++#ifdef __GNUC__
++# undef  alloca
++# define alloca __builtin_alloca
++# define HAVE_ALLOCA 1
++#else
++# ifdef _MSC_VER
++#  include <malloc.h>
++#  define alloca _alloca
++# else
++#  if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC
++#   include <alloca.h>
++#  else
++#   ifdef _AIX
++ #pragma alloca
++#   else
++#    ifndef alloca
++char *alloca ();
++#    endif
++#   endif
++#  endif
++# endif
+ #endif
+ 
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <string.h>
++
+ #if defined HAVE_UNISTD_H || defined _LIBC
+ # include <unistd.h>
+ #endif
+ 
+-#if (defined HAVE_MMAP && defined HAVE_MUNMAP) || defined _LIBC
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# include <langinfo.h>
++# include <locale.h>
++#endif
++
++#if (defined HAVE_MMAP && defined HAVE_MUNMAP && !defined DISALLOW_MMAP) \
++    || (defined _LIBC && defined _POSIX_MAPPED_FILES)
+ # include <sys/mman.h>
++# undef HAVE_MMAP
++# define HAVE_MMAP	1
++#else
++# undef HAVE_MMAP
+ #endif
+ 
+-#include "gettext.h"
++#if defined HAVE_STDINT_H_WITH_UINTMAX || defined _LIBC
++# include <stdint.h>
++#endif
++#if defined HAVE_INTTYPES_H || defined _LIBC
++# include <inttypes.h>
++#endif
++
++#include "gmo.h"
+ #include "gettextP.h"
++#include "hash-string.h"
++#include "plural-exp.h"
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# include "../locale/localeinfo.h"
++#endif
++
++/* Provide fallback values for macros that ought to be defined in <inttypes.h>.
++   Note that our fallback values need not be literal strings, because we don't
++   use them with preprocessor string concatenation.  */
++#if !defined PRId8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRId8
++# define PRId8 "d"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIi8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIi8
++# define PRIi8 "i"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIo8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIo8
++# define PRIo8 "o"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIu8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIu8
++# define PRIu8 "u"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIx8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIx8
++# define PRIx8 "x"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIX8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIX8
++# define PRIX8 "X"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRId16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRId16
++# define PRId16 "d"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIi16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIi16
++# define PRIi16 "i"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIo16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIo16
++# define PRIo16 "o"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIu16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIu16
++# define PRIu16 "u"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIx16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIx16
++# define PRIx16 "x"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIX16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIX16
++# define PRIX16 "X"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRId32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRId32
++# define PRId32 "d"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIi32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIi32
++# define PRIi32 "i"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIo32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIo32
++# define PRIo32 "o"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIu32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIu32
++# define PRIu32 "u"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIx32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIx32
++# define PRIx32 "x"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIX32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIX32
++# define PRIX32 "X"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRId64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRId64
++# define PRId64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "ld" : "lld")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIi64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIi64
++# define PRIi64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "li" : "lli")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIo64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIo64
++# define PRIo64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lo" : "llo")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIu64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIu64
++# define PRIu64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lu" : "llu")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIx64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIx64
++# define PRIx64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lx" : "llx")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIX64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIX64
++# define PRIX64 (sizeof (long) == 8 ? "lX" : "llX")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIdLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIdLEAST8
++# define PRIdLEAST8 "d"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIiLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIiLEAST8
++# define PRIiLEAST8 "i"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIoLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIoLEAST8
++# define PRIoLEAST8 "o"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIuLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIuLEAST8
++# define PRIuLEAST8 "u"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIxLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIxLEAST8
++# define PRIxLEAST8 "x"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIXLEAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIXLEAST8
++# define PRIXLEAST8 "X"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIdLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIdLEAST16
++# define PRIdLEAST16 "d"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIiLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIiLEAST16
++# define PRIiLEAST16 "i"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIoLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIoLEAST16
++# define PRIoLEAST16 "o"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIuLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIuLEAST16
++# define PRIuLEAST16 "u"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIxLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIxLEAST16
++# define PRIxLEAST16 "x"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIXLEAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIXLEAST16
++# define PRIXLEAST16 "X"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIdLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIdLEAST32
++# define PRIdLEAST32 "d"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIiLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIiLEAST32
++# define PRIiLEAST32 "i"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIoLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIoLEAST32
++# define PRIoLEAST32 "o"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIuLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIuLEAST32
++# define PRIuLEAST32 "u"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIxLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIxLEAST32
++# define PRIxLEAST32 "x"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIXLEAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIXLEAST32
++# define PRIXLEAST32 "X"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIdLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIdLEAST64
++# define PRIdLEAST64 PRId64
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIiLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIiLEAST64
++# define PRIiLEAST64 PRIi64
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIoLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIoLEAST64
++# define PRIoLEAST64 PRIo64
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIuLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIuLEAST64
++# define PRIuLEAST64 PRIu64
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIxLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIxLEAST64
++# define PRIxLEAST64 PRIx64
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIXLEAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIXLEAST64
++# define PRIXLEAST64 PRIX64
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIdFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIdFAST8
++# define PRIdFAST8 "d"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIiFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIiFAST8
++# define PRIiFAST8 "i"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIoFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIoFAST8
++# define PRIoFAST8 "o"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIuFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIuFAST8
++# define PRIuFAST8 "u"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIxFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIxFAST8
++# define PRIxFAST8 "x"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIXFAST8 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIXFAST8
++# define PRIXFAST8 "X"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIdFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIdFAST16
++# define PRIdFAST16 "d"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIiFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIiFAST16
++# define PRIiFAST16 "i"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIoFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIoFAST16
++# define PRIoFAST16 "o"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIuFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIuFAST16
++# define PRIuFAST16 "u"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIxFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIxFAST16
++# define PRIxFAST16 "x"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIXFAST16 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIXFAST16
++# define PRIXFAST16 "X"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIdFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIdFAST32
++# define PRIdFAST32 "d"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIiFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIiFAST32
++# define PRIiFAST32 "i"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIoFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIoFAST32
++# define PRIoFAST32 "o"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIuFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIuFAST32
++# define PRIuFAST32 "u"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIxFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIxFAST32
++# define PRIxFAST32 "x"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIXFAST32 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIXFAST32
++# define PRIXFAST32 "X"
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIdFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIdFAST64
++# define PRIdFAST64 PRId64
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIiFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIiFAST64
++# define PRIiFAST64 PRIi64
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIoFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIoFAST64
++# define PRIoFAST64 PRIo64
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIuFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIuFAST64
++# define PRIuFAST64 PRIu64
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIxFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIxFAST64
++# define PRIxFAST64 PRIx64
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIXFAST64 || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIXFAST64
++# define PRIXFAST64 PRIX64
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIdMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIdMAX
++# define PRIdMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "ld" : "lld")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIiMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIiMAX
++# define PRIiMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "li" : "lli")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIoMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIoMAX
++# define PRIoMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lo" : "llo")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIuMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIuMAX
++# define PRIuMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lu" : "llu")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIxMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIxMAX
++# define PRIxMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lx" : "llx")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIXMAX || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIXMAX
++# define PRIXMAX (sizeof (uintmax_t) == sizeof (long) ? "lX" : "llX")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIdPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIdPTR
++# define PRIdPTR \
++  (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "ld" : \
++   sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "d" : \
++   "lld")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIiPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIiPTR
++# define PRIiPTR \
++  (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "li" : \
++   sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "i" : \
++   "lli")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIoPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIoPTR
++# define PRIoPTR \
++  (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lo" : \
++   sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "o" : \
++   "llo")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIuPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIuPTR
++# define PRIuPTR \
++  (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lu" : \
++   sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "u" : \
++   "llu")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIxPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIxPTR
++# define PRIxPTR \
++  (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lx" : \
++   sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "x" : \
++   "llx")
++#endif
++#if !defined PRIXPTR || PRI_MACROS_BROKEN
++# undef PRIXPTR
++# define PRIXPTR \
++  (sizeof (void *) == sizeof (long) ? "lX" : \
++   sizeof (void *) == sizeof (int) ? "X" : \
++   "llX")
++#endif
+ 
+ /* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+ 
+@@ -44,7 +457,6 @@
+ /* Rename the non ISO C functions.  This is required by the standard
+    because some ISO C functions will require linking with this object
+    file and the name space must not be polluted.  */
+-# define fstat  __fstat
+ # define open   __open
+ # define close  __close
+ # define read   __read
+@@ -52,30 +464,471 @@
+ # define munmap __munmap
+ #endif
+ 
++/* For those losing systems which don't have `alloca' we have to add
++   some additional code emulating it.  */
++#ifdef HAVE_ALLOCA
++# define freea(p) /* nothing */
++#else
++# define alloca(n) malloc (n)
++# define freea(p) free (p)
++#endif
++
++/* For systems that distinguish between text and binary I/O.
++   O_BINARY is usually declared in <fcntl.h>. */
++#if !defined O_BINARY && defined _O_BINARY
++  /* For MSC-compatible compilers.  */
++# define O_BINARY _O_BINARY
++# define O_TEXT _O_TEXT
++#endif
++#ifdef __BEOS__
++  /* BeOS 5 has O_BINARY and O_TEXT, but they have no effect.  */
++# undef O_BINARY
++# undef O_TEXT
++#endif
++/* On reasonable systems, binary I/O is the default.  */
++#ifndef O_BINARY
++# define O_BINARY 0
++#endif
++
++
+ /* We need a sign, whether a new catalog was loaded, which can be associated
+    with all translations.  This is important if the translations are
+    cached by one of GCC's features.  */
+-int _nl_msg_cat_cntr = 0;
++int _nl_msg_cat_cntr;
+ 
+ 
++/* Expand a system dependent string segment.  Return NULL if unsupported.  */
++static const char *
++get_sysdep_segment_value (const char *name)
++{
++  /* Test for an ISO C 99 section 7.8.1 format string directive.
++     Syntax:
++     P R I { d | i | o | u | x | X }
++     { { | LEAST | FAST } { 8 | 16 | 32 | 64 } | MAX | PTR }  */
++  /* We don't use a table of 14 times 6 'const char *' strings here, because
++     data relocations cost startup time.  */
++  if (name[0] == 'P' && name[1] == 'R' && name[2] == 'I')
++    {
++      if (name[3] == 'd' || name[3] == 'i' || name[3] == 'o' || name[3] == 'u'
++	  || name[3] == 'x' || name[3] == 'X')
++	{
++	  if (name[4] == '8' && name[5] == '\0')
++	    {
++	      if (name[3] == 'd')
++		return PRId8;
++	      if (name[3] == 'i')
++		return PRIi8;
++	      if (name[3] == 'o')
++		return PRIo8;
++	      if (name[3] == 'u')
++		return PRIu8;
++	      if (name[3] == 'x')
++		return PRIx8;
++	      if (name[3] == 'X')
++		return PRIX8;
++	      abort ();
++	    }
++	  if (name[4] == '1' && name[5] == '6' && name[6] == '\0')
++	    {
++	      if (name[3] == 'd')
++		return PRId16;
++	      if (name[3] == 'i')
++		return PRIi16;
++	      if (name[3] == 'o')
++		return PRIo16;
++	      if (name[3] == 'u')
++		return PRIu16;
++	      if (name[3] == 'x')
++		return PRIx16;
++	      if (name[3] == 'X')
++		return PRIX16;
++	      abort ();
++	    }
++	  if (name[4] == '3' && name[5] == '2' && name[6] == '\0')
++	    {
++	      if (name[3] == 'd')
++		return PRId32;
++	      if (name[3] == 'i')
++		return PRIi32;
++	      if (name[3] == 'o')
++		return PRIo32;
++	      if (name[3] == 'u')
++		return PRIu32;
++	      if (name[3] == 'x')
++		return PRIx32;
++	      if (name[3] == 'X')
++		return PRIX32;
++	      abort ();
++	    }
++	  if (name[4] == '6' && name[5] == '4' && name[6] == '\0')
++	    {
++	      if (name[3] == 'd')
++		return PRId64;
++	      if (name[3] == 'i')
++		return PRIi64;
++	      if (name[3] == 'o')
++		return PRIo64;
++	      if (name[3] == 'u')
++		return PRIu64;
++	      if (name[3] == 'x')
++		return PRIx64;
++	      if (name[3] == 'X')
++		return PRIX64;
++	      abort ();
++	    }
++	  if (name[4] == 'L' && name[5] == 'E' && name[6] == 'A'
++	      && name[7] == 'S' && name[8] == 'T')
++	    {
++	      if (name[9] == '8' && name[10] == '\0')
++		{
++		  if (name[3] == 'd')
++		    return PRIdLEAST8;
++		  if (name[3] == 'i')
++		    return PRIiLEAST8;
++		  if (name[3] == 'o')
++		    return PRIoLEAST8;
++		  if (name[3] == 'u')
++		    return PRIuLEAST8;
++		  if (name[3] == 'x')
++		    return PRIxLEAST8;
++		  if (name[3] == 'X')
++		    return PRIXLEAST8;
++		  abort ();
++		}
++	      if (name[9] == '1' && name[10] == '6' && name[11] == '\0')
++		{
++		  if (name[3] == 'd')
++		    return PRIdLEAST16;
++		  if (name[3] == 'i')
++		    return PRIiLEAST16;
++		  if (name[3] == 'o')
++		    return PRIoLEAST16;
++		  if (name[3] == 'u')
++		    return PRIuLEAST16;
++		  if (name[3] == 'x')
++		    return PRIxLEAST16;
++		  if (name[3] == 'X')
++		    return PRIXLEAST16;
++		  abort ();
++		}
++	      if (name[9] == '3' && name[10] == '2' && name[11] == '\0')
++		{
++		  if (name[3] == 'd')
++		    return PRIdLEAST32;
++		  if (name[3] == 'i')
++		    return PRIiLEAST32;
++		  if (name[3] == 'o')
++		    return PRIoLEAST32;
++		  if (name[3] == 'u')
++		    return PRIuLEAST32;
++		  if (name[3] == 'x')
++		    return PRIxLEAST32;
++		  if (name[3] == 'X')
++		    return PRIXLEAST32;
++		  abort ();
++		}
++	      if (name[9] == '6' && name[10] == '4' && name[11] == '\0')
++		{
++		  if (name[3] == 'd')
++		    return PRIdLEAST64;
++		  if (name[3] == 'i')
++		    return PRIiLEAST64;
++		  if (name[3] == 'o')
++		    return PRIoLEAST64;
++		  if (name[3] == 'u')
++		    return PRIuLEAST64;
++		  if (name[3] == 'x')
++		    return PRIxLEAST64;
++		  if (name[3] == 'X')
++		    return PRIXLEAST64;
++		  abort ();
++		}
++	    }
++	  if (name[4] == 'F' && name[5] == 'A' && name[6] == 'S'
++	      && name[7] == 'T')
++	    {
++	      if (name[8] == '8' && name[9] == '\0')
++		{
++		  if (name[3] == 'd')
++		    return PRIdFAST8;
++		  if (name[3] == 'i')
++		    return PRIiFAST8;
++		  if (name[3] == 'o')
++		    return PRIoFAST8;
++		  if (name[3] == 'u')
++		    return PRIuFAST8;
++		  if (name[3] == 'x')
++		    return PRIxFAST8;
++		  if (name[3] == 'X')
++		    return PRIXFAST8;
++		  abort ();
++		}
++	      if (name[8] == '1' && name[9] == '6' && name[10] == '\0')
++		{
++		  if (name[3] == 'd')
++		    return PRIdFAST16;
++		  if (name[3] == 'i')
++		    return PRIiFAST16;
++		  if (name[3] == 'o')
++		    return PRIoFAST16;
++		  if (name[3] == 'u')
++		    return PRIuFAST16;
++		  if (name[3] == 'x')
++		    return PRIxFAST16;
++		  if (name[3] == 'X')
++		    return PRIXFAST16;
++		  abort ();
++		}
++	      if (name[8] == '3' && name[9] == '2' && name[10] == '\0')
++		{
++		  if (name[3] == 'd')
++		    return PRIdFAST32;
++		  if (name[3] == 'i')
++		    return PRIiFAST32;
++		  if (name[3] == 'o')
++		    return PRIoFAST32;
++		  if (name[3] == 'u')
++		    return PRIuFAST32;
++		  if (name[3] == 'x')
++		    return PRIxFAST32;
++		  if (name[3] == 'X')
++		    return PRIXFAST32;
++		  abort ();
++		}
++	      if (name[8] == '6' && name[9] == '4' && name[10] == '\0')
++		{
++		  if (name[3] == 'd')
++		    return PRIdFAST64;
++		  if (name[3] == 'i')
++		    return PRIiFAST64;
++		  if (name[3] == 'o')
++		    return PRIoFAST64;
++		  if (name[3] == 'u')
++		    return PRIuFAST64;
++		  if (name[3] == 'x')
++		    return PRIxFAST64;
++		  if (name[3] == 'X')
++		    return PRIXFAST64;
++		  abort ();
++		}
++	    }
++	  if (name[4] == 'M' && name[5] == 'A' && name[6] == 'X'
++	      && name[7] == '\0')
++	    {
++	      if (name[3] == 'd')
++		return PRIdMAX;
++	      if (name[3] == 'i')
++		return PRIiMAX;
++	      if (name[3] == 'o')
++		return PRIoMAX;
++	      if (name[3] == 'u')
++		return PRIuMAX;
++	      if (name[3] == 'x')
++		return PRIxMAX;
++	      if (name[3] == 'X')
++		return PRIXMAX;
++	      abort ();
++	    }
++	  if (name[4] == 'P' && name[5] == 'T' && name[6] == 'R'
++	      && name[7] == '\0')
++	    {
++	      if (name[3] == 'd')
++		return PRIdPTR;
++	      if (name[3] == 'i')
++		return PRIiPTR;
++	      if (name[3] == 'o')
++		return PRIoPTR;
++	      if (name[3] == 'u')
++		return PRIuPTR;
++	      if (name[3] == 'x')
++		return PRIxPTR;
++	      if (name[3] == 'X')
++		return PRIXPTR;
++	      abort ();
++	    }
++	}
++    }
++  /* Test for a glibc specific printf() format directive flag.  */
++  if (name[0] == 'I' && name[1] == '\0')
++    {
++#if defined _LIBC || __GLIBC__ > 2 || (__GLIBC__ == 2 && __GLIBC_MINOR__ >= 2)
++      /* The 'I' flag, in numeric format directives, replaces ASCII digits
++	 with the 'outdigits' defined in the LC_CTYPE locale facet.  This is
++	 used for Farsi (Persian) and maybe Arabic.  */
++      return "I";
++#else
++      return "";
++#endif
++    }
++  /* Other system dependent strings are not valid.  */
++  return NULL;
++}
++
++/* Initialize the codeset dependent parts of an opened message catalog.
++   Return the header entry.  */
++const char *
++internal_function
++_nl_init_domain_conv (struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file,
++		      struct loaded_domain *domain,
++		      struct binding *domainbinding)
++{
++  /* Find out about the character set the file is encoded with.
++     This can be found (in textual form) in the entry "".  If this
++     entry does not exist or if this does not contain the `charset='
++     information, we will assume the charset matches the one the
++     current locale and we don't have to perform any conversion.  */
++  char *nullentry;
++  size_t nullentrylen;
++
++  /* Preinitialize fields, to avoid recursion during _nl_find_msg.  */
++  domain->codeset_cntr =
++    (domainbinding != NULL ? domainbinding->codeset_cntr : 0);
++#ifdef _LIBC
++  domain->conv = (__gconv_t) -1;
++#else
++# if HAVE_ICONV
++  domain->conv = (iconv_t) -1;
++# endif
++#endif
++  domain->conv_tab = NULL;
++
++  /* Get the header entry.  */
++  nullentry = _nl_find_msg (domain_file, domainbinding, "", &nullentrylen);
++
++  if (nullentry != NULL)
++    {
++#if defined _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV
++      const char *charsetstr;
++
++      charsetstr = strstr (nullentry, "charset=");
++      if (charsetstr != NULL)
++	{
++	  size_t len;
++	  char *charset;
++	  const char *outcharset;
++
++	  charsetstr += strlen ("charset=");
++	  len = strcspn (charsetstr, " \t\n");
++
++	  charset = (char *) alloca (len + 1);
++# if defined _LIBC || HAVE_MEMPCPY
++	  *((char *) mempcpy (charset, charsetstr, len)) = '\0';
++# else
++	  memcpy (charset, charsetstr, len);
++	  charset[len] = '\0';
++# endif
++
++	  /* The output charset should normally be determined by the
++	     locale.  But sometimes the locale is not used or not correctly
++	     set up, so we provide a possibility for the user to override
++	     this.  Moreover, the value specified through
++	     bind_textdomain_codeset overrides both.  */
++	  if (domainbinding != NULL && domainbinding->codeset != NULL)
++	    outcharset = domainbinding->codeset;
++	  else
++	    {
++	      outcharset = getenv ("OUTPUT_CHARSET");
++	      if (outcharset == NULL || outcharset[0] == '\0')
++		{
++# ifdef _LIBC
++		  outcharset = _NL_CURRENT (LC_CTYPE, CODESET);
++# else
++#  if HAVE_ICONV
++		  extern const char *locale_charset (void);
++		  outcharset = locale_charset ();
++#  endif
++# endif
++		}
++	    }
++
++# ifdef _LIBC
++	  /* We always want to use transliteration.  */
++	  outcharset = norm_add_slashes (outcharset, "TRANSLIT");
++	  charset = norm_add_slashes (charset, NULL);
++	  if (__gconv_open (outcharset, charset, &domain->conv,
++			    GCONV_AVOID_NOCONV)
++	      != __GCONV_OK)
++	    domain->conv = (__gconv_t) -1;
++# else
++#  if HAVE_ICONV
++	  /* When using GNU libc >= 2.2 or GNU libiconv >= 1.5,
++	     we want to use transliteration.  */
++#   if (__GLIBC__ == 2 && __GLIBC_MINOR__ >= 2) || __GLIBC__ > 2 \
++       || _LIBICONV_VERSION >= 0x0105
++	  if (strchr (outcharset, '/') == NULL)
++	    {
++	      char *tmp;
++
++	      len = strlen (outcharset);
++	      tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 10 + 1);
++	      memcpy (tmp, outcharset, len);
++	      memcpy (tmp + len, "//TRANSLIT", 10 + 1);
++	      outcharset = tmp;
++
++	      domain->conv = iconv_open (outcharset, charset);
++
++	      freea (outcharset);
++	    }
++	  else
++#   endif
++	    domain->conv = iconv_open (outcharset, charset);
++#  endif
++# endif
++
++	  freea (charset);
++	}
++#endif /* _LIBC || HAVE_ICONV */
++    }
++
++  return nullentry;
++}
++
++/* Frees the codeset dependent parts of an opened message catalog.  */
++void
++internal_function
++_nl_free_domain_conv (struct loaded_domain *domain)
++{
++  if (domain->conv_tab != NULL && domain->conv_tab != (char **) -1)
++    free (domain->conv_tab);
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++  if (domain->conv != (__gconv_t) -1)
++    __gconv_close (domain->conv);
++#else
++# if HAVE_ICONV
++  if (domain->conv != (iconv_t) -1)
++    iconv_close (domain->conv);
++# endif
++#endif
++}
++
+ /* Load the message catalogs specified by FILENAME.  If it is no valid
+    message catalog do nothing.  */
+ void
+-_nl_load_domain (domain_file)
+-     struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file;
++internal_function
++_nl_load_domain (struct loaded_l10nfile *domain_file,
++		 struct binding *domainbinding)
+ {
+   int fd;
++  size_t size;
++#ifdef _LIBC
++  struct stat64 st;
++#else
+   struct stat st;
++#endif
+   struct mo_file_header *data = (struct mo_file_header *) -1;
+-#if (defined HAVE_MMAP && defined HAVE_MUNMAP && !defined DISALLOW_MMAP) \
+-    || defined _LIBC
+   int use_mmap = 0;
+-#endif
+   struct loaded_domain *domain;
++  int revision;
++  const char *nullentry;
+ 
+   domain_file->decided = 1;
+   domain_file->data = NULL;
+ 
++  /* Note that it would be useless to store domainbinding in domain_file
++     because domainbinding might be == NULL now but != NULL later (after
++     a call to bind_textdomain_codeset).  */
++
+   /* If the record does not represent a valid locale the FILENAME
+      might be NULL.  This can happen when according to the given
+      specification the locale file name is different for XPG and CEN
+@@ -84,27 +937,32 @@
+     return;
+ 
+   /* Try to open the addressed file.  */
+-  fd = open (domain_file->filename, O_RDONLY);
++  fd = open (domain_file->filename, O_RDONLY | O_BINARY);
+   if (fd == -1)
+     return;
+ 
+   /* We must know about the size of the file.  */
+-  if (fstat (fd, &st) != 0
+-      && st.st_size < (off_t) sizeof (struct mo_file_header))
++  if (
++#ifdef _LIBC
++      __builtin_expect (fstat64 (fd, &st) != 0, 0)
++#else
++      __builtin_expect (fstat (fd, &st) != 0, 0)
++#endif
++      || __builtin_expect ((size = (size_t) st.st_size) != st.st_size, 0)
++      || __builtin_expect (size < sizeof (struct mo_file_header), 0))
+     {
+       /* Something went wrong.  */
+       close (fd);
+       return;
+     }
+ 
+-#if (defined HAVE_MMAP && defined HAVE_MUNMAP && !defined DISALLOW_MMAP) \
+-    || defined _LIBC
++#ifdef HAVE_MMAP
+   /* Now we are ready to load the file.  If mmap() is available we try
+      this first.  If not available or it failed we try to load it.  */
+-  data = (struct mo_file_header *) mmap (NULL, st.st_size, PROT_READ,
++  data = (struct mo_file_header *) mmap (NULL, size, PROT_READ,
+ 					 MAP_PRIVATE, fd, 0);
+ 
+-  if (data != (struct mo_file_header *) -1)
++  if (__builtin_expect (data != (struct mo_file_header *) -1, 1))
+     {
+       /* mmap() call was successful.  */
+       close (fd);
+@@ -116,24 +974,27 @@
+      it manually.  */
+   if (data == (struct mo_file_header *) -1)
+     {
+-      off_t to_read;
++      size_t to_read;
+       char *read_ptr;
+ 
+-      data = (struct mo_file_header *) malloc (st.st_size);
++      data = (struct mo_file_header *) malloc (size);
+       if (data == NULL)
+ 	return;
+ 
+-      to_read = st.st_size;
++      to_read = size;
+       read_ptr = (char *) data;
+       do
+ 	{
+ 	  long int nb = (long int) read (fd, read_ptr, to_read);
+-	  if (nb == -1)
++	  if (nb <= 0)
+ 	    {
++#ifdef EINTR
++	      if (nb == -1 && errno == EINTR)
++		continue;
++#endif
+ 	      close (fd);
+ 	      return;
+ 	    }
+-
+ 	  read_ptr += nb;
+ 	  to_read -= nb;
+ 	}
+@@ -144,47 +1005,378 @@
+ 
+   /* Using the magic number we can test whether it really is a message
+      catalog file.  */
+-  if (data->magic != _MAGIC && data->magic != _MAGIC_SWAPPED)
++  if (__builtin_expect (data->magic != _MAGIC && data->magic != _MAGIC_SWAPPED,
++			0))
+     {
+       /* The magic number is wrong: not a message catalog file.  */
+-#if (defined HAVE_MMAP && defined HAVE_MUNMAP && !defined DISALLOW_MMAP) \
+-    || defined _LIBC
++#ifdef HAVE_MMAP
+       if (use_mmap)
+-	munmap ((caddr_t) data, st.st_size);
++	munmap ((caddr_t) data, size);
+       else
+ #endif
+ 	free (data);
+       return;
+     }
+ 
+-  domain_file->data
+-    = (struct loaded_domain *) malloc (sizeof (struct loaded_domain));
+-  if (domain_file->data == NULL)
++  domain = (struct loaded_domain *) malloc (sizeof (struct loaded_domain));
++  if (domain == NULL)
+     return;
++  domain_file->data = domain;
+ 
+-  domain = (struct loaded_domain *) domain_file->data;
+   domain->data = (char *) data;
++  domain->use_mmap = use_mmap;
++  domain->mmap_size = size;
+   domain->must_swap = data->magic != _MAGIC;
++  domain->malloced = NULL;
+ 
+   /* Fill in the information about the available tables.  */
+-  switch (W (domain->must_swap, data->revision))
++  revision = W (domain->must_swap, data->revision);
++  /* We support only the major revisions 0 and 1.  */
++  switch (revision >> 16)
+     {
+     case 0:
++    case 1:
+       domain->nstrings = W (domain->must_swap, data->nstrings);
+-      domain->orig_tab = (struct string_desc *)
++      domain->orig_tab = (const struct string_desc *)
+ 	((char *) data + W (domain->must_swap, data->orig_tab_offset));
+-      domain->trans_tab = (struct string_desc *)
++      domain->trans_tab = (const struct string_desc *)
+ 	((char *) data + W (domain->must_swap, data->trans_tab_offset));
+       domain->hash_size = W (domain->must_swap, data->hash_tab_size);
+-      domain->hash_tab = (nls_uint32 *)
+-	((char *) data + W (domain->must_swap, data->hash_tab_offset));
++      domain->hash_tab =
++	(domain->hash_size > 2
++	 ? (const nls_uint32 *)
++	   ((char *) data + W (domain->must_swap, data->hash_tab_offset))
++	 : NULL);
++      domain->must_swap_hash_tab = domain->must_swap;
++
++      /* Now dispatch on the minor revision.  */
++      switch (revision & 0xffff)
++	{
++	case 0:
++	  domain->n_sysdep_strings = 0;
++	  domain->orig_sysdep_tab = NULL;
++	  domain->trans_sysdep_tab = NULL;
++	  break;
++	case 1:
++	default:
++	  {
++	    nls_uint32 n_sysdep_strings;
++
++	    if (domain->hash_tab == NULL)
++	      /* This is invalid.  These minor revisions need a hash table.  */
++	      goto invalid;
++
++	    n_sysdep_strings =
++	      W (domain->must_swap, data->n_sysdep_strings);
++	    if (n_sysdep_strings > 0)
++	      {
++		nls_uint32 n_sysdep_segments;
++		const struct sysdep_segment *sysdep_segments;
++		const char **sysdep_segment_values;
++		const nls_uint32 *orig_sysdep_tab;
++		const nls_uint32 *trans_sysdep_tab;
++		nls_uint32 n_inmem_sysdep_strings;
++		size_t memneed;
++		char *mem;
++		struct sysdep_string_desc *inmem_orig_sysdep_tab;
++		struct sysdep_string_desc *inmem_trans_sysdep_tab;
++		nls_uint32 *inmem_hash_tab;
++		unsigned int i, j;
++
++		/* Get the values of the system dependent segments.  */
++		n_sysdep_segments =
++		  W (domain->must_swap, data->n_sysdep_segments);
++		sysdep_segments = (const struct sysdep_segment *)
++		  ((char *) data
++		   + W (domain->must_swap, data->sysdep_segments_offset));
++		sysdep_segment_values =
++		  alloca (n_sysdep_segments * sizeof (const char *));
++		for (i = 0; i < n_sysdep_segments; i++)
++		  {
++		    const char *name =
++		      (char *) data
++		      + W (domain->must_swap, sysdep_segments[i].offset);
++		    nls_uint32 namelen =
++		      W (domain->must_swap, sysdep_segments[i].length);
++
++		    if (!(namelen > 0 && name[namelen - 1] == '\0'))
++		      {
++			freea (sysdep_segment_values);
++			goto invalid;
++		      }
++
++		    sysdep_segment_values[i] = get_sysdep_segment_value (name);
++		  }
++
++		orig_sysdep_tab = (const nls_uint32 *)
++		  ((char *) data
++		   + W (domain->must_swap, data->orig_sysdep_tab_offset));
++		trans_sysdep_tab = (const nls_uint32 *)
++		  ((char *) data
++		   + W (domain->must_swap, data->trans_sysdep_tab_offset));
++
++		/* Compute the amount of additional memory needed for the
++		   system dependent strings and the augmented hash table.
++		   At the same time, also drop string pairs which refer to
++		   an undefined system dependent segment.  */
++		n_inmem_sysdep_strings = 0;
++		memneed = domain->hash_size * sizeof (nls_uint32);
++		for (i = 0; i < n_sysdep_strings; i++)
++		  {
++		    int valid = 1;
++		    size_t needs[2];
++
++		    for (j = 0; j < 2; j++)
++		      {
++			const struct sysdep_string *sysdep_string =
++			  (const struct sysdep_string *)
++			  ((char *) data
++			   + W (domain->must_swap,
++				j == 0
++				? orig_sysdep_tab[i]
++				: trans_sysdep_tab[i]));
++			size_t need = 0;
++			const struct segment_pair *p = sysdep_string->segments;
++
++			if (W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref) != SEGMENTS_END)
++			  for (p = sysdep_string->segments;; p++)
++			    {
++			      nls_uint32 sysdepref;
++
++			      need += W (domain->must_swap, p->segsize);
++
++			      sysdepref = W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref);
++			      if (sysdepref == SEGMENTS_END)
++				break;
++
++			      if (sysdepref >= n_sysdep_segments)
++				{
++				  /* Invalid.  */
++				  freea (sysdep_segment_values);
++				  goto invalid;
++				}
++
++			      if (sysdep_segment_values[sysdepref] == NULL)
++				{
++				  /* This particular string pair is invalid.  */
++				  valid = 0;
++				  break;
++				}
++
++			      need += strlen (sysdep_segment_values[sysdepref]);
++			    }
++
++			needs[j] = need;
++			if (!valid)
++			  break;
++		      }
++
++		    if (valid)
++		      {
++			n_inmem_sysdep_strings++;
++			memneed += needs[0] + needs[1];
++		      }
++		  }
++		memneed += 2 * n_inmem_sysdep_strings
++			   * sizeof (struct sysdep_string_desc);
++
++		if (n_inmem_sysdep_strings > 0)
++		  {
++		    unsigned int k;
++
++		    /* Allocate additional memory.  */
++		    mem = (char *) malloc (memneed);
++		    if (mem == NULL)
++		      goto invalid;
++
++		    domain->malloced = mem;
++		    inmem_orig_sysdep_tab = (struct sysdep_string_desc *) mem;
++		    mem += n_inmem_sysdep_strings
++			   * sizeof (struct sysdep_string_desc);
++		    inmem_trans_sysdep_tab = (struct sysdep_string_desc *) mem;
++		    mem += n_inmem_sysdep_strings
++			   * sizeof (struct sysdep_string_desc);
++		    inmem_hash_tab = (nls_uint32 *) mem;
++		    mem += domain->hash_size * sizeof (nls_uint32);
++
++		    /* Compute the system dependent strings.  */
++		    k = 0;
++		    for (i = 0; i < n_sysdep_strings; i++)
++		      {
++			int valid = 1;
++
++			for (j = 0; j < 2; j++)
++			  {
++			    const struct sysdep_string *sysdep_string =
++			      (const struct sysdep_string *)
++			      ((char *) data
++			       + W (domain->must_swap,
++				    j == 0
++				    ? orig_sysdep_tab[i]
++				    : trans_sysdep_tab[i]));
++			    const struct segment_pair *p =
++			      sysdep_string->segments;
++
++			    if (W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref)
++				!= SEGMENTS_END)
++			      for (p = sysdep_string->segments;; p++)
++				{
++				  nls_uint32 sysdepref;
++
++				  sysdepref =
++				    W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref);
++				  if (sysdepref == SEGMENTS_END)
++				    break;
++
++				  if (sysdep_segment_values[sysdepref] == NULL)
++				    {
++				      /* This particular string pair is
++					 invalid.  */
++				      valid = 0;
++				      break;
++				    }
++				}
++
++			    if (!valid)
++			      break;
++			  }
++
++			if (valid)
++			  {
++			    for (j = 0; j < 2; j++)
++			      {
++				const struct sysdep_string *sysdep_string =
++				  (const struct sysdep_string *)
++				  ((char *) data
++				   + W (domain->must_swap,
++					j == 0
++					? orig_sysdep_tab[i]
++					: trans_sysdep_tab[i]));
++				const char *static_segments =
++				  (char *) data
++				  + W (domain->must_swap, sysdep_string->offset);
++				const struct segment_pair *p =
++				  sysdep_string->segments;
++
++				/* Concatenate the segments, and fill
++				   inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[k] (for j == 0) and
++				   inmem_trans_sysdep_tab[k] (for j == 1).  */
++
++				struct sysdep_string_desc *inmem_tab_entry =
++				  (j == 0
++				   ? inmem_orig_sysdep_tab
++				   : inmem_trans_sysdep_tab)
++				  + k;
++
++				if (W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref)
++				    == SEGMENTS_END)
++				  {
++				    /* Only one static segment.  */
++				    inmem_tab_entry->length =
++				      W (domain->must_swap, p->segsize);
++				    inmem_tab_entry->pointer = static_segments;
++				  }
++				else
++				  {
++				    inmem_tab_entry->pointer = mem;
++
++				    for (p = sysdep_string->segments;; p++)
++				      {
++					nls_uint32 segsize =
++					  W (domain->must_swap, p->segsize);
++					nls_uint32 sysdepref =
++					  W (domain->must_swap, p->sysdepref);
++					size_t n;
++
++					if (segsize > 0)
++					  {
++					    memcpy (mem, static_segments, segsize);
++					    mem += segsize;
++					    static_segments += segsize;
++					  }
++
++					if (sysdepref == SEGMENTS_END)
++					  break;
++
++					n = strlen (sysdep_segment_values[sysdepref]);
++					memcpy (mem, sysdep_segment_values[sysdepref], n);
++					mem += n;
++				      }
++
++				    inmem_tab_entry->length =
++				      mem - inmem_tab_entry->pointer;
++				  }
++			      }
++
++			    k++;
++			  }
++		      }
++		    if (k != n_inmem_sysdep_strings)
++		      abort ();
++
++		    /* Compute the augmented hash table.  */
++		    for (i = 0; i < domain->hash_size; i++)
++		      inmem_hash_tab[i] =
++			W (domain->must_swap_hash_tab, domain->hash_tab[i]);
++		    for (i = 0; i < n_inmem_sysdep_strings; i++)
++		      {
++			const char *msgid = inmem_orig_sysdep_tab[i].pointer;
++			nls_uint32 hash_val = hash_string (msgid);
++			nls_uint32 idx = hash_val % domain->hash_size;
++			nls_uint32 incr =
++			  1 + (hash_val % (domain->hash_size - 2));
++
++			for (;;)
++			  {
++			    if (inmem_hash_tab[idx] == 0)
++			      {
++				/* Hash table entry is empty.  Use it.  */
++				inmem_hash_tab[idx] = 1 + domain->nstrings + i;
++				break;
++			      }
++
++			    if (idx >= domain->hash_size - incr)
++			      idx -= domain->hash_size - incr;
++			    else
++			      idx += incr;
++			  }
++		      }
++
++		    domain->n_sysdep_strings = n_inmem_sysdep_strings;
++		    domain->orig_sysdep_tab = inmem_orig_sysdep_tab;
++		    domain->trans_sysdep_tab = inmem_trans_sysdep_tab;
++
++		    domain->hash_tab = inmem_hash_tab;
++		    domain->must_swap_hash_tab = 0;
++		  }
++		else
++		  {
++		    domain->n_sysdep_strings = 0;
++		    domain->orig_sysdep_tab = NULL;
++		    domain->trans_sysdep_tab = NULL;
++		  }
++
++		freea (sysdep_segment_values);
++	      }
++	    else
++	      {
++		domain->n_sysdep_strings = 0;
++		domain->orig_sysdep_tab = NULL;
++		domain->trans_sysdep_tab = NULL;
++	      }
++	  }
++	  break;
++	}
+       break;
+     default:
+-      /* This is an illegal revision.  */
+-#if (defined HAVE_MMAP && defined HAVE_MUNMAP && !defined DISALLOW_MMAP) \
+-    || defined _LIBC
++      /* This is an invalid revision.  */
++    invalid:
++      /* This is an invalid .mo file.  */
++      if (domain->malloced)
++	free (domain->malloced);
++#ifdef HAVE_MMAP
+       if (use_mmap)
+-	munmap ((caddr_t) data, st.st_size);
++	munmap ((caddr_t) data, size);
+       else
+ #endif
+ 	free (data);
+@@ -193,7 +1385,36 @@
+       return;
+     }
+ 
+-  /* Show that one domain is changed.  This might make some cached
+-     translations invalid.  */
+-  ++_nl_msg_cat_cntr;
++  /* Now initialize the character set converter from the character set
++     the file is encoded with (found in the header entry) to the domain's
++     specified character set or the locale's character set.  */
++  nullentry = _nl_init_domain_conv (domain_file, domain, domainbinding);
++
++  /* Also look for a plural specification.  */
++  EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION (nullentry, &domain->plural, &domain->nplurals);
+ }
++
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++void
++internal_function
++_nl_unload_domain (struct loaded_domain *domain)
++{
++  if (domain->plural != &__gettext_germanic_plural)
++    __gettext_free_exp (domain->plural);
++
++  _nl_free_domain_conv (domain);
++
++  if (domain->malloced)
++    free (domain->malloced);
++
++# ifdef _POSIX_MAPPED_FILES
++  if (domain->use_mmap)
++    munmap ((caddr_t) domain->data, domain->mmap_size);
++  else
++# endif	/* _POSIX_MAPPED_FILES */
++    free ((void *) domain->data);
++
++  free (domain);
++}
++#endif
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/localcharset.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/localcharset.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.478729392 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,398 @@
++/* Determine a canonical name for the current locale's character encoding.
++
++   Copyright (C) 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++/* Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>.  */
++
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++# include <config.h>
++#endif
++
++/* Specification.  */
++#include "localcharset.h"
++
++#if HAVE_STDDEF_H
++# include <stddef.h>
++#endif
++
++#include <stdio.h>
++#if HAVE_STRING_H
++# include <string.h>
++#else
++# include <strings.h>
++#endif
++#if HAVE_STDLIB_H
++# include <stdlib.h>
++#endif
++
++#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__
++# undef WIN32   /* avoid warning on mingw32 */
++# define WIN32
++#endif
++
++#if defined __EMX__
++/* Assume EMX program runs on OS/2, even if compiled under DOS.  */
++# define OS2
++#endif
++
++#if !defined WIN32
++# if HAVE_LANGINFO_CODESET
++#  include <langinfo.h>
++# else
++#  if HAVE_SETLOCALE
++#   include <locale.h>
++#  endif
++# endif
++#elif defined WIN32
++# define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN
++# include <windows.h>
++#endif
++#if defined OS2
++# define INCL_DOS
++# include <os2.h>
++#endif
++
++#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE
++# include "relocatable.h"
++#else
++# define relocate(pathname) (pathname)
++#endif
++
++#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__
++  /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */
++# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\')
++#endif
++
++#ifndef DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR
++# define DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR '/'
++#endif
++
++#ifndef ISSLASH
++# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR)
++#endif
++
++#if HAVE_DECL_GETC_UNLOCKED
++# undef getc
++# define getc getc_unlocked
++#endif
++
++/* The following static variable is declared 'volatile' to avoid a
++   possible multithread problem in the function get_charset_aliases. If we
++   are running in a threaded environment, and if two threads initialize
++   'charset_aliases' simultaneously, both will produce the same value,
++   and everything will be ok if the two assignments to 'charset_aliases'
++   are atomic. But I don't know what will happen if the two assignments mix.  */
++#if __STDC__ != 1
++# define volatile /* empty */
++#endif
++/* Pointer to the contents of the charset.alias file, if it has already been
++   read, else NULL.  Its format is:
++   ALIAS_1 '\0' CANONICAL_1 '\0' ... ALIAS_n '\0' CANONICAL_n '\0' '\0'  */
++static const char * volatile charset_aliases;
++
++/* Return a pointer to the contents of the charset.alias file.  */
++static const char *
++get_charset_aliases ()
++{
++  const char *cp;
++
++  cp = charset_aliases;
++  if (cp == NULL)
++    {
++#if !(defined VMS || defined WIN32)
++      FILE *fp;
++      const char *dir = relocate (LIBDIR);
++      const char *base = "charset.alias";
++      char *file_name;
++
++      /* Concatenate dir and base into freshly allocated file_name.  */
++      {
++	size_t dir_len = strlen (dir);
++	size_t base_len = strlen (base);
++	int add_slash = (dir_len > 0 && !ISSLASH (dir[dir_len - 1]));
++	file_name = (char *) malloc (dir_len + add_slash + base_len + 1);
++	if (file_name != NULL)
++	  {
++	    memcpy (file_name, dir, dir_len);
++	    if (add_slash)
++	      file_name[dir_len] = DIRECTORY_SEPARATOR;
++	    memcpy (file_name + dir_len + add_slash, base, base_len + 1);
++	  }
++      }
++
++      if (file_name == NULL || (fp = fopen (file_name, "r")) == NULL)
++	/* Out of memory or file not found, treat it as empty.  */
++	cp = "";
++      else
++	{
++	  /* Parse the file's contents.  */
++	  int c;
++	  char buf1[50+1];
++	  char buf2[50+1];
++	  char *res_ptr = NULL;
++	  size_t res_size = 0;
++	  size_t l1, l2;
++
++	  for (;;)
++	    {
++	      c = getc (fp);
++	      if (c == EOF)
++		break;
++	      if (c == '\n' || c == ' ' || c == '\t')
++		continue;
++	      if (c == '#')
++		{
++		  /* Skip comment, to end of line.  */
++		  do
++		    c = getc (fp);
++		  while (!(c == EOF || c == '\n'));
++		  if (c == EOF)
++		    break;
++		  continue;
++		}
++	      ungetc (c, fp);
++	      if (fscanf (fp, "%50s %50s", buf1, buf2) < 2)
++		break;
++	      l1 = strlen (buf1);
++	      l2 = strlen (buf2);
++	      if (res_size == 0)
++		{
++		  res_size = l1 + 1 + l2 + 1;
++		  res_ptr = (char *) malloc (res_size + 1);
++		}
++	      else
++		{
++		  res_size += l1 + 1 + l2 + 1;
++		  res_ptr = (char *) realloc (res_ptr, res_size + 1);
++		}
++	      if (res_ptr == NULL)
++		{
++		  /* Out of memory. */
++		  res_size = 0;
++		  break;
++		}
++	      strcpy (res_ptr + res_size - (l2 + 1) - (l1 + 1), buf1);
++	      strcpy (res_ptr + res_size - (l2 + 1), buf2);
++	    }
++	  fclose (fp);
++	  if (res_size == 0)
++	    cp = "";
++	  else
++	    {
++	      *(res_ptr + res_size) = '\0';
++	      cp = res_ptr;
++	    }
++	}
++
++      if (file_name != NULL)
++	free (file_name);
++
++#else
++
++# if defined VMS
++      /* To avoid the troubles of an extra file charset.alias_vms in the
++	 sources of many GNU packages, simply inline the aliases here.  */
++      /* The list of encodings is taken from the OpenVMS 7.3-1 documentation
++	 "Compaq C Run-Time Library Reference Manual for OpenVMS systems"
++	 section 10.7 "Handling Different Character Sets".  */
++      cp = "ISO8859-1" "\0" "ISO-8859-1" "\0"
++	   "ISO8859-2" "\0" "ISO-8859-2" "\0"
++	   "ISO8859-5" "\0" "ISO-8859-5" "\0"
++	   "ISO8859-7" "\0" "ISO-8859-7" "\0"
++	   "ISO8859-8" "\0" "ISO-8859-8" "\0"
++	   "ISO8859-9" "\0" "ISO-8859-9" "\0"
++	   /* Japanese */
++	   "eucJP" "\0" "EUC-JP" "\0"
++	   "SJIS" "\0" "SHIFT_JIS" "\0"
++	   "DECKANJI" "\0" "DEC-KANJI" "\0"
++	   "SDECKANJI" "\0" "EUC-JP" "\0"
++	   /* Chinese */
++	   "eucTW" "\0" "EUC-TW" "\0"
++	   "DECHANYU" "\0" "DEC-HANYU" "\0"
++	   "DECHANZI" "\0" "GB2312" "\0"
++	   /* Korean */
++	   "DECKOREAN" "\0" "EUC-KR" "\0";
++# endif
++
++# if defined WIN32
++      /* To avoid the troubles of installing a separate file in the same
++	 directory as the DLL and of retrieving the DLL's directory at
++	 runtime, simply inline the aliases here.  */
++
++      cp = "CP936" "\0" "GBK" "\0"
++	   "CP1361" "\0" "JOHAB" "\0"
++	   "CP20127" "\0" "ASCII" "\0"
++	   "CP20866" "\0" "KOI8-R" "\0"
++	   "CP21866" "\0" "KOI8-RU" "\0"
++	   "CP28591" "\0" "ISO-8859-1" "\0"
++	   "CP28592" "\0" "ISO-8859-2" "\0"
++	   "CP28593" "\0" "ISO-8859-3" "\0"
++	   "CP28594" "\0" "ISO-8859-4" "\0"
++	   "CP28595" "\0" "ISO-8859-5" "\0"
++	   "CP28596" "\0" "ISO-8859-6" "\0"
++	   "CP28597" "\0" "ISO-8859-7" "\0"
++	   "CP28598" "\0" "ISO-8859-8" "\0"
++	   "CP28599" "\0" "ISO-8859-9" "\0"
++	   "CP28605" "\0" "ISO-8859-15" "\0";
++# endif
++#endif
++
++      charset_aliases = cp;
++    }
++
++  return cp;
++}
++
++/* Determine the current locale's character encoding, and canonicalize it
++   into one of the canonical names listed in config.charset.
++   The result must not be freed; it is statically allocated.
++   If the canonical name cannot be determined, the result is a non-canonical
++   name.  */
++
++#ifdef STATIC
++STATIC
++#endif
++const char *
++locale_charset ()
++{
++  const char *codeset;
++  const char *aliases;
++
++#if !(defined WIN32 || defined OS2)
++
++# if HAVE_LANGINFO_CODESET
++
++  /* Most systems support nl_langinfo (CODESET) nowadays.  */
++  codeset = nl_langinfo (CODESET);
++
++# else
++
++  /* On old systems which lack it, use setlocale or getenv.  */
++  const char *locale = NULL;
++
++  /* But most old systems don't have a complete set of locales.  Some
++     (like SunOS 4 or DJGPP) have only the C locale.  Therefore we don't
++     use setlocale here; it would return "C" when it doesn't support the
++     locale name the user has set.  */
++#  if HAVE_SETLOCALE && 0
++  locale = setlocale (LC_CTYPE, NULL);
++#  endif
++  if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0')
++    {
++      locale = getenv ("LC_ALL");
++      if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0')
++	{
++	  locale = getenv ("LC_CTYPE");
++	  if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0')
++	    locale = getenv ("LANG");
++	}
++    }
++
++  /* On some old systems, one used to set locale = "iso8859_1". On others,
++     you set it to "language_COUNTRY.charset". In any case, we resolve it
++     through the charset.alias file.  */
++  codeset = locale;
++
++# endif
++
++#elif defined WIN32
++
++  static char buf[2 + 10 + 1];
++
++  /* Woe32 has a function returning the locale's codepage as a number.  */
++  sprintf (buf, "CP%u", GetACP ());
++  codeset = buf;
++
++#elif defined OS2
++
++  const char *locale;
++  static char buf[2 + 10 + 1];
++  ULONG cp[3];
++  ULONG cplen;
++
++  /* Allow user to override the codeset, as set in the operating system,
++     with standard language environment variables.  */
++  locale = getenv ("LC_ALL");
++  if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0')
++    {
++      locale = getenv ("LC_CTYPE");
++      if (locale == NULL || locale[0] == '\0')
++	locale = getenv ("LANG");
++    }
++  if (locale != NULL && locale[0] != '\0')
++    {
++      /* If the locale name contains an encoding after the dot, return it.  */
++      const char *dot = strchr (locale, '.');
++
++      if (dot != NULL)
++	{
++	  const char *modifier;
++
++	  dot++;
++	  /* Look for the possible @... trailer and remove it, if any.  */
++	  modifier = strchr (dot, '@');
++	  if (modifier == NULL)
++	    return dot;
++	  if (modifier - dot < sizeof (buf))
++	    {
++	      memcpy (buf, dot, modifier - dot);
++	      buf [modifier - dot] = '\0';
++	      return buf;
++	    }
++	}
++
++      /* Resolve through the charset.alias file.  */
++      codeset = locale;
++    }
++  else
++    {
++      /* OS/2 has a function returning the locale's codepage as a number.  */
++      if (DosQueryCp (sizeof (cp), cp, &cplen))
++	codeset = "";
++      else
++	{
++	  sprintf (buf, "CP%u", cp[0]);
++	  codeset = buf;
++	}
++    }
++
++#endif
++
++  if (codeset == NULL)
++    /* The canonical name cannot be determined.  */
++    codeset = "";
++
++  /* Resolve alias. */
++  for (aliases = get_charset_aliases ();
++       *aliases != '\0';
++       aliases += strlen (aliases) + 1, aliases += strlen (aliases) + 1)
++    if (strcmp (codeset, aliases) == 0
++	|| (aliases[0] == '*' && aliases[1] == '\0'))
++      {
++	codeset = aliases + strlen (aliases) + 1;
++	break;
++      }
++
++  /* Don't return an empty string.  GNU libc and GNU libiconv interpret
++     the empty string as denoting "the locale's character encoding",
++     thus GNU libiconv would call this function a second time.  */
++  if (codeset[0] == '\0')
++    codeset = "ASCII";
++
++  return codeset;
++}
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/localcharset.h	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/localcharset.h	2004-09-12 14:40:34.483728632 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,42 @@
++/* Determine a canonical name for the current locale's character encoding.
++   Copyright (C) 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++   This file is part of the GNU CHARSET Library.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifndef _LOCALCHARSET_H
++#define _LOCALCHARSET_H
++
++
++#ifdef __cplusplus
++extern "C" {
++#endif
++
++
++/* Determine the current locale's character encoding, and canonicalize it
++   into one of the canonical names listed in config.charset.
++   The result must not be freed; it is statically allocated.
++   If the canonical name cannot be determined, the result is a non-canonical
++   name.  */
++extern const char * locale_charset (void);
++
++
++#ifdef __cplusplus
++}
++#endif
++
++
++#endif /* _LOCALCHARSET_H */
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/locale.alias	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/locale.alias	2004-09-12 14:40:34.499726200 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,78 @@
++# Locale name alias data base.
++# Copyright (C) 1996-2001,2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++#
++# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++# under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++# by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++# any later version.
++#
++# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++# Library General Public License for more details.
++#
++# You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++# License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++# USA.
++
++# The format of this file is the same as for the corresponding file of
++# the X Window System, which normally can be found in
++#	/usr/lib/X11/locale/locale.alias
++# A single line contains two fields: an alias and a substitution value.
++# All entries are case independent.
++
++# Note: This file is far from being complete.  If you have a value for
++# your own site which you think might be useful for others too, share
++# it with the rest of us.  Send it using the `glibcbug' script to
++# bugs@gnu.org.
++
++# Packages using this file: 
++
++bokmal		nb_NO.ISO-8859-1
++bokmål		nb_NO.ISO-8859-1
++catalan		ca_ES.ISO-8859-1
++croatian	hr_HR.ISO-8859-2
++czech		cs_CZ.ISO-8859-2
++danish          da_DK.ISO-8859-1
++dansk		da_DK.ISO-8859-1
++deutsch		de_DE.ISO-8859-1
++dutch		nl_NL.ISO-8859-1
++eesti		et_EE.ISO-8859-1
++estonian	et_EE.ISO-8859-1
++finnish         fi_FI.ISO-8859-1
++français	fr_FR.ISO-8859-1
++french		fr_FR.ISO-8859-1
++galego		gl_ES.ISO-8859-1
++galician	gl_ES.ISO-8859-1
++german		de_DE.ISO-8859-1
++greek           el_GR.ISO-8859-7
++hebrew          he_IL.ISO-8859-8
++hrvatski	hr_HR.ISO-8859-2
++hungarian       hu_HU.ISO-8859-2
++icelandic       is_IS.ISO-8859-1
++italian         it_IT.ISO-8859-1
++japanese	ja_JP.eucJP
++japanese.euc	ja_JP.eucJP
++ja_JP		ja_JP.eucJP
++ja_JP.ujis	ja_JP.eucJP
++japanese.sjis	ja_JP.SJIS
++korean		ko_KR.eucKR
++korean.euc 	ko_KR.eucKR
++ko_KR		ko_KR.eucKR
++lithuanian      lt_LT.ISO-8859-13
++no_NO		nb_NO.ISO-8859-1
++no_NO.ISO-8859-1 nb_NO.ISO-8859-1
++norwegian       nb_NO.ISO-8859-1
++nynorsk		nn_NO.ISO-8859-1
++polish          pl_PL.ISO-8859-2
++portuguese      pt_PT.ISO-8859-1
++romanian        ro_RO.ISO-8859-2
++russian         ru_RU.ISO-8859-5
++slovak          sk_SK.ISO-8859-2
++slovene         sl_SI.ISO-8859-2
++slovenian       sl_SI.ISO-8859-2
++spanish         es_ES.ISO-8859-1
++swedish         sv_SE.ISO-8859-1
++thai		th_TH.TIS-620
++turkish         tr_TR.ISO-8859-9
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/localealias.c	1998-04-26 09:22:37.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/localealias.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.505725288 -0400
+@@ -1,20 +1,27 @@
+-/* Handle aliases for locale names
+-   Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+-   Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1995.
++/* Handle aliases for locale names.
++   Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2001, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ 
+-   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+    any later version.
+ 
+    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-   GNU General Public License for more details.
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
+ 
+-   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+-   Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++/* Tell glibc's <string.h> to provide a prototype for mempcpy().
++   This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include
++   <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late.  */
++#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
++# define _GNU_SOURCE    1
++#endif
+ 
+ #ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+ # include <config.h>
+@@ -22,56 +29,45 @@
+ 
+ #include <ctype.h>
+ #include <stdio.h>
++#if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE___FSETLOCKING
++# include <stdio_ext.h>
++#endif
+ #include <sys/types.h>
+ 
+ #ifdef __GNUC__
++# undef alloca
+ # define alloca __builtin_alloca
+ # define HAVE_ALLOCA 1
+ #else
+-# if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC
+-#  include <alloca.h>
++# ifdef _MSC_VER
++#  include <malloc.h>
++#  define alloca _alloca
+ # else
+-#  ifdef _AIX
+- #pragma alloca
++#  if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC
++#   include <alloca.h>
+ #  else
+-#   ifndef alloca
++#   ifdef _AIX
++ #pragma alloca
++#   else
++#    ifndef alloca
+ char *alloca ();
++#    endif
+ #   endif
+ #  endif
+ # endif
+ #endif
+ 
+-#if defined STDC_HEADERS || defined _LIBC
+-# include <stdlib.h>
+-#else
+-char *getenv ();
+-# ifdef HAVE_MALLOC_H
+-#  include <malloc.h>
+-# else
+-void free ();
+-# endif
+-#endif
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <string.h>
+ 
+-#if defined HAVE_STRING_H || defined _LIBC
+-# ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
+-#  define _GNU_SOURCE	1
+-# endif
+-# include <string.h>
++#include "gettextP.h"
++
++#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE
++# include "relocatable.h"
+ #else
+-# include <strings.h>
+-# ifndef memcpy
+-#  define memcpy(Dst, Src, Num) bcopy (Src, Dst, Num)
+-# endif
+-#endif
+-#if !HAVE_STRCHR && !defined _LIBC
+-# ifndef strchr
+-#  define strchr index
+-# endif
++# define relocate(pathname) (pathname)
+ #endif
+ 
+-#include "gettext.h"
+-#include "gettextP.h"
+-
+ /* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+ 
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+@@ -79,43 +75,49 @@
+    because some ANSI C functions will require linking with this object
+    file and the name space must not be polluted.  */
+ # define strcasecmp __strcasecmp
++
++# ifndef mempcpy
++#  define mempcpy __mempcpy
++# endif
++# define HAVE_MEMPCPY	1
++# define HAVE___FSETLOCKING	1
++
++/* We need locking here since we can be called from different places.  */
++# include <bits/libc-lock.h>
++
++__libc_lock_define_initialized (static, lock);
++#endif
++
++#ifndef internal_function
++# define internal_function
+ #endif
+ 
++/* Some optimizations for glibc.  */
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# define FEOF(fp)		feof_unlocked (fp)
++# define FGETS(buf, n, fp)	fgets_unlocked (buf, n, fp)
++#else
++# define FEOF(fp)		feof (fp)
++# define FGETS(buf, n, fp)	fgets (buf, n, fp)
++#endif
+ 
+-/* For those loosing systems which don't have `alloca' we have to add
++/* For those losing systems which don't have `alloca' we have to add
+    some additional code emulating it.  */
+ #ifdef HAVE_ALLOCA
+-/* Nothing has to be done.  */
+-# define ADD_BLOCK(list, address) /* nothing */
+-# define FREE_BLOCKS(list) /* nothing */
++# define freea(p) /* nothing */
+ #else
+-struct block_list
+-{
+-  void *address;
+-  struct block_list *next;
+-};
+-# define ADD_BLOCK(list, addr)						      \
+-  do {									      \
+-    struct block_list *newp = (struct block_list *) malloc (sizeof (*newp));  \
+-    /* If we cannot get a free block we cannot add the new element to	      \
+-       the list.  */							      \
+-    if (newp != NULL) {							      \
+-      newp->address = (addr);						      \
+-      newp->next = (list);						      \
+-      (list) = newp;							      \
+-    }									      \
+-  } while (0)
+-# define FREE_BLOCKS(list)						      \
+-  do {									      \
+-    while (list != NULL) {						      \
+-      struct block_list *old = list;					      \
+-      list = list->next;						      \
+-      free (old);							      \
+-    }									      \
+-  } while (0)
+-# undef alloca
+-# define alloca(size) (malloc (size))
+-#endif	/* have alloca */
++# define alloca(n) malloc (n)
++# define freea(p) free (p)
++#endif
++
++#if defined _LIBC_REENTRANT || HAVE_DECL_FGETS_UNLOCKED
++# undef fgets
++# define fgets(buf, len, s) fgets_unlocked (buf, len, s)
++#endif
++#if defined _LIBC_REENTRANT || HAVE_DECL_FEOF_UNLOCKED
++# undef feof
++# define feof(s) feof_unlocked (s)
++#endif
+ 
+ 
+ struct alias_map
+@@ -125,26 +127,41 @@
+ };
+ 
+ 
+-static struct alias_map *map;
+-static size_t nmap = 0;
+-static size_t maxmap = 0;
++#ifndef _LIBC
++# define libc_freeres_ptr(decl) decl
++#endif
++
++libc_freeres_ptr (static char *string_space);
++static size_t string_space_act;
++static size_t string_space_max;
++libc_freeres_ptr (static struct alias_map *map);
++static size_t nmap;
++static size_t maxmap;
+ 
+ 
+ /* Prototypes for local functions.  */
+-static size_t read_alias_file PARAMS ((const char *fname, int fname_len));
+-static void extend_alias_table PARAMS ((void));
+-static int alias_compare PARAMS ((const struct alias_map *map1,
+-				  const struct alias_map *map2));
++static size_t read_alias_file (const char *fname, int fname_len)
++     internal_function;
++static int extend_alias_table (void);
++static int alias_compare (const struct alias_map *map1,
++			  const struct alias_map *map2);
+ 
+ 
+ const char *
+-_nl_expand_alias (name)
+-    const char *name;
++_nl_expand_alias (const char *name)
+ {
+-  static const char *locale_alias_path = LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH;
++  static const char *locale_alias_path;
+   struct alias_map *retval;
++  const char *result = NULL;
+   size_t added;
+ 
++#ifdef _LIBC
++  __libc_lock_lock (lock);
++#endif
++
++  if (locale_alias_path == NULL)
++    locale_alias_path = LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH;
++
+   do
+     {
+       struct alias_map item;
+@@ -154,15 +171,18 @@
+       if (nmap > 0)
+ 	retval = (struct alias_map *) bsearch (&item, map, nmap,
+ 					       sizeof (struct alias_map),
+-					       (int (*) PARAMS ((const void *,
+-								 const void *))
++					       (int (*) (const void *,
++							 const void *)
+ 						) alias_compare);
+       else
+ 	retval = NULL;
+ 
+       /* We really found an alias.  Return the value.  */
+       if (retval != NULL)
+-	return retval->value;
++	{
++	  result = retval->value;
++	  break;
++	}
+ 
+       /* Perhaps we can find another alias file.  */
+       added = 0;
+@@ -170,11 +190,12 @@
+ 	{
+ 	  const char *start;
+ 
+-	  while (locale_alias_path[0] == ':')
++	  while (locale_alias_path[0] == PATH_SEPARATOR)
+ 	    ++locale_alias_path;
+ 	  start = locale_alias_path;
+ 
+-	  while (locale_alias_path[0] != '\0' && locale_alias_path[0] != ':')
++	  while (locale_alias_path[0] != '\0'
++		 && locale_alias_path[0] != PATH_SEPARATOR)
+ 	    ++locale_alias_path;
+ 
+ 	  if (start < locale_alias_path)
+@@ -183,78 +204,87 @@
+     }
+   while (added != 0);
+ 
+-  return NULL;
++#ifdef _LIBC
++  __libc_lock_unlock (lock);
++#endif
++
++  return result;
+ }
+ 
+ 
+ static size_t
+-read_alias_file (fname, fname_len)
+-     const char *fname;
+-     int fname_len;
++internal_function
++read_alias_file (const char *fname, int fname_len)
+ {
+-#ifndef HAVE_ALLOCA
+-  struct block_list *block_list = NULL;
+-#endif
+   FILE *fp;
+   char *full_fname;
+   size_t added;
+   static const char aliasfile[] = "/locale.alias";
+ 
+   full_fname = (char *) alloca (fname_len + sizeof aliasfile);
+-  ADD_BLOCK (block_list, full_fname);
++#ifdef HAVE_MEMPCPY
++  mempcpy (mempcpy (full_fname, fname, fname_len),
++	   aliasfile, sizeof aliasfile);
++#else
+   memcpy (full_fname, fname, fname_len);
+   memcpy (&full_fname[fname_len], aliasfile, sizeof aliasfile);
++#endif
+ 
+-  fp = fopen (full_fname, "r");
++  fp = fopen (relocate (full_fname), "r");
++  freea (full_fname);
+   if (fp == NULL)
+-    {
+-      FREE_BLOCKS (block_list);
+-      return 0;
+-    }
++    return 0;
++
++#ifdef HAVE___FSETLOCKING
++  /* No threads present.  */
++  __fsetlocking (fp, FSETLOCKING_BYCALLER);
++#endif
+ 
+   added = 0;
+-  while (!feof (fp))
++  while (!FEOF (fp))
+     {
+       /* It is a reasonable approach to use a fix buffer here because
+ 	 a) we are only interested in the first two fields
+ 	 b) these fields must be usable as file names and so must not
+ 	    be that long
+-       */
+-      char buf[BUFSIZ];
++	 We avoid a multi-kilobyte buffer here since this would use up
++	 stack space which we might not have if the program ran out of
++	 memory.  */
++      char buf[400];
+       char *alias;
+       char *value;
+       char *cp;
+ 
+-      if (fgets (buf, BUFSIZ, fp) == NULL)
++      if (FGETS (buf, sizeof buf, fp) == NULL)
+ 	/* EOF reached.  */
+ 	break;
+ 
+       cp = buf;
+       /* Ignore leading white space.  */
+-      while (isspace (cp[0]))
++      while (isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0]))
+ 	++cp;
+ 
+       /* A leading '#' signals a comment line.  */
+       if (cp[0] != '\0' && cp[0] != '#')
+ 	{
+ 	  alias = cp++;
+-	  while (cp[0] != '\0' && !isspace (cp[0]))
++	  while (cp[0] != '\0' && !isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0]))
+ 	    ++cp;
+ 	  /* Terminate alias name.  */
+ 	  if (cp[0] != '\0')
+ 	    *cp++ = '\0';
+ 
+ 	  /* Now look for the beginning of the value.  */
+-	  while (isspace (cp[0]))
++	  while (isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0]))
+ 	    ++cp;
+ 
+ 	  if (cp[0] != '\0')
+ 	    {
+-	      char *tp;
+-	      size_t len;
++	      size_t alias_len;
++	      size_t value_len;
+ 
+ 	      value = cp++;
+-	      while (cp[0] != '\0' && !isspace (cp[0]))
++	      while (cp[0] != '\0' && !isspace ((unsigned char) cp[0]))
+ 		++cp;
+ 	      /* Terminate value.  */
+ 	      if (cp[0] == '\n')
+@@ -269,28 +299,44 @@
+ 		*cp++ = '\0';
+ 
+ 	      if (nmap >= maxmap)
+-		extend_alias_table ();
+-
+-	      /* We cannot depend on strdup available in the libc.  Sigh!  */
+-	      len = strlen (alias) + 1;
+-	      tp = (char *) malloc (len);
+-	      if (tp == NULL)
+-		{
+-		  FREE_BLOCKS (block_list);
++		if (__builtin_expect (extend_alias_table (), 0))
+ 		  return added;
+-		}
+-	      memcpy (tp, alias, len);
+-	      map[nmap].alias = tp;
+ 
+-	      len = strlen (value) + 1;
+-	      tp = (char *) malloc (len);
+-	      if (tp == NULL)
++	      alias_len = strlen (alias) + 1;
++	      value_len = strlen (value) + 1;
++
++	      if (string_space_act + alias_len + value_len > string_space_max)
+ 		{
+-		  FREE_BLOCKS (block_list);
+-		  return added;
++		  /* Increase size of memory pool.  */
++		  size_t new_size = (string_space_max
++				     + (alias_len + value_len > 1024
++					? alias_len + value_len : 1024));
++		  char *new_pool = (char *) realloc (string_space, new_size);
++		  if (new_pool == NULL)
++		    return added;
++
++		  if (__builtin_expect (string_space != new_pool, 0))
++		    {
++		      size_t i;
++
++		      for (i = 0; i < nmap; i++)
++			{
++			  map[i].alias += new_pool - string_space;
++			  map[i].value += new_pool - string_space;
++			}
++		    }
++
++		  string_space = new_pool;
++		  string_space_max = new_size;
+ 		}
+-	      memcpy (tp, value, len);
+-	      map[nmap].value = tp;
++
++	      map[nmap].alias = memcpy (&string_space[string_space_act],
++					alias, alias_len);
++	      string_space_act += alias_len;
++
++	      map[nmap].value = memcpy (&string_space[string_space_act],
++					value, value_len);
++	      string_space_act += value_len;
+ 
+ 	      ++nmap;
+ 	      ++added;
+@@ -299,14 +345,11 @@
+ 
+       /* Possibly not the whole line fits into the buffer.  Ignore
+ 	 the rest of the line.  */
+-      while (strchr (cp, '\n') == NULL)
+-	{
+-	  cp = buf;
+-	  if (fgets (buf, BUFSIZ, fp) == NULL)
+-	    /* Make sure the inner loop will be left.  The outer loop
+-	       will exit at the `feof' test.  */
+-	    *cp = '\n';
+-	}
++      while (strchr (buf, '\n') == NULL)
++	if (FGETS (buf, sizeof buf, fp) == NULL)
++	  /* Make sure the inner loop will be left.  The outer loop
++	     will exit at the `feof' test.  */
++	  break;
+     }
+ 
+   /* Should we test for ferror()?  I think we have to silently ignore
+@@ -315,40 +358,33 @@
+ 
+   if (added > 0)
+     qsort (map, nmap, sizeof (struct alias_map),
+-	   (int (*) PARAMS ((const void *, const void *))) alias_compare);
++	   (int (*) (const void *, const void *)) alias_compare);
+ 
+-  FREE_BLOCKS (block_list);
+   return added;
+ }
+ 
+ 
+-static void
++static int
+ extend_alias_table ()
+ {
+   size_t new_size;
+   struct alias_map *new_map;
+ 
+   new_size = maxmap == 0 ? 100 : 2 * maxmap;
+-  new_map = (struct alias_map *) malloc (new_size
+-					 * sizeof (struct alias_map));
++  new_map = (struct alias_map *) realloc (map, (new_size
++						* sizeof (struct alias_map)));
+   if (new_map == NULL)
+     /* Simply don't extend: we don't have any more core.  */
+-    return;
+-
+-  memcpy (new_map, map, nmap * sizeof (struct alias_map));
+-
+-  if (maxmap != 0)
+-    free (map);
++    return -1;
+ 
+   map = new_map;
+   maxmap = new_size;
++  return 0;
+ }
+ 
+ 
+ static int
+-alias_compare (map1, map2)
+-     const struct alias_map *map1;
+-     const struct alias_map *map2;
++alias_compare (const struct alias_map *map1, const struct alias_map *map2)
+ {
+ #if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRCASECMP
+   return strcasecmp (map1->alias, map2->alias);
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/localename.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/localename.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.510724528 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,1142 @@
++/* Determine the current selected locale.
++   Copyright (C) 1995-1999, 2000-2004 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++/* Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.org>, 1995.  */
++/* Win32 code written by Tor Lillqvist <tml@iki.fi>.  */
++
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++# include <config.h>
++#endif
++
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <locale.h>
++
++#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__
++# undef WIN32   /* avoid warning on mingw32 */
++# define WIN32
++#endif
++
++#ifdef WIN32
++# define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN
++# include <windows.h>
++/* List of language codes, sorted by value:
++   0x01 LANG_ARABIC
++   0x02 LANG_BULGARIAN
++   0x03 LANG_CATALAN
++   0x04 LANG_CHINESE
++   0x05 LANG_CZECH
++   0x06 LANG_DANISH
++   0x07 LANG_GERMAN
++   0x08 LANG_GREEK
++   0x09 LANG_ENGLISH
++   0x0a LANG_SPANISH
++   0x0b LANG_FINNISH
++   0x0c LANG_FRENCH
++   0x0d LANG_HEBREW
++   0x0e LANG_HUNGARIAN
++   0x0f LANG_ICELANDIC
++   0x10 LANG_ITALIAN
++   0x11 LANG_JAPANESE
++   0x12 LANG_KOREAN
++   0x13 LANG_DUTCH
++   0x14 LANG_NORWEGIAN
++   0x15 LANG_POLISH
++   0x16 LANG_PORTUGUESE
++   0x17 LANG_RHAETO_ROMANCE
++   0x18 LANG_ROMANIAN
++   0x19 LANG_RUSSIAN
++   0x1a LANG_CROATIAN == LANG_SERBIAN
++   0x1b LANG_SLOVAK
++   0x1c LANG_ALBANIAN
++   0x1d LANG_SWEDISH
++   0x1e LANG_THAI
++   0x1f LANG_TURKISH
++   0x20 LANG_URDU
++   0x21 LANG_INDONESIAN
++   0x22 LANG_UKRAINIAN
++   0x23 LANG_BELARUSIAN
++   0x24 LANG_SLOVENIAN
++   0x25 LANG_ESTONIAN
++   0x26 LANG_LATVIAN
++   0x27 LANG_LITHUANIAN
++   0x28 LANG_TAJIK
++   0x29 LANG_FARSI
++   0x2a LANG_VIETNAMESE
++   0x2b LANG_ARMENIAN
++   0x2c LANG_AZERI
++   0x2d LANG_BASQUE
++   0x2e LANG_SORBIAN
++   0x2f LANG_MACEDONIAN
++   0x30 LANG_SUTU
++   0x31 LANG_TSONGA
++   0x32 LANG_TSWANA
++   0x33 LANG_VENDA
++   0x34 LANG_XHOSA
++   0x35 LANG_ZULU
++   0x36 LANG_AFRIKAANS
++   0x37 LANG_GEORGIAN
++   0x38 LANG_FAEROESE
++   0x39 LANG_HINDI
++   0x3a LANG_MALTESE
++   0x3b LANG_SAAMI
++   0x3c LANG_GAELIC
++   0x3d LANG_YIDDISH
++   0x3e LANG_MALAY
++   0x3f LANG_KAZAK
++   0x40 LANG_KYRGYZ
++   0x41 LANG_SWAHILI
++   0x42 LANG_TURKMEN
++   0x43 LANG_UZBEK
++   0x44 LANG_TATAR
++   0x45 LANG_BENGALI
++   0x46 LANG_PUNJABI
++   0x47 LANG_GUJARATI
++   0x48 LANG_ORIYA
++   0x49 LANG_TAMIL
++   0x4a LANG_TELUGU
++   0x4b LANG_KANNADA
++   0x4c LANG_MALAYALAM
++   0x4d LANG_ASSAMESE
++   0x4e LANG_MARATHI
++   0x4f LANG_SANSKRIT
++   0x50 LANG_MONGOLIAN
++   0x51 LANG_TIBETAN
++   0x52 LANG_WELSH
++   0x53 LANG_CAMBODIAN
++   0x54 LANG_LAO
++   0x55 LANG_BURMESE
++   0x56 LANG_GALICIAN
++   0x57 LANG_KONKANI
++   0x58 LANG_MANIPURI
++   0x59 LANG_SINDHI
++   0x5a LANG_SYRIAC
++   0x5b LANG_SINHALESE
++   0x5c LANG_CHEROKEE
++   0x5d LANG_INUKTITUT
++   0x5e LANG_AMHARIC
++   0x5f LANG_TAMAZIGHT
++   0x60 LANG_KASHMIRI
++   0x61 LANG_NEPALI
++   0x62 LANG_FRISIAN
++   0x63 LANG_PASHTO
++   0x64 LANG_TAGALOG
++   0x65 LANG_DIVEHI
++   0x66 LANG_EDO
++   0x67 LANG_FULFULDE
++   0x68 LANG_HAUSA
++   0x69 LANG_IBIBIO
++   0x6a LANG_YORUBA
++   0x70 LANG_IGBO
++   0x71 LANG_KANURI
++   0x72 LANG_OROMO
++   0x73 LANG_TIGRINYA
++   0x74 LANG_GUARANI
++   0x75 LANG_HAWAIIAN
++   0x76 LANG_LATIN
++   0x77 LANG_SOMALI
++   0x78 LANG_YI
++   0x79 LANG_PAPIAMENTU
++*/
++/* Mingw headers don't have latest language and sublanguage codes.  */
++# ifndef LANG_AFRIKAANS
++# define LANG_AFRIKAANS 0x36
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_ALBANIAN
++# define LANG_ALBANIAN 0x1c
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_AMHARIC
++# define LANG_AMHARIC 0x5e
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_ARABIC
++# define LANG_ARABIC 0x01
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_ARMENIAN
++# define LANG_ARMENIAN 0x2b
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_ASSAMESE
++# define LANG_ASSAMESE 0x4d
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_AZERI
++# define LANG_AZERI 0x2c
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_BASQUE
++# define LANG_BASQUE 0x2d
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_BELARUSIAN
++# define LANG_BELARUSIAN 0x23
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_BENGALI
++# define LANG_BENGALI 0x45
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_BURMESE
++# define LANG_BURMESE 0x55
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_CAMBODIAN
++# define LANG_CAMBODIAN 0x53
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_CATALAN
++# define LANG_CATALAN 0x03
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_CHEROKEE
++# define LANG_CHEROKEE 0x5c
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_DIVEHI
++# define LANG_DIVEHI 0x65
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_EDO
++# define LANG_EDO 0x66
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_ESTONIAN
++# define LANG_ESTONIAN 0x25
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_FAEROESE
++# define LANG_FAEROESE 0x38
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_FARSI
++# define LANG_FARSI 0x29
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_FRISIAN
++# define LANG_FRISIAN 0x62
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_FULFULDE
++# define LANG_FULFULDE 0x67
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_GAELIC
++# define LANG_GAELIC 0x3c
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_GALICIAN
++# define LANG_GALICIAN 0x56
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_GEORGIAN
++# define LANG_GEORGIAN 0x37
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_GUARANI
++# define LANG_GUARANI 0x74
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_GUJARATI
++# define LANG_GUJARATI 0x47
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_HAUSA
++# define LANG_HAUSA 0x68
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_HAWAIIAN
++# define LANG_HAWAIIAN 0x75
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_HEBREW
++# define LANG_HEBREW 0x0d
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_HINDI
++# define LANG_HINDI 0x39
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_IBIBIO
++# define LANG_IBIBIO 0x69
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_IGBO
++# define LANG_IGBO 0x70
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_INDONESIAN
++# define LANG_INDONESIAN 0x21
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_INUKTITUT
++# define LANG_INUKTITUT 0x5d
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_KANNADA
++# define LANG_KANNADA 0x4b
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_KANURI
++# define LANG_KANURI 0x71
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_KASHMIRI
++# define LANG_KASHMIRI 0x60
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_KAZAK
++# define LANG_KAZAK 0x3f
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_KONKANI
++# define LANG_KONKANI 0x57
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_KYRGYZ
++# define LANG_KYRGYZ 0x40
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_LAO
++# define LANG_LAO 0x54
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_LATIN
++# define LANG_LATIN 0x76
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_LATVIAN
++# define LANG_LATVIAN 0x26
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_LITHUANIAN
++# define LANG_LITHUANIAN 0x27
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_MACEDONIAN
++# define LANG_MACEDONIAN 0x2f
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_MALAY
++# define LANG_MALAY 0x3e
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_MALAYALAM
++# define LANG_MALAYALAM 0x4c
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_MALTESE
++# define LANG_MALTESE 0x3a
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_MANIPURI
++# define LANG_MANIPURI 0x58
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_MARATHI
++# define LANG_MARATHI 0x4e
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_MONGOLIAN
++# define LANG_MONGOLIAN 0x50
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_NEPALI
++# define LANG_NEPALI 0x61
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_ORIYA
++# define LANG_ORIYA 0x48
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_OROMO
++# define LANG_OROMO 0x72
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_PAPIAMENTU
++# define LANG_PAPIAMENTU 0x79
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_PASHTO
++# define LANG_PASHTO 0x63
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_PUNJABI
++# define LANG_PUNJABI 0x46
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_RHAETO_ROMANCE
++# define LANG_RHAETO_ROMANCE 0x17
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_SAAMI
++# define LANG_SAAMI 0x3b
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_SANSKRIT
++# define LANG_SANSKRIT 0x4f
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_SERBIAN
++# define LANG_SERBIAN 0x1a
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_SINDHI
++# define LANG_SINDHI 0x59
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_SINHALESE
++# define LANG_SINHALESE 0x5b
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_SLOVAK
++# define LANG_SLOVAK 0x1b
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_SOMALI
++# define LANG_SOMALI 0x77
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_SORBIAN
++# define LANG_SORBIAN 0x2e
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_SUTU
++# define LANG_SUTU 0x30
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_SWAHILI
++# define LANG_SWAHILI 0x41
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_SYRIAC
++# define LANG_SYRIAC 0x5a
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_TAGALOG
++# define LANG_TAGALOG 0x64
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_TAJIK
++# define LANG_TAJIK 0x28
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_TAMAZIGHT
++# define LANG_TAMAZIGHT 0x5f
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_TAMIL
++# define LANG_TAMIL 0x49
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_TATAR
++# define LANG_TATAR 0x44
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_TELUGU
++# define LANG_TELUGU 0x4a
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_THAI
++# define LANG_THAI 0x1e
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_TIBETAN
++# define LANG_TIBETAN 0x51
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_TIGRINYA
++# define LANG_TIGRINYA 0x73
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_TSONGA
++# define LANG_TSONGA 0x31
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_TSWANA
++# define LANG_TSWANA 0x32
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_TURKMEN
++# define LANG_TURKMEN 0x42
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_UKRAINIAN
++# define LANG_UKRAINIAN 0x22
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_URDU
++# define LANG_URDU 0x20
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_UZBEK
++# define LANG_UZBEK 0x43
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_VENDA
++# define LANG_VENDA 0x33
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_VIETNAMESE
++# define LANG_VIETNAMESE 0x2a
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_WELSH
++# define LANG_WELSH 0x52
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_XHOSA
++# define LANG_XHOSA 0x34
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_YI
++# define LANG_YI 0x78
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_YIDDISH
++# define LANG_YIDDISH 0x3d
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_YORUBA
++# define LANG_YORUBA 0x6a
++# endif
++# ifndef LANG_ZULU
++# define LANG_ZULU 0x35
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_SAUDI_ARABIA
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_SAUDI_ARABIA 0x01
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_IRAQ
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_IRAQ 0x02
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_EGYPT
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_EGYPT 0x03
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_LIBYA
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_LIBYA 0x04
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_ALGERIA
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_ALGERIA 0x05
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_MOROCCO
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_MOROCCO 0x06
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_TUNISIA
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_TUNISIA 0x07
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_OMAN
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_OMAN 0x08
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_YEMEN
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_YEMEN 0x09
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_SYRIA
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_SYRIA 0x0a
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_JORDAN
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_JORDAN 0x0b
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_LEBANON
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_LEBANON 0x0c
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_KUWAIT
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_KUWAIT 0x0d
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_UAE
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_UAE 0x0e
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_BAHRAIN
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_BAHRAIN 0x0f
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ARABIC_QATAR
++# define SUBLANG_ARABIC_QATAR 0x10
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_AZERI_LATIN
++# define SUBLANG_AZERI_LATIN 0x01
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_AZERI_CYRILLIC
++# define SUBLANG_AZERI_CYRILLIC 0x02
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_BENGALI_INDIA
++# define SUBLANG_BENGALI_INDIA 0x00
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_BENGALI_BANGLADESH
++# define SUBLANG_BENGALI_BANGLADESH 0x01
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_CHINESE_MACAU
++# define SUBLANG_CHINESE_MACAU 0x05
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_SOUTH_AFRICA
++# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_SOUTH_AFRICA 0x07
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_JAMAICA
++# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_JAMAICA 0x08
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CARIBBEAN
++# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CARIBBEAN 0x09
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_BELIZE
++# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_BELIZE 0x0a
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_TRINIDAD
++# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_TRINIDAD 0x0b
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_ZIMBABWE
++# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_ZIMBABWE 0x0c
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_PHILIPPINES
++# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_PHILIPPINES 0x0d
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_INDONESIA
++# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_INDONESIA 0x0e
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_HONGKONG
++# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_HONGKONG 0x0f
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_INDIA
++# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_INDIA 0x10
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_MALAYSIA
++# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_MALAYSIA 0x11
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ENGLISH_SINGAPORE
++# define SUBLANG_ENGLISH_SINGAPORE 0x12
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_LUXEMBOURG
++# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_LUXEMBOURG 0x05
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_MONACO
++# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_MONACO 0x06
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_WESTINDIES
++# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_WESTINDIES 0x07
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_REUNION
++# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_REUNION 0x08
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_CONGO
++# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_CONGO 0x09
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_SENEGAL
++# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_SENEGAL 0x0a
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_CAMEROON
++# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_CAMEROON 0x0b
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_COTEDIVOIRE
++# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_COTEDIVOIRE 0x0c
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_MALI
++# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_MALI 0x0d
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_MOROCCO
++# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_MOROCCO 0x0e
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_FRENCH_HAITI
++# define SUBLANG_FRENCH_HAITI 0x0f
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_GERMAN_LUXEMBOURG
++# define SUBLANG_GERMAN_LUXEMBOURG 0x04
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_GERMAN_LIECHTENSTEIN
++# define SUBLANG_GERMAN_LIECHTENSTEIN 0x05
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_KASHMIRI_INDIA
++# define SUBLANG_KASHMIRI_INDIA 0x02
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_MALAY_MALAYSIA
++# define SUBLANG_MALAY_MALAYSIA 0x01
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_MALAY_BRUNEI_DARUSSALAM
++# define SUBLANG_MALAY_BRUNEI_DARUSSALAM 0x02
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_NEPALI_INDIA
++# define SUBLANG_NEPALI_INDIA 0x02
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_PUNJABI_INDIA
++# define SUBLANG_PUNJABI_INDIA 0x00
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_PUNJABI_PAKISTAN
++# define SUBLANG_PUNJABI_PAKISTAN 0x01
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ROMANIAN_ROMANIA
++# define SUBLANG_ROMANIAN_ROMANIA 0x00
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_ROMANIAN_MOLDOVA
++# define SUBLANG_ROMANIAN_MOLDOVA 0x01
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SERBIAN_LATIN
++# define SUBLANG_SERBIAN_LATIN 0x02
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SERBIAN_CYRILLIC
++# define SUBLANG_SERBIAN_CYRILLIC 0x03
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SINDHI_INDIA
++# define SUBLANG_SINDHI_INDIA 0x00
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SINDHI_PAKISTAN
++# define SUBLANG_SINDHI_PAKISTAN 0x01
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_GUATEMALA
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_GUATEMALA 0x04
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_COSTA_RICA
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_COSTA_RICA 0x05
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PANAMA
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PANAMA 0x06
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_DOMINICAN_REPUBLIC
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_DOMINICAN_REPUBLIC 0x07
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_VENEZUELA
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_VENEZUELA 0x08
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_COLOMBIA
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_COLOMBIA 0x09
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PERU
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PERU 0x0a
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_ARGENTINA
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_ARGENTINA 0x0b
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_ECUADOR
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_ECUADOR 0x0c
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_CHILE
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_CHILE 0x0d
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_URUGUAY
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_URUGUAY 0x0e
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PARAGUAY
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PARAGUAY 0x0f
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_BOLIVIA
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_BOLIVIA 0x10
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_EL_SALVADOR
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_EL_SALVADOR 0x11
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_HONDURAS
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_HONDURAS 0x12
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_NICARAGUA
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_NICARAGUA 0x13
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SPANISH_PUERTO_RICO
++# define SUBLANG_SPANISH_PUERTO_RICO 0x14
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_SWEDISH_FINLAND
++# define SUBLANG_SWEDISH_FINLAND 0x02
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_TAMAZIGHT_ARABIC
++# define SUBLANG_TAMAZIGHT_ARABIC 0x01
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_TAMAZIGHT_LATIN
++# define SUBLANG_TAMAZIGHT_LATIN 0x02
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_TIGRINYA_ETHIOPIA
++# define SUBLANG_TIGRINYA_ETHIOPIA 0x00
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_TIGRINYA_ERITREA
++# define SUBLANG_TIGRINYA_ERITREA 0x01
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_URDU_PAKISTAN
++# define SUBLANG_URDU_PAKISTAN 0x01
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_URDU_INDIA
++# define SUBLANG_URDU_INDIA 0x02
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_UZBEK_LATIN
++# define SUBLANG_UZBEK_LATIN 0x01
++# endif
++# ifndef SUBLANG_UZBEK_CYRILLIC
++# define SUBLANG_UZBEK_CYRILLIC 0x02
++# endif
++#endif
++
++/* XPG3 defines the result of 'setlocale (category, NULL)' as:
++   "Directs 'setlocale()' to query 'category' and return the current
++    setting of 'local'."
++   However it does not specify the exact format.  Neither do SUSV2 and
++   ISO C 99.  So we can use this feature only on selected systems (e.g.
++   those using GNU C Library).  */
++#if defined _LIBC || (defined __GNU_LIBRARY__ && __GNU_LIBRARY__ >= 2)
++# define HAVE_LOCALE_NULL
++#endif
++
++/* Determine the current locale's name, and canonicalize it into XPG syntax
++     language[_territory[.codeset]][@modifier]
++   The codeset part in the result is not reliable; the locale_charset()
++   should be used for codeset information instead.
++   The result must not be freed; it is statically allocated.  */
++
++const char *
++_nl_locale_name (int category, const char *categoryname)
++{
++  const char *retval;
++
++#ifndef WIN32
++
++  /* Use the POSIX methods of looking to 'LC_ALL', 'LC_xxx', and 'LANG'.
++     On some systems this can be done by the 'setlocale' function itself.  */
++# if defined HAVE_SETLOCALE && defined HAVE_LC_MESSAGES && defined HAVE_LOCALE_NULL
++  retval = setlocale (category, NULL);
++# else
++  /* Setting of LC_ALL overwrites all other.  */
++  retval = getenv ("LC_ALL");
++  if (retval == NULL || retval[0] == '\0')
++    {
++      /* Next comes the name of the desired category.  */
++      retval = getenv (categoryname);
++      if (retval == NULL || retval[0] == '\0')
++	{
++	  /* Last possibility is the LANG environment variable.  */
++	  retval = getenv ("LANG");
++	  if (retval == NULL || retval[0] == '\0')
++	    /* We use C as the default domain.  POSIX says this is
++	       implementation defined.  */
++	    retval = "C";
++	}
++    }
++# endif
++
++  return retval;
++
++#else /* WIN32 */
++
++  /* Return an XPG style locale name language[_territory][@modifier].
++     Don't even bother determining the codeset; it's not useful in this
++     context, because message catalogs are not specific to a single
++     codeset.  */
++
++  LCID lcid;
++  LANGID langid;
++  int primary, sub;
++
++  /* Let the user override the system settings through environment
++     variables, as on POSIX systems.  */
++  retval = getenv ("LC_ALL");
++  if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0')
++    return retval;
++  retval = getenv (categoryname);
++  if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0')
++    return retval;
++  retval = getenv ("LANG");
++  if (retval != NULL && retval[0] != '\0')
++    return retval;
++
++  /* Use native Win32 API locale ID.  */
++  lcid = GetThreadLocale ();
++
++  /* Strip off the sorting rules, keep only the language part.  */
++  langid = LANGIDFROMLCID (lcid);
++
++  /* Split into language and territory part.  */
++  primary = PRIMARYLANGID (langid);
++  sub = SUBLANGID (langid);
++
++  /* Dispatch on language.
++     See also http://www.unicode.org/unicode/onlinedat/languages.html .
++     For details about languages, see http://www.ethnologue.com/ .  */
++  switch (primary)
++    {
++    case LANG_AFRIKAANS: return "af_ZA";
++    case LANG_ALBANIAN: return "sq_AL";
++    case LANG_AMHARIC: return "am_ET";
++    case LANG_ARABIC:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_SAUDI_ARABIA: return "ar_SA";
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_IRAQ: return "ar_IQ";
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_EGYPT: return "ar_EG";
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_LIBYA: return "ar_LY";
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_ALGERIA: return "ar_DZ";
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_MOROCCO: return "ar_MA";
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_TUNISIA: return "ar_TN";
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_OMAN: return "ar_OM";
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_YEMEN: return "ar_YE";
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_SYRIA: return "ar_SY";
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_JORDAN: return "ar_JO";
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_LEBANON: return "ar_LB";
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_KUWAIT: return "ar_KW";
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_UAE: return "ar_AE";
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_BAHRAIN: return "ar_BH";
++	case SUBLANG_ARABIC_QATAR: return "ar_QA";
++	}
++      return "ar";
++    case LANG_ARMENIAN: return "hy_AM";
++    case LANG_ASSAMESE: return "as_IN";
++    case LANG_AZERI:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	/* FIXME: Adjust this when Azerbaijani locales appear on Unix.  */
++	case SUBLANG_AZERI_LATIN: return "az_AZ@latin";
++	case SUBLANG_AZERI_CYRILLIC: return "az_AZ@cyrillic";
++	}
++      return "az";
++    case LANG_BASQUE:
++      return "eu"; /* Ambiguous: could be "eu_ES" or "eu_FR".  */
++    case LANG_BELARUSIAN: return "be_BY";
++    case LANG_BENGALI:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_BENGALI_INDIA: return "bn_IN";
++	case SUBLANG_BENGALI_BANGLADESH: return "bn_BD";
++	}
++      return "bn";
++    case LANG_BULGARIAN: return "bg_BG";
++    case LANG_BURMESE: return "my_MM";
++    case LANG_CAMBODIAN: return "km_KH";
++    case LANG_CATALAN: return "ca_ES";
++    case LANG_CHEROKEE: return "chr_US";
++    case LANG_CHINESE:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_CHINESE_TRADITIONAL: return "zh_TW";
++	case SUBLANG_CHINESE_SIMPLIFIED: return "zh_CN";
++	case SUBLANG_CHINESE_HONGKONG: return "zh_HK";
++	case SUBLANG_CHINESE_SINGAPORE: return "zh_SG";
++	case SUBLANG_CHINESE_MACAU: return "zh_MO";
++	}
++      return "zh";
++    case LANG_CROATIAN:		/* LANG_CROATIAN == LANG_SERBIAN
++				 * What used to be called Serbo-Croatian
++				 * should really now be two separate
++				 * languages because of political reasons.
++				 * (Says tml, who knows nothing about Serbian
++				 * or Croatian.)
++				 * (I can feel those flames coming already.)
++				 */
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "hr_HR";
++	case SUBLANG_SERBIAN_LATIN: return "sr_CS";
++	case SUBLANG_SERBIAN_CYRILLIC: return "sr_CS@cyrillic";
++	}
++      return "hr";
++    case LANG_CZECH: return "cs_CZ";
++    case LANG_DANISH: return "da_DK";
++    case LANG_DIVEHI: return "dv_MV";
++    case LANG_DUTCH:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_DUTCH: return "nl_NL";
++	case SUBLANG_DUTCH_BELGIAN: /* FLEMISH, VLAAMS */ return "nl_BE";
++	}
++      return "nl";
++    case LANG_EDO: return "bin_NG";
++    case LANG_ENGLISH:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	/* SUBLANG_ENGLISH_US == SUBLANG_DEFAULT. Heh. I thought
++	 * English was the language spoken in England.
++	 * Oh well.
++	 */
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_US: return "en_US";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_UK: return "en_GB";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_AUS: return "en_AU";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CAN: return "en_CA";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_NZ: return "en_NZ";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_EIRE: return "en_IE";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_SOUTH_AFRICA: return "en_ZA";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_JAMAICA: return "en_JM";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_CARIBBEAN: return "en_GD"; /* Grenada? */
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_BELIZE: return "en_BZ";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_TRINIDAD: return "en_TT";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_ZIMBABWE: return "en_ZW";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_PHILIPPINES: return "en_PH";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_INDONESIA: return "en_ID";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_HONGKONG: return "en_HK";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_INDIA: return "en_IN";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_MALAYSIA: return "en_MY";
++	case SUBLANG_ENGLISH_SINGAPORE: return "en_SG";
++	}
++      return "en";
++    case LANG_ESTONIAN: return "et_EE";
++    case LANG_FAEROESE: return "fo_FO";
++    case LANG_FARSI: return "fa_IR";
++    case LANG_FINNISH: return "fi_FI";
++    case LANG_FRENCH:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_FRENCH: return "fr_FR";
++	case SUBLANG_FRENCH_BELGIAN: /* WALLOON */ return "fr_BE";
++	case SUBLANG_FRENCH_CANADIAN: return "fr_CA";
++	case SUBLANG_FRENCH_SWISS: return "fr_CH";
++	case SUBLANG_FRENCH_LUXEMBOURG: return "fr_LU";
++	case SUBLANG_FRENCH_MONACO: return "fr_MC";
++	case SUBLANG_FRENCH_WESTINDIES: return "fr"; /* Caribbean? */
++	case SUBLANG_FRENCH_REUNION: return "fr_RE";
++	case SUBLANG_FRENCH_CONGO: return "fr_CG";
++	case SUBLANG_FRENCH_SENEGAL: return "fr_SN";
++	case SUBLANG_FRENCH_CAMEROON: return "fr_CM";
++	case SUBLANG_FRENCH_COTEDIVOIRE: return "fr_CI";
++	case SUBLANG_FRENCH_MALI: return "fr_ML";
++	case SUBLANG_FRENCH_MOROCCO: return "fr_MA";
++	case SUBLANG_FRENCH_HAITI: return "fr_HT";
++	}
++      return "fr";
++    case LANG_FRISIAN: return "fy_NL";
++    case LANG_FULFULDE:
++      /* Spoken in Nigeria, Guinea, Senegal, Mali, Niger, Cameroon, Benin. */
++      return "ff_NG";
++    case LANG_GAELIC:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case 0x01: /* SCOTTISH */ return "gd_GB";
++	case 0x02: /* IRISH */ return "ga_IE";
++	}
++      return "C";
++    case LANG_GALICIAN: return "gl_ES";
++    case LANG_GEORGIAN: return "ka_GE";
++    case LANG_GERMAN:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_GERMAN: return "de_DE";
++	case SUBLANG_GERMAN_SWISS: return "de_CH";
++	case SUBLANG_GERMAN_AUSTRIAN: return "de_AT";
++	case SUBLANG_GERMAN_LUXEMBOURG: return "de_LU";
++	case SUBLANG_GERMAN_LIECHTENSTEIN: return "de_LI";
++	}
++      return "de";
++    case LANG_GREEK: return "el_GR";
++    case LANG_GUARANI: return "gn_PY";
++    case LANG_GUJARATI: return "gu_IN";
++    case LANG_HAUSA: return "ha_NG";
++    case LANG_HAWAIIAN:
++      /* FIXME: Do they mean Hawaiian ("haw_US", 1000 speakers)
++	 or Hawaii Creole English ("cpe_US", 600000 speakers)?  */
++      return "cpe_US";
++    case LANG_HEBREW: return "he_IL";
++    case LANG_HINDI: return "hi_IN";
++    case LANG_HUNGARIAN: return "hu_HU";
++    case LANG_IBIBIO: return "nic_NG";
++    case LANG_ICELANDIC: return "is_IS";
++    case LANG_IGBO: return "ig_NG";
++    case LANG_INDONESIAN: return "id_ID";
++    case LANG_INUKTITUT: return "iu_CA";
++    case LANG_ITALIAN:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_ITALIAN: return "it_IT";
++	case SUBLANG_ITALIAN_SWISS: return "it_CH";
++	}
++      return "it";
++    case LANG_JAPANESE: return "ja_JP";
++    case LANG_KANNADA: return "kn_IN";
++    case LANG_KANURI: return "kr_NG";
++    case LANG_KASHMIRI:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "ks_PK";
++	case SUBLANG_KASHMIRI_INDIA: return "ks_IN";
++	}
++      return "ks";
++    case LANG_KAZAK: return "kk_KZ";
++    case LANG_KONKANI:
++      /* FIXME: Adjust this when such locales appear on Unix.  */
++      return "kok_IN";
++    case LANG_KOREAN: return "ko_KR";
++    case LANG_KYRGYZ: return "ky_KG";
++    case LANG_LAO: return "lo_LA";
++    case LANG_LATIN: return "la_VA";
++    case LANG_LATVIAN: return "lv_LV";
++    case LANG_LITHUANIAN: return "lt_LT";
++    case LANG_MACEDONIAN: return "mk_MK";
++    case LANG_MALAY:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_MALAY_MALAYSIA: return "ms_MY";
++	case SUBLANG_MALAY_BRUNEI_DARUSSALAM: return "ms_BN";
++	}
++      return "ms";
++    case LANG_MALAYALAM: return "ml_IN";
++    case LANG_MALTESE: return "mt_MT";
++    case LANG_MANIPURI:
++      /* FIXME: Adjust this when such locales appear on Unix.  */
++      return "mni_IN";
++    case LANG_MARATHI: return "mr_IN";
++    case LANG_MONGOLIAN:
++      return "mn"; /* Ambiguous: could be "mn_CN" or "mn_MN".  */
++    case LANG_NEPALI:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "ne_NP";
++	case SUBLANG_NEPALI_INDIA: return "ne_IN";
++	}
++      return "ne";
++    case LANG_NORWEGIAN:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_NORWEGIAN_BOKMAL: return "no_NO";
++	case SUBLANG_NORWEGIAN_NYNORSK: return "nn_NO";
++	}
++      return "no";
++    case LANG_ORIYA: return "or_IN";
++    case LANG_OROMO: return "om_ET";
++    case LANG_PAPIAMENTU: return "pap_AN";
++    case LANG_PASHTO:
++      return "ps"; /* Ambiguous: could be "ps_PK" or "ps_AF".  */
++    case LANG_POLISH: return "pl_PL";
++    case LANG_PORTUGUESE:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_PORTUGUESE: return "pt_PT";
++	/* Hmm. SUBLANG_PORTUGUESE_BRAZILIAN == SUBLANG_DEFAULT.
++	   Same phenomenon as SUBLANG_ENGLISH_US == SUBLANG_DEFAULT. */
++	case SUBLANG_PORTUGUESE_BRAZILIAN: return "pt_BR";
++	}
++      return "pt";
++    case LANG_PUNJABI:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_PUNJABI_INDIA: return "pa_IN"; /* Gurmukhi script */
++	case SUBLANG_PUNJABI_PAKISTAN: return "pa_PK"; /* Arabic script */
++	}
++      return "pa";
++    case LANG_RHAETO_ROMANCE: return "rm_CH";
++    case LANG_ROMANIAN:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_ROMANIAN_ROMANIA: return "ro_RO";
++	case SUBLANG_ROMANIAN_MOLDOVA: return "ro_MD";
++	}
++      return "ro";
++    case LANG_RUSSIAN:
++      return "ru"; /* Ambiguous: could be "ru_RU" or "ru_UA" or "ru_MD".  */
++    case LANG_SAAMI: /* actually Northern Sami */ return "se_NO";
++    case LANG_SANSKRIT: return "sa_IN";
++    case LANG_SINDHI:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_SINDHI_INDIA: return "sd_IN";
++	case SUBLANG_SINDHI_PAKISTAN: return "sd_PK";
++	}
++      return "sd";
++    case LANG_SINHALESE: return "si_LK";
++    case LANG_SLOVAK: return "sk_SK";
++    case LANG_SLOVENIAN: return "sl_SI";
++    case LANG_SOMALI: return "so_SO";
++    case LANG_SORBIAN:
++      /* FIXME: Adjust this when such locales appear on Unix.  */
++      return "wen_DE";
++    case LANG_SPANISH:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH: return "es_ES";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_MEXICAN: return "es_MX";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_MODERN:
++	  return "es_ES@modern";	/* not seen on Unix */
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_GUATEMALA: return "es_GT";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_COSTA_RICA: return "es_CR";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PANAMA: return "es_PA";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_DOMINICAN_REPUBLIC: return "es_DO";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_VENEZUELA: return "es_VE";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_COLOMBIA: return "es_CO";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PERU: return "es_PE";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_ARGENTINA: return "es_AR";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_ECUADOR: return "es_EC";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_CHILE: return "es_CL";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_URUGUAY: return "es_UY";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PARAGUAY: return "es_PY";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_BOLIVIA: return "es_BO";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_EL_SALVADOR: return "es_SV";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_HONDURAS: return "es_HN";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_NICARAGUA: return "es_NI";
++	case SUBLANG_SPANISH_PUERTO_RICO: return "es_PR";
++	}
++      return "es";
++    case LANG_SUTU: return "bnt_TZ"; /* or "st_LS" or "nso_ZA"? */
++    case LANG_SWAHILI: return "sw_KE";
++    case LANG_SWEDISH:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_DEFAULT: return "sv_SE";
++	case SUBLANG_SWEDISH_FINLAND: return "sv_FI";
++	}
++      return "sv";
++    case LANG_SYRIAC: return "syr_TR"; /* An extinct language.  */
++    case LANG_TAGALOG: return "tl_PH";
++    case LANG_TAJIK: return "tg_TJ";
++    case LANG_TAMAZIGHT:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	/* FIXME: Adjust this when Tamazight locales appear on Unix.  */
++	case SUBLANG_TAMAZIGHT_ARABIC: return "ber_MA@arabic";
++	case SUBLANG_TAMAZIGHT_LATIN: return "ber_MA@latin";
++	}
++      return "ber_MA";
++    case LANG_TAMIL:
++      return "ta"; /* Ambiguous: could be "ta_IN" or "ta_LK" or "ta_SG".  */
++    case LANG_TATAR: return "tt_RU";
++    case LANG_TELUGU: return "te_IN";
++    case LANG_THAI: return "th_TH";
++    case LANG_TIBETAN: return "bo_CN";
++    case LANG_TIGRINYA:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_TIGRINYA_ETHIOPIA: return "ti_ET";
++	case SUBLANG_TIGRINYA_ERITREA: return "ti_ER";
++	}
++      return "ti";
++    case LANG_TSONGA: return "ts_ZA";
++    case LANG_TSWANA: return "tn_BW";
++    case LANG_TURKISH: return "tr_TR";
++    case LANG_TURKMEN: return "tk_TM";
++    case LANG_UKRAINIAN: return "uk_UA";
++    case LANG_URDU:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_URDU_PAKISTAN: return "ur_PK";
++	case SUBLANG_URDU_INDIA: return "ur_IN";
++	}
++      return "ur";
++    case LANG_UZBEK:
++      switch (sub)
++	{
++	case SUBLANG_UZBEK_LATIN: return "uz_UZ";
++	case SUBLANG_UZBEK_CYRILLIC: return "uz_UZ@cyrillic";
++	}
++      return "uz";
++    case LANG_VENDA: return "ve_ZA";
++    case LANG_VIETNAMESE: return "vi_VN";
++    case LANG_WELSH: return "cy_GB";
++    case LANG_XHOSA: return "xh_ZA";
++    case LANG_YI: return "sit_CN";
++    case LANG_YIDDISH: return "yi_IL";
++    case LANG_YORUBA: return "yo_NG";
++    case LANG_ZULU: return "zu_ZA";
++    default: return "C";
++    }
++
++#endif
++}
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/log.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/log.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.515723768 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,98 @@
++/* Log file output.
++   Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++/* Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>.  */
++
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++# include <config.h>
++#endif
++
++#include <stdio.h>
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <string.h>
++
++/* Print an ASCII string with quotes and escape sequences where needed.  */
++static void
++print_escaped (FILE *stream, const char *str)
++{
++  putc ('"', stream);
++  for (; *str != '\0'; str++)
++    if (*str == '\n')
++      {
++	fputs ("\\n\"", stream);
++	if (str[1] == '\0')
++	  return;
++	fputs ("\n\"", stream);
++      }
++    else
++      {
++	if (*str == '"' || *str == '\\')
++	  putc ('\\', stream);
++	putc (*str, stream);
++      }
++  putc ('"', stream);
++}
++
++/* Add to the log file an entry denoting a failed translation.  */
++void
++_nl_log_untranslated (const char *logfilename, const char *domainname,
++		      const char *msgid1, const char *msgid2, int plural)
++{
++  static char *last_logfilename = NULL;
++  static FILE *last_logfile = NULL;
++  FILE *logfile;
++
++  /* Can we reuse the last opened logfile?  */
++  if (last_logfilename == NULL || strcmp (logfilename, last_logfilename) != 0)
++    {
++      /* Close the last used logfile.  */
++      if (last_logfilename != NULL)
++	{
++	  if (last_logfile != NULL)
++	    {
++	      fclose (last_logfile);
++	      last_logfile = NULL;
++	    }
++	  free (last_logfilename);
++	  last_logfilename = NULL;
++	}
++      /* Open the logfile.  */
++      last_logfilename = (char *) malloc (strlen (logfilename) + 1);
++      if (last_logfilename == NULL)
++	return;
++      strcpy (last_logfilename, logfilename);
++      last_logfile = fopen (logfilename, "a");
++      if (last_logfile == NULL)
++	return;
++    }
++  logfile = last_logfile;
++
++  fprintf (logfile, "domain ");
++  print_escaped (logfile, domainname);
++  fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgid ");
++  print_escaped (logfile, msgid1);
++  if (plural)
++    {
++      fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgid_plural ");
++      print_escaped (logfile, msgid2);
++      fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgstr[0] \"\"\n");
++    }
++  else
++    fprintf (logfile, "\nmsgstr \"\"\n");
++  putc ('\n', logfile);
++}
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/Makefile.in	1998-04-26 09:22:35.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/Makefile.in	2004-09-12 14:40:34.521722856 -0400
+@@ -1,19 +1,20 @@
+-# Makefile for directory with message catalog handling in GNU NLS Utilities.
+-# Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++# Makefile for directory with message catalog handling library of GNU gettext
++# Copyright (C) 1995-1998, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ #
+-# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++# under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++# by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+ # any later version.
+ #
+ # This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+ # but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-# GNU General Public License for more details.
++# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++# Library General Public License for more details.
+ #
+-# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+-# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
++# You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++# License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++# USA.
+ 
+ PACKAGE = @PACKAGE@
+ VERSION = @VERSION@
+@@ -23,118 +24,341 @@
+ srcdir = @srcdir@
+ top_srcdir = @top_srcdir@
+ top_builddir = ..
+-VPATH = @srcdir@
++#VPATH = $(srcdir)
+ 
+ prefix = @prefix@
+ exec_prefix = @exec_prefix@
+ transform = @program_transform_name@
+-libdir = $(exec_prefix)/lib
+-includedir = $(prefix)/include
+-datadir = $(prefix)/@DATADIRNAME@
++libdir = @libdir@
++includedir = @includedir@
++datadir = @datadir@
+ localedir = $(datadir)/locale
+-gnulocaledir = $(prefix)/share/locale
+-gettextsrcdir = @datadir@/gettext/intl
+-aliaspath = $(localedir):.
++gettextsrcdir = $(datadir)/gettext/intl
++aliaspath = $(localedir)
+ subdir = intl
+ 
+ INSTALL = @INSTALL@
+ INSTALL_DATA = @INSTALL_DATA@
+ MKINSTALLDIRS = @MKINSTALLDIRS@
++mkinstalldirs = $(SHELL) $(MKINSTALLDIRS)
+ 
+-l = @l@
++l = @INTL_LIBTOOL_SUFFIX_PREFIX@
+ 
+ AR = ar
+ CC = @CC@
+ LIBTOOL = @LIBTOOL@
+ RANLIB = @RANLIB@
++YACC = @INTLBISON@ -y -d
++YFLAGS = --name-prefix=__gettext
+ 
+-DEFS = -DLOCALEDIR=\"$(localedir)\" -DGNULOCALEDIR=\"$(gnulocaledir)\" \
+--DLOCALE_ALIAS_PATH=\"$(aliaspath)\" @DEFS@
++DEFS = -DLOCALEDIR=\"$(localedir)\" -DLOCALE_ALIAS_PATH=\"$(aliaspath)\" \
++-DLIBDIR=\"$(libdir)\" -DIN_LIBINTL \
++-DENABLE_RELOCATABLE=1 -DIN_LIBRARY -DINSTALLDIR=\"$(libdir)\" -DNO_XMALLOC \
++-Dset_relocation_prefix=libintl_set_relocation_prefix \
++-Drelocate=libintl_relocate \
++-DDEPENDS_ON_LIBICONV=1 @DEFS@
+ CPPFLAGS = @CPPFLAGS@
+ CFLAGS = @CFLAGS@
+ LDFLAGS = @LDFLAGS@
++LIBS = @LIBS@
+ 
+ COMPILE = $(CC) -c $(DEFS) $(INCLUDES) $(CPPFLAGS) $(CFLAGS) $(XCFLAGS)
+ 
+-HEADERS = $(COMHDRS) libgettext.h loadinfo.h
+-COMHDRS = gettext.h gettextP.h hash-string.h
+-SOURCES = $(COMSRCS) intl-compat.c cat-compat.c
+-COMSRCS = bindtextdom.c dcgettext.c dgettext.c gettext.c \
+-finddomain.c loadmsgcat.c localealias.c textdomain.c l10nflist.c \
+-explodename.c
+-OBJECTS = @INTLOBJS@ bindtextdom.$lo dcgettext.$lo dgettext.$lo gettext.$lo \
+-finddomain.$lo loadmsgcat.$lo localealias.$lo textdomain.$lo l10nflist.$lo \
+-explodename.$lo
+-CATOBJS = cat-compat.$lo ../po/cat-id-tbl.$lo
+-GETTOBJS = intl-compat.$lo
+-DISTFILES.common = ChangeLog Makefile.in linux-msg.sed po2tbl.sed.in \
+-xopen-msg.sed $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)
++HEADERS = \
++  gmo.h \
++  gettextP.h \
++  hash-string.h \
++  loadinfo.h \
++  plural-exp.h \
++  eval-plural.h \
++  localcharset.h \
++  relocatable.h \
++  xsize.h \
++  printf-args.h printf-args.c \
++  printf-parse.h wprintf-parse.h printf-parse.c \
++  vasnprintf.h vasnwprintf.h vasnprintf.c \
++  os2compat.h \
++  libgnuintl.h.in
++SOURCES = \
++  bindtextdom.c \
++  dcgettext.c \
++  dgettext.c \
++  gettext.c \
++  finddomain.c \
++  loadmsgcat.c \
++  localealias.c \
++  textdomain.c \
++  l10nflist.c \
++  explodename.c \
++  dcigettext.c \
++  dcngettext.c \
++  dngettext.c \
++  ngettext.c \
++  plural.y \
++  plural-exp.c \
++  localcharset.c \
++  relocatable.c \
++  localename.c \
++  log.c \
++  printf.c \
++  osdep.c \
++  os2compat.c \
++  intl-compat.c
++OBJECTS = \
++  bindtextdom.$lo \
++  dcgettext.$lo \
++  dgettext.$lo \
++  gettext.$lo \
++  finddomain.$lo \
++  loadmsgcat.$lo \
++  localealias.$lo \
++  textdomain.$lo \
++  l10nflist.$lo \
++  explodename.$lo \
++  dcigettext.$lo \
++  dcngettext.$lo \
++  dngettext.$lo \
++  ngettext.$lo \
++  plural.$lo \
++  plural-exp.$lo \
++  localcharset.$lo \
++  relocatable.$lo \
++  localename.$lo \
++  log.$lo \
++  printf.$lo \
++  osdep.$lo \
++  intl-compat.$lo
++DISTFILES.common = Makefile.in \
++config.charset locale.alias ref-add.sin ref-del.sin $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)
++DISTFILES.generated = plural.c
+ DISTFILES.normal = VERSION
+-DISTFILES.gettext = libintl.glibc intlh.inst.in
++DISTFILES.gettext = COPYING.LIB-2.0 COPYING.LIB-2.1 libintl.glibc \
++libgnuintl.h_vms Makefile.vms \
++libgnuintl.h.msvc-static libgnuintl.h.msvc-shared README.woe32 Makefile.msvc
++DISTFILES.obsolete = xopen-msg.sed linux-msg.sed po2tbl.sed.in cat-compat.c \
++COPYING.LIB-2 gettext.h libgettext.h plural-eval.c libgnuintl.h
++
++all: all-@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@
++all-yes: libintl.$la libintl.h charset.alias ref-add.sed ref-del.sed
++all-no: all-no-@BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@
++all-no-yes: libgnuintl.$la
++all-no-no:
++
++libintl.a libgnuintl.a: $(OBJECTS)
++	rm -f $@
++	$(AR) cru $@ $(OBJECTS)
++	$(RANLIB) $@
++
++libintl.la libgnuintl.la: $(OBJECTS)
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=link \
++	  $(CC) $(CPPFLAGS) $(CFLAGS) $(XCFLAGS) $(LDFLAGS) -o $@ \
++	  $(OBJECTS) @LTLIBICONV@ $(LIBS) -lc \
++	  -version-info $(LTV_CURRENT):$(LTV_REVISION):$(LTV_AGE) \
++	  -rpath $(libdir) \
++	  -no-undefined
++
++# Libtool's library version information for libintl.
++# Before making a gettext release, the gettext maintainer must change this
++# according to the libtool documentation, section "Library interface versions".
++# Maintainers of other packages that include the intl directory must *not*
++# change these values.
++LTV_CURRENT=7
++LTV_REVISION=0
++LTV_AGE=4
+ 
+ .SUFFIXES:
+-.SUFFIXES: .c .o .lo
++.SUFFIXES: .c .y .o .lo .sin .sed
++
+ .c.o:
+ 	$(COMPILE) $<
+-.c.lo:
+-	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $<
+ 
+-INCLUDES = -I.. -I. -I$(top_srcdir)/intl -I$(top_srcdir)/lib
++.y.c:
++	$(YACC) $(YFLAGS) --output $@ $<
++	rm -f $*.h
+ 
+-all: all-@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@
++bindtextdom.lo: $(srcdir)/bindtextdom.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/bindtextdom.c
++dcgettext.lo: $(srcdir)/dcgettext.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/dcgettext.c
++dgettext.lo: $(srcdir)/dgettext.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/dgettext.c
++gettext.lo: $(srcdir)/gettext.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/gettext.c
++finddomain.lo: $(srcdir)/finddomain.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/finddomain.c
++loadmsgcat.lo: $(srcdir)/loadmsgcat.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/loadmsgcat.c
++localealias.lo: $(srcdir)/localealias.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/localealias.c
++textdomain.lo: $(srcdir)/textdomain.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/textdomain.c
++l10nflist.lo: $(srcdir)/l10nflist.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/l10nflist.c
++explodename.lo: $(srcdir)/explodename.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/explodename.c
++dcigettext.lo: $(srcdir)/dcigettext.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/dcigettext.c
++dcngettext.lo: $(srcdir)/dcngettext.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/dcngettext.c
++dngettext.lo: $(srcdir)/dngettext.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/dngettext.c
++ngettext.lo: $(srcdir)/ngettext.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/ngettext.c
++plural.lo: $(srcdir)/plural.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/plural.c
++plural-exp.lo: $(srcdir)/plural-exp.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/plural-exp.c
++localcharset.lo: $(srcdir)/localcharset.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/localcharset.c
++relocatable.lo: $(srcdir)/relocatable.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/relocatable.c
++localename.lo: $(srcdir)/localename.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/localename.c
++log.lo: $(srcdir)/log.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/log.c
++printf.lo: $(srcdir)/printf.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/printf.c
++osdep.lo: $(srcdir)/osdep.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/osdep.c
++intl-compat.lo: $(srcdir)/intl-compat.c
++	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=compile $(COMPILE) $(srcdir)/intl-compat.c
+ 
+-all-yes: libintl.$la intlh.inst
+-all-no:
++ref-add.sed: $(srcdir)/ref-add.sin
++	sed -e '/^#/d' -e 's/@''PACKAGE''@/@PACKAGE@/g' $(srcdir)/ref-add.sin > t-ref-add.sed
++	mv t-ref-add.sed ref-add.sed
++ref-del.sed: $(srcdir)/ref-del.sin
++	sed -e '/^#/d' -e 's/@''PACKAGE''@/@PACKAGE@/g' $(srcdir)/ref-del.sin > t-ref-del.sed
++	mv t-ref-del.sed ref-del.sed
+ 
+-libintl.a: $(OBJECTS)
+-	rm -f $@
+-	$(AR) cru $@ $(OBJECTS)
+-	$(RANLIB) $@
++INCLUDES = -I. -I$(srcdir) -I..
+ 
+-libintl.la: $(OBJECTS)
+-	$(LIBTOOL) --mode=link $(CC) $(LDFLAGS) -o $@ $(OBJECTS) \
+-		   -version-info 1:0 -rpath $(libdir)
++libgnuintl.h: $(srcdir)/libgnuintl.h.in
++	sed -e 's,@''HAVE_POSIX_PRINTF''@,@HAVE_POSIX_PRINTF@,g' \
++	    -e 's,@''HAVE_ASPRINTF''@,@HAVE_ASPRINTF@,g' \
++	    -e 's,@''HAVE_SNPRINTF''@,@HAVE_SNPRINTF@,g' \
++	    -e 's,@''HAVE_WPRINTF''@,@HAVE_WPRINTF@,g' \
++	  < $(srcdir)/libgnuintl.h.in > libgnuintl.h
+ 
+-../po/cat-id-tbl.$lo: ../po/cat-id-tbl.c $(top_srcdir)/po/$(PACKAGE).pot
+-	cd ../po && $(MAKE) cat-id-tbl.$lo
++libintl.h: libgnuintl.h
++	cp libgnuintl.h libintl.h
+ 
+-check: all
++charset.alias: $(srcdir)/config.charset
++	$(SHELL) $(srcdir)/config.charset '@host@' > t-$@
++	mv t-$@ $@
+ 
+-# This installation goal is only used in GNU gettext.  Packages which
+-# only use the library should use install instead.
++check: all
+ 
+ # We must not install the libintl.h/libintl.a files if we are on a
+-# system which has the gettext() function in its C library or in a
+-# separate library or use the catgets interface.  A special case is
+-# where configure found a previously installed GNU gettext library.
++# system which has the GNU gettext() function in its C library or in a
++# separate library.
+ # If you want to use the one which comes with this version of the
+ # package, you have to use `configure --with-included-gettext'.
+ install: install-exec install-data
+ install-exec: all
+-	if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext" \
+-	   && test '@INTLOBJS@' = '$(GETTOBJS)'; then \
+-	  if test -r $(MKINSTALLDIRS); then \
+-	    $(MKINSTALLDIRS) $(libdir) $(includedir); \
+-	  else \
+-	    $(top_srcdir)/mkinstalldirs $(libdir) $(includedir); \
++	if { test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-runtime" || test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; } \
++	   && test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = yes; then \
++	  $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(libdir) $(DESTDIR)$(includedir); \
++	  $(INSTALL_DATA) libintl.h $(DESTDIR)$(includedir)/libintl.h; \
++	  $(LIBTOOL) --mode=install \
++	    $(INSTALL_DATA) libintl.$la $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libintl.$la; \
++	  if test "@RELOCATABLE@" = yes; then \
++	    dependencies=`sed -n -e 's,^dependency_libs=\(.*\),\1,p' < $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libintl.la | sed -e "s,^',," -e "s,'\$$,,"`; \
++	    if test -n "$$dependencies"; then \
++	      rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libintl.la; \
++	    fi; \
+ 	  fi; \
+-	  $(INSTALL_DATA) intlh.inst $(includedir)/libintl.h; \
+-	  $(INSTALL_DATA) libintl.a $(libdir)/libintl.a; \
+ 	else \
+ 	  : ; \
+ 	fi
+-install-data: all
+-	if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext"; then \
+-	  if test -r $(MKINSTALLDIRS); then \
+-	    $(MKINSTALLDIRS) $(gettextsrcdir); \
++	if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools" \
++	   && test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = no; then \
++	  $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(libdir); \
++	  $(LIBTOOL) --mode=install \
++	    $(INSTALL_DATA) libgnuintl.$la $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libgnuintl.$la; \
++	  rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/preloadable_libintl.so; \
++	  $(INSTALL_DATA) $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libgnuintl.so $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/preloadable_libintl.so; \
++	  $(LIBTOOL) --mode=uninstall \
++	    rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libgnuintl.$la; \
++	else \
++	  : ; \
++	fi
++	if test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = yes; then \
++	  test @GLIBC21@ != no || $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(libdir); \
++	  temp=$(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/t-charset.alias; \
++	  dest=$(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/charset.alias; \
++	  if test -f $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/charset.alias; then \
++	    orig=$(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/charset.alias; \
++	    sed -f ref-add.sed $$orig > $$temp; \
++	    $(INSTALL_DATA) $$temp $$dest; \
++	    rm -f $$temp; \
+ 	  else \
+-	    $(top_srcdir)/mkinstalldirs $(gettextsrcdir); \
++	    if test @GLIBC21@ = no; then \
++	      orig=charset.alias; \
++	      sed -f ref-add.sed $$orig > $$temp; \
++	      $(INSTALL_DATA) $$temp $$dest; \
++	      rm -f $$temp; \
++	    fi; \
+ 	  fi; \
+-	  $(INSTALL_DATA) VERSION $(gettextsrcdir)/VERSION; \
+-	  dists="$(DISTFILES.common)"; \
++	  $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(localedir); \
++	  test -f $(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/locale.alias \
++	    && orig=$(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/locale.alias \
++	    || orig=$(srcdir)/locale.alias; \
++	  temp=$(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/t-locale.alias; \
++	  dest=$(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/locale.alias; \
++	  sed -f ref-add.sed $$orig > $$temp; \
++	  $(INSTALL_DATA) $$temp $$dest; \
++	  rm -f $$temp; \
++	else \
++	  : ; \
++	fi
++install-data: all
++	if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; then \
++	  $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir); \
++	  $(INSTALL_DATA) VERSION $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/VERSION; \
++	  $(INSTALL_DATA) ChangeLog.inst $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/ChangeLog; \
++	  dists="COPYING.LIB-2.0 COPYING.LIB-2.1 $(DISTFILES.common)"; \
+ 	  for file in $$dists; do \
+-	    $(INSTALL_DATA) $(srcdir)/$$file $(gettextsrcdir)/$$file; \
++	    $(INSTALL_DATA) $(srcdir)/$$file \
++			    $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/$$file; \
+ 	  done; \
++	  chmod a+x $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/config.charset; \
++	  dists="$(DISTFILES.generated)"; \
++	  for file in $$dists; do \
++	    if test -f $$file; then dir=.; else dir=$(srcdir); fi; \
++	    $(INSTALL_DATA) $$dir/$$file \
++			    $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/$$file; \
++	  done; \
++	  dists="$(DISTFILES.obsolete)"; \
++	  for file in $$dists; do \
++	    rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/$$file; \
++	  done; \
++	else \
++	  : ; \
++	fi
++
++install-strip: install
++
++installdirs:
++	if { test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-runtime" || test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; } \
++	   && test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = yes; then \
++	  $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(libdir) $(DESTDIR)$(includedir); \
++	else \
++	  : ; \
++	fi
++	if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools" \
++	   && test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = no; then \
++	  $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(libdir); \
++	else \
++	  : ; \
++	fi
++	if test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = yes; then \
++	  test @GLIBC21@ != no || $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(libdir); \
++	  $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(localedir); \
++	else \
++	  : ; \
++	fi
++	if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; then \
++	  $(mkinstalldirs) $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir); \
+ 	else \
+ 	  : ; \
+ 	fi
+@@ -143,22 +367,76 @@
+ installcheck:
+ 
+ uninstall:
+-	dists="$(DISTFILES.common)"; \
+-	for file in $$dists; do \
+-	  rm -f $(gettextsrcdir)/$$file; \
+-	done
++	if { test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-runtime" || test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; } \
++	   && test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = yes; then \
++	  rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(includedir)/libintl.h; \
++	  $(LIBTOOL) --mode=uninstall \
++	    rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/libintl.$la; \
++	else \
++	  : ; \
++	fi
++	if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools" \
++	   && test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = no; then \
++	  rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/preloadable_libintl.so; \
++	else \
++	  : ; \
++	fi
++	if test '@USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL@' = yes; then \
++	  if test -f $(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/charset.alias; then \
++	    temp=$(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/t-charset.alias; \
++	    dest=$(DESTDIR)$(libdir)/charset.alias; \
++	    sed -f ref-del.sed $$dest > $$temp; \
++	    if grep '^# Packages using this file: $$' $$temp > /dev/null; then \
++	      rm -f $$dest; \
++	    else \
++	      $(INSTALL_DATA) $$temp $$dest; \
++	    fi; \
++	    rm -f $$temp; \
++	  fi; \
++	  if test -f $(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/locale.alias; then \
++	    temp=$(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/t-locale.alias; \
++	    dest=$(DESTDIR)$(localedir)/locale.alias; \
++	    sed -f ref-del.sed $$dest > $$temp; \
++	    if grep '^# Packages using this file: $$' $$temp > /dev/null; then \
++	      rm -f $$dest; \
++	    else \
++	      $(INSTALL_DATA) $$temp $$dest; \
++	    fi; \
++	    rm -f $$temp; \
++	  fi; \
++	else \
++	  : ; \
++	fi
++	if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; then \
++	  for file in VERSION ChangeLog COPYING.LIB-2.0 COPYING.LIB-2.1 $(DISTFILES.common) $(DISTFILES.generated); do \
++	    rm -f $(DESTDIR)$(gettextsrcdir)/$$file; \
++	  done; \
++	else \
++	  : ; \
++	fi
+ 
+-info dvi:
++info dvi ps pdf html:
+ 
+-$(OBJECTS): ../config.h libgettext.h
+-bindtextdom.$lo finddomain.$lo loadmsgcat.$lo: gettextP.h gettext.h loadinfo.h
+-dcgettext.$lo: gettextP.h gettext.h hash-string.h loadinfo.h
++$(OBJECTS): ../config.h libgnuintl.h
++bindtextdom.$lo dcgettext.$lo dcigettext.$lo dcngettext.$lo dgettext.$lo dngettext.$lo finddomain.$lo gettext.$lo intl-compat.$lo loadmsgcat.$lo localealias.$lo ngettext.$lo textdomain.$lo: $(srcdir)/gettextP.h $(srcdir)/gmo.h $(srcdir)/loadinfo.h
++dcigettext.$lo loadmsgcat.$lo: $(srcdir)/hash-string.h
++explodename.$lo l10nflist.$lo: $(srcdir)/loadinfo.h
++dcigettext.$lo loadmsgcat.$lo plural.$lo plural-exp.$lo: $(srcdir)/plural-exp.h
++dcigettext.$lo: $(srcdir)/eval-plural.h
++localcharset.$lo: $(srcdir)/localcharset.h
++localealias.$lo localcharset.$lo relocatable.$lo: $(srcdir)/relocatable.h
++printf.$lo: $(srcdir)/printf-args.h $(srcdir)/printf-args.c $(srcdir)/printf-parse.h $(srcdir)/wprintf-parse.h $(srcdir)/xsize.h $(srcdir)/printf-parse.c $(srcdir)/vasnprintf.h $(srcdir)/vasnwprintf.h $(srcdir)/vasnprintf.c
+ 
+ tags: TAGS
+ 
+ TAGS: $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)
+ 	here=`pwd`; cd $(srcdir) && etags -o $$here/TAGS $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)
+ 
++ctags: CTAGS
++
++CTAGS: $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)
++	here=`pwd`; cd $(srcdir) && ctags -o $$here/CTAGS $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)
++
+ id: ID
+ 
+ ID: $(HEADERS) $(SOURCES)
+@@ -166,12 +444,19 @@
+ 
+ 
+ mostlyclean:
+-	rm -f *.a *.o *.lo core core.*
++	rm -f *.a *.la *.o *.obj *.lo core core.*
++	rm -f libgnuintl.h libintl.h charset.alias ref-add.sed ref-del.sed
++	rm -f -r .libs _libs
+ 
+ clean: mostlyclean
+ 
+ distclean: clean
+-	rm -f Makefile ID TAGS po2msg.sed po2tbl.sed libintl.h
++	rm -f Makefile ID TAGS
++	if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-runtime" || test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; then \
++	  rm -f ChangeLog.inst $(DISTFILES.normal); \
++	else \
++	  : ; \
++	fi
+ 
+ maintainer-clean: distclean
+ 	@echo "This command is intended for maintainers to use;"
+@@ -181,33 +466,27 @@
+ # GNU gettext needs not contain the file `VERSION' but contains some
+ # other files which should not be distributed in other packages.
+ distdir = ../$(PACKAGE)-$(VERSION)/$(subdir)
+-dist distdir: Makefile $(DISTFILES)
+-	if test "$(PACKAGE)" = gettext; then \
+-	  additional="$(DISTFILES.gettext)"; \
++dist distdir: Makefile
++	if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-tools"; then \
++	  : ; \
+ 	else \
+-	  additional="$(DISTFILES.normal)"; \
+-	fi; \
+-	for file in $(DISTFILES.common) $$additional; do \
+-	  ln $(srcdir)/$$file $(distdir) 2> /dev/null \
+-	    || cp -p $(srcdir)/$$file $(distdir); \
+-	done
+-
+-dist-libc:
+-	tar zcvf intl-glibc.tar.gz $(COMSRCS) $(COMHDRS) libintl.h.glibc
+-
+-Makefile: Makefile.in ../config.status
+-	cd .. \
+-	  && CONFIG_FILES=$(subdir)/$@ CONFIG_HEADERS= $(SHELL) ./config.status
++	  if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext-runtime"; then \
++	    additional="$(DISTFILES.gettext)"; \
++	  else \
++	    additional="$(DISTFILES.normal)"; \
++	  fi; \
++	  $(MAKE) $(DISTFILES.common) $(DISTFILES.generated) $$additional; \
++	  for file in ChangeLog $(DISTFILES.common) $(DISTFILES.generated) $$additional; do \
++	    if test -f $$file; then dir=.; else dir=$(srcdir); fi; \
++	    cp -p $$dir/$$file $(distdir); \
++	  done; \
++	fi
+ 
+-# The dependency for intlh.inst is different in gettext and all other
+-# packages.  Because we cannot you GNU make features we have to solve
+-# the problem while rewriting Makefile.in.
+-@GT_YES@intlh.inst: intlh.inst.in ../config.status
+-@GT_YES@	cd .. \
+-@GT_YES@	&& CONFIG_FILES=$(subdir)/$@ CONFIG_HEADERS= \
+-@GT_YES@	  $(SHELL) ./config.status
+-@GT_NO@.PHONY: intlh.inst
+-@GT_NO@intlh.inst:
++Makefile: $(srcdir)/Makefile.in $(top_builddir)/config.status
++	cd $(top_builddir) && $(SHELL) ./config.status
++# This would be more efficient, but doesn't work any more with autoconf-2.57,
++# when AC_CONFIG_FILES([intl/Makefile:somedir/Makefile.in]) is used.
++#	cd $(top_builddir) && CONFIG_FILES=$(subdir)/$@ CONFIG_HEADERS= $(SHELL) ./config.status
+ 
+ # Tell versions [3.59,3.63) of GNU make not to export all variables.
+ # Otherwise a system limit (for SysV at least) may be exceeded.
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/ngettext.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/ngettext.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.533721032 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,65 @@
++/* Implementation of ngettext(3) function.
++   Copyright (C) 1995, 1997, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++# include <config.h>
++#endif
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# define __need_NULL
++# include <stddef.h>
++#else
++# include <stdlib.h>		/* Just for NULL.  */
++#endif
++
++#include "gettextP.h"
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# include <libintl.h>
++#else
++# include "libgnuintl.h"
++#endif
++
++#include <locale.h>
++
++/* @@ end of prolog @@ */
++
++/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem.  They must not clash
++   with existing names and they should follow ANSI C.  But this source
++   code is also used in GNU C Library where the names have a __
++   prefix.  So we have to make a difference here.  */
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# define NGETTEXT __ngettext
++# define DCNGETTEXT __dcngettext
++#else
++# define NGETTEXT libintl_ngettext
++# define DCNGETTEXT libintl_dcngettext
++#endif
++
++/* Look up MSGID in the current default message catalog for the current
++   LC_MESSAGES locale.  If not found, returns MSGID itself (the default
++   text).  */
++char *
++NGETTEXT (const char *msgid1, const char *msgid2, unsigned long int n)
++{
++  return DCNGETTEXT (NULL, msgid1, msgid2, n, LC_MESSAGES);
++}
++
++#ifdef _LIBC
++/* Alias for function name in GNU C Library.  */
++weak_alias (__ngettext, ngettext);
++#endif
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/os2compat.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/os2compat.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.539720120 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,98 @@
++/* OS/2 compatibility functions.
++   Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#define OS2_AWARE
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++#include <config.h>
++#endif
++
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <string.h>
++#include <sys/param.h>
++
++/* A version of getenv() that works from DLLs */
++extern unsigned long DosScanEnv (const unsigned char *pszName, unsigned char **ppszValue);
++
++char *
++_nl_getenv (const char *name)
++{
++  unsigned char *value;
++  if (DosScanEnv (name, &value))
++    return NULL;
++  else
++    return value;
++}
++
++/* A fixed size buffer.  */
++char libintl_nl_default_dirname[MAXPATHLEN+1];
++
++char *_nlos2_libdir = NULL;
++char *_nlos2_localealiaspath = NULL;
++char *_nlos2_localedir = NULL;
++
++static __attribute__((constructor)) void
++nlos2_initialize ()
++{
++  char *root = getenv ("UNIXROOT");
++  char *gnulocaledir = getenv ("GNULOCALEDIR");
++
++  _nlos2_libdir = gnulocaledir;
++  if (!_nlos2_libdir)
++    {
++      if (root)
++        {
++          size_t sl = strlen (root);
++          _nlos2_libdir = (char *) malloc (sl + strlen (LIBDIR) + 1);
++          memcpy (_nlos2_libdir, root, sl);
++          memcpy (_nlos2_libdir + sl, LIBDIR, strlen (LIBDIR) + 1);
++        }
++      else
++        _nlos2_libdir = LIBDIR;
++    }
++
++  _nlos2_localealiaspath = gnulocaledir;
++  if (!_nlos2_localealiaspath)
++    {
++      if (root)
++        {
++          size_t sl = strlen (root);
++          _nlos2_localealiaspath = (char *) malloc (sl + strlen (LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH) + 1);
++          memcpy (_nlos2_localealiaspath, root, sl);
++          memcpy (_nlos2_localealiaspath + sl, LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH, strlen (LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH) + 1);
++        }
++     else
++        _nlos2_localealiaspath = LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH;
++    }
++
++  _nlos2_localedir = gnulocaledir;
++  if (!_nlos2_localedir)
++    {
++      if (root)
++        {
++          size_t sl = strlen (root);
++          _nlos2_localedir = (char *) malloc (sl + strlen (LOCALEDIR) + 1);
++          memcpy (_nlos2_localedir, root, sl);
++          memcpy (_nlos2_localedir + sl, LOCALEDIR, strlen (LOCALEDIR) + 1);
++        }
++      else
++        _nlos2_localedir = LOCALEDIR;
++    }
++
++  if (strlen (_nlos2_localedir) <= MAXPATHLEN)
++    strcpy (libintl_nl_default_dirname, _nlos2_localedir);
++}
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/os2compat.h	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/os2compat.h	2004-09-12 14:40:34.544719360 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,46 @@
++/* OS/2 compatibility defines.
++   This file is intended to be included from config.h
++   Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++/* When included from os2compat.h we need all the original definitions */
++#ifndef OS2_AWARE
++
++#undef LIBDIR
++#define LIBDIR			_nlos2_libdir
++extern char *_nlos2_libdir;
++
++#undef LOCALEDIR
++#define LOCALEDIR		_nlos2_localedir
++extern char *_nlos2_localedir;
++
++#undef LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH
++#define LOCALE_ALIAS_PATH	_nlos2_localealiaspath
++extern char *_nlos2_localealiaspath;
++
++#endif
++
++#undef HAVE_STRCASECMP
++#define HAVE_STRCASECMP 1
++#define strcasecmp stricmp
++#define strncasecmp strnicmp
++
++/* We have our own getenv() which works even if library is compiled as DLL */
++#define getenv _nl_getenv
++
++/* Older versions of gettext used -1 as the value of LC_MESSAGES */
++#define LC_MESSAGES_COMPAT (-1)
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/osdep.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/osdep.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.550718448 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,24 @@
++/* OS dependent parts of libintl.
++   Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#if defined __EMX__
++# include "os2compat.c"
++#else
++/* Avoid AIX compiler warning.  */
++typedef int dummy;
++#endif
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/plural.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/plural.c	2004-09-12 14:40:36.571411256 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,1490 @@
++/* A Bison parser, made from plural.y
++   by GNU bison 1.35.  */
++
++#define YYBISON 1  /* Identify Bison output.  */
++
++#define yyparse __gettextparse
++#define yylex __gettextlex
++#define yyerror __gettexterror
++#define yylval __gettextlval
++#define yychar __gettextchar
++#define yydebug __gettextdebug
++#define yynerrs __gettextnerrs
++# define	EQUOP2	257
++# define	CMPOP2	258
++# define	ADDOP2	259
++# define	MULOP2	260
++# define	NUMBER	261
++
++#line 1 "plural.y"
++
++/* Expression parsing for plural form selection.
++   Copyright (C) 2000-2001, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++   Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++/* The bison generated parser uses alloca.  AIX 3 forces us to put this
++   declaration at the beginning of the file.  The declaration in bison's
++   skeleton file comes too late.  This must come before <config.h>
++   because <config.h> may include arbitrary system headers.  */
++#if defined _AIX && !defined __GNUC__
++ #pragma alloca
++#endif
++
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++# include <config.h>
++#endif
++
++#include <stddef.h>
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include "plural-exp.h"
++
++/* The main function generated by the parser is called __gettextparse,
++   but we want it to be called PLURAL_PARSE.  */
++#ifndef _LIBC
++# define __gettextparse PLURAL_PARSE
++#endif
++
++#define YYLEX_PARAM	&((struct parse_args *) arg)->cp
++#define YYPARSE_PARAM	arg
++
++#line 49 "plural.y"
++#ifndef YYSTYPE
++typedef union {
++  unsigned long int num;
++  enum operator op;
++  struct expression *exp;
++} yystype;
++# define YYSTYPE yystype
++# define YYSTYPE_IS_TRIVIAL 1
++#endif
++#line 55 "plural.y"
++
++/* Prototypes for local functions.  */
++static int yylex (YYSTYPE *lval, const char **pexp);
++static void yyerror (const char *str);
++
++/* Allocation of expressions.  */
++
++static struct expression *
++new_exp (int nargs, enum operator op, struct expression * const *args)
++{
++  int i;
++  struct expression *newp;
++
++  /* If any of the argument could not be malloc'ed, just return NULL.  */
++  for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--)
++    if (args[i] == NULL)
++      goto fail;
++
++  /* Allocate a new expression.  */
++  newp = (struct expression *) malloc (sizeof (*newp));
++  if (newp != NULL)
++    {
++      newp->nargs = nargs;
++      newp->operation = op;
++      for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--)
++	newp->val.args[i] = args[i];
++      return newp;
++    }
++
++ fail:
++  for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--)
++    FREE_EXPRESSION (args[i]);
++
++  return NULL;
++}
++
++static inline struct expression *
++new_exp_0 (enum operator op)
++{
++  return new_exp (0, op, NULL);
++}
++
++static inline struct expression *
++new_exp_1 (enum operator op, struct expression *right)
++{
++  struct expression *args[1];
++
++  args[0] = right;
++  return new_exp (1, op, args);
++}
++
++static struct expression *
++new_exp_2 (enum operator op, struct expression *left, struct expression *right)
++{
++  struct expression *args[2];
++
++  args[0] = left;
++  args[1] = right;
++  return new_exp (2, op, args);
++}
++
++static inline struct expression *
++new_exp_3 (enum operator op, struct expression *bexp,
++	   struct expression *tbranch, struct expression *fbranch)
++{
++  struct expression *args[3];
++
++  args[0] = bexp;
++  args[1] = tbranch;
++  args[2] = fbranch;
++  return new_exp (3, op, args);
++}
++
++#ifndef YYDEBUG
++# define YYDEBUG 0
++#endif
++
++
++
++#define	YYFINAL		27
++#define	YYFLAG		-32768
++#define	YYNTBASE	16
++
++/* YYTRANSLATE(YYLEX) -- Bison token number corresponding to YYLEX. */
++#define YYTRANSLATE(x) ((unsigned)(x) <= 261 ? yytranslate[x] : 18)
++
++/* YYTRANSLATE[YYLEX] -- Bison token number corresponding to YYLEX. */
++static const char yytranslate[] =
++{
++       0,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,    10,     2,     2,     2,     2,     5,     2,
++      14,    15,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,    12,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     3,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++      13,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     4,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,
++       2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     2,     1,     6,     7,     8,
++       9,    11
++};
++
++#if YYDEBUG
++static const short yyprhs[] =
++{
++       0,     0,     2,     8,    12,    16,    20,    24,    28,    32,
++      35,    37,    39
++};
++static const short yyrhs[] =
++{
++      17,     0,    17,     3,    17,    12,    17,     0,    17,     4,
++      17,     0,    17,     5,    17,     0,    17,     6,    17,     0,
++      17,     7,    17,     0,    17,     8,    17,     0,    17,     9,
++      17,     0,    10,    17,     0,    13,     0,    11,     0,    14,
++      17,    15,     0
++};
++
++#endif
++
++#if YYDEBUG
++/* YYRLINE[YYN] -- source line where rule number YYN was defined. */
++static const short yyrline[] =
++{
++       0,   150,   158,   162,   166,   170,   174,   178,   182,   186,
++     190,   194,   199
++};
++#endif
++
++
++#if (YYDEBUG) || defined YYERROR_VERBOSE
++
++/* YYTNAME[TOKEN_NUM] -- String name of the token TOKEN_NUM. */
++static const char *const yytname[] =
++{
++  "$", "error", "$undefined.", "'?'", "'|'", "'&'", "EQUOP2", "CMPOP2", 
++  "ADDOP2", "MULOP2", "'!'", "NUMBER", "':'", "'n'", "'('", "')'", 
++  "start", "exp", 0
++};
++#endif
++
++/* YYR1[YYN] -- Symbol number of symbol that rule YYN derives. */
++static const short yyr1[] =
++{
++       0,    16,    17,    17,    17,    17,    17,    17,    17,    17,
++      17,    17,    17
++};
++
++/* YYR2[YYN] -- Number of symbols composing right hand side of rule YYN. */
++static const short yyr2[] =
++{
++       0,     1,     5,     3,     3,     3,     3,     3,     3,     2,
++       1,     1,     3
++};
++
++/* YYDEFACT[S] -- default rule to reduce with in state S when YYTABLE
++   doesn't specify something else to do.  Zero means the default is an
++   error. */
++static const short yydefact[] =
++{
++       0,     0,    11,    10,     0,     1,     9,     0,     0,     0,
++       0,     0,     0,     0,     0,    12,     0,     3,     4,     5,
++       6,     7,     8,     0,     2,     0,     0,     0
++};
++
++static const short yydefgoto[] =
++{
++      25,     5
++};
++
++static const short yypact[] =
++{
++      -9,    -9,-32768,-32768,    -9,    34,-32768,    11,    -9,    -9,
++      -9,    -9,    -9,    -9,    -9,-32768,    24,    39,    43,    16,
++      26,    -3,-32768,    -9,    34,    21,    53,-32768
++};
++
++static const short yypgoto[] =
++{
++  -32768,    -1
++};
++
++
++#define	YYLAST		53
++
++
++static const short yytable[] =
++{
++       6,     1,     2,     7,     3,     4,    14,    16,    17,    18,
++      19,    20,    21,    22,     8,     9,    10,    11,    12,    13,
++      14,    26,    24,    12,    13,    14,    15,     8,     9,    10,
++      11,    12,    13,    14,    13,    14,    23,     8,     9,    10,
++      11,    12,    13,    14,    10,    11,    12,    13,    14,    11,
++      12,    13,    14,    27
++};
++
++static const short yycheck[] =
++{
++       1,    10,    11,     4,    13,    14,     9,     8,     9,    10,
++      11,    12,    13,    14,     3,     4,     5,     6,     7,     8,
++       9,     0,    23,     7,     8,     9,    15,     3,     4,     5,
++       6,     7,     8,     9,     8,     9,    12,     3,     4,     5,
++       6,     7,     8,     9,     5,     6,     7,     8,     9,     6,
++       7,     8,     9,     0
++};
++#define YYPURE 1
++
++/* -*-C-*-  Note some compilers choke on comments on `#line' lines.  */
++#line 3 "/usr/local/share/bison/bison.simple"
++
++/* Skeleton output parser for bison,
++
++   Copyright (C) 1984, 1989, 1990, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
++   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
++   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
++   GNU General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
++   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
++   Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
++
++/* As a special exception, when this file is copied by Bison into a
++   Bison output file, you may use that output file without restriction.
++   This special exception was added by the Free Software Foundation
++   in version 1.24 of Bison.  */
++
++/* This is the parser code that is written into each bison parser when
++   the %semantic_parser declaration is not specified in the grammar.
++   It was written by Richard Stallman by simplifying the hairy parser
++   used when %semantic_parser is specified.  */
++
++/* All symbols defined below should begin with yy or YY, to avoid
++   infringing on user name space.  This should be done even for local
++   variables, as they might otherwise be expanded by user macros.
++   There are some unavoidable exceptions within include files to
++   define necessary library symbols; they are noted "INFRINGES ON
++   USER NAME SPACE" below.  */
++
++#if ! defined (yyoverflow) || defined (YYERROR_VERBOSE)
++
++/* The parser invokes alloca or malloc; define the necessary symbols.  */
++
++# if YYSTACK_USE_ALLOCA
++#  define YYSTACK_ALLOC alloca
++# else
++#  ifndef YYSTACK_USE_ALLOCA
++#   if defined (alloca) || defined (_ALLOCA_H)
++#    define YYSTACK_ALLOC alloca
++#   else
++#    ifdef __GNUC__
++#     define YYSTACK_ALLOC __builtin_alloca
++#    endif
++#   endif
++#  endif
++# endif
++
++# ifdef YYSTACK_ALLOC
++   /* Pacify GCC's `empty if-body' warning. */
++#  define YYSTACK_FREE(Ptr) do { /* empty */; } while (0)
++# else
++#  if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus)
++#   include <stdlib.h> /* INFRINGES ON USER NAME SPACE */
++#   define YYSIZE_T size_t
++#  endif
++#  define YYSTACK_ALLOC malloc
++#  define YYSTACK_FREE free
++# endif
++#endif /* ! defined (yyoverflow) || defined (YYERROR_VERBOSE) */
++
++
++#if (! defined (yyoverflow) \
++     && (! defined (__cplusplus) \
++	 || (YYLTYPE_IS_TRIVIAL && YYSTYPE_IS_TRIVIAL)))
++
++/* A type that is properly aligned for any stack member.  */
++union yyalloc
++{
++  short yyss;
++  YYSTYPE yyvs;
++# if YYLSP_NEEDED
++  YYLTYPE yyls;
++# endif
++};
++
++/* The size of the maximum gap between one aligned stack and the next.  */
++# define YYSTACK_GAP_MAX (sizeof (union yyalloc) - 1)
++
++/* The size of an array large to enough to hold all stacks, each with
++   N elements.  */
++# if YYLSP_NEEDED
++#  define YYSTACK_BYTES(N) \
++     ((N) * (sizeof (short) + sizeof (YYSTYPE) + sizeof (YYLTYPE))	\
++      + 2 * YYSTACK_GAP_MAX)
++# else
++#  define YYSTACK_BYTES(N) \
++     ((N) * (sizeof (short) + sizeof (YYSTYPE))				\
++      + YYSTACK_GAP_MAX)
++# endif
++
++/* Copy COUNT objects from FROM to TO.  The source and destination do
++   not overlap.  */
++# ifndef YYCOPY
++#  if 1 < __GNUC__
++#   define YYCOPY(To, From, Count) \
++      __builtin_memcpy (To, From, (Count) * sizeof (*(From)))
++#  else
++#   define YYCOPY(To, From, Count)		\
++      do					\
++	{					\
++	  register YYSIZE_T yyi;		\
++	  for (yyi = 0; yyi < (Count); yyi++)	\
++	    (To)[yyi] = (From)[yyi];		\
++	}					\
++      while (0)
++#  endif
++# endif
++
++/* Relocate STACK from its old location to the new one.  The
++   local variables YYSIZE and YYSTACKSIZE give the old and new number of
++   elements in the stack, and YYPTR gives the new location of the
++   stack.  Advance YYPTR to a properly aligned location for the next
++   stack.  */
++# define YYSTACK_RELOCATE(Stack)					\
++    do									\
++      {									\
++	YYSIZE_T yynewbytes;						\
++	YYCOPY (&yyptr->Stack, Stack, yysize);				\
++	Stack = &yyptr->Stack;						\
++	yynewbytes = yystacksize * sizeof (*Stack) + YYSTACK_GAP_MAX;	\
++	yyptr += yynewbytes / sizeof (*yyptr);				\
++      }									\
++    while (0)
++
++#endif
++
++
++#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T) && defined (__SIZE_TYPE__)
++# define YYSIZE_T __SIZE_TYPE__
++#endif
++#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T) && defined (size_t)
++# define YYSIZE_T size_t
++#endif
++#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T)
++# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus)
++#  include <stddef.h> /* INFRINGES ON USER NAME SPACE */
++#  define YYSIZE_T size_t
++# endif
++#endif
++#if ! defined (YYSIZE_T)
++# define YYSIZE_T unsigned int
++#endif
++
++#define yyerrok		(yyerrstatus = 0)
++#define yyclearin	(yychar = YYEMPTY)
++#define YYEMPTY		-2
++#define YYEOF		0
++#define YYACCEPT	goto yyacceptlab
++#define YYABORT 	goto yyabortlab
++#define YYERROR		goto yyerrlab1
++/* Like YYERROR except do call yyerror.  This remains here temporarily
++   to ease the transition to the new meaning of YYERROR, for GCC.
++   Once GCC version 2 has supplanted version 1, this can go.  */
++#define YYFAIL		goto yyerrlab
++#define YYRECOVERING()  (!!yyerrstatus)
++#define YYBACKUP(Token, Value)					\
++do								\
++  if (yychar == YYEMPTY && yylen == 1)				\
++    {								\
++      yychar = (Token);						\
++      yylval = (Value);						\
++      yychar1 = YYTRANSLATE (yychar);				\
++      YYPOPSTACK;						\
++      goto yybackup;						\
++    }								\
++  else								\
++    { 								\
++      yyerror ("syntax error: cannot back up");			\
++      YYERROR;							\
++    }								\
++while (0)
++
++#define YYTERROR	1
++#define YYERRCODE	256
++
++
++/* YYLLOC_DEFAULT -- Compute the default location (before the actions
++   are run).
++
++   When YYLLOC_DEFAULT is run, CURRENT is set the location of the
++   first token.  By default, to implement support for ranges, extend
++   its range to the last symbol.  */
++
++#ifndef YYLLOC_DEFAULT
++# define YYLLOC_DEFAULT(Current, Rhs, N)       	\
++   Current.last_line   = Rhs[N].last_line;	\
++   Current.last_column = Rhs[N].last_column;
++#endif
++
++
++/* YYLEX -- calling `yylex' with the right arguments.  */
++
++#if YYPURE
++# if YYLSP_NEEDED
++#  ifdef YYLEX_PARAM
++#   define YYLEX		yylex (&yylval, &yylloc, YYLEX_PARAM)
++#  else
++#   define YYLEX		yylex (&yylval, &yylloc)
++#  endif
++# else /* !YYLSP_NEEDED */
++#  ifdef YYLEX_PARAM
++#   define YYLEX		yylex (&yylval, YYLEX_PARAM)
++#  else
++#   define YYLEX		yylex (&yylval)
++#  endif
++# endif /* !YYLSP_NEEDED */
++#else /* !YYPURE */
++# define YYLEX			yylex ()
++#endif /* !YYPURE */
++
++
++/* Enable debugging if requested.  */
++#if YYDEBUG
++
++# ifndef YYFPRINTF
++#  include <stdio.h> /* INFRINGES ON USER NAME SPACE */
++#  define YYFPRINTF fprintf
++# endif
++
++# define YYDPRINTF(Args)			\
++do {						\
++  if (yydebug)					\
++    YYFPRINTF Args;				\
++} while (0)
++/* Nonzero means print parse trace.  It is left uninitialized so that
++   multiple parsers can coexist.  */
++int yydebug;
++#else /* !YYDEBUG */
++# define YYDPRINTF(Args)
++#endif /* !YYDEBUG */
++
++/* YYINITDEPTH -- initial size of the parser's stacks.  */
++#ifndef	YYINITDEPTH
++# define YYINITDEPTH 200
++#endif
++
++/* YYMAXDEPTH -- maximum size the stacks can grow to (effective only
++   if the built-in stack extension method is used).
++
++   Do not make this value too large; the results are undefined if
++   SIZE_MAX < YYSTACK_BYTES (YYMAXDEPTH)
++   evaluated with infinite-precision integer arithmetic.  */
++
++#if YYMAXDEPTH == 0
++# undef YYMAXDEPTH
++#endif
++
++#ifndef YYMAXDEPTH
++# define YYMAXDEPTH 10000
++#endif
++
++#ifdef YYERROR_VERBOSE
++
++# ifndef yystrlen
++#  if defined (__GLIBC__) && defined (_STRING_H)
++#   define yystrlen strlen
++#  else
++/* Return the length of YYSTR.  */
++static YYSIZE_T
++#   if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus)
++yystrlen (const char *yystr)
++#   else
++yystrlen (yystr)
++     const char *yystr;
++#   endif
++{
++  register const char *yys = yystr;
++
++  while (*yys++ != '\0')
++    continue;
++
++  return yys - yystr - 1;
++}
++#  endif
++# endif
++
++# ifndef yystpcpy
++#  if defined (__GLIBC__) && defined (_STRING_H) && defined (_GNU_SOURCE)
++#   define yystpcpy stpcpy
++#  else
++/* Copy YYSRC to YYDEST, returning the address of the terminating '\0' in
++   YYDEST.  */
++static char *
++#   if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus)
++yystpcpy (char *yydest, const char *yysrc)
++#   else
++yystpcpy (yydest, yysrc)
++     char *yydest;
++     const char *yysrc;
++#   endif
++{
++  register char *yyd = yydest;
++  register const char *yys = yysrc;
++
++  while ((*yyd++ = *yys++) != '\0')
++    continue;
++
++  return yyd - 1;
++}
++#  endif
++# endif
++#endif
++
++#line 315 "/usr/local/share/bison/bison.simple"
++
++
++/* The user can define YYPARSE_PARAM as the name of an argument to be passed
++   into yyparse.  The argument should have type void *.
++   It should actually point to an object.
++   Grammar actions can access the variable by casting it
++   to the proper pointer type.  */
++
++#ifdef YYPARSE_PARAM
++# if defined (__STDC__) || defined (__cplusplus)
++#  define YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG void *YYPARSE_PARAM
++#  define YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL
++# else
++#  define YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG YYPARSE_PARAM
++#  define YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL void *YYPARSE_PARAM;
++# endif
++#else /* !YYPARSE_PARAM */
++# define YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG
++# define YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL
++#endif /* !YYPARSE_PARAM */
++
++/* Prevent warning if -Wstrict-prototypes.  */
++#ifdef __GNUC__
++# ifdef YYPARSE_PARAM
++int yyparse (void *);
++# else
++int yyparse (void);
++# endif
++#endif
++
++/* YY_DECL_VARIABLES -- depending whether we use a pure parser,
++   variables are global, or local to YYPARSE.  */
++
++#define YY_DECL_NON_LSP_VARIABLES			\
++/* The lookahead symbol.  */				\
++int yychar;						\
++							\
++/* The semantic value of the lookahead symbol. */	\
++YYSTYPE yylval;						\
++							\
++/* Number of parse errors so far.  */			\
++int yynerrs;
++
++#if YYLSP_NEEDED
++# define YY_DECL_VARIABLES			\
++YY_DECL_NON_LSP_VARIABLES			\
++						\
++/* Location data for the lookahead symbol.  */	\
++YYLTYPE yylloc;
++#else
++# define YY_DECL_VARIABLES			\
++YY_DECL_NON_LSP_VARIABLES
++#endif
++
++
++/* If nonreentrant, generate the variables here. */
++
++#if !YYPURE
++YY_DECL_VARIABLES
++#endif  /* !YYPURE */
++
++int
++yyparse (YYPARSE_PARAM_ARG)
++     YYPARSE_PARAM_DECL
++{
++  /* If reentrant, generate the variables here. */
++#if YYPURE
++  YY_DECL_VARIABLES
++#endif  /* !YYPURE */
++
++  register int yystate;
++  register int yyn;
++  int yyresult;
++  /* Number of tokens to shift before error messages enabled.  */
++  int yyerrstatus;
++  /* Lookahead token as an internal (translated) token number.  */
++  int yychar1 = 0;
++
++  /* Three stacks and their tools:
++     `yyss': related to states,
++     `yyvs': related to semantic values,
++     `yyls': related to locations.
++
++     Refer to the stacks thru separate pointers, to allow yyoverflow
++     to reallocate them elsewhere.  */
++
++  /* The state stack. */
++  short	yyssa[YYINITDEPTH];
++  short *yyss = yyssa;
++  register short *yyssp;
++
++  /* The semantic value stack.  */
++  YYSTYPE yyvsa[YYINITDEPTH];
++  YYSTYPE *yyvs = yyvsa;
++  register YYSTYPE *yyvsp;
++
++#if YYLSP_NEEDED
++  /* The location stack.  */
++  YYLTYPE yylsa[YYINITDEPTH];
++  YYLTYPE *yyls = yylsa;
++  YYLTYPE *yylsp;
++#endif
++
++#if YYLSP_NEEDED
++# define YYPOPSTACK   (yyvsp--, yyssp--, yylsp--)
++#else
++# define YYPOPSTACK   (yyvsp--, yyssp--)
++#endif
++
++  YYSIZE_T yystacksize = YYINITDEPTH;
++
++
++  /* The variables used to return semantic value and location from the
++     action routines.  */
++  YYSTYPE yyval;
++#if YYLSP_NEEDED
++  YYLTYPE yyloc;
++#endif
++
++  /* When reducing, the number of symbols on the RHS of the reduced
++     rule. */
++  int yylen;
++
++  YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Starting parse\n"));
++
++  yystate = 0;
++  yyerrstatus = 0;
++  yynerrs = 0;
++  yychar = YYEMPTY;		/* Cause a token to be read.  */
++
++  /* Initialize stack pointers.
++     Waste one element of value and location stack
++     so that they stay on the same level as the state stack.
++     The wasted elements are never initialized.  */
++
++  yyssp = yyss;
++  yyvsp = yyvs;
++#if YYLSP_NEEDED
++  yylsp = yyls;
++#endif
++  goto yysetstate;
++
++/*------------------------------------------------------------.
++| yynewstate -- Push a new state, which is found in yystate.  |
++`------------------------------------------------------------*/
++ yynewstate:
++  /* In all cases, when you get here, the value and location stacks
++     have just been pushed. so pushing a state here evens the stacks.
++     */
++  yyssp++;
++
++ yysetstate:
++  *yyssp = yystate;
++
++  if (yyssp >= yyss + yystacksize - 1)
++    {
++      /* Get the current used size of the three stacks, in elements.  */
++      YYSIZE_T yysize = yyssp - yyss + 1;
++
++#ifdef yyoverflow
++      {
++	/* Give user a chance to reallocate the stack. Use copies of
++	   these so that the &'s don't force the real ones into
++	   memory.  */
++	YYSTYPE *yyvs1 = yyvs;
++	short *yyss1 = yyss;
++
++	/* Each stack pointer address is followed by the size of the
++	   data in use in that stack, in bytes.  */
++# if YYLSP_NEEDED
++	YYLTYPE *yyls1 = yyls;
++	/* This used to be a conditional around just the two extra args,
++	   but that might be undefined if yyoverflow is a macro.  */
++	yyoverflow ("parser stack overflow",
++		    &yyss1, yysize * sizeof (*yyssp),
++		    &yyvs1, yysize * sizeof (*yyvsp),
++		    &yyls1, yysize * sizeof (*yylsp),
++		    &yystacksize);
++	yyls = yyls1;
++# else
++	yyoverflow ("parser stack overflow",
++		    &yyss1, yysize * sizeof (*yyssp),
++		    &yyvs1, yysize * sizeof (*yyvsp),
++		    &yystacksize);
++# endif
++	yyss = yyss1;
++	yyvs = yyvs1;
++      }
++#else /* no yyoverflow */
++# ifndef YYSTACK_RELOCATE
++      goto yyoverflowlab;
++# else
++      /* Extend the stack our own way.  */
++      if (yystacksize >= YYMAXDEPTH)
++	goto yyoverflowlab;
++      yystacksize *= 2;
++      if (yystacksize > YYMAXDEPTH)
++	yystacksize = YYMAXDEPTH;
++
++      {
++	short *yyss1 = yyss;
++	union yyalloc *yyptr =
++	  (union yyalloc *) YYSTACK_ALLOC (YYSTACK_BYTES (yystacksize));
++	if (! yyptr)
++	  goto yyoverflowlab;
++	YYSTACK_RELOCATE (yyss);
++	YYSTACK_RELOCATE (yyvs);
++# if YYLSP_NEEDED
++	YYSTACK_RELOCATE (yyls);
++# endif
++# undef YYSTACK_RELOCATE
++	if (yyss1 != yyssa)
++	  YYSTACK_FREE (yyss1);
++      }
++# endif
++#endif /* no yyoverflow */
++
++      yyssp = yyss + yysize - 1;
++      yyvsp = yyvs + yysize - 1;
++#if YYLSP_NEEDED
++      yylsp = yyls + yysize - 1;
++#endif
++
++      YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Stack size increased to %lu\n",
++		  (unsigned long int) yystacksize));
++
++      if (yyssp >= yyss + yystacksize - 1)
++	YYABORT;
++    }
++
++  YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Entering state %d\n", yystate));
++
++  goto yybackup;
++
++
++/*-----------.
++| yybackup.  |
++`-----------*/
++yybackup:
++
++/* Do appropriate processing given the current state.  */
++/* Read a lookahead token if we need one and don't already have one.  */
++/* yyresume: */
++
++  /* First try to decide what to do without reference to lookahead token.  */
++
++  yyn = yypact[yystate];
++  if (yyn == YYFLAG)
++    goto yydefault;
++
++  /* Not known => get a lookahead token if don't already have one.  */
++
++  /* yychar is either YYEMPTY or YYEOF
++     or a valid token in external form.  */
++
++  if (yychar == YYEMPTY)
++    {
++      YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Reading a token: "));
++      yychar = YYLEX;
++    }
++
++  /* Convert token to internal form (in yychar1) for indexing tables with */
++
++  if (yychar <= 0)		/* This means end of input. */
++    {
++      yychar1 = 0;
++      yychar = YYEOF;		/* Don't call YYLEX any more */
++
++      YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Now at end of input.\n"));
++    }
++  else
++    {
++      yychar1 = YYTRANSLATE (yychar);
++
++#if YYDEBUG
++     /* We have to keep this `#if YYDEBUG', since we use variables
++	which are defined only if `YYDEBUG' is set.  */
++      if (yydebug)
++	{
++	  YYFPRINTF (stderr, "Next token is %d (%s",
++		     yychar, yytname[yychar1]);
++	  /* Give the individual parser a way to print the precise
++	     meaning of a token, for further debugging info.  */
++# ifdef YYPRINT
++	  YYPRINT (stderr, yychar, yylval);
++# endif
++	  YYFPRINTF (stderr, ")\n");
++	}
++#endif
++    }
++
++  yyn += yychar1;
++  if (yyn < 0 || yyn > YYLAST || yycheck[yyn] != yychar1)
++    goto yydefault;
++
++  yyn = yytable[yyn];
++
++  /* yyn is what to do for this token type in this state.
++     Negative => reduce, -yyn is rule number.
++     Positive => shift, yyn is new state.
++       New state is final state => don't bother to shift,
++       just return success.
++     0, or most negative number => error.  */
++
++  if (yyn < 0)
++    {
++      if (yyn == YYFLAG)
++	goto yyerrlab;
++      yyn = -yyn;
++      goto yyreduce;
++    }
++  else if (yyn == 0)
++    goto yyerrlab;
++
++  if (yyn == YYFINAL)
++    YYACCEPT;
++
++  /* Shift the lookahead token.  */
++  YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Shifting token %d (%s), ",
++	      yychar, yytname[yychar1]));
++
++  /* Discard the token being shifted unless it is eof.  */
++  if (yychar != YYEOF)
++    yychar = YYEMPTY;
++
++  *++yyvsp = yylval;
++#if YYLSP_NEEDED
++  *++yylsp = yylloc;
++#endif
++
++  /* Count tokens shifted since error; after three, turn off error
++     status.  */
++  if (yyerrstatus)
++    yyerrstatus--;
++
++  yystate = yyn;
++  goto yynewstate;
++
++
++/*-----------------------------------------------------------.
++| yydefault -- do the default action for the current state.  |
++`-----------------------------------------------------------*/
++yydefault:
++  yyn = yydefact[yystate];
++  if (yyn == 0)
++    goto yyerrlab;
++  goto yyreduce;
++
++
++/*-----------------------------.
++| yyreduce -- Do a reduction.  |
++`-----------------------------*/
++yyreduce:
++  /* yyn is the number of a rule to reduce with.  */
++  yylen = yyr2[yyn];
++
++  /* If YYLEN is nonzero, implement the default value of the action:
++     `$$ = $1'.
++
++     Otherwise, the following line sets YYVAL to the semantic value of
++     the lookahead token.  This behavior is undocumented and Bison
++     users should not rely upon it.  Assigning to YYVAL
++     unconditionally makes the parser a bit smaller, and it avoids a
++     GCC warning that YYVAL may be used uninitialized.  */
++  yyval = yyvsp[1-yylen];
++
++#if YYLSP_NEEDED
++  /* Similarly for the default location.  Let the user run additional
++     commands if for instance locations are ranges.  */
++  yyloc = yylsp[1-yylen];
++  YYLLOC_DEFAULT (yyloc, (yylsp - yylen), yylen);
++#endif
++
++#if YYDEBUG
++  /* We have to keep this `#if YYDEBUG', since we use variables which
++     are defined only if `YYDEBUG' is set.  */
++  if (yydebug)
++    {
++      int yyi;
++
++      YYFPRINTF (stderr, "Reducing via rule %d (line %d), ",
++		 yyn, yyrline[yyn]);
++
++      /* Print the symbols being reduced, and their result.  */
++      for (yyi = yyprhs[yyn]; yyrhs[yyi] > 0; yyi++)
++	YYFPRINTF (stderr, "%s ", yytname[yyrhs[yyi]]);
++      YYFPRINTF (stderr, " -> %s\n", yytname[yyr1[yyn]]);
++    }
++#endif
++
++  switch (yyn) {
++
++case 1:
++#line 151 "plural.y"
++{
++	    if (yyvsp[0].exp == NULL)
++	      YYABORT;
++	    ((struct parse_args *) arg)->res = yyvsp[0].exp;
++	  }
++    break;
++case 2:
++#line 159 "plural.y"
++{
++	    yyval.exp = new_exp_3 (qmop, yyvsp[-4].exp, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp);
++	  }
++    break;
++case 3:
++#line 163 "plural.y"
++{
++	    yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (lor, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp);
++	  }
++    break;
++case 4:
++#line 167 "plural.y"
++{
++	    yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (land, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp);
++	  }
++    break;
++case 5:
++#line 171 "plural.y"
++{
++	    yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp);
++	  }
++    break;
++case 6:
++#line 175 "plural.y"
++{
++	    yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp);
++	  }
++    break;
++case 7:
++#line 179 "plural.y"
++{
++	    yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp);
++	  }
++    break;
++case 8:
++#line 183 "plural.y"
++{
++	    yyval.exp = new_exp_2 (yyvsp[-1].op, yyvsp[-2].exp, yyvsp[0].exp);
++	  }
++    break;
++case 9:
++#line 187 "plural.y"
++{
++	    yyval.exp = new_exp_1 (lnot, yyvsp[0].exp);
++	  }
++    break;
++case 10:
++#line 191 "plural.y"
++{
++	    yyval.exp = new_exp_0 (var);
++	  }
++    break;
++case 11:
++#line 195 "plural.y"
++{
++	    if ((yyval.exp = new_exp_0 (num)) != NULL)
++	      yyval.exp->val.num = yyvsp[0].num;
++	  }
++    break;
++case 12:
++#line 200 "plural.y"
++{
++	    yyval.exp = yyvsp[-1].exp;
++	  }
++    break;
++}
++
++#line 705 "/usr/local/share/bison/bison.simple"
++
++
++  yyvsp -= yylen;
++  yyssp -= yylen;
++#if YYLSP_NEEDED
++  yylsp -= yylen;
++#endif
++
++#if YYDEBUG
++  if (yydebug)
++    {
++      short *yyssp1 = yyss - 1;
++      YYFPRINTF (stderr, "state stack now");
++      while (yyssp1 != yyssp)
++	YYFPRINTF (stderr, " %d", *++yyssp1);
++      YYFPRINTF (stderr, "\n");
++    }
++#endif
++
++  *++yyvsp = yyval;
++#if YYLSP_NEEDED
++  *++yylsp = yyloc;
++#endif
++
++  /* Now `shift' the result of the reduction.  Determine what state
++     that goes to, based on the state we popped back to and the rule
++     number reduced by.  */
++
++  yyn = yyr1[yyn];
++
++  yystate = yypgoto[yyn - YYNTBASE] + *yyssp;
++  if (yystate >= 0 && yystate <= YYLAST && yycheck[yystate] == *yyssp)
++    yystate = yytable[yystate];
++  else
++    yystate = yydefgoto[yyn - YYNTBASE];
++
++  goto yynewstate;
++
++
++/*------------------------------------.
++| yyerrlab -- here on detecting error |
++`------------------------------------*/
++yyerrlab:
++  /* If not already recovering from an error, report this error.  */
++  if (!yyerrstatus)
++    {
++      ++yynerrs;
++
++#ifdef YYERROR_VERBOSE
++      yyn = yypact[yystate];
++
++      if (yyn > YYFLAG && yyn < YYLAST)
++	{
++	  YYSIZE_T yysize = 0;
++	  char *yymsg;
++	  int yyx, yycount;
++
++	  yycount = 0;
++	  /* Start YYX at -YYN if negative to avoid negative indexes in
++	     YYCHECK.  */
++	  for (yyx = yyn < 0 ? -yyn : 0;
++	       yyx < (int) (sizeof (yytname) / sizeof (char *)); yyx++)
++	    if (yycheck[yyx + yyn] == yyx)
++	      yysize += yystrlen (yytname[yyx]) + 15, yycount++;
++	  yysize += yystrlen ("parse error, unexpected ") + 1;
++	  yysize += yystrlen (yytname[YYTRANSLATE (yychar)]);
++	  yymsg = (char *) YYSTACK_ALLOC (yysize);
++	  if (yymsg != 0)
++	    {
++	      char *yyp = yystpcpy (yymsg, "parse error, unexpected ");
++	      yyp = yystpcpy (yyp, yytname[YYTRANSLATE (yychar)]);
++
++	      if (yycount < 5)
++		{
++		  yycount = 0;
++		  for (yyx = yyn < 0 ? -yyn : 0;
++		       yyx < (int) (sizeof (yytname) / sizeof (char *));
++		       yyx++)
++		    if (yycheck[yyx + yyn] == yyx)
++		      {
++			const char *yyq = ! yycount ? ", expecting " : " or ";
++			yyp = yystpcpy (yyp, yyq);
++			yyp = yystpcpy (yyp, yytname[yyx]);
++			yycount++;
++		      }
++		}
++	      yyerror (yymsg);
++	      YYSTACK_FREE (yymsg);
++	    }
++	  else
++	    yyerror ("parse error; also virtual memory exhausted");
++	}
++      else
++#endif /* defined (YYERROR_VERBOSE) */
++	yyerror ("parse error");
++    }
++  goto yyerrlab1;
++
++
++/*--------------------------------------------------.
++| yyerrlab1 -- error raised explicitly by an action |
++`--------------------------------------------------*/
++yyerrlab1:
++  if (yyerrstatus == 3)
++    {
++      /* If just tried and failed to reuse lookahead token after an
++	 error, discard it.  */
++
++      /* return failure if at end of input */
++      if (yychar == YYEOF)
++	YYABORT;
++      YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Discarding token %d (%s).\n",
++		  yychar, yytname[yychar1]));
++      yychar = YYEMPTY;
++    }
++
++  /* Else will try to reuse lookahead token after shifting the error
++     token.  */
++
++  yyerrstatus = 3;		/* Each real token shifted decrements this */
++
++  goto yyerrhandle;
++
++
++/*-------------------------------------------------------------------.
++| yyerrdefault -- current state does not do anything special for the |
++| error token.                                                       |
++`-------------------------------------------------------------------*/
++yyerrdefault:
++#if 0
++  /* This is wrong; only states that explicitly want error tokens
++     should shift them.  */
++
++  /* If its default is to accept any token, ok.  Otherwise pop it.  */
++  yyn = yydefact[yystate];
++  if (yyn)
++    goto yydefault;
++#endif
++
++
++/*---------------------------------------------------------------.
++| yyerrpop -- pop the current state because it cannot handle the |
++| error token                                                    |
++`---------------------------------------------------------------*/
++yyerrpop:
++  if (yyssp == yyss)
++    YYABORT;
++  yyvsp--;
++  yystate = *--yyssp;
++#if YYLSP_NEEDED
++  yylsp--;
++#endif
++
++#if YYDEBUG
++  if (yydebug)
++    {
++      short *yyssp1 = yyss - 1;
++      YYFPRINTF (stderr, "Error: state stack now");
++      while (yyssp1 != yyssp)
++	YYFPRINTF (stderr, " %d", *++yyssp1);
++      YYFPRINTF (stderr, "\n");
++    }
++#endif
++
++/*--------------.
++| yyerrhandle.  |
++`--------------*/
++yyerrhandle:
++  yyn = yypact[yystate];
++  if (yyn == YYFLAG)
++    goto yyerrdefault;
++
++  yyn += YYTERROR;
++  if (yyn < 0 || yyn > YYLAST || yycheck[yyn] != YYTERROR)
++    goto yyerrdefault;
++
++  yyn = yytable[yyn];
++  if (yyn < 0)
++    {
++      if (yyn == YYFLAG)
++	goto yyerrpop;
++      yyn = -yyn;
++      goto yyreduce;
++    }
++  else if (yyn == 0)
++    goto yyerrpop;
++
++  if (yyn == YYFINAL)
++    YYACCEPT;
++
++  YYDPRINTF ((stderr, "Shifting error token, "));
++
++  *++yyvsp = yylval;
++#if YYLSP_NEEDED
++  *++yylsp = yylloc;
++#endif
++
++  yystate = yyn;
++  goto yynewstate;
++
++
++/*-------------------------------------.
++| yyacceptlab -- YYACCEPT comes here.  |
++`-------------------------------------*/
++yyacceptlab:
++  yyresult = 0;
++  goto yyreturn;
++
++/*-----------------------------------.
++| yyabortlab -- YYABORT comes here.  |
++`-----------------------------------*/
++yyabortlab:
++  yyresult = 1;
++  goto yyreturn;
++
++/*---------------------------------------------.
++| yyoverflowab -- parser overflow comes here.  |
++`---------------------------------------------*/
++yyoverflowlab:
++  yyerror ("parser stack overflow");
++  yyresult = 2;
++  /* Fall through.  */
++
++yyreturn:
++#ifndef yyoverflow
++  if (yyss != yyssa)
++    YYSTACK_FREE (yyss);
++#endif
++  return yyresult;
++}
++#line 205 "plural.y"
++
++
++void
++internal_function
++FREE_EXPRESSION (struct expression *exp)
++{
++  if (exp == NULL)
++    return;
++
++  /* Handle the recursive case.  */
++  switch (exp->nargs)
++    {
++    case 3:
++      FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[2]);
++      /* FALLTHROUGH */
++    case 2:
++      FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[1]);
++      /* FALLTHROUGH */
++    case 1:
++      FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[0]);
++      /* FALLTHROUGH */
++    default:
++      break;
++    }
++
++  free (exp);
++}
++
++
++static int
++yylex (YYSTYPE *lval, const char **pexp)
++{
++  const char *exp = *pexp;
++  int result;
++
++  while (1)
++    {
++      if (exp[0] == '\0')
++	{
++	  *pexp = exp;
++	  return YYEOF;
++	}
++
++      if (exp[0] != ' ' && exp[0] != '\t')
++	break;
++
++      ++exp;
++    }
++
++  result = *exp++;
++  switch (result)
++    {
++    case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4':
++    case '5': case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9':
++      {
++	unsigned long int n = result - '0';
++	while (exp[0] >= '0' && exp[0] <= '9')
++	  {
++	    n *= 10;
++	    n += exp[0] - '0';
++	    ++exp;
++	  }
++	lval->num = n;
++	result = NUMBER;
++      }
++      break;
++
++    case '=':
++      if (exp[0] == '=')
++	{
++	  ++exp;
++	  lval->op = equal;
++	  result = EQUOP2;
++	}
++      else
++	result = YYERRCODE;
++      break;
++
++    case '!':
++      if (exp[0] == '=')
++	{
++	  ++exp;
++	  lval->op = not_equal;
++	  result = EQUOP2;
++	}
++      break;
++
++    case '&':
++    case '|':
++      if (exp[0] == result)
++	++exp;
++      else
++	result = YYERRCODE;
++      break;
++
++    case '<':
++      if (exp[0] == '=')
++	{
++	  ++exp;
++	  lval->op = less_or_equal;
++	}
++      else
++	lval->op = less_than;
++      result = CMPOP2;
++      break;
++
++    case '>':
++      if (exp[0] == '=')
++	{
++	  ++exp;
++	  lval->op = greater_or_equal;
++	}
++      else
++	lval->op = greater_than;
++      result = CMPOP2;
++      break;
++
++    case '*':
++      lval->op = mult;
++      result = MULOP2;
++      break;
++
++    case '/':
++      lval->op = divide;
++      result = MULOP2;
++      break;
++
++    case '%':
++      lval->op = module;
++      result = MULOP2;
++      break;
++
++    case '+':
++      lval->op = plus;
++      result = ADDOP2;
++      break;
++
++    case '-':
++      lval->op = minus;
++      result = ADDOP2;
++      break;
++
++    case 'n':
++    case '?':
++    case ':':
++    case '(':
++    case ')':
++      /* Nothing, just return the character.  */
++      break;
++
++    case ';':
++    case '\n':
++    case '\0':
++      /* Be safe and let the user call this function again.  */
++      --exp;
++      result = YYEOF;
++      break;
++
++    default:
++      result = YYERRCODE;
++#if YYDEBUG != 0
++      --exp;
++#endif
++      break;
++    }
++
++  *pexp = exp;
++
++  return result;
++}
++
++
++static void
++yyerror (const char *str)
++{
++  /* Do nothing.  We don't print error messages here.  */
++}
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/plural-exp.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/plural-exp.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.578714192 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,154 @@
++/* Expression parsing for plural form selection.
++   Copyright (C) 2000-2001, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++   Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++# include <config.h>
++#endif
++
++#include <ctype.h>
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <string.h>
++
++#include "plural-exp.h"
++
++#if (defined __GNUC__ && !defined __APPLE_CC__) \
++    || (defined __STDC_VERSION__ && __STDC_VERSION__ >= 199901L)
++
++/* These structs are the constant expression for the germanic plural
++   form determination.  It represents the expression  "n != 1".  */
++static const struct expression plvar =
++{
++  .nargs = 0,
++  .operation = var,
++};
++static const struct expression plone =
++{
++  .nargs = 0,
++  .operation = num,
++  .val =
++  {
++    .num = 1
++  }
++};
++struct expression GERMANIC_PLURAL =
++{
++  .nargs = 2,
++  .operation = not_equal,
++  .val =
++  {
++    .args =
++    {
++      [0] = (struct expression *) &plvar,
++      [1] = (struct expression *) &plone
++    }
++  }
++};
++
++# define INIT_GERMANIC_PLURAL()
++
++#else
++
++/* For compilers without support for ISO C 99 struct/union initializers:
++   Initialization at run-time.  */
++
++static struct expression plvar;
++static struct expression plone;
++struct expression GERMANIC_PLURAL;
++
++static void
++init_germanic_plural ()
++{
++  if (plone.val.num == 0)
++    {
++      plvar.nargs = 0;
++      plvar.operation = var;
++
++      plone.nargs = 0;
++      plone.operation = num;
++      plone.val.num = 1;
++
++      GERMANIC_PLURAL.nargs = 2;
++      GERMANIC_PLURAL.operation = not_equal;
++      GERMANIC_PLURAL.val.args[0] = &plvar;
++      GERMANIC_PLURAL.val.args[1] = &plone;
++    }
++}
++
++# define INIT_GERMANIC_PLURAL() init_germanic_plural ()
++
++#endif
++
++void
++internal_function
++EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION (const char *nullentry, struct expression **pluralp,
++			   unsigned long int *npluralsp)
++{
++  if (nullentry != NULL)
++    {
++      const char *plural;
++      const char *nplurals;
++
++      plural = strstr (nullentry, "plural=");
++      nplurals = strstr (nullentry, "nplurals=");
++      if (plural == NULL || nplurals == NULL)
++	goto no_plural;
++      else
++	{
++	  char *endp;
++	  unsigned long int n;
++	  struct parse_args args;
++
++	  /* First get the number.  */
++	  nplurals += 9;
++	  while (*nplurals != '\0' && isspace ((unsigned char) *nplurals))
++	    ++nplurals;
++	  if (!(*nplurals >= '0' && *nplurals <= '9'))
++	    goto no_plural;
++#if defined HAVE_STRTOUL || defined _LIBC
++	  n = strtoul (nplurals, &endp, 10);
++#else
++	  for (endp = nplurals, n = 0; *endp >= '0' && *endp <= '9'; endp++)
++	    n = n * 10 + (*endp - '0');
++#endif
++	  if (nplurals == endp)
++	    goto no_plural;
++	  *npluralsp = n;
++
++	  /* Due to the restrictions bison imposes onto the interface of the
++	     scanner function we have to put the input string and the result
++	     passed up from the parser into the same structure which address
++	     is passed down to the parser.  */
++	  plural += 7;
++	  args.cp = plural;
++	  if (PLURAL_PARSE (&args) != 0)
++	    goto no_plural;
++	  *pluralp = args.res;
++	}
++    }
++  else
++    {
++      /* By default we are using the Germanic form: singular form only
++         for `one', the plural form otherwise.  Yes, this is also what
++         English is using since English is a Germanic language.  */
++    no_plural:
++      INIT_GERMANIC_PLURAL ();
++      *pluralp = &GERMANIC_PLURAL;
++      *npluralsp = 2;
++    }
++}
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/plural-exp.h	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/plural-exp.h	2004-09-12 14:40:34.584713280 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,118 @@
++/* Expression parsing and evaluation for plural form selection.
++   Copyright (C) 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++   Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifndef _PLURAL_EXP_H
++#define _PLURAL_EXP_H
++
++#ifndef internal_function
++# define internal_function
++#endif
++
++#ifndef attribute_hidden
++# define attribute_hidden
++#endif
++
++
++/* This is the representation of the expressions to determine the
++   plural form.  */
++struct expression
++{
++  int nargs;			/* Number of arguments.  */
++  enum operator
++  {
++    /* Without arguments:  */
++    var,			/* The variable "n".  */
++    num,			/* Decimal number.  */
++    /* Unary operators:  */
++    lnot,			/* Logical NOT.  */
++    /* Binary operators:  */
++    mult,			/* Multiplication.  */
++    divide,			/* Division.  */
++    module,			/* Modulo operation.  */
++    plus,			/* Addition.  */
++    minus,			/* Subtraction.  */
++    less_than,			/* Comparison.  */
++    greater_than,		/* Comparison.  */
++    less_or_equal,		/* Comparison.  */
++    greater_or_equal,		/* Comparison.  */
++    equal,			/* Comparison for equality.  */
++    not_equal,			/* Comparison for inequality.  */
++    land,			/* Logical AND.  */
++    lor,			/* Logical OR.  */
++    /* Ternary operators:  */
++    qmop			/* Question mark operator.  */
++  } operation;
++  union
++  {
++    unsigned long int num;	/* Number value for `num'.  */
++    struct expression *args[3];	/* Up to three arguments.  */
++  } val;
++};
++
++/* This is the data structure to pass information to the parser and get
++   the result in a thread-safe way.  */
++struct parse_args
++{
++  const char *cp;
++  struct expression *res;
++};
++
++
++/* Names for the libintl functions are a problem.  This source code is used
++   1. in the GNU C Library library,
++   2. in the GNU libintl library,
++   3. in the GNU gettext tools.
++   The function names in each situation must be different, to allow for
++   binary incompatible changes in 'struct expression'.  Furthermore,
++   1. in the GNU C Library library, the names have a __ prefix,
++   2.+3. in the GNU libintl library and in the GNU gettext tools, the names
++         must follow ANSI C and not start with __.
++   So we have to distinguish the three cases.  */
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# define FREE_EXPRESSION __gettext_free_exp
++# define PLURAL_PARSE __gettextparse
++# define GERMANIC_PLURAL __gettext_germanic_plural
++# define EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION __gettext_extract_plural
++#elif defined (IN_LIBINTL)
++# define FREE_EXPRESSION libintl_gettext_free_exp
++# define PLURAL_PARSE libintl_gettextparse
++# define GERMANIC_PLURAL libintl_gettext_germanic_plural
++# define EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION libintl_gettext_extract_plural
++#else
++# define FREE_EXPRESSION free_plural_expression
++# define PLURAL_PARSE parse_plural_expression
++# define GERMANIC_PLURAL germanic_plural
++# define EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION extract_plural_expression
++#endif
++
++extern void FREE_EXPRESSION (struct expression *exp)
++     internal_function;
++extern int PLURAL_PARSE (void *arg);
++extern struct expression GERMANIC_PLURAL attribute_hidden;
++extern void EXTRACT_PLURAL_EXPRESSION (const char *nullentry,
++				       struct expression **pluralp,
++				       unsigned long int *npluralsp)
++     internal_function;
++
++#if !defined (_LIBC) && !defined (IN_LIBINTL)
++extern unsigned long int plural_eval (struct expression *pexp,
++				      unsigned long int n);
++#endif
++
++#endif /* _PLURAL_EXP_H */
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/plural.y	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/plural.y	2004-09-12 14:40:34.589712520 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,381 @@
++%{
++/* Expression parsing for plural form selection.
++   Copyright (C) 2000-2001, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++   Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 2000.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++/* The bison generated parser uses alloca.  AIX 3 forces us to put this
++   declaration at the beginning of the file.  The declaration in bison's
++   skeleton file comes too late.  This must come before <config.h>
++   because <config.h> may include arbitrary system headers.  */
++#if defined _AIX && !defined __GNUC__
++ #pragma alloca
++#endif
++
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++# include <config.h>
++#endif
++
++#include <stddef.h>
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include "plural-exp.h"
++
++/* The main function generated by the parser is called __gettextparse,
++   but we want it to be called PLURAL_PARSE.  */
++#ifndef _LIBC
++# define __gettextparse PLURAL_PARSE
++#endif
++
++#define YYLEX_PARAM	&((struct parse_args *) arg)->cp
++#define YYPARSE_PARAM	arg
++%}
++%pure_parser
++%expect 7
++
++%union {
++  unsigned long int num;
++  enum operator op;
++  struct expression *exp;
++}
++
++%{
++/* Prototypes for local functions.  */
++static int yylex (YYSTYPE *lval, const char **pexp);
++static void yyerror (const char *str);
++
++/* Allocation of expressions.  */
++
++static struct expression *
++new_exp (int nargs, enum operator op, struct expression * const *args)
++{
++  int i;
++  struct expression *newp;
++
++  /* If any of the argument could not be malloc'ed, just return NULL.  */
++  for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--)
++    if (args[i] == NULL)
++      goto fail;
++
++  /* Allocate a new expression.  */
++  newp = (struct expression *) malloc (sizeof (*newp));
++  if (newp != NULL)
++    {
++      newp->nargs = nargs;
++      newp->operation = op;
++      for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--)
++	newp->val.args[i] = args[i];
++      return newp;
++    }
++
++ fail:
++  for (i = nargs - 1; i >= 0; i--)
++    FREE_EXPRESSION (args[i]);
++
++  return NULL;
++}
++
++static inline struct expression *
++new_exp_0 (enum operator op)
++{
++  return new_exp (0, op, NULL);
++}
++
++static inline struct expression *
++new_exp_1 (enum operator op, struct expression *right)
++{
++  struct expression *args[1];
++
++  args[0] = right;
++  return new_exp (1, op, args);
++}
++
++static struct expression *
++new_exp_2 (enum operator op, struct expression *left, struct expression *right)
++{
++  struct expression *args[2];
++
++  args[0] = left;
++  args[1] = right;
++  return new_exp (2, op, args);
++}
++
++static inline struct expression *
++new_exp_3 (enum operator op, struct expression *bexp,
++	   struct expression *tbranch, struct expression *fbranch)
++{
++  struct expression *args[3];
++
++  args[0] = bexp;
++  args[1] = tbranch;
++  args[2] = fbranch;
++  return new_exp (3, op, args);
++}
++
++%}
++
++/* This declares that all operators have the same associativity and the
++   precedence order as in C.  See [Harbison, Steele: C, A Reference Manual].
++   There is no unary minus and no bitwise operators.
++   Operators with the same syntactic behaviour have been merged into a single
++   token, to save space in the array generated by bison.  */
++%right '?'		/*   ?		*/
++%left '|'		/*   ||		*/
++%left '&'		/*   &&		*/
++%left EQUOP2		/*   == !=	*/
++%left CMPOP2		/*   < > <= >=	*/
++%left ADDOP2		/*   + -	*/
++%left MULOP2		/*   * / %	*/
++%right '!'		/*   !		*/
++
++%token <op> EQUOP2 CMPOP2 ADDOP2 MULOP2
++%token <num> NUMBER
++%type <exp> exp
++
++%%
++
++start:	  exp
++	  {
++	    if ($1 == NULL)
++	      YYABORT;
++	    ((struct parse_args *) arg)->res = $1;
++	  }
++	;
++
++exp:	  exp '?' exp ':' exp
++	  {
++	    $$ = new_exp_3 (qmop, $1, $3, $5);
++	  }
++	| exp '|' exp
++	  {
++	    $$ = new_exp_2 (lor, $1, $3);
++	  }
++	| exp '&' exp
++	  {
++	    $$ = new_exp_2 (land, $1, $3);
++	  }
++	| exp EQUOP2 exp
++	  {
++	    $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3);
++	  }
++	| exp CMPOP2 exp
++	  {
++	    $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3);
++	  }
++	| exp ADDOP2 exp
++	  {
++	    $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3);
++	  }
++	| exp MULOP2 exp
++	  {
++	    $$ = new_exp_2 ($2, $1, $3);
++	  }
++	| '!' exp
++	  {
++	    $$ = new_exp_1 (lnot, $2);
++	  }
++	| 'n'
++	  {
++	    $$ = new_exp_0 (var);
++	  }
++	| NUMBER
++	  {
++	    if (($$ = new_exp_0 (num)) != NULL)
++	      $$->val.num = $1;
++	  }
++	| '(' exp ')'
++	  {
++	    $$ = $2;
++	  }
++	;
++
++%%
++
++void
++internal_function
++FREE_EXPRESSION (struct expression *exp)
++{
++  if (exp == NULL)
++    return;
++
++  /* Handle the recursive case.  */
++  switch (exp->nargs)
++    {
++    case 3:
++      FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[2]);
++      /* FALLTHROUGH */
++    case 2:
++      FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[1]);
++      /* FALLTHROUGH */
++    case 1:
++      FREE_EXPRESSION (exp->val.args[0]);
++      /* FALLTHROUGH */
++    default:
++      break;
++    }
++
++  free (exp);
++}
++
++
++static int
++yylex (YYSTYPE *lval, const char **pexp)
++{
++  const char *exp = *pexp;
++  int result;
++
++  while (1)
++    {
++      if (exp[0] == '\0')
++	{
++	  *pexp = exp;
++	  return YYEOF;
++	}
++
++      if (exp[0] != ' ' && exp[0] != '\t')
++	break;
++
++      ++exp;
++    }
++
++  result = *exp++;
++  switch (result)
++    {
++    case '0': case '1': case '2': case '3': case '4':
++    case '5': case '6': case '7': case '8': case '9':
++      {
++	unsigned long int n = result - '0';
++	while (exp[0] >= '0' && exp[0] <= '9')
++	  {
++	    n *= 10;
++	    n += exp[0] - '0';
++	    ++exp;
++	  }
++	lval->num = n;
++	result = NUMBER;
++      }
++      break;
++
++    case '=':
++      if (exp[0] == '=')
++	{
++	  ++exp;
++	  lval->op = equal;
++	  result = EQUOP2;
++	}
++      else
++	result = YYERRCODE;
++      break;
++
++    case '!':
++      if (exp[0] == '=')
++	{
++	  ++exp;
++	  lval->op = not_equal;
++	  result = EQUOP2;
++	}
++      break;
++
++    case '&':
++    case '|':
++      if (exp[0] == result)
++	++exp;
++      else
++	result = YYERRCODE;
++      break;
++
++    case '<':
++      if (exp[0] == '=')
++	{
++	  ++exp;
++	  lval->op = less_or_equal;
++	}
++      else
++	lval->op = less_than;
++      result = CMPOP2;
++      break;
++
++    case '>':
++      if (exp[0] == '=')
++	{
++	  ++exp;
++	  lval->op = greater_or_equal;
++	}
++      else
++	lval->op = greater_than;
++      result = CMPOP2;
++      break;
++
++    case '*':
++      lval->op = mult;
++      result = MULOP2;
++      break;
++
++    case '/':
++      lval->op = divide;
++      result = MULOP2;
++      break;
++
++    case '%':
++      lval->op = module;
++      result = MULOP2;
++      break;
++
++    case '+':
++      lval->op = plus;
++      result = ADDOP2;
++      break;
++
++    case '-':
++      lval->op = minus;
++      result = ADDOP2;
++      break;
++
++    case 'n':
++    case '?':
++    case ':':
++    case '(':
++    case ')':
++      /* Nothing, just return the character.  */
++      break;
++
++    case ';':
++    case '\n':
++    case '\0':
++      /* Be safe and let the user call this function again.  */
++      --exp;
++      result = YYEOF;
++      break;
++
++    default:
++      result = YYERRCODE;
++#if YYDEBUG != 0
++      --exp;
++#endif
++      break;
++    }
++
++  *pexp = exp;
++
++  return result;
++}
++
++
++static void
++yyerror (const char *str)
++{
++  /* Do nothing.  We don't print error messages here.  */
++}
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/po2tbl.sed.in	1998-04-26 09:20:52.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/po2tbl.sed.in	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
+@@ -1,102 +0,0 @@
+-# po2tbl.sed - Convert Uniforum style .po file to lookup table for catgets
+-# Copyright (C) 1995 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+-# Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1995.
+-#
+-# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+-# any later version.
+-#
+-# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+-# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-# GNU General Public License for more details.
+-#
+-# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+-# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
+-#
+-1 {
+-  i\
+-/* Automatically generated by po2tbl.sed from @PACKAGE NAME@.pot.  */\
+-\
+-#if HAVE_CONFIG_H\
+-# include <config.h>\
+-#endif\
+-\
+-#include "libgettext.h"\
+-\
+-const struct _msg_ent _msg_tbl[] = {
+-  h
+-  s/.*/0/
+-  x
+-}
+-#
+-# Write msgid entries in C array form.
+-#
+-/^msgid/ {
+-  s/msgid[ 	]*\(".*"\)/  {\1/
+-  tb
+-# Append the next line
+-  :b
+-  N
+-# Look whether second part is continuation line.
+-  s/\(.*\)"\(\n\)"\(.*"\)/\1\2\3/
+-# Yes, then branch.
+-  ta
+-# Because we assume that the input file correctly formed the line
+-# just read cannot be again be a msgid line.  So it's safe to ignore
+-# it.
+-  s/\(.*\)\n.*/\1/
+-  bc
+-# We found a continuation line.  But before printing insert '\'.
+-  :a
+-  s/\(.*\)\(\n.*\)/\1\\\2/
+-  P
+-# We cannot use D here.
+-  s/.*\n\(.*\)/\1/
+-# Some buggy seds do not clear the `successful substitution since last ``t'''
+-# flag on `N', so we do a `t' here to clear it.
+-  tb
+-# Not reached
+-  :c
+-  x
+-# The following nice solution is by
+-# Bruno <Haible@ma2s2.mathematik.uni-karlsruhe.de>
+-  td
+-# Increment a decimal number in pattern space.
+-# First hide trailing `9' digits.
+-  :d
+-  s/9\(_*\)$/_\1/
+-  td
+-# Assure at least one digit is available.
+-  s/^\(_*\)$/0\1/
+-# Increment the last digit.
+-  s/8\(_*\)$/9\1/
+-  s/7\(_*\)$/8\1/
+-  s/6\(_*\)$/7\1/
+-  s/5\(_*\)$/6\1/
+-  s/4\(_*\)$/5\1/
+-  s/3\(_*\)$/4\1/
+-  s/2\(_*\)$/3\1/
+-  s/1\(_*\)$/2\1/
+-  s/0\(_*\)$/1\1/
+-# Convert the hidden `9' digits to `0's.
+-  s/_/0/g
+-  x
+-  G
+-  s/\(.*\)\n\([0-9]*\)/\1, \2},/
+-  s/\(.*\)"$/\1/
+-  p
+-}
+-#
+-# Last line.
+-#
+-$ {
+-  i\
+-};\
+-
+-  g
+-  s/0*\(.*\)/int _msg_tbl_length = \1;/p
+-}
+-d
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/printf-args.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/printf-args.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.595711608 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,119 @@
++/* Decomposed printf argument list.
++   Copyright (C) 1999, 2002-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++# include <config.h>
++#endif
++
++/* Specification.  */
++#include "printf-args.h"
++
++#ifdef STATIC
++STATIC
++#endif
++int
++printf_fetchargs (va_list args, arguments *a)
++{
++  size_t i;
++  argument *ap;
++
++  for (i = 0, ap = &a->arg[0]; i < a->count; i++, ap++)
++    switch (ap->type)
++      {
++      case TYPE_SCHAR:
++	ap->a.a_schar = va_arg (args, /*signed char*/ int);
++	break;
++      case TYPE_UCHAR:
++	ap->a.a_uchar = va_arg (args, /*unsigned char*/ int);
++	break;
++      case TYPE_SHORT:
++	ap->a.a_short = va_arg (args, /*short*/ int);
++	break;
++      case TYPE_USHORT:
++	ap->a.a_ushort = va_arg (args, /*unsigned short*/ int);
++	break;
++      case TYPE_INT:
++	ap->a.a_int = va_arg (args, int);
++	break;
++      case TYPE_UINT:
++	ap->a.a_uint = va_arg (args, unsigned int);
++	break;
++      case TYPE_LONGINT:
++	ap->a.a_longint = va_arg (args, long int);
++	break;
++      case TYPE_ULONGINT:
++	ap->a.a_ulongint = va_arg (args, unsigned long int);
++	break;
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
++      case TYPE_LONGLONGINT:
++	ap->a.a_longlongint = va_arg (args, long long int);
++	break;
++      case TYPE_ULONGLONGINT:
++	ap->a.a_ulonglongint = va_arg (args, unsigned long long int);
++	break;
++#endif
++      case TYPE_DOUBLE:
++	ap->a.a_double = va_arg (args, double);
++	break;
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE
++      case TYPE_LONGDOUBLE:
++	ap->a.a_longdouble = va_arg (args, long double);
++	break;
++#endif
++      case TYPE_CHAR:
++	ap->a.a_char = va_arg (args, int);
++	break;
++#ifdef HAVE_WINT_T
++      case TYPE_WIDE_CHAR:
++	ap->a.a_wide_char = va_arg (args, wint_t);
++	break;
++#endif
++      case TYPE_STRING:
++	ap->a.a_string = va_arg (args, const char *);
++	break;
++#ifdef HAVE_WCHAR_T
++      case TYPE_WIDE_STRING:
++	ap->a.a_wide_string = va_arg (args, const wchar_t *);
++	break;
++#endif
++      case TYPE_POINTER:
++	ap->a.a_pointer = va_arg (args, void *);
++	break;
++      case TYPE_COUNT_SCHAR_POINTER:
++	ap->a.a_count_schar_pointer = va_arg (args, signed char *);
++	break;
++      case TYPE_COUNT_SHORT_POINTER:
++	ap->a.a_count_short_pointer = va_arg (args, short *);
++	break;
++      case TYPE_COUNT_INT_POINTER:
++	ap->a.a_count_int_pointer = va_arg (args, int *);
++	break;
++      case TYPE_COUNT_LONGINT_POINTER:
++	ap->a.a_count_longint_pointer = va_arg (args, long int *);
++	break;
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
++      case TYPE_COUNT_LONGLONGINT_POINTER:
++	ap->a.a_count_longlongint_pointer = va_arg (args, long long int *);
++	break;
++#endif
++      default:
++	/* Unknown type.  */
++	return -1;
++      }
++  return 0;
++}
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/printf-args.h	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/printf-args.h	2004-09-12 14:40:34.601710696 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,137 @@
++/* Decomposed printf argument list.
++   Copyright (C) 1999, 2002-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifndef _PRINTF_ARGS_H
++#define _PRINTF_ARGS_H
++
++/* Get size_t.  */
++#include <stddef.h>
++
++/* Get wchar_t.  */
++#ifdef HAVE_WCHAR_T
++# include <stddef.h>
++#endif
++
++/* Get wint_t.  */
++#ifdef HAVE_WINT_T
++# include <wchar.h>
++#endif
++
++/* Get va_list.  */
++#include <stdarg.h>
++
++
++/* Argument types */
++typedef enum
++{
++  TYPE_NONE,
++  TYPE_SCHAR,
++  TYPE_UCHAR,
++  TYPE_SHORT,
++  TYPE_USHORT,
++  TYPE_INT,
++  TYPE_UINT,
++  TYPE_LONGINT,
++  TYPE_ULONGINT,
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
++  TYPE_LONGLONGINT,
++  TYPE_ULONGLONGINT,
++#endif
++  TYPE_DOUBLE,
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE
++  TYPE_LONGDOUBLE,
++#endif
++  TYPE_CHAR,
++#ifdef HAVE_WINT_T
++  TYPE_WIDE_CHAR,
++#endif
++  TYPE_STRING,
++#ifdef HAVE_WCHAR_T
++  TYPE_WIDE_STRING,
++#endif
++  TYPE_POINTER,
++  TYPE_COUNT_SCHAR_POINTER,
++  TYPE_COUNT_SHORT_POINTER,
++  TYPE_COUNT_INT_POINTER,
++  TYPE_COUNT_LONGINT_POINTER
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
++, TYPE_COUNT_LONGLONGINT_POINTER
++#endif
++} arg_type;
++
++/* Polymorphic argument */
++typedef struct
++{
++  arg_type type;
++  union
++  {
++    signed char			a_schar;
++    unsigned char		a_uchar;
++    short			a_short;
++    unsigned short		a_ushort;
++    int				a_int;
++    unsigned int		a_uint;
++    long int			a_longint;
++    unsigned long int		a_ulongint;
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
++    long long int		a_longlongint;
++    unsigned long long int	a_ulonglongint;
++#endif
++    float			a_float;
++    double			a_double;
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE
++    long double			a_longdouble;
++#endif
++    int				a_char;
++#ifdef HAVE_WINT_T
++    wint_t			a_wide_char;
++#endif
++    const char*			a_string;
++#ifdef HAVE_WCHAR_T
++    const wchar_t*		a_wide_string;
++#endif
++    void*			a_pointer;
++    signed char *		a_count_schar_pointer;
++    short *			a_count_short_pointer;
++    int *			a_count_int_pointer;
++    long int *			a_count_longint_pointer;
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
++    long long int *		a_count_longlongint_pointer;
++#endif
++  }
++  a;
++}
++argument;
++
++typedef struct
++{
++  size_t count;
++  argument *arg;
++}
++arguments;
++
++
++/* Fetch the arguments, putting them into a. */
++#ifdef STATIC
++STATIC
++#else
++extern
++#endif
++int printf_fetchargs (va_list args, arguments *a);
++
++#endif /* _PRINTF_ARGS_H */
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/printf.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/printf.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.607709784 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,371 @@
++/* Formatted output to strings, using POSIX/XSI format strings with positions.
++   Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++   Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>, 2003.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++# include <config.h>
++#endif
++
++#ifdef __GNUC__
++# define alloca __builtin_alloca
++# define HAVE_ALLOCA 1
++#else
++# ifdef _MSC_VER
++#  include <malloc.h>
++#  define alloca _alloca
++# else
++#  if defined HAVE_ALLOCA_H || defined _LIBC
++#   include <alloca.h>
++#  else
++#   ifdef _AIX
++ #pragma alloca
++#   else
++#    ifndef alloca
++char *alloca ();
++#    endif
++#   endif
++#  endif
++# endif
++#endif
++
++#include <stdio.h>
++
++#if !HAVE_POSIX_PRINTF
++
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <string.h>
++
++/* When building a DLL, we must export some functions.  Note that because
++   the functions are only defined for binary backward compatibility, we
++   don't need to use __declspec(dllimport) in any case.  */
++#if defined _MSC_VER && BUILDING_DLL
++# define DLL_EXPORTED __declspec(dllexport)
++#else
++# define DLL_EXPORTED
++#endif
++
++#define STATIC static
++
++/* Define auxiliary functions declared in "printf-args.h".  */
++#include "printf-args.c"
++
++/* Define auxiliary functions declared in "printf-parse.h".  */
++#include "printf-parse.c"
++
++/* Define functions declared in "vasnprintf.h".  */
++#define vasnprintf libintl_vasnprintf
++#include "vasnprintf.c"
++#if 0 /* not needed */
++#define asnprintf libintl_asnprintf
++#include "asnprintf.c"
++#endif
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_vfprintf (FILE *stream, const char *format, va_list args)
++{
++  if (strchr (format, '$') == NULL)
++    return vfprintf (stream, format, args);
++  else
++    {
++      size_t length;
++      char *result = libintl_vasnprintf (NULL, &length, format, args);
++      int retval = -1;
++      if (result != NULL)
++	{
++	  if (fwrite (result, 1, length, stream) == length)
++	    retval = length;
++	  free (result);
++	}
++      return retval;
++    }
++}
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_fprintf (FILE *stream, const char *format, ...)
++{
++  va_list args;
++  int retval;
++
++  va_start (args, format);
++  retval = libintl_vfprintf (stream, format, args);
++  va_end (args);
++  return retval;
++}
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_vprintf (const char *format, va_list args)
++{
++  return libintl_vfprintf (stdout, format, args);
++}
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_printf (const char *format, ...)
++{
++  va_list args;
++  int retval;
++
++  va_start (args, format);
++  retval = libintl_vprintf (format, args);
++  va_end (args);
++  return retval;
++}
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_vsprintf (char *resultbuf, const char *format, va_list args)
++{
++  if (strchr (format, '$') == NULL)
++    return vsprintf (resultbuf, format, args);
++  else
++    {
++      size_t length = (size_t) ~0 / (4 * sizeof (char));
++      char *result = libintl_vasnprintf (resultbuf, &length, format, args);
++      if (result != resultbuf)
++	{
++	  free (result);
++	  return -1;
++	}
++      else
++	return length;
++    }
++}
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_sprintf (char *resultbuf, const char *format, ...)
++{
++  va_list args;
++  int retval;
++
++  va_start (args, format);
++  retval = libintl_vsprintf (resultbuf, format, args);
++  va_end (args);
++  return retval;
++}
++
++#if HAVE_SNPRINTF
++
++# if HAVE_DECL__SNPRINTF
++   /* Windows.  */
++#  define system_vsnprintf _vsnprintf
++# else
++   /* Unix.  */
++#  define system_vsnprintf vsnprintf
++# endif
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_vsnprintf (char *resultbuf, size_t length, const char *format, va_list args)
++{
++  if (strchr (format, '$') == NULL)
++    return system_vsnprintf (resultbuf, length, format, args);
++  else
++    {
++      size_t maxlength = length;
++      char *result = libintl_vasnprintf (resultbuf, &length, format, args);
++      if (result != resultbuf)
++	{
++	  if (maxlength > 0)
++	    {
++	      if (length < maxlength)
++		abort ();
++	      memcpy (resultbuf, result, maxlength - 1);
++	      resultbuf[maxlength - 1] = '\0';
++	    }
++	  free (result);
++	  return -1;
++	}
++      else
++	return length;
++    }
++}
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_snprintf (char *resultbuf, size_t length, const char *format, ...)
++{
++  va_list args;
++  int retval;
++
++  va_start (args, format);
++  retval = libintl_vsnprintf (resultbuf, length, format, args);
++  va_end (args);
++  return retval;
++}
++
++#endif
++
++#if HAVE_ASPRINTF
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_vasprintf (char **resultp, const char *format, va_list args)
++{
++  size_t length;
++  char *result = libintl_vasnprintf (NULL, &length, format, args);
++  if (result == NULL)
++    return -1;
++  *resultp = result;
++  return length;
++}
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_asprintf (char **resultp, const char *format, ...)
++{
++  va_list args;
++  int retval;
++
++  va_start (args, format);
++  retval = libintl_vasprintf (resultp, format, args);
++  va_end (args);
++  return retval;
++}
++
++#endif
++
++#if HAVE_FWPRINTF
++
++#include <wchar.h>
++
++#define WIDE_CHAR_VERSION 1
++
++/* Define auxiliary functions declared in "wprintf-parse.h".  */
++#include "printf-parse.c"
++
++/* Define functions declared in "vasnprintf.h".  */
++#define vasnwprintf libintl_vasnwprintf
++#include "vasnprintf.c"
++#if 0 /* not needed */
++#define asnwprintf libintl_asnwprintf
++#include "asnprintf.c"
++#endif
++
++# if HAVE_DECL__SNWPRINTF
++   /* Windows.  */
++#  define system_vswprintf _vsnwprintf
++# else
++   /* Unix.  */
++#  define system_vswprintf vswprintf
++# endif
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_vfwprintf (FILE *stream, const wchar_t *format, va_list args)
++{
++  if (wcschr (format, '$') == NULL)
++    return vfwprintf (stream, format, args);
++  else
++    {
++      size_t length;
++      wchar_t *result = libintl_vasnwprintf (NULL, &length, format, args);
++      int retval = -1;
++      if (result != NULL)
++	{
++	  size_t i;
++	  for (i = 0; i < length; i++)
++	    if (fputwc (result[i], stream) == WEOF)
++	      break;
++	  if (i == length)
++	    retval = length;
++	  free (result);
++	}
++      return retval;
++    }
++}
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_fwprintf (FILE *stream, const wchar_t *format, ...)
++{
++  va_list args;
++  int retval;
++
++  va_start (args, format);
++  retval = libintl_vfwprintf (stream, format, args);
++  va_end (args);
++  return retval;
++}
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_vwprintf (const wchar_t *format, va_list args)
++{
++  return libintl_vfwprintf (stdout, format, args);
++}
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_wprintf (const wchar_t *format, ...)
++{
++  va_list args;
++  int retval;
++
++  va_start (args, format);
++  retval = libintl_vwprintf (format, args);
++  va_end (args);
++  return retval;
++}
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_vswprintf (wchar_t *resultbuf, size_t length, const wchar_t *format, va_list args)
++{
++  if (wcschr (format, '$') == NULL)
++    return system_vswprintf (resultbuf, length, format, args);
++  else
++    {
++      size_t maxlength = length;
++      wchar_t *result = libintl_vasnwprintf (resultbuf, &length, format, args);
++      if (result != resultbuf)
++	{
++	  if (maxlength > 0)
++	    {
++	      if (length < maxlength)
++		abort ();
++	      memcpy (resultbuf, result, (maxlength - 1) * sizeof (wchar_t));
++	      resultbuf[maxlength - 1] = 0;
++	    }
++	  free (result);
++	  return -1;
++	}
++      else
++	return length;
++    }
++}
++
++DLL_EXPORTED
++int
++libintl_swprintf (wchar_t *resultbuf, size_t length, const wchar_t *format, ...)
++{
++  va_list args;
++  int retval;
++
++  va_start (args, format);
++  retval = libintl_vswprintf (resultbuf, length, format, args);
++  va_end (args);
++  return retval;
++}
++
++#endif
++
++#endif
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/printf-parse.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/printf-parse.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.622707504 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,537 @@
++/* Formatted output to strings.
++   Copyright (C) 1999-2000, 2002-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++# include <config.h>
++#endif
++
++/* Specification.  */
++#if WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
++# include "wprintf-parse.h"
++#else
++# include "printf-parse.h"
++#endif
++
++/* Get size_t, NULL.  */
++#include <stddef.h>
++
++/* Get intmax_t.  */
++#if HAVE_STDINT_H_WITH_UINTMAX
++# include <stdint.h>
++#endif
++#if HAVE_INTTYPES_H_WITH_UINTMAX
++# include <inttypes.h>
++#endif
++
++/* malloc(), realloc(), free().  */
++#include <stdlib.h>
++
++/* Checked size_t computations.  */
++#include "xsize.h"
++
++#if WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
++# define PRINTF_PARSE wprintf_parse
++# define CHAR_T wchar_t
++# define DIRECTIVE wchar_t_directive
++# define DIRECTIVES wchar_t_directives
++#else
++# define PRINTF_PARSE printf_parse
++# define CHAR_T char
++# define DIRECTIVE char_directive
++# define DIRECTIVES char_directives
++#endif
++
++#ifdef STATIC
++STATIC
++#endif
++int
++PRINTF_PARSE (const CHAR_T *format, DIRECTIVES *d, arguments *a)
++{
++  const CHAR_T *cp = format;		/* pointer into format */
++  size_t arg_posn = 0;		/* number of regular arguments consumed */
++  size_t d_allocated;			/* allocated elements of d->dir */
++  size_t a_allocated;			/* allocated elements of a->arg */
++  size_t max_width_length = 0;
++  size_t max_precision_length = 0;
++
++  d->count = 0;
++  d_allocated = 1;
++  d->dir = malloc (d_allocated * sizeof (DIRECTIVE));
++  if (d->dir == NULL)
++    /* Out of memory.  */
++    return -1;
++
++  a->count = 0;
++  a_allocated = 0;
++  a->arg = NULL;
++
++#define REGISTER_ARG(_index_,_type_) \
++  {									\
++    size_t n = (_index_);						\
++    if (n >= a_allocated)						\
++      {									\
++	size_t memory_size;						\
++	argument *memory;						\
++									\
++	a_allocated = xtimes (a_allocated, 2);				\
++	if (a_allocated <= n)						\
++	  a_allocated = xsum (n, 1);					\
++	memory_size = xtimes (a_allocated, sizeof (argument));		\
++	if (size_overflow_p (memory_size))				\
++	  /* Overflow, would lead to out of memory.  */			\
++	  goto error;							\
++	memory = (a->arg						\
++		  ? realloc (a->arg, memory_size)			\
++		  : malloc (memory_size));				\
++	if (memory == NULL)						\
++	  /* Out of memory.  */						\
++	  goto error;							\
++	a->arg = memory;						\
++      }									\
++    while (a->count <= n)						\
++      a->arg[a->count++].type = TYPE_NONE;				\
++    if (a->arg[n].type == TYPE_NONE)					\
++      a->arg[n].type = (_type_);					\
++    else if (a->arg[n].type != (_type_))				\
++      /* Ambiguous type for positional argument.  */			\
++      goto error;							\
++  }
++
++  while (*cp != '\0')
++    {
++      CHAR_T c = *cp++;
++      if (c == '%')
++	{
++	  size_t arg_index = ARG_NONE;
++	  DIRECTIVE *dp = &d->dir[d->count];/* pointer to next directive */
++
++	  /* Initialize the next directive.  */
++	  dp->dir_start = cp - 1;
++	  dp->flags = 0;
++	  dp->width_start = NULL;
++	  dp->width_end = NULL;
++	  dp->width_arg_index = ARG_NONE;
++	  dp->precision_start = NULL;
++	  dp->precision_end = NULL;
++	  dp->precision_arg_index = ARG_NONE;
++	  dp->arg_index = ARG_NONE;
++
++	  /* Test for positional argument.  */
++	  if (*cp >= '0' && *cp <= '9')
++	    {
++	      const CHAR_T *np;
++
++	      for (np = cp; *np >= '0' && *np <= '9'; np++)
++		;
++	      if (*np == '$')
++		{
++		  size_t n = 0;
++
++		  for (np = cp; *np >= '0' && *np <= '9'; np++)
++		    n = xsum (xtimes (n, 10), *np - '0');
++		  if (n == 0)
++		    /* Positional argument 0.  */
++		    goto error;
++		  if (size_overflow_p (n))
++		    /* n too large, would lead to out of memory later.  */
++		    goto error;
++		  arg_index = n - 1;
++		  cp = np + 1;
++		}
++	    }
++
++	  /* Read the flags.  */
++	  for (;;)
++	    {
++	      if (*cp == '\'')
++		{
++		  dp->flags |= FLAG_GROUP;
++		  cp++;
++		}
++	      else if (*cp == '-')
++		{
++		  dp->flags |= FLAG_LEFT;
++		  cp++;
++		}
++	      else if (*cp == '+')
++		{
++		  dp->flags |= FLAG_SHOWSIGN;
++		  cp++;
++		}
++	      else if (*cp == ' ')
++		{
++		  dp->flags |= FLAG_SPACE;
++		  cp++;
++		}
++	      else if (*cp == '#')
++		{
++		  dp->flags |= FLAG_ALT;
++		  cp++;
++		}
++	      else if (*cp == '0')
++		{
++		  dp->flags |= FLAG_ZERO;
++		  cp++;
++		}
++	      else
++		break;
++	    }
++
++	  /* Parse the field width.  */
++	  if (*cp == '*')
++	    {
++	      dp->width_start = cp;
++	      cp++;
++	      dp->width_end = cp;
++	      if (max_width_length < 1)
++		max_width_length = 1;
++
++	      /* Test for positional argument.  */
++	      if (*cp >= '0' && *cp <= '9')
++		{
++		  const CHAR_T *np;
++
++		  for (np = cp; *np >= '0' && *np <= '9'; np++)
++		    ;
++		  if (*np == '$')
++		    {
++		      size_t n = 0;
++
++		      for (np = cp; *np >= '0' && *np <= '9'; np++)
++			n = xsum (xtimes (n, 10), *np - '0');
++		      if (n == 0)
++			/* Positional argument 0.  */
++			goto error;
++		      if (size_overflow_p (n))
++			/* n too large, would lead to out of memory later.  */
++			goto error;
++		      dp->width_arg_index = n - 1;
++		      cp = np + 1;
++		    }
++		}
++	      if (dp->width_arg_index == ARG_NONE)
++		{
++		  dp->width_arg_index = arg_posn++;
++		  if (dp->width_arg_index == ARG_NONE)
++		    /* arg_posn wrapped around.  */
++		    goto error;
++		}
++	      REGISTER_ARG (dp->width_arg_index, TYPE_INT);
++	    }
++	  else if (*cp >= '0' && *cp <= '9')
++	    {
++	      size_t width_length;
++
++	      dp->width_start = cp;
++	      for (; *cp >= '0' && *cp <= '9'; cp++)
++		;
++	      dp->width_end = cp;
++	      width_length = dp->width_end - dp->width_start;
++	      if (max_width_length < width_length)
++		max_width_length = width_length;
++	    }
++
++	  /* Parse the precision.  */
++	  if (*cp == '.')
++	    {
++	      cp++;
++	      if (*cp == '*')
++		{
++		  dp->precision_start = cp - 1;
++		  cp++;
++		  dp->precision_end = cp;
++		  if (max_precision_length < 2)
++		    max_precision_length = 2;
++
++		  /* Test for positional argument.  */
++		  if (*cp >= '0' && *cp <= '9')
++		    {
++		      const CHAR_T *np;
++
++		      for (np = cp; *np >= '0' && *np <= '9'; np++)
++			;
++		      if (*np == '$')
++			{
++			  size_t n = 0;
++
++			  for (np = cp; *np >= '0' && *np <= '9'; np++)
++			    n = xsum (xtimes (n, 10), *np - '0');
++			  if (n == 0)
++			    /* Positional argument 0.  */
++			    goto error;
++			  if (size_overflow_p (n))
++			    /* n too large, would lead to out of memory
++			       later.  */
++			    goto error;
++			  dp->precision_arg_index = n - 1;
++			  cp = np + 1;
++			}
++		    }
++		  if (dp->precision_arg_index == ARG_NONE)
++		    {
++		      dp->precision_arg_index = arg_posn++;
++		      if (dp->precision_arg_index == ARG_NONE)
++			/* arg_posn wrapped around.  */
++			goto error;
++		    }
++		  REGISTER_ARG (dp->precision_arg_index, TYPE_INT);
++		}
++	      else
++		{
++		  size_t precision_length;
++
++		  dp->precision_start = cp - 1;
++		  for (; *cp >= '0' && *cp <= '9'; cp++)
++		    ;
++		  dp->precision_end = cp;
++		  precision_length = dp->precision_end - dp->precision_start;
++		  if (max_precision_length < precision_length)
++		    max_precision_length = precision_length;
++		}
++	    }
++
++	  {
++	    arg_type type;
++
++	    /* Parse argument type/size specifiers.  */
++	    {
++	      int flags = 0;
++
++	      for (;;)
++		{
++		  if (*cp == 'h')
++		    {
++		      flags |= (1 << (flags & 1));
++		      cp++;
++		    }
++		  else if (*cp == 'L')
++		    {
++		      flags |= 4;
++		      cp++;
++		    }
++		  else if (*cp == 'l')
++		    {
++		      flags += 8;
++		      cp++;
++		    }
++#ifdef HAVE_INTMAX_T
++		  else if (*cp == 'j')
++		    {
++		      if (sizeof (intmax_t) > sizeof (long))
++			{
++			  /* intmax_t = long long */
++			  flags += 16;
++			}
++		      else if (sizeof (intmax_t) > sizeof (int))
++			{
++			  /* intmax_t = long */
++			  flags += 8;
++			}
++		      cp++;
++		    }
++#endif
++		  else if (*cp == 'z' || *cp == 'Z')
++		    {
++		      /* 'z' is standardized in ISO C 99, but glibc uses 'Z'
++			 because the warning facility in gcc-2.95.2 understands
++			 only 'Z' (see gcc-2.95.2/gcc/c-common.c:1784).  */
++		      if (sizeof (size_t) > sizeof (long))
++			{
++			  /* size_t = long long */
++			  flags += 16;
++			}
++		      else if (sizeof (size_t) > sizeof (int))
++			{
++			  /* size_t = long */
++			  flags += 8;
++			}
++		      cp++;
++		    }
++		  else if (*cp == 't')
++		    {
++		      if (sizeof (ptrdiff_t) > sizeof (long))
++			{
++			  /* ptrdiff_t = long long */
++			  flags += 16;
++			}
++		      else if (sizeof (ptrdiff_t) > sizeof (int))
++			{
++			  /* ptrdiff_t = long */
++			  flags += 8;
++			}
++		      cp++;
++		    }
++		  else
++		    break;
++		}
++
++	      /* Read the conversion character.  */
++	      c = *cp++;
++	      switch (c)
++		{
++		case 'd': case 'i':
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
++		  if (flags >= 16 || (flags & 4))
++		    type = TYPE_LONGLONGINT;
++		  else
++#endif
++		  if (flags >= 8)
++		    type = TYPE_LONGINT;
++		  else if (flags & 2)
++		    type = TYPE_SCHAR;
++		  else if (flags & 1)
++		    type = TYPE_SHORT;
++		  else
++		    type = TYPE_INT;
++		  break;
++		case 'o': case 'u': case 'x': case 'X':
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
++		  if (flags >= 16 || (flags & 4))
++		    type = TYPE_ULONGLONGINT;
++		  else
++#endif
++		  if (flags >= 8)
++		    type = TYPE_ULONGINT;
++		  else if (flags & 2)
++		    type = TYPE_UCHAR;
++		  else if (flags & 1)
++		    type = TYPE_USHORT;
++		  else
++		    type = TYPE_UINT;
++		  break;
++		case 'f': case 'F': case 'e': case 'E': case 'g': case 'G':
++		case 'a': case 'A':
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE
++		  if (flags >= 16 || (flags & 4))
++		    type = TYPE_LONGDOUBLE;
++		  else
++#endif
++		  type = TYPE_DOUBLE;
++		  break;
++		case 'c':
++		  if (flags >= 8)
++#ifdef HAVE_WINT_T
++		    type = TYPE_WIDE_CHAR;
++#else
++		    goto error;
++#endif
++		  else
++		    type = TYPE_CHAR;
++		  break;
++#ifdef HAVE_WINT_T
++		case 'C':
++		  type = TYPE_WIDE_CHAR;
++		  c = 'c';
++		  break;
++#endif
++		case 's':
++		  if (flags >= 8)
++#ifdef HAVE_WCHAR_T
++		    type = TYPE_WIDE_STRING;
++#else
++		    goto error;
++#endif
++		  else
++		    type = TYPE_STRING;
++		  break;
++#ifdef HAVE_WCHAR_T
++		case 'S':
++		  type = TYPE_WIDE_STRING;
++		  c = 's';
++		  break;
++#endif
++		case 'p':
++		  type = TYPE_POINTER;
++		  break;
++		case 'n':
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
++		  if (flags >= 16 || (flags & 4))
++		    type = TYPE_COUNT_LONGLONGINT_POINTER;
++		  else
++#endif
++		  if (flags >= 8)
++		    type = TYPE_COUNT_LONGINT_POINTER;
++		  else if (flags & 2)
++		    type = TYPE_COUNT_SCHAR_POINTER;
++		  else if (flags & 1)
++		    type = TYPE_COUNT_SHORT_POINTER;
++		  else
++		    type = TYPE_COUNT_INT_POINTER;
++		  break;
++		case '%':
++		  type = TYPE_NONE;
++		  break;
++		default:
++		  /* Unknown conversion character.  */
++		  goto error;
++		}
++	    }
++
++	    if (type != TYPE_NONE)
++	      {
++		dp->arg_index = arg_index;
++		if (dp->arg_index == ARG_NONE)
++		  {
++		    dp->arg_index = arg_posn++;
++		    if (dp->arg_index == ARG_NONE)
++		      /* arg_posn wrapped around.  */
++		      goto error;
++		  }
++		REGISTER_ARG (dp->arg_index, type);
++	      }
++	    dp->conversion = c;
++	    dp->dir_end = cp;
++	  }
++
++	  d->count++;
++	  if (d->count >= d_allocated)
++	    {
++	      size_t memory_size;
++	      DIRECTIVE *memory;
++
++	      d_allocated = xtimes (d_allocated, 2);
++	      memory_size = xtimes (d_allocated, sizeof (DIRECTIVE));
++	      if (size_overflow_p (memory_size))
++		/* Overflow, would lead to out of memory.  */
++		goto error;
++	      memory = realloc (d->dir, memory_size);
++	      if (memory == NULL)
++		/* Out of memory.  */
++		goto error;
++	      d->dir = memory;
++	    }
++	}
++    }
++  d->dir[d->count].dir_start = cp;
++
++  d->max_width_length = max_width_length;
++  d->max_precision_length = max_precision_length;
++  return 0;
++
++error:
++  if (a->arg)
++    free (a->arg);
++  if (d->dir)
++    free (d->dir);
++  return -1;
++}
++
++#undef DIRECTIVES
++#undef DIRECTIVE
++#undef CHAR_T
++#undef PRINTF_PARSE
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/printf-parse.h	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/printf-parse.h	2004-09-12 14:40:34.628706592 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,75 @@
++/* Parse printf format string.
++   Copyright (C) 1999, 2002-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifndef _PRINTF_PARSE_H
++#define _PRINTF_PARSE_H
++
++#include "printf-args.h"
++
++
++/* Flags */
++#define FLAG_GROUP	 1	/* ' flag */
++#define FLAG_LEFT	 2	/* - flag */
++#define FLAG_SHOWSIGN	 4	/* + flag */
++#define FLAG_SPACE	 8	/* space flag */
++#define FLAG_ALT	16	/* # flag */
++#define FLAG_ZERO	32
++
++/* arg_index value indicating that no argument is consumed.  */
++#define ARG_NONE	(~(size_t)0)
++
++/* A parsed directive.  */
++typedef struct
++{
++  const char* dir_start;
++  const char* dir_end;
++  int flags;
++  const char* width_start;
++  const char* width_end;
++  size_t width_arg_index;
++  const char* precision_start;
++  const char* precision_end;
++  size_t precision_arg_index;
++  char conversion; /* d i o u x X f e E g G c s p n U % but not C S */
++  size_t arg_index;
++}
++char_directive;
++
++/* A parsed format string.  */
++typedef struct
++{
++  size_t count;
++  char_directive *dir;
++  size_t max_width_length;
++  size_t max_precision_length;
++}
++char_directives;
++
++
++/* Parses the format string.  Fills in the number N of directives, and fills
++   in directives[0], ..., directives[N-1], and sets directives[N].dir_start
++   to the end of the format string.  Also fills in the arg_type fields of the
++   arguments and the needed count of arguments.  */
++#ifdef STATIC
++STATIC
++#else
++extern
++#endif
++int printf_parse (const char *format, char_directives *d, arguments *a);
++
++#endif /* _PRINTF_PARSE_H */
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/ref-add.sin	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/ref-add.sin	2004-09-12 14:40:34.633705832 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,31 @@
++# Add this package to a list of references stored in a text file.
++#
++#   Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++#
++#   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++#   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++#   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++#   any later version.
++#
++#   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++#   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++#   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++#   Library General Public License for more details.
++#
++#   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++#   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++#   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++#   USA.
++#
++# Written by Bruno Haible <haible@clisp.cons.org>.
++#
++/^# Packages using this file: / {
++  s/# Packages using this file://
++  ta
++  :a
++  s/ @PACKAGE@ / @PACKAGE@ /
++  tb
++  s/ $/ @PACKAGE@ /
++  :b
++  s/^/# Packages using this file:/
++}
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/ref-del.sin	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/ref-del.sin	2004-09-12 14:40:34.638705072 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
++# Remove this package from a list of references stored in a text file.
++#
++#   Copyright (C) 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++#
++#   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++#   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++#   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++#   any later version.
++#
++#   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++#   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++#   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++#   Library General Public License for more details.
++#
++#   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++#   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++#   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++#   USA.
++#
++# Written by Bruno Haible <haible@clisp.cons.org>.
++#
++/^# Packages using this file: / {
++  s/# Packages using this file://
++  s/ @PACKAGE@ / /
++  s/^/# Packages using this file:/
++}
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/relocatable.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/relocatable.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.644704160 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,449 @@
++/* Provide relocatable packages.
++   Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++   Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>, 2003.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++
++/* Tell glibc's <stdio.h> to provide a prototype for getline().
++   This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include
++   <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late.  */
++#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
++# define _GNU_SOURCE	1
++#endif
++
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++# include "config.h"
++#endif
++
++/* Specification.  */
++#include "relocatable.h"
++
++#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE
++
++#include <stddef.h>
++#include <stdio.h>
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <string.h>
++
++#ifdef NO_XMALLOC
++# define xmalloc malloc
++#else
++# include "xalloc.h"
++#endif
++
++#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__
++# define WIN32_LEAN_AND_MEAN
++# include <windows.h>
++#endif
++
++#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBCHARSET
++# include <libcharset.h>
++#endif
++#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBICONV && HAVE_ICONV
++# include <iconv.h>
++#endif
++#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBINTL && ENABLE_NLS
++# include <libintl.h>
++#endif
++
++/* Faked cheap 'bool'.  */
++#undef bool
++#undef false
++#undef true
++#define bool int
++#define false 0
++#define true 1
++
++/* Pathname support.
++   ISSLASH(C)           tests whether C is a directory separator character.
++   IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P)  tests whether P contains a directory specification.
++ */
++#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__
++  /* Win32, OS/2, DOS */
++# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/' || (C) == '\\')
++# define HAS_DEVICE(P) \
++    ((((P)[0] >= 'A' && (P)[0] <= 'Z') || ((P)[0] >= 'a' && (P)[0] <= 'z')) \
++     && (P)[1] == ':')
++# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) \
++    (strchr (P, '/') != NULL || strchr (P, '\\') != NULL || HAS_DEVICE (P))
++# define FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN(P) (HAS_DEVICE (P) ? 2 : 0)
++#else
++  /* Unix */
++# define ISSLASH(C) ((C) == '/')
++# define IS_PATH_WITH_DIR(P) (strchr (P, '/') != NULL)
++# define FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN(P) 0
++#endif
++
++/* Original installation prefix.  */
++static char *orig_prefix;
++static size_t orig_prefix_len;
++/* Current installation prefix.  */
++static char *curr_prefix;
++static size_t curr_prefix_len;
++/* These prefixes do not end in a slash.  Anything that will be concatenated
++   to them must start with a slash.  */
++
++/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of this module.
++   Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix
++   by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead.  Both
++   prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use ""
++   instead of "/").  */
++static void
++set_this_relocation_prefix (const char *orig_prefix_arg,
++			    const char *curr_prefix_arg)
++{
++  if (orig_prefix_arg != NULL && curr_prefix_arg != NULL
++      /* Optimization: if orig_prefix and curr_prefix are equal, the
++	 relocation is a nop.  */
++      && strcmp (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg) != 0)
++    {
++      /* Duplicate the argument strings.  */
++      char *memory;
++
++      orig_prefix_len = strlen (orig_prefix_arg);
++      curr_prefix_len = strlen (curr_prefix_arg);
++      memory = (char *) xmalloc (orig_prefix_len + 1 + curr_prefix_len + 1);
++#ifdef NO_XMALLOC
++      if (memory != NULL)
++#endif
++	{
++	  memcpy (memory, orig_prefix_arg, orig_prefix_len + 1);
++	  orig_prefix = memory;
++	  memory += orig_prefix_len + 1;
++	  memcpy (memory, curr_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_len + 1);
++	  curr_prefix = memory;
++	  return;
++	}
++    }
++  orig_prefix = NULL;
++  curr_prefix = NULL;
++  /* Don't worry about wasted memory here - this function is usually only
++     called once.  */
++}
++
++/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of the package.
++   Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix
++   by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead.  Both
++   prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use ""
++   instead of "/").  */
++void
++set_relocation_prefix (const char *orig_prefix_arg, const char *curr_prefix_arg)
++{
++  set_this_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg);
++
++  /* Now notify all dependent libraries.  */
++#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBCHARSET
++  libcharset_set_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg);
++#endif
++#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBICONV && HAVE_ICONV && _LIBICONV_VERSION >= 0x0109
++  libiconv_set_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg);
++#endif
++#if DEPENDS_ON_LIBINTL && ENABLE_NLS && defined libintl_set_relocation_prefix
++  libintl_set_relocation_prefix (orig_prefix_arg, curr_prefix_arg);
++#endif
++}
++
++#if !defined IN_LIBRARY || (defined PIC && defined INSTALLDIR)
++
++/* Convenience function:
++   Computes the current installation prefix, based on the original
++   installation prefix, the original installation directory of a particular
++   file, and the current pathname of this file.  Returns NULL upon failure.  */
++#ifdef IN_LIBRARY
++#define compute_curr_prefix local_compute_curr_prefix
++static
++#endif
++const char *
++compute_curr_prefix (const char *orig_installprefix,
++		     const char *orig_installdir,
++		     const char *curr_pathname)
++{
++  const char *curr_installdir;
++  const char *rel_installdir;
++
++  if (curr_pathname == NULL)
++    return NULL;
++
++  /* Determine the relative installation directory, relative to the prefix.
++     This is simply the difference between orig_installprefix and
++     orig_installdir.  */
++  if (strncmp (orig_installprefix, orig_installdir, strlen (orig_installprefix))
++      != 0)
++    /* Shouldn't happen - nothing should be installed outside $(prefix).  */
++    return NULL;
++  rel_installdir = orig_installdir + strlen (orig_installprefix);
++
++  /* Determine the current installation directory.  */
++  {
++    const char *p_base = curr_pathname + FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN (curr_pathname);
++    const char *p = curr_pathname + strlen (curr_pathname);
++    char *q;
++
++    while (p > p_base)
++      {
++	p--;
++	if (ISSLASH (*p))
++	  break;
++      }
++
++    q = (char *) xmalloc (p - curr_pathname + 1);
++#ifdef NO_XMALLOC
++    if (q == NULL)
++      return NULL;
++#endif
++    memcpy (q, curr_pathname, p - curr_pathname);
++    q[p - curr_pathname] = '\0';
++    curr_installdir = q;
++  }
++
++  /* Compute the current installation prefix by removing the trailing
++     rel_installdir from it.  */
++  {
++    const char *rp = rel_installdir + strlen (rel_installdir);
++    const char *cp = curr_installdir + strlen (curr_installdir);
++    const char *cp_base =
++      curr_installdir + FILESYSTEM_PREFIX_LEN (curr_installdir);
++
++    while (rp > rel_installdir && cp > cp_base)
++      {
++	bool same = false;
++	const char *rpi = rp;
++	const char *cpi = cp;
++
++	while (rpi > rel_installdir && cpi > cp_base)
++	  {
++	    rpi--;
++	    cpi--;
++	    if (ISSLASH (*rpi) || ISSLASH (*cpi))
++	      {
++		if (ISSLASH (*rpi) && ISSLASH (*cpi))
++		  same = true;
++		break;
++	      }
++#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__ || defined __EMX__ || defined __DJGPP__
++	    /* Win32, OS/2, DOS - case insignificant filesystem */
++	    if ((*rpi >= 'a' && *rpi <= 'z' ? *rpi - 'a' + 'A' : *rpi)
++		!= (*cpi >= 'a' && *cpi <= 'z' ? *cpi - 'a' + 'A' : *cpi))
++	      break;
++#else
++	    if (*rpi != *cpi)
++	      break;
++#endif
++	  }
++	if (!same)
++	  break;
++	/* The last pathname component was the same.  opi and cpi now point
++	   to the slash before it.  */
++	rp = rpi;
++	cp = cpi;
++      }
++
++    if (rp > rel_installdir)
++      /* Unexpected: The curr_installdir does not end with rel_installdir.  */
++      return NULL;
++
++    {
++      size_t curr_prefix_len = cp - curr_installdir;
++      char *curr_prefix;
++
++      curr_prefix = (char *) xmalloc (curr_prefix_len + 1);
++#ifdef NO_XMALLOC
++      if (curr_prefix == NULL)
++	return NULL;
++#endif
++      memcpy (curr_prefix, curr_installdir, curr_prefix_len);
++      curr_prefix[curr_prefix_len] = '\0';
++
++      return curr_prefix;
++    }
++  }
++}
++
++#endif /* !IN_LIBRARY || PIC */
++
++#if defined PIC && defined INSTALLDIR
++
++/* Full pathname of shared library, or NULL.  */
++static char *shared_library_fullname;
++
++#if defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__
++
++/* Determine the full pathname of the shared library when it is loaded.  */
++
++BOOL WINAPI
++DllMain (HINSTANCE module_handle, DWORD event, LPVOID reserved)
++{
++  (void) reserved;
++
++  if (event == DLL_PROCESS_ATTACH)
++    {
++      /* The DLL is being loaded into an application's address range.  */
++      static char location[MAX_PATH];
++
++      if (!GetModuleFileName (module_handle, location, sizeof (location)))
++	/* Shouldn't happen.  */
++	return FALSE;
++
++      if (!IS_PATH_WITH_DIR (location))
++	/* Shouldn't happen.  */
++	return FALSE;
++
++      shared_library_fullname = strdup (location);
++    }
++
++  return TRUE;
++}
++
++#else /* Unix */
++
++static void
++find_shared_library_fullname ()
++{
++#if defined __linux__ && __GLIBC__ >= 2
++  /* Linux has /proc/self/maps. glibc 2 has the getline() function.  */
++  FILE *fp;
++
++  /* Open the current process' maps file.  It describes one VMA per line.  */
++  fp = fopen ("/proc/self/maps", "r");
++  if (fp)
++    {
++      unsigned long address = (unsigned long) &find_shared_library_fullname;
++      for (;;)
++	{
++	  unsigned long start, end;
++	  int c;
++
++	  if (fscanf (fp, "%lx-%lx", &start, &end) != 2)
++	    break;
++	  if (address >= start && address <= end - 1)
++	    {
++	      /* Found it.  Now see if this line contains a filename.  */
++	      while (c = getc (fp), c != EOF && c != '\n' && c != '/')
++		continue;
++	      if (c == '/')
++		{
++		  size_t size;
++		  int len;
++
++		  ungetc (c, fp);
++		  shared_library_fullname = NULL; size = 0;
++		  len = getline (&shared_library_fullname, &size, fp);
++		  if (len >= 0)
++		    {
++		      /* Success: filled shared_library_fullname.  */
++		      if (len > 0 && shared_library_fullname[len - 1] == '\n')
++			shared_library_fullname[len - 1] = '\0';
++		    }
++		}
++	      break;
++	    }
++	  while (c = getc (fp), c != EOF && c != '\n')
++	    continue;
++	}
++      fclose (fp);
++    }
++#endif
++}
++
++#endif /* WIN32 / Unix */
++
++/* Return the full pathname of the current shared library.
++   Return NULL if unknown.
++   Guaranteed to work only on Linux and Woe32.  */
++static char *
++get_shared_library_fullname ()
++{
++#if !(defined _WIN32 || defined __WIN32__)
++  static bool tried_find_shared_library_fullname;
++  if (!tried_find_shared_library_fullname)
++    {
++      find_shared_library_fullname ();
++      tried_find_shared_library_fullname = true;
++    }
++#endif
++  return shared_library_fullname;
++}
++
++#endif /* PIC */
++
++/* Returns the pathname, relocated according to the current installation
++   directory.  */
++const char *
++relocate (const char *pathname)
++{
++#if defined PIC && defined INSTALLDIR
++  static int initialized;
++
++  /* Initialization code for a shared library.  */
++  if (!initialized)
++    {
++      /* At this point, orig_prefix and curr_prefix likely have already been
++	 set through the main program's set_program_name_and_installdir
++	 function.  This is sufficient in the case that the library has
++	 initially been installed in the same orig_prefix.  But we can do
++	 better, to also cover the cases that 1. it has been installed
++	 in a different prefix before being moved to orig_prefix and (later)
++	 to curr_prefix, 2. unlike the program, it has not moved away from
++	 orig_prefix.  */
++      const char *orig_installprefix = INSTALLPREFIX;
++      const char *orig_installdir = INSTALLDIR;
++      const char *curr_prefix_better;
++
++      curr_prefix_better =
++	compute_curr_prefix (orig_installprefix, orig_installdir,
++			     get_shared_library_fullname ());
++      if (curr_prefix_better == NULL)
++	curr_prefix_better = curr_prefix;
++
++      set_relocation_prefix (orig_installprefix, curr_prefix_better);
++
++      initialized = 1;
++    }
++#endif
++
++  /* Note: It is not necessary to perform case insensitive comparison here,
++     even for DOS-like filesystems, because the pathname argument was
++     typically created from the same Makefile variable as orig_prefix came
++     from.  */
++  if (orig_prefix != NULL && curr_prefix != NULL
++      && strncmp (pathname, orig_prefix, orig_prefix_len) == 0)
++    {
++      if (pathname[orig_prefix_len] == '\0')
++	/* pathname equals orig_prefix.  */
++	return curr_prefix;
++      if (ISSLASH (pathname[orig_prefix_len]))
++	{
++	  /* pathname starts with orig_prefix.  */
++	  const char *pathname_tail = &pathname[orig_prefix_len];
++	  char *result =
++	    (char *) xmalloc (curr_prefix_len + strlen (pathname_tail) + 1);
++
++#ifdef NO_XMALLOC
++	  if (result != NULL)
++#endif
++	    {
++	      memcpy (result, curr_prefix, curr_prefix_len);
++	      strcpy (result + curr_prefix_len, pathname_tail);
++	      return result;
++	    }
++	}
++    }
++  /* Nothing to relocate.  */
++  return pathname;
++}
++
++#endif
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/relocatable.h	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/relocatable.h	2004-09-12 14:40:34.651703096 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,77 @@
++/* Provide relocatable packages.
++   Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++   Written by Bruno Haible <bruno@clisp.org>, 2003.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifndef _RELOCATABLE_H
++#define _RELOCATABLE_H
++
++#ifdef __cplusplus
++extern "C" {
++#endif
++
++
++/* This can be enabled through the configure --enable-relocatable option.  */
++#if ENABLE_RELOCATABLE
++
++/* When building a DLL, we must export some functions.  Note that because
++   this is a private .h file, we don't need to use __declspec(dllimport)
++   in any case.  */
++#if defined _MSC_VER && BUILDING_DLL
++# define RELOCATABLE_DLL_EXPORTED __declspec(dllexport)
++#else
++# define RELOCATABLE_DLL_EXPORTED
++#endif
++
++/* Sets the original and the current installation prefix of the package.
++   Relocation simply replaces a pathname starting with the original prefix
++   by the corresponding pathname with the current prefix instead.  Both
++   prefixes should be directory names without trailing slash (i.e. use ""
++   instead of "/").  */
++extern RELOCATABLE_DLL_EXPORTED void
++       set_relocation_prefix (const char *orig_prefix,
++			      const char *curr_prefix);
++
++/* Returns the pathname, relocated according to the current installation
++   directory.  */
++extern const char * relocate (const char *pathname);
++
++/* Memory management: relocate() leaks memory, because it has to construct
++   a fresh pathname.  If this is a problem because your program calls
++   relocate() frequently, think about caching the result.  */
++
++/* Convenience function:
++   Computes the current installation prefix, based on the original
++   installation prefix, the original installation directory of a particular
++   file, and the current pathname of this file.  Returns NULL upon failure.  */
++extern const char * compute_curr_prefix (const char *orig_installprefix,
++					 const char *orig_installdir,
++					 const char *curr_pathname);
++
++#else
++
++/* By default, we use the hardwired pathnames.  */
++#define relocate(pathname) (pathname)
++
++#endif
++
++
++#ifdef __cplusplus
++}
++#endif
++
++#endif /* _RELOCATABLE_H */
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/textdomain.c	1998-04-26 09:22:37.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/textdomain.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.656702336 -0400
+@@ -1,51 +1,60 @@
+-/* Implementation of the textdomain(3) function
+-   Copyright (C) 1995, 1996, 1997 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+-   Written by Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1995.
++/* Implementation of the textdomain(3) function.
++   Copyright (C) 1995-1998, 2000-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+ 
+-   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-   it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-   the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+    any later version.
+ 
+    This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+    but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-   GNU General Public License for more details.
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
+ 
+-   You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-   along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation,
+-   Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.  */
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
+ 
+ #ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
+ # include <config.h>
+ #endif
+ 
+-#if defined STDC_HEADERS || defined _LIBC
+-# include <stdlib.h>
+-#endif
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <string.h>
+ 
+-#if defined STDC_HEADERS || defined HAVE_STRING_H || defined _LIBC
+-# include <string.h>
++#ifdef _LIBC
++# include <libintl.h>
+ #else
+-# include <strings.h>
+-# ifndef memcpy
+-#  define memcpy(Dst, Src, Num) bcopy (Src, Dst, Num)
+-# endif
++# include "libgnuintl.h"
+ #endif
++#include "gettextP.h"
+ 
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+-# include <libintl.h>
++/* We have to handle multi-threaded applications.  */
++# include <bits/libc-lock.h>
+ #else
+-# include "libgettext.h"
++/* Provide dummy implementation if this is outside glibc.  */
++# define __libc_rwlock_define(CLASS, NAME)
++# define __libc_rwlock_wrlock(NAME)
++# define __libc_rwlock_unlock(NAME)
++#endif
++
++/* The internal variables in the standalone libintl.a must have different
++   names than the internal variables in GNU libc, otherwise programs
++   using libintl.a cannot be linked statically.  */
++#if !defined _LIBC
++# define _nl_default_default_domain libintl_nl_default_default_domain
++# define _nl_current_default_domain libintl_nl_current_default_domain
+ #endif
+ 
+ /* @@ end of prolog @@ */
+ 
+ /* Name of the default text domain.  */
+-extern const char _nl_default_default_domain[];
++extern const char _nl_default_default_domain[] attribute_hidden;
+ 
+ /* Default text domain in which entries for gettext(3) are to be found.  */
+-extern const char *_nl_current_default_domain;
++extern const char *_nl_current_default_domain attribute_hidden;
+ 
+ 
+ /* Names for the libintl functions are a problem.  They must not clash
+@@ -54,50 +63,76 @@
+    prefix.  So we have to make a difference here.  */
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+ # define TEXTDOMAIN __textdomain
+-# define strdup(str) __strdup (str)
++# ifndef strdup
++#  define strdup(str) __strdup (str)
++# endif
+ #else
+-# define TEXTDOMAIN textdomain__
++# define TEXTDOMAIN libintl_textdomain
+ #endif
+ 
++/* Lock variable to protect the global data in the gettext implementation.  */
++__libc_rwlock_define (extern, _nl_state_lock attribute_hidden)
++
+ /* Set the current default message catalog to DOMAINNAME.
+    If DOMAINNAME is null, return the current default.
+    If DOMAINNAME is "", reset to the default of "messages".  */
+ char *
+-TEXTDOMAIN (domainname)
+-     const char *domainname;
++TEXTDOMAIN (const char *domainname)
+ {
+-  char *old;
++  char *new_domain;
++  char *old_domain;
+ 
+   /* A NULL pointer requests the current setting.  */
+   if (domainname == NULL)
+     return (char *) _nl_current_default_domain;
+ 
+-  old = (char *) _nl_current_default_domain;
++  __libc_rwlock_wrlock (_nl_state_lock);
++
++  old_domain = (char *) _nl_current_default_domain;
+ 
+   /* If domain name is the null string set to default domain "messages".  */
+   if (domainname[0] == '\0'
+       || strcmp (domainname, _nl_default_default_domain) == 0)
+-    _nl_current_default_domain = _nl_default_default_domain;
++    {
++      _nl_current_default_domain = _nl_default_default_domain;
++      new_domain = (char *) _nl_current_default_domain;
++    }
++  else if (strcmp (domainname, old_domain) == 0)
++    /* This can happen and people will use it to signal that some
++       environment variable changed.  */
++    new_domain = old_domain;
+   else
+     {
+       /* If the following malloc fails `_nl_current_default_domain'
+ 	 will be NULL.  This value will be returned and so signals we
+ 	 are out of core.  */
+ #if defined _LIBC || defined HAVE_STRDUP
+-      _nl_current_default_domain = strdup (domainname);
++      new_domain = strdup (domainname);
+ #else
+       size_t len = strlen (domainname) + 1;
+-      char *cp = (char *) malloc (len);
+-      if (cp != NULL)
+-	memcpy (cp, domainname, len);
+-      _nl_current_default_domain = cp;
++      new_domain = (char *) malloc (len);
++      if (new_domain != NULL)
++	memcpy (new_domain, domainname, len);
+ #endif
++
++      if (new_domain != NULL)
++	_nl_current_default_domain = new_domain;
+     }
+ 
+-  if (old != _nl_default_default_domain)
+-    free (old);
++  /* We use this possibility to signal a change of the loaded catalogs
++     since this is most likely the case and there is no other easy we
++     to do it.  Do it only when the call was successful.  */
++  if (new_domain != NULL)
++    {
++      ++_nl_msg_cat_cntr;
+ 
+-  return (char *) _nl_current_default_domain;
++      if (old_domain != new_domain && old_domain != _nl_default_default_domain)
++	free (old_domain);
++    }
++
++  __libc_rwlock_unlock (_nl_state_lock);
++
++  return new_domain;
+ }
+ 
+ #ifdef _LIBC
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/vasnprintf.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/vasnprintf.c	2004-09-12 14:40:34.662701424 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,887 @@
++/* vsprintf with automatic memory allocation.
++   Copyright (C) 1999, 2002-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++/* Tell glibc's <stdio.h> to provide a prototype for snprintf().
++   This must come before <config.h> because <config.h> may include
++   <features.h>, and once <features.h> has been included, it's too late.  */
++#ifndef _GNU_SOURCE
++# define _GNU_SOURCE    1
++#endif
++
++#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H
++# include <config.h>
++#endif
++#ifndef IN_LIBINTL
++# include <alloca.h>
++#endif
++
++/* Specification.  */
++#if WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
++# include "vasnwprintf.h"
++#else
++# include "vasnprintf.h"
++#endif
++
++#include <stdio.h>	/* snprintf(), sprintf() */
++#include <stdlib.h>	/* abort(), malloc(), realloc(), free() */
++#include <string.h>	/* memcpy(), strlen() */
++#include <errno.h>	/* errno */
++#include <limits.h>	/* CHAR_BIT */
++#include <float.h>	/* DBL_MAX_EXP, LDBL_MAX_EXP */
++#if WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
++# include "wprintf-parse.h"
++#else
++# include "printf-parse.h"
++#endif
++
++/* Checked size_t computations.  */
++#include "xsize.h"
++
++#ifdef HAVE_WCHAR_T
++# ifdef HAVE_WCSLEN
++#  define local_wcslen wcslen
++# else
++   /* Solaris 2.5.1 has wcslen() in a separate library libw.so. To avoid
++      a dependency towards this library, here is a local substitute.
++      Define this substitute only once, even if this file is included
++      twice in the same compilation unit.  */
++#  ifndef local_wcslen_defined
++#   define local_wcslen_defined 1
++static size_t
++local_wcslen (const wchar_t *s)
++{
++  const wchar_t *ptr;
++
++  for (ptr = s; *ptr != (wchar_t) 0; ptr++)
++    ;
++  return ptr - s;
++}
++#  endif
++# endif
++#endif
++
++#if WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
++# define VASNPRINTF vasnwprintf
++# define CHAR_T wchar_t
++# define DIRECTIVE wchar_t_directive
++# define DIRECTIVES wchar_t_directives
++# define PRINTF_PARSE wprintf_parse
++# define USE_SNPRINTF 1
++# if HAVE_DECL__SNWPRINTF
++   /* On Windows, the function swprintf() has a different signature than
++      on Unix; we use the _snwprintf() function instead.  */
++#  define SNPRINTF _snwprintf
++# else
++   /* Unix.  */
++#  define SNPRINTF swprintf
++# endif
++#else
++# define VASNPRINTF vasnprintf
++# define CHAR_T char
++# define DIRECTIVE char_directive
++# define DIRECTIVES char_directives
++# define PRINTF_PARSE printf_parse
++# define USE_SNPRINTF (HAVE_DECL__SNPRINTF || HAVE_SNPRINTF)
++# if HAVE_DECL__SNPRINTF
++   /* Windows.  */
++#  define SNPRINTF _snprintf
++# else
++   /* Unix.  */
++#  define SNPRINTF snprintf
++# endif
++#endif
++
++CHAR_T *
++VASNPRINTF (CHAR_T *resultbuf, size_t *lengthp, const CHAR_T *format, va_list args)
++{
++  DIRECTIVES d;
++  arguments a;
++
++  if (PRINTF_PARSE (format, &d, &a) < 0)
++    {
++      errno = EINVAL;
++      return NULL;
++    }
++
++#define CLEANUP() \
++  free (d.dir);								\
++  if (a.arg)								\
++    free (a.arg);
++
++  if (printf_fetchargs (args, &a) < 0)
++    {
++      CLEANUP ();
++      errno = EINVAL;
++      return NULL;
++    }
++
++  {
++    size_t buf_neededlength;
++    CHAR_T *buf;
++    CHAR_T *buf_malloced;
++    const CHAR_T *cp;
++    size_t i;
++    DIRECTIVE *dp;
++    /* Output string accumulator.  */
++    CHAR_T *result;
++    size_t allocated;
++    size_t length;
++
++    /* Allocate a small buffer that will hold a directive passed to
++       sprintf or snprintf.  */
++    buf_neededlength =
++      xsum4 (7, d.max_width_length, d.max_precision_length, 6);
++#if HAVE_ALLOCA
++    if (buf_neededlength < 4000 / sizeof (CHAR_T))
++      {
++	buf = (CHAR_T *) alloca (buf_neededlength * sizeof (CHAR_T));
++	buf_malloced = NULL;
++      }
++    else
++#endif
++      {
++	size_t buf_memsize = xtimes (buf_neededlength, sizeof (CHAR_T));
++	if (size_overflow_p (buf_memsize))
++	  goto out_of_memory_1;
++	buf = (CHAR_T *) malloc (buf_memsize);
++	if (buf == NULL)
++	  goto out_of_memory_1;
++	buf_malloced = buf;
++      }
++
++    if (resultbuf != NULL)
++      {
++	result = resultbuf;
++	allocated = *lengthp;
++      }
++    else
++      {
++	result = NULL;
++	allocated = 0;
++      }
++    length = 0;
++    /* Invariants:
++       result is either == resultbuf or == NULL or malloc-allocated.
++       If length > 0, then result != NULL.  */
++
++    /* Ensures that allocated >= needed.  Aborts through a jump to
++       out_of_memory if needed is SIZE_MAX or otherwise too big.  */
++#define ENSURE_ALLOCATION(needed) \
++    if ((needed) > allocated)						     \
++      {									     \
++	size_t memory_size;						     \
++	CHAR_T *memory;							     \
++									     \
++	allocated = (allocated > 0 ? xtimes (allocated, 2) : 12);	     \
++	if ((needed) > allocated)					     \
++	  allocated = (needed);						     \
++	memory_size = xtimes (allocated, sizeof (CHAR_T));		     \
++	if (size_overflow_p (memory_size))				     \
++	  goto out_of_memory;						     \
++	if (result == resultbuf || result == NULL)			     \
++	  memory = (CHAR_T *) malloc (memory_size);			     \
++	else								     \
++	  memory = (CHAR_T *) realloc (result, memory_size);		     \
++	if (memory == NULL)						     \
++	  goto out_of_memory;						     \
++	if (result == resultbuf && length > 0)				     \
++	  memcpy (memory, result, length * sizeof (CHAR_T));		     \
++	result = memory;						     \
++      }
++
++    for (cp = format, i = 0, dp = &d.dir[0]; ; cp = dp->dir_end, i++, dp++)
++      {
++	if (cp != dp->dir_start)
++	  {
++	    size_t n = dp->dir_start - cp;
++	    size_t augmented_length = xsum (length, n);
++
++	    ENSURE_ALLOCATION (augmented_length);
++	    memcpy (result + length, cp, n * sizeof (CHAR_T));
++	    length = augmented_length;
++	  }
++	if (i == d.count)
++	  break;
++
++	/* Execute a single directive.  */
++	if (dp->conversion == '%')
++	  {
++	    size_t augmented_length;
++
++	    if (!(dp->arg_index == ARG_NONE))
++	      abort ();
++	    augmented_length = xsum (length, 1);
++	    ENSURE_ALLOCATION (augmented_length);
++	    result[length] = '%';
++	    length = augmented_length;
++	  }
++	else
++	  {
++	    if (!(dp->arg_index != ARG_NONE))
++	      abort ();
++
++	    if (dp->conversion == 'n')
++	      {
++		switch (a.arg[dp->arg_index].type)
++		  {
++		  case TYPE_COUNT_SCHAR_POINTER:
++		    *a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_count_schar_pointer = length;
++		    break;
++		  case TYPE_COUNT_SHORT_POINTER:
++		    *a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_count_short_pointer = length;
++		    break;
++		  case TYPE_COUNT_INT_POINTER:
++		    *a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_count_int_pointer = length;
++		    break;
++		  case TYPE_COUNT_LONGINT_POINTER:
++		    *a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_count_longint_pointer = length;
++		    break;
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
++		  case TYPE_COUNT_LONGLONGINT_POINTER:
++		    *a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_count_longlongint_pointer = length;
++		    break;
++#endif
++		  default:
++		    abort ();
++		  }
++	      }
++	    else
++	      {
++		arg_type type = a.arg[dp->arg_index].type;
++		CHAR_T *p;
++		unsigned int prefix_count;
++		int prefixes[2];
++#if !USE_SNPRINTF
++		size_t tmp_length;
++		CHAR_T tmpbuf[700];
++		CHAR_T *tmp;
++
++		/* Allocate a temporary buffer of sufficient size for calling
++		   sprintf.  */
++		{
++		  size_t width;
++		  size_t precision;
++
++		  width = 0;
++		  if (dp->width_start != dp->width_end)
++		    {
++		      if (dp->width_arg_index != ARG_NONE)
++			{
++			  int arg;
++
++			  if (!(a.arg[dp->width_arg_index].type == TYPE_INT))
++			    abort ();
++			  arg = a.arg[dp->width_arg_index].a.a_int;
++			  width = (arg < 0 ? (unsigned int) (-arg) : arg);
++			}
++		      else
++			{
++			  const CHAR_T *digitp = dp->width_start;
++
++			  do
++			    width = xsum (xtimes (width, 10), *digitp++ - '0');
++			  while (digitp != dp->width_end);
++			}
++		    }
++
++		  precision = 6;
++		  if (dp->precision_start != dp->precision_end)
++		    {
++		      if (dp->precision_arg_index != ARG_NONE)
++			{
++			  int arg;
++
++			  if (!(a.arg[dp->precision_arg_index].type == TYPE_INT))
++			    abort ();
++			  arg = a.arg[dp->precision_arg_index].a.a_int;
++			  precision = (arg < 0 ? 0 : arg);
++			}
++		      else
++			{
++			  const CHAR_T *digitp = dp->precision_start + 1;
++
++			  precision = 0;
++			  do
++			    precision = xsum (xtimes (precision, 10), *digitp++ - '0');
++			  while (digitp != dp->precision_end);
++			}
++		    }
++
++		  switch (dp->conversion)
++		    {
++
++		    case 'd': case 'i': case 'u':
++# ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
++		      if (type == TYPE_LONGLONGINT || type == TYPE_ULONGLONGINT)
++			tmp_length =
++			  (unsigned int) (sizeof (unsigned long long) * CHAR_BIT
++					  * 0.30103 /* binary -> decimal */
++					  * 2 /* estimate for FLAG_GROUP */
++					 )
++			  + 1 /* turn floor into ceil */
++			  + 1; /* account for leading sign */
++		      else
++# endif
++		      if (type == TYPE_LONGINT || type == TYPE_ULONGINT)
++			tmp_length =
++			  (unsigned int) (sizeof (unsigned long) * CHAR_BIT
++					  * 0.30103 /* binary -> decimal */
++					  * 2 /* estimate for FLAG_GROUP */
++					 )
++			  + 1 /* turn floor into ceil */
++			  + 1; /* account for leading sign */
++		      else
++			tmp_length =
++			  (unsigned int) (sizeof (unsigned int) * CHAR_BIT
++					  * 0.30103 /* binary -> decimal */
++					  * 2 /* estimate for FLAG_GROUP */
++					 )
++			  + 1 /* turn floor into ceil */
++			  + 1; /* account for leading sign */
++		      break;
++
++		    case 'o':
++# ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
++		      if (type == TYPE_LONGLONGINT || type == TYPE_ULONGLONGINT)
++			tmp_length =
++			  (unsigned int) (sizeof (unsigned long long) * CHAR_BIT
++					  * 0.333334 /* binary -> octal */
++					 )
++			  + 1 /* turn floor into ceil */
++			  + 1; /* account for leading sign */
++		      else
++# endif
++		      if (type == TYPE_LONGINT || type == TYPE_ULONGINT)
++			tmp_length =
++			  (unsigned int) (sizeof (unsigned long) * CHAR_BIT
++					  * 0.333334 /* binary -> octal */
++					 )
++			  + 1 /* turn floor into ceil */
++			  + 1; /* account for leading sign */
++		      else
++			tmp_length =
++			  (unsigned int) (sizeof (unsigned int) * CHAR_BIT
++					  * 0.333334 /* binary -> octal */
++					 )
++			  + 1 /* turn floor into ceil */
++			  + 1; /* account for leading sign */
++		      break;
++
++		    case 'x': case 'X':
++# ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
++		      if (type == TYPE_LONGLONGINT || type == TYPE_ULONGLONGINT)
++			tmp_length =
++			  (unsigned int) (sizeof (unsigned long long) * CHAR_BIT
++					  * 0.25 /* binary -> hexadecimal */
++					 )
++			  + 1 /* turn floor into ceil */
++			  + 2; /* account for leading sign or alternate form */
++		      else
++# endif
++		      if (type == TYPE_LONGINT || type == TYPE_ULONGINT)
++			tmp_length =
++			  (unsigned int) (sizeof (unsigned long) * CHAR_BIT
++					  * 0.25 /* binary -> hexadecimal */
++					 )
++			  + 1 /* turn floor into ceil */
++			  + 2; /* account for leading sign or alternate form */
++		      else
++			tmp_length =
++			  (unsigned int) (sizeof (unsigned int) * CHAR_BIT
++					  * 0.25 /* binary -> hexadecimal */
++					 )
++			  + 1 /* turn floor into ceil */
++			  + 2; /* account for leading sign or alternate form */
++		      break;
++
++		    case 'f': case 'F':
++# ifdef HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE
++		      if (type == TYPE_LONGDOUBLE)
++			tmp_length =
++			  (unsigned int) (LDBL_MAX_EXP
++					  * 0.30103 /* binary -> decimal */
++					  * 2 /* estimate for FLAG_GROUP */
++					 )
++			  + 1 /* turn floor into ceil */
++			  + 10; /* sign, decimal point etc. */
++		      else
++# endif
++			tmp_length =
++			  (unsigned int) (DBL_MAX_EXP
++					  * 0.30103 /* binary -> decimal */
++					  * 2 /* estimate for FLAG_GROUP */
++					 )
++			  + 1 /* turn floor into ceil */
++			  + 10; /* sign, decimal point etc. */
++		      tmp_length = xsum (tmp_length, precision);
++		      break;
++
++		    case 'e': case 'E': case 'g': case 'G':
++		    case 'a': case 'A':
++		      tmp_length =
++			12; /* sign, decimal point, exponent etc. */
++		      tmp_length = xsum (tmp_length, precision);
++		      break;
++
++		    case 'c':
++# if defined HAVE_WINT_T && !WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
++		      if (type == TYPE_WIDE_CHAR)
++			tmp_length = MB_CUR_MAX;
++		      else
++# endif
++			tmp_length = 1;
++		      break;
++
++		    case 's':
++# ifdef HAVE_WCHAR_T
++		      if (type == TYPE_WIDE_STRING)
++			{
++			  tmp_length =
++			    local_wcslen (a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_wide_string);
++
++#  if !WIDE_CHAR_VERSION
++			  tmp_length = xtimes (tmp_length, MB_CUR_MAX);
++#  endif
++			}
++		      else
++# endif
++			tmp_length = strlen (a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_string);
++		      break;
++
++		    case 'p':
++		      tmp_length =
++			(unsigned int) (sizeof (void *) * CHAR_BIT
++					* 0.25 /* binary -> hexadecimal */
++				       )
++			  + 1 /* turn floor into ceil */
++			  + 2; /* account for leading 0x */
++		      break;
++
++		    default:
++		      abort ();
++		    }
++
++		  if (tmp_length < width)
++		    tmp_length = width;
++
++		  tmp_length = xsum (tmp_length, 1); /* account for trailing NUL */
++		}
++
++		if (tmp_length <= sizeof (tmpbuf) / sizeof (CHAR_T))
++		  tmp = tmpbuf;
++		else
++		  {
++		    size_t tmp_memsize = xtimes (tmp_length, sizeof (CHAR_T));
++
++		    if (size_overflow_p (tmp_memsize))
++		      /* Overflow, would lead to out of memory.  */
++		      goto out_of_memory;
++		    tmp = (CHAR_T *) malloc (tmp_memsize);
++		    if (tmp == NULL)
++		      /* Out of memory.  */
++		      goto out_of_memory;
++		  }
++#endif
++
++		/* Construct the format string for calling snprintf or
++		   sprintf.  */
++		p = buf;
++		*p++ = '%';
++		if (dp->flags & FLAG_GROUP)
++		  *p++ = '\'';
++		if (dp->flags & FLAG_LEFT)
++		  *p++ = '-';
++		if (dp->flags & FLAG_SHOWSIGN)
++		  *p++ = '+';
++		if (dp->flags & FLAG_SPACE)
++		  *p++ = ' ';
++		if (dp->flags & FLAG_ALT)
++		  *p++ = '#';
++		if (dp->flags & FLAG_ZERO)
++		  *p++ = '0';
++		if (dp->width_start != dp->width_end)
++		  {
++		    size_t n = dp->width_end - dp->width_start;
++		    memcpy (p, dp->width_start, n * sizeof (CHAR_T));
++		    p += n;
++		  }
++		if (dp->precision_start != dp->precision_end)
++		  {
++		    size_t n = dp->precision_end - dp->precision_start;
++		    memcpy (p, dp->precision_start, n * sizeof (CHAR_T));
++		    p += n;
++		  }
++
++		switch (type)
++		  {
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
++		  case TYPE_LONGLONGINT:
++		  case TYPE_ULONGLONGINT:
++		    *p++ = 'l';
++		    /*FALLTHROUGH*/
++#endif
++		  case TYPE_LONGINT:
++		  case TYPE_ULONGINT:
++#ifdef HAVE_WINT_T
++		  case TYPE_WIDE_CHAR:
++#endif
++#ifdef HAVE_WCHAR_T
++		  case TYPE_WIDE_STRING:
++#endif
++		    *p++ = 'l';
++		    break;
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE
++		  case TYPE_LONGDOUBLE:
++		    *p++ = 'L';
++		    break;
++#endif
++		  default:
++		    break;
++		  }
++		*p = dp->conversion;
++#if USE_SNPRINTF
++		p[1] = '%';
++		p[2] = 'n';
++		p[3] = '\0';
++#else
++		p[1] = '\0';
++#endif
++
++		/* Construct the arguments for calling snprintf or sprintf.  */
++		prefix_count = 0;
++		if (dp->width_arg_index != ARG_NONE)
++		  {
++		    if (!(a.arg[dp->width_arg_index].type == TYPE_INT))
++		      abort ();
++		    prefixes[prefix_count++] = a.arg[dp->width_arg_index].a.a_int;
++		  }
++		if (dp->precision_arg_index != ARG_NONE)
++		  {
++		    if (!(a.arg[dp->precision_arg_index].type == TYPE_INT))
++		      abort ();
++		    prefixes[prefix_count++] = a.arg[dp->precision_arg_index].a.a_int;
++		  }
++
++#if USE_SNPRINTF
++		/* Prepare checking whether snprintf returns the count
++		   via %n.  */
++		ENSURE_ALLOCATION (xsum (length, 1));
++		result[length] = '\0';
++#endif
++
++		for (;;)
++		  {
++		    size_t maxlen;
++		    int count;
++		    int retcount;
++
++		    maxlen = allocated - length;
++		    count = -1;
++		    retcount = 0;
++
++#if USE_SNPRINTF
++# define SNPRINTF_BUF(arg) \
++		    switch (prefix_count)				    \
++		      {							    \
++		      case 0:						    \
++			retcount = SNPRINTF (result + length, maxlen, buf,  \
++					     arg, &count);		    \
++			break;						    \
++		      case 1:						    \
++			retcount = SNPRINTF (result + length, maxlen, buf,  \
++					     prefixes[0], arg, &count);	    \
++			break;						    \
++		      case 2:						    \
++			retcount = SNPRINTF (result + length, maxlen, buf,  \
++					     prefixes[0], prefixes[1], arg, \
++					     &count);			    \
++			break;						    \
++		      default:						    \
++			abort ();					    \
++		      }
++#else
++# define SNPRINTF_BUF(arg) \
++		    switch (prefix_count)				    \
++		      {							    \
++		      case 0:						    \
++			count = sprintf (tmp, buf, arg);		    \
++			break;						    \
++		      case 1:						    \
++			count = sprintf (tmp, buf, prefixes[0], arg);	    \
++			break;						    \
++		      case 2:						    \
++			count = sprintf (tmp, buf, prefixes[0], prefixes[1],\
++					 arg);				    \
++			break;						    \
++		      default:						    \
++			abort ();					    \
++		      }
++#endif
++
++		    switch (type)
++		      {
++		      case TYPE_SCHAR:
++			{
++			  int arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_schar;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++		      case TYPE_UCHAR:
++			{
++			  unsigned int arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_uchar;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++		      case TYPE_SHORT:
++			{
++			  int arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_short;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++		      case TYPE_USHORT:
++			{
++			  unsigned int arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_ushort;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++		      case TYPE_INT:
++			{
++			  int arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_int;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++		      case TYPE_UINT:
++			{
++			  unsigned int arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_uint;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++		      case TYPE_LONGINT:
++			{
++			  long int arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_longint;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++		      case TYPE_ULONGINT:
++			{
++			  unsigned long int arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_ulongint;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_LONG
++		      case TYPE_LONGLONGINT:
++			{
++			  long long int arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_longlongint;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++		      case TYPE_ULONGLONGINT:
++			{
++			  unsigned long long int arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_ulonglongint;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++#endif
++		      case TYPE_DOUBLE:
++			{
++			  double arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_double;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++#ifdef HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE
++		      case TYPE_LONGDOUBLE:
++			{
++			  long double arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_longdouble;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++#endif
++		      case TYPE_CHAR:
++			{
++			  int arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_char;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++#ifdef HAVE_WINT_T
++		      case TYPE_WIDE_CHAR:
++			{
++			  wint_t arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_wide_char;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++#endif
++		      case TYPE_STRING:
++			{
++			  const char *arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_string;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++#ifdef HAVE_WCHAR_T
++		      case TYPE_WIDE_STRING:
++			{
++			  const wchar_t *arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_wide_string;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++#endif
++		      case TYPE_POINTER:
++			{
++			  void *arg = a.arg[dp->arg_index].a.a_pointer;
++			  SNPRINTF_BUF (arg);
++			}
++			break;
++		      default:
++			abort ();
++		      }
++
++#if USE_SNPRINTF
++		    /* Portability: Not all implementations of snprintf()
++		       are ISO C 99 compliant.  Determine the number of
++		       bytes that snprintf() has produced or would have
++		       produced.  */
++		    if (count >= 0)
++		      {
++			/* Verify that snprintf() has NUL-terminated its
++			   result.  */
++			if (count < maxlen && result[length + count] != '\0')
++			  abort ();
++			/* Portability hack.  */
++			if (retcount > count)
++			  count = retcount;
++		      }
++		    else
++		      {
++			/* snprintf() doesn't understand the '%n'
++			   directive.  */
++			if (p[1] != '\0')
++			  {
++			    /* Don't use the '%n' directive; instead, look
++			       at the snprintf() return value.  */
++			    p[1] = '\0';
++			    continue;
++			  }
++			else
++			  {
++			    /* Look at the snprintf() return value.  */
++			    if (retcount < 0)
++			      {
++				/* HP-UX 10.20 snprintf() is doubly deficient:
++				   It doesn't understand the '%n' directive,
++				   *and* it returns -1 (rather than the length
++				   that would have been required) when the
++				   buffer is too small.  */
++				size_t bigger_need =
++				  xsum (xtimes (allocated, 2), 12);
++				ENSURE_ALLOCATION (bigger_need);
++				continue;
++			      }
++			    else
++			      count = retcount;
++			  }
++		      }
++#endif
++
++		    /* Attempt to handle failure.  */
++		    if (count < 0)
++		      {
++			if (!(result == resultbuf || result == NULL))
++			  free (result);
++			if (buf_malloced != NULL)
++			  free (buf_malloced);
++			CLEANUP ();
++			errno = EINVAL;
++			return NULL;
++		      }
++
++#if !USE_SNPRINTF
++		    if (count >= tmp_length)
++		      /* tmp_length was incorrectly calculated - fix the
++			 code above!  */
++		      abort ();
++#endif
++
++		    /* Make room for the result.  */
++		    if (count >= maxlen)
++		      {
++			/* Need at least count bytes.  But allocate
++			   proportionally, to avoid looping eternally if
++			   snprintf() reports a too small count.  */
++			size_t n =
++			  xmax (xsum (length, count), xtimes (allocated, 2));
++
++			ENSURE_ALLOCATION (n);
++#if USE_SNPRINTF
++			continue;
++#endif
++		      }
++
++#if USE_SNPRINTF
++		    /* The snprintf() result did fit.  */
++#else
++		    /* Append the sprintf() result.  */
++		    memcpy (result + length, tmp, count * sizeof (CHAR_T));
++		    if (tmp != tmpbuf)
++		      free (tmp);
++#endif
++
++		    length += count;
++		    break;
++		  }
++	      }
++	  }
++      }
++
++    /* Add the final NUL.  */
++    ENSURE_ALLOCATION (xsum (length, 1));
++    result[length] = '\0';
++
++    if (result != resultbuf && length + 1 < allocated)
++      {
++	/* Shrink the allocated memory if possible.  */
++	CHAR_T *memory;
++
++	memory = (CHAR_T *) realloc (result, (length + 1) * sizeof (CHAR_T));
++	if (memory != NULL)
++	  result = memory;
++      }
++
++    if (buf_malloced != NULL)
++      free (buf_malloced);
++    CLEANUP ();
++    *lengthp = length;
++    return result;
++
++  out_of_memory:
++    if (!(result == resultbuf || result == NULL))
++      free (result);
++    if (buf_malloced != NULL)
++      free (buf_malloced);
++  out_of_memory_1:
++    CLEANUP ();
++    errno = ENOMEM;
++    return NULL;
++  }
++}
++
++#undef SNPRINTF
++#undef USE_SNPRINTF
++#undef PRINTF_PARSE
++#undef DIRECTIVES
++#undef DIRECTIVE
++#undef CHAR_T
++#undef VASNPRINTF
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/vasnprintf.h	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/vasnprintf.h	2004-09-12 14:40:34.667700664 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,61 @@
++/* vsprintf with automatic memory allocation.
++   Copyright (C) 2002-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifndef _VASNPRINTF_H
++#define _VASNPRINTF_H
++
++/* Get va_list.  */
++#include <stdarg.h>
++
++/* Get size_t.  */
++#include <stddef.h>
++
++#ifndef __attribute__
++/* This feature is available in gcc versions 2.5 and later.  */
++# if __GNUC__ < 2 || (__GNUC__ == 2 && __GNUC_MINOR__ < 5) || __STRICT_ANSI__
++#  define __attribute__(Spec) /* empty */
++# endif
++/* The __-protected variants of `format' and `printf' attributes
++   are accepted by gcc versions 2.6.4 (effectively 2.7) and later.  */
++# if __GNUC__ < 2 || (__GNUC__ == 2 && __GNUC_MINOR__ < 7)
++#  define __format__ format
++#  define __printf__ printf
++# endif
++#endif
++
++#ifdef	__cplusplus
++extern "C" {
++#endif
++
++/* Write formatted output to a string dynamically allocated with malloc().
++   You can pass a preallocated buffer for the result in RESULTBUF and its
++   size in *LENGTHP; otherwise you pass RESULTBUF = NULL.
++   If successful, return the address of the string (this may be = RESULTBUF
++   if no dynamic memory allocation was necessary) and set *LENGTHP to the
++   number of resulting bytes, excluding the trailing NUL.  Upon error, set
++   errno and return NULL.  */
++extern char * asnprintf (char *resultbuf, size_t *lengthp, const char *format, ...)
++       __attribute__ ((__format__ (__printf__, 3, 4)));
++extern char * vasnprintf (char *resultbuf, size_t *lengthp, const char *format, va_list args)
++       __attribute__ ((__format__ (__printf__, 3, 0)));
++
++#ifdef	__cplusplus
++}
++#endif
++
++#endif /* _VASNPRINTF_H */
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/vasnwprintf.h	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/vasnwprintf.h	2004-09-12 14:40:34.673699752 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,46 @@
++/* vswprintf with automatic memory allocation.
++   Copyright (C) 2002-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifndef _VASNWPRINTF_H
++#define _VASNWPRINTF_H
++
++/* Get va_list.  */
++#include <stdarg.h>
++
++/* Get wchar_t, size_t.  */
++#include <stddef.h>
++
++#ifdef	__cplusplus
++extern "C" {
++#endif
++
++/* Write formatted output to a string dynamically allocated with malloc().
++   You can pass a preallocated buffer for the result in RESULTBUF and its
++   size in *LENGTHP; otherwise you pass RESULTBUF = NULL.
++   If successful, return the address of the string (this may be = RESULTBUF
++   if no dynamic memory allocation was necessary) and set *LENGTHP to the
++   number of resulting bytes, excluding the trailing NUL.  Upon error, set
++   errno and return NULL.  */
++extern wchar_t * asnwprintf (wchar_t *resultbuf, size_t *lengthp, const wchar_t *format, ...);
++extern wchar_t * vasnwprintf (wchar_t *resultbuf, size_t *lengthp, const wchar_t *format, va_list args);
++
++#ifdef	__cplusplus
++}
++#endif
++
++#endif /* _VASNWPRINTF_H */
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/VERSION	1998-04-26 09:22:37.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/VERSION	2004-09-12 14:40:34.679698840 -0400
+@@ -1 +1 @@
+-GNU gettext library from gettext-0.10.32
++GNU gettext library from gettext-0.14.1
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/wprintf-parse.h	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/wprintf-parse.h	2004-09-12 14:40:34.695696408 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,75 @@
++/* Parse printf format string.
++   Copyright (C) 1999, 2002-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifndef _WPRINTF_PARSE_H
++#define _WPRINTF_PARSE_H
++
++#include "printf-args.h"
++
++
++/* Flags */
++#define FLAG_GROUP	 1	/* ' flag */
++#define FLAG_LEFT	 2	/* - flag */
++#define FLAG_SHOWSIGN	 4	/* + flag */
++#define FLAG_SPACE	 8	/* space flag */
++#define FLAG_ALT	16	/* # flag */
++#define FLAG_ZERO	32
++
++/* arg_index value indicating that no argument is consumed.  */
++#define ARG_NONE	(~(size_t)0)
++
++/* A parsed directive.  */
++typedef struct
++{
++  const wchar_t* dir_start;
++  const wchar_t* dir_end;
++  int flags;
++  const wchar_t* width_start;
++  const wchar_t* width_end;
++  size_t width_arg_index;
++  const wchar_t* precision_start;
++  const wchar_t* precision_end;
++  size_t precision_arg_index;
++  wchar_t conversion; /* d i o u x X f e E g G c s p n U % but not C S */
++  size_t arg_index;
++}
++wchar_t_directive;
++
++/* A parsed format string.  */
++typedef struct
++{
++  size_t count;
++  wchar_t_directive *dir;
++  size_t max_width_length;
++  size_t max_precision_length;
++}
++wchar_t_directives;
++
++
++/* Parses the format string.  Fills in the number N of directives, and fills
++   in directives[0], ..., directives[N-1], and sets directives[N].dir_start
++   to the end of the format string.  Also fills in the arg_type fields of the
++   arguments and the needed count of arguments.  */
++#ifdef STATIC
++STATIC
++#else
++extern
++#endif
++int wprintf_parse (const wchar_t *format, wchar_t_directives *d, arguments *a);
++
++#endif /* _WPRINTF_PARSE_H */
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/xopen-msg.sed	1998-04-26 09:20:52.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/xopen-msg.sed	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
+@@ -1,104 +0,0 @@
+-# po2msg.sed - Convert Uniforum style .po file to X/Open style .msg file
+-# Copyright (C) 1995 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+-# Ulrich Drepper <drepper@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1995.
+-#
+-# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+-# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+-# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+-# any later version.
+-#
+-# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+-# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+-# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the
+-# GNU General Public License for more details.
+-#
+-# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+-# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+-# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
+-#
+-#
+-# The first directive in the .msg should be the definition of the
+-# message set number.  We use always set number 1.
+-#
+-1 {
+-  i\
+-$set 1 # Automatically created by po2msg.sed
+-  h
+-  s/.*/0/
+-  x
+-}
+-#
+-# We copy all comments into the .msg file.  Perhaps they can help.
+-#
+-/^#/ s/^#[ 	]*/$ /p
+-#
+-# We copy the original message as a comment into the .msg file.
+-#
+-/^msgid/ {
+-# Does not work now
+-#  /"$/! {
+-#    s/\\$//
+-#    s/$/ ... (more lines following)"/
+-#  }
+-  s/^msgid[ 	]*"\(.*\)"$/$ Original Message: \1/
+-  p
+-}
+-#
+-# The .msg file contains, other then the .po file, only the translations
+-# but each given a unique ID.  Starting from 1 and incrementing by 1 for
+-# each message we assign them to the messages.
+-# It is important that the .po file used to generate the cat-id-tbl.c file
+-# (with po-to-tbl) is the same as the one used here.  (At least the order
+-# of declarations must not be changed.)
+-#
+-/^msgstr/ {
+-  s/msgstr[ 	]*"\(.*\)"/\1/
+-  x
+-# The following nice solution is by
+-# Bruno <Haible@ma2s2.mathematik.uni-karlsruhe.de>
+-  td
+-# Increment a decimal number in pattern space.
+-# First hide trailing `9' digits.
+-  :d
+-  s/9\(_*\)$/_\1/
+-  td
+-# Assure at least one digit is available.
+-  s/^\(_*\)$/0\1/
+-# Increment the last digit.
+-  s/8\(_*\)$/9\1/
+-  s/7\(_*\)$/8\1/
+-  s/6\(_*\)$/7\1/
+-  s/5\(_*\)$/6\1/
+-  s/4\(_*\)$/5\1/
+-  s/3\(_*\)$/4\1/
+-  s/2\(_*\)$/3\1/
+-  s/1\(_*\)$/2\1/
+-  s/0\(_*\)$/1\1/
+-# Convert the hidden `9' digits to `0's.
+-  s/_/0/g
+-  x
+-# Bring the line in the format `<number> <message>'
+-  G
+-  s/^[^\n]*$/& /
+-  s/\(.*\)\n\([0-9]*\)/\2 \1/
+-# Clear flag from last substitution.
+-  tb
+-# Append the next line.
+-  :b
+-  N
+-# Look whether second part is a continuation line.
+-  s/\(.*\n\)"\(.*\)"/\1\2/
+-# Yes, then branch.
+-  ta
+-  P
+-  D
+-# Note that `D' includes a jump to the start!!
+-# We found a continuation line.  But before printing insert '\'.
+-  :a
+-  s/\(.*\)\(\n.*\)/\1\\\2/
+-  P
+-# We cannot use the sed command `D' here
+-  s/.*\n\(.*\)/\1/
+-  tb
+-}
+-d
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/intl/xsize.h	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/intl/xsize.h	2004-09-12 14:40:34.700695648 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,109 @@
++/* xsize.h -- Checked size_t computations.
++
++   Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++   This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
++   under the terms of the GNU Library General Public License as published
++   by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
++   any later version.
++
++   This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
++   but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
++   MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU
++   Library General Public License for more details.
++
++   You should have received a copy of the GNU Library General Public
++   License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
++   Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307,
++   USA.  */
++
++#ifndef _XSIZE_H
++#define _XSIZE_H
++
++/* Get size_t.  */
++#include <stddef.h>
++
++/* Get SIZE_MAX.  */
++#include <limits.h>
++#if HAVE_STDINT_H
++# include <stdint.h>
++#endif
++
++/* The size of memory objects is often computed through expressions of
++   type size_t. Example:
++      void* p = malloc (header_size + n * element_size).
++   These computations can lead to overflow.  When this happens, malloc()
++   returns a piece of memory that is way too small, and the program then
++   crashes while attempting to fill the memory.
++   To avoid this, the functions and macros in this file check for overflow.
++   The convention is that SIZE_MAX represents overflow.
++   malloc (SIZE_MAX) is not guaranteed to fail -- think of a malloc
++   implementation that uses mmap --, it's recommended to use size_overflow_p()
++   or size_in_bounds_p() before invoking malloc().
++   The example thus becomes:
++      size_t size = xsum (header_size, xtimes (n, element_size));
++      void *p = (size_in_bounds_p (size) ? malloc (size) : NULL);
++*/
++
++/* Convert an arbitrary value >= 0 to type size_t.  */
++#define xcast_size_t(N) \
++  ((N) <= SIZE_MAX ? (size_t) (N) : SIZE_MAX)
++
++/* Sum of two sizes, with overflow check.  */
++static inline size_t
++#if __GNUC__ >= 3
++__attribute__ ((__pure__))
++#endif
++xsum (size_t size1, size_t size2)
++{
++  size_t sum = size1 + size2;
++  return (sum >= size1 ? sum : SIZE_MAX);
++}
++
++/* Sum of three sizes, with overflow check.  */
++static inline size_t
++#if __GNUC__ >= 3
++__attribute__ ((__pure__))
++#endif
++xsum3 (size_t size1, size_t size2, size_t size3)
++{
++  return xsum (xsum (size1, size2), size3);
++}
++
++/* Sum of four sizes, with overflow check.  */
++static inline size_t
++#if __GNUC__ >= 3
++__attribute__ ((__pure__))
++#endif
++xsum4 (size_t size1, size_t size2, size_t size3, size_t size4)
++{
++  return xsum (xsum (xsum (size1, size2), size3), size4);
++}
++
++/* Maximum of two sizes, with overflow check.  */
++static inline size_t
++#if __GNUC__ >= 3
++__attribute__ ((__pure__))
++#endif
++xmax (size_t size1, size_t size2)
++{
++  /* No explicit check is needed here, because for any n:
++     max (SIZE_MAX, n) == SIZE_MAX and max (n, SIZE_MAX) == SIZE_MAX.  */
++  return (size1 >= size2 ? size1 : size2);
++}
++
++/* Multiplication of a count with an element size, with overflow check.
++   The count must be >= 0 and the element size must be > 0.
++   This is a macro, not an inline function, so that it works correctly even
++   when N is of a wider tupe and N > SIZE_MAX.  */
++#define xtimes(N, ELSIZE) \
++  ((N) <= SIZE_MAX / (ELSIZE) ? (size_t) (N) * (ELSIZE) : SIZE_MAX)
++
++/* Check for overflow.  */
++#define size_overflow_p(SIZE) \
++  ((SIZE) == SIZE_MAX)
++/* Check against overflow.  */
++#define size_in_bounds_p(SIZE) \
++  ((SIZE) != SIZE_MAX)
++
++#endif /* _XSIZE_H */
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/ChangeLog	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/ChangeLog	2004-09-12 14:40:35.054641840 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,32 @@
++2004-09-12  gettextize  <bug-gnu-gettext@gnu.org>
++
++	* codeset.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* gettext.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* glibc21.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* iconv.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* intdiv0.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* intmax.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* inttypes.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* inttypes_h.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* inttypes-pri.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* isc-posix.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* lcmessage.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* lib-ld.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* lib-link.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* lib-prefix.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* longdouble.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* longlong.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* nls.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* po.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* printf-posix.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* progtest.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* signed.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* size_max.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* stdint_h.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* uintmax_t.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* ulonglong.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* wchar_t.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* wint_t.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* xsize.m4: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* Makefile.am: New file.
++
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/codeset.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/codeset.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.820677408 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,23 @@
++# codeset.m4 serial AM1 (gettext-0.10.40)
++dnl Copyright (C) 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Bruno Haible.
++
++AC_DEFUN([AM_LANGINFO_CODESET],
++[
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([for nl_langinfo and CODESET], am_cv_langinfo_codeset,
++    [AC_TRY_LINK([#include <langinfo.h>],
++      [char* cs = nl_langinfo(CODESET);],
++      am_cv_langinfo_codeset=yes,
++      am_cv_langinfo_codeset=no)
++    ])
++  if test $am_cv_langinfo_codeset = yes; then
++    AC_DEFINE(HAVE_LANGINFO_CODESET, 1,
++      [Define if you have <langinfo.h> and nl_langinfo(CODESET).])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/gettext.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/gettext.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.826676496 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,487 @@
++# gettext.m4 serial 28 (gettext-0.13)
++dnl Copyright (C) 1995-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++dnl
++dnl This file can can be used in projects which are not available under
++dnl the GNU General Public License or the GNU Library General Public
++dnl License but which still want to provide support for the GNU gettext
++dnl functionality.
++dnl Please note that the actual code of the GNU gettext library is covered
++dnl by the GNU Library General Public License, and the rest of the GNU
++dnl gettext package package is covered by the GNU General Public License.
++dnl They are *not* in the public domain.
++
++dnl Authors:
++dnl   Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995-2000.
++dnl   Bruno Haible <haible@clisp.cons.org>, 2000-2003.
++
++dnl Macro to add for using GNU gettext.
++
++dnl Usage: AM_GNU_GETTEXT([INTLSYMBOL], [NEEDSYMBOL], [INTLDIR]).
++dnl INTLSYMBOL can be one of 'external', 'no-libtool', 'use-libtool'. The
++dnl    default (if it is not specified or empty) is 'no-libtool'.
++dnl    INTLSYMBOL should be 'external' for packages with no intl directory,
++dnl    and 'no-libtool' or 'use-libtool' for packages with an intl directory.
++dnl    If INTLSYMBOL is 'use-libtool', then a libtool library
++dnl    $(top_builddir)/intl/libintl.la will be created (shared and/or static,
++dnl    depending on --{enable,disable}-{shared,static} and on the presence of
++dnl    AM-DISABLE-SHARED). If INTLSYMBOL is 'no-libtool', a static library
++dnl    $(top_builddir)/intl/libintl.a will be created.
++dnl If NEEDSYMBOL is specified and is 'need-ngettext', then GNU gettext
++dnl    implementations (in libc or libintl) without the ngettext() function
++dnl    will be ignored.  If NEEDSYMBOL is specified and is
++dnl    'need-formatstring-macros', then GNU gettext implementations that don't
++dnl    support the ISO C 99 <inttypes.h> formatstring macros will be ignored.
++dnl INTLDIR is used to find the intl libraries.  If empty,
++dnl    the value `$(top_builddir)/intl/' is used.
++dnl
++dnl The result of the configuration is one of three cases:
++dnl 1) GNU gettext, as included in the intl subdirectory, will be compiled
++dnl    and used.
++dnl    Catalog format: GNU --> install in $(datadir)
++dnl    Catalog extension: .mo after installation, .gmo in source tree
++dnl 2) GNU gettext has been found in the system's C library.
++dnl    Catalog format: GNU --> install in $(datadir)
++dnl    Catalog extension: .mo after installation, .gmo in source tree
++dnl 3) No internationalization, always use English msgid.
++dnl    Catalog format: none
++dnl    Catalog extension: none
++dnl If INTLSYMBOL is 'external', only cases 2 and 3 can occur.
++dnl The use of .gmo is historical (it was needed to avoid overwriting the
++dnl GNU format catalogs when building on a platform with an X/Open gettext),
++dnl but we keep it in order not to force irrelevant filename changes on the
++dnl maintainers.
++dnl
++AC_DEFUN([AM_GNU_GETTEXT],
++[
++  dnl Argument checking.
++  ifelse([$1], [], , [ifelse([$1], [external], , [ifelse([$1], [no-libtool], , [ifelse([$1], [use-libtool], ,
++    [errprint([ERROR: invalid first argument to AM_GNU_GETTEXT
++])])])])])
++  ifelse([$2], [], , [ifelse([$2], [need-ngettext], , [ifelse([$2], [need-formatstring-macros], ,
++    [errprint([ERROR: invalid second argument to AM_GNU_GETTEXT
++])])])])
++  define(gt_included_intl, ifelse([$1], [external], [no], [yes]))
++  define(gt_libtool_suffix_prefix, ifelse([$1], [use-libtool], [l], []))
++
++  AC_REQUIRE([AM_PO_SUBDIRS])dnl
++  ifelse(gt_included_intl, yes, [
++    AC_REQUIRE([AM_INTL_SUBDIR])dnl
++  ])
++
++  dnl Prerequisites of AC_LIB_LINKFLAGS_BODY.
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_LIB_PREPARE_PREFIX])
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_LIB_RPATH])
++
++  dnl Sometimes libintl requires libiconv, so first search for libiconv.
++  dnl Ideally we would do this search only after the
++  dnl      if test "$USE_NLS" = "yes"; then
++  dnl        if test "$gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc" != "yes"; then
++  dnl tests. But if configure.in invokes AM_ICONV after AM_GNU_GETTEXT
++  dnl the configure script would need to contain the same shell code
++  dnl again, outside any 'if'. There are two solutions:
++  dnl - Invoke AM_ICONV_LINKFLAGS_BODY here, outside any 'if'.
++  dnl - Control the expansions in more detail using AC_PROVIDE_IFELSE.
++  dnl Since AC_PROVIDE_IFELSE is only in autoconf >= 2.52 and not
++  dnl documented, we avoid it.
++  ifelse(gt_included_intl, yes, , [
++    AC_REQUIRE([AM_ICONV_LINKFLAGS_BODY])
++  ])
++
++  dnl Set USE_NLS.
++  AM_NLS
++
++  ifelse(gt_included_intl, yes, [
++    BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=no
++    USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=no
++  ])
++  LIBINTL=
++  LTLIBINTL=
++  POSUB=
++
++  dnl If we use NLS figure out what method
++  if test "$USE_NLS" = "yes"; then
++    gt_use_preinstalled_gnugettext=no
++    ifelse(gt_included_intl, yes, [
++      AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether included gettext is requested])
++      AC_ARG_WITH(included-gettext,
++        [  --with-included-gettext use the GNU gettext library included here],
++        nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext=$withval,
++        nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext=no)
++      AC_MSG_RESULT($nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext)
++
++      nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext="$nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext"
++      if test "$nls_cv_force_use_gnu_gettext" != "yes"; then
++    ])
++        dnl User does not insist on using GNU NLS library.  Figure out what
++        dnl to use.  If GNU gettext is available we use this.  Else we have
++        dnl to fall back to GNU NLS library.
++
++        dnl Add a version number to the cache macros.
++        define([gt_api_version], ifelse([$2], [need-formatstring-macros], 3, ifelse([$2], [need-ngettext], 2, 1)))
++        define([gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc], [gt_cv_func_gnugettext]gt_api_version[_libc])
++        define([gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl], [gt_cv_func_gnugettext]gt_api_version[_libintl])
++
++        AC_CACHE_CHECK([for GNU gettext in libc], gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc,
++         [AC_TRY_LINK([#include <libintl.h>
++]ifelse([$2], [need-formatstring-macros],
++[#ifndef __GNU_GETTEXT_SUPPORTED_REVISION
++#define __GNU_GETTEXT_SUPPORTED_REVISION(major) ((major) == 0 ? 0 : -1)
++#endif
++changequote(,)dnl
++typedef int array [2 * (__GNU_GETTEXT_SUPPORTED_REVISION(0) >= 1) - 1];
++changequote([,])dnl
++], [])[extern int _nl_msg_cat_cntr;
++extern int *_nl_domain_bindings;],
++            [bindtextdomain ("", "");
++return (int) gettext ("")]ifelse([$2], [need-ngettext], [ + (int) ngettext ("", "", 0)], [])[ + _nl_msg_cat_cntr + *_nl_domain_bindings],
++            gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc=yes,
++            gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc=no)])
++
++        if test "$gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc" != "yes"; then
++          dnl Sometimes libintl requires libiconv, so first search for libiconv.
++          ifelse(gt_included_intl, yes, , [
++            AM_ICONV_LINK
++          ])
++          dnl Search for libintl and define LIBINTL, LTLIBINTL and INCINTL
++          dnl accordingly. Don't use AC_LIB_LINKFLAGS_BODY([intl],[iconv])
++          dnl because that would add "-liconv" to LIBINTL and LTLIBINTL
++          dnl even if libiconv doesn't exist.
++          AC_LIB_LINKFLAGS_BODY([intl])
++          AC_CACHE_CHECK([for GNU gettext in libintl],
++            gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl,
++           [gt_save_CPPFLAGS="$CPPFLAGS"
++            CPPFLAGS="$CPPFLAGS $INCINTL"
++            gt_save_LIBS="$LIBS"
++            LIBS="$LIBS $LIBINTL"
++            dnl Now see whether libintl exists and does not depend on libiconv.
++            AC_TRY_LINK([#include <libintl.h>
++]ifelse([$2], [need-formatstring-macros],
++[#ifndef __GNU_GETTEXT_SUPPORTED_REVISION
++#define __GNU_GETTEXT_SUPPORTED_REVISION(major) ((major) == 0 ? 0 : -1)
++#endif
++changequote(,)dnl
++typedef int array [2 * (__GNU_GETTEXT_SUPPORTED_REVISION(0) >= 1) - 1];
++changequote([,])dnl
++], [])[extern int _nl_msg_cat_cntr;
++extern
++#ifdef __cplusplus
++"C"
++#endif
++const char *_nl_expand_alias ();],
++              [bindtextdomain ("", "");
++return (int) gettext ("")]ifelse([$2], [need-ngettext], [ + (int) ngettext ("", "", 0)], [])[ + _nl_msg_cat_cntr + *_nl_expand_alias (0)],
++              gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl=yes,
++              gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl=no)
++            dnl Now see whether libintl exists and depends on libiconv.
++            if test "$gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl" != yes && test -n "$LIBICONV"; then
++              LIBS="$LIBS $LIBICONV"
++              AC_TRY_LINK([#include <libintl.h>
++]ifelse([$2], [need-formatstring-macros],
++[#ifndef __GNU_GETTEXT_SUPPORTED_REVISION
++#define __GNU_GETTEXT_SUPPORTED_REVISION(major) ((major) == 0 ? 0 : -1)
++#endif
++changequote(,)dnl
++typedef int array [2 * (__GNU_GETTEXT_SUPPORTED_REVISION(0) >= 1) - 1];
++changequote([,])dnl
++], [])[extern int _nl_msg_cat_cntr;
++extern
++#ifdef __cplusplus
++"C"
++#endif
++const char *_nl_expand_alias ();],
++                [bindtextdomain ("", "");
++return (int) gettext ("")]ifelse([$2], [need-ngettext], [ + (int) ngettext ("", "", 0)], [])[ + _nl_msg_cat_cntr + *_nl_expand_alias (0)],
++               [LIBINTL="$LIBINTL $LIBICONV"
++                LTLIBINTL="$LTLIBINTL $LTLIBICONV"
++                gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl=yes
++               ])
++            fi
++            CPPFLAGS="$gt_save_CPPFLAGS"
++            LIBS="$gt_save_LIBS"])
++        fi
++
++        dnl If an already present or preinstalled GNU gettext() is found,
++        dnl use it.  But if this macro is used in GNU gettext, and GNU
++        dnl gettext is already preinstalled in libintl, we update this
++        dnl libintl.  (Cf. the install rule in intl/Makefile.in.)
++        if test "$gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libc" = "yes" \
++           || { test "$gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl" = "yes" \
++                && test "$PACKAGE" != gettext-runtime \
++                && test "$PACKAGE" != gettext-tools; }; then
++          gt_use_preinstalled_gnugettext=yes
++        else
++          dnl Reset the values set by searching for libintl.
++          LIBINTL=
++          LTLIBINTL=
++          INCINTL=
++        fi
++
++    ifelse(gt_included_intl, yes, [
++        if test "$gt_use_preinstalled_gnugettext" != "yes"; then
++          dnl GNU gettext is not found in the C library.
++          dnl Fall back on included GNU gettext library.
++          nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext=yes
++        fi
++      fi
++
++      if test "$nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext" = "yes"; then
++        dnl Mark actions used to generate GNU NLS library.
++        BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=yes
++        USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=yes
++        LIBINTL="ifelse([$3],[],\${top_builddir}/intl,[$3])/libintl.[]gt_libtool_suffix_prefix[]a $LIBICONV"
++        LTLIBINTL="ifelse([$3],[],\${top_builddir}/intl,[$3])/libintl.[]gt_libtool_suffix_prefix[]a $LTLIBICONV"
++        LIBS=`echo " $LIBS " | sed -e 's/ -lintl / /' -e 's/^ //' -e 's/ $//'`
++      fi
++
++      if test "$gt_use_preinstalled_gnugettext" = "yes" \
++         || test "$nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext" = "yes"; then
++        dnl Mark actions to use GNU gettext tools.
++        CATOBJEXT=.gmo
++      fi
++    ])
++
++    if test "$gt_use_preinstalled_gnugettext" = "yes" \
++       || test "$nls_cv_use_gnu_gettext" = "yes"; then
++      AC_DEFINE(ENABLE_NLS, 1,
++        [Define to 1 if translation of program messages to the user's native language
++   is requested.])
++    else
++      USE_NLS=no
++    fi
++  fi
++
++  AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether to use NLS])
++  AC_MSG_RESULT([$USE_NLS])
++  if test "$USE_NLS" = "yes"; then
++    AC_MSG_CHECKING([where the gettext function comes from])
++    if test "$gt_use_preinstalled_gnugettext" = "yes"; then
++      if test "$gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl" = "yes"; then
++        gt_source="external libintl"
++      else
++        gt_source="libc"
++      fi
++    else
++      gt_source="included intl directory"
++    fi
++    AC_MSG_RESULT([$gt_source])
++  fi
++
++  if test "$USE_NLS" = "yes"; then
++
++    if test "$gt_use_preinstalled_gnugettext" = "yes"; then
++      if test "$gt_cv_func_gnugettext_libintl" = "yes"; then
++        AC_MSG_CHECKING([how to link with libintl])
++        AC_MSG_RESULT([$LIBINTL])
++        AC_LIB_APPENDTOVAR([CPPFLAGS], [$INCINTL])
++      fi
++
++      dnl For backward compatibility. Some packages may be using this.
++      AC_DEFINE(HAVE_GETTEXT, 1,
++       [Define if the GNU gettext() function is already present or preinstalled.])
++      AC_DEFINE(HAVE_DCGETTEXT, 1,
++       [Define if the GNU dcgettext() function is already present or preinstalled.])
++    fi
++
++    dnl We need to process the po/ directory.
++    POSUB=po
++  fi
++
++  ifelse(gt_included_intl, yes, [
++    dnl If this is used in GNU gettext we have to set BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL
++    dnl to 'yes' because some of the testsuite requires it.
++    if test "$PACKAGE" = gettext-runtime || test "$PACKAGE" = gettext-tools; then
++      BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL=yes
++    fi
++
++    dnl Make all variables we use known to autoconf.
++    AC_SUBST(BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL)
++    AC_SUBST(USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL)
++    AC_SUBST(CATOBJEXT)
++
++    dnl For backward compatibility. Some configure.ins may be using this.
++    nls_cv_header_intl=
++    nls_cv_header_libgt=
++
++    dnl For backward compatibility. Some Makefiles may be using this.
++    DATADIRNAME=share
++    AC_SUBST(DATADIRNAME)
++
++    dnl For backward compatibility. Some Makefiles may be using this.
++    INSTOBJEXT=.mo
++    AC_SUBST(INSTOBJEXT)
++
++    dnl For backward compatibility. Some Makefiles may be using this.
++    GENCAT=gencat
++    AC_SUBST(GENCAT)
++
++    dnl For backward compatibility. Some Makefiles may be using this.
++    if test "$USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL" = yes; then
++      INTLOBJS="\$(GETTOBJS)"
++    fi
++    AC_SUBST(INTLOBJS)
++
++    dnl Enable libtool support if the surrounding package wishes it.
++    INTL_LIBTOOL_SUFFIX_PREFIX=gt_libtool_suffix_prefix
++    AC_SUBST(INTL_LIBTOOL_SUFFIX_PREFIX)
++  ])
++
++  dnl For backward compatibility. Some Makefiles may be using this.
++  INTLLIBS="$LIBINTL"
++  AC_SUBST(INTLLIBS)
++
++  dnl Make all documented variables known to autoconf.
++  AC_SUBST(LIBINTL)
++  AC_SUBST(LTLIBINTL)
++  AC_SUBST(POSUB)
++])
++
++
++dnl Checks for all prerequisites of the intl subdirectory,
++dnl except for INTL_LIBTOOL_SUFFIX_PREFIX (and possibly LIBTOOL), INTLOBJS,
++dnl            USE_INCLUDED_LIBINTL, BUILD_INCLUDED_LIBINTL.
++AC_DEFUN([AM_INTL_SUBDIR],
++[
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_INSTALL])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([AM_MKINSTALLDIRS])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_CC])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_CANONICAL_HOST])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_RANLIB])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_ISC_POSIX])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_HEADER_STDC])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_C_CONST])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([bh_C_SIGNED])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_C_INLINE])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_TYPE_OFF_T])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_TYPE_SIZE_T])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_LONG_LONG])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([gt_TYPE_LONGDOUBLE])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([gt_TYPE_WCHAR_T])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([gt_TYPE_WINT_T])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_HEADER_INTTYPES_H])
++  AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_HEADER_STDINT_H])
++  AC_REQUIRE([gt_TYPE_INTMAX_T])
++  AC_REQUIRE([gt_PRINTF_POSIX])
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_FUNC_ALLOCA])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_FUNC_MMAP])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([jm_GLIBC21])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([gt_INTDIV0])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UINTMAX_T])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([gt_HEADER_INTTYPES_H])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([gt_INTTYPES_PRI])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([gl_XSIZE])dnl
++
++  AC_CHECK_TYPE([ptrdiff_t], ,
++    [AC_DEFINE([ptrdiff_t], [long],
++       [Define as the type of the result of subtracting two pointers, if the system doesn't define it.])
++    ])
++  AC_CHECK_HEADERS([argz.h limits.h locale.h nl_types.h malloc.h stddef.h \
++stdlib.h string.h unistd.h sys/param.h])
++  AC_CHECK_FUNCS([asprintf fwprintf getcwd getegid geteuid getgid getuid \
++mempcpy munmap putenv setenv setlocale snprintf stpcpy strcasecmp strdup \
++strtoul tsearch wcslen __argz_count __argz_stringify __argz_next \
++__fsetlocking])
++
++  dnl Use the _snprintf function only if it is declared (because on NetBSD it
++  dnl is defined as a weak alias of snprintf; we prefer to use the latter).
++  gt_CHECK_DECL(_snprintf, [#include <stdio.h>])
++  gt_CHECK_DECL(_snwprintf, [#include <stdio.h>])
++
++  dnl Use the *_unlocked functions only if they are declared.
++  dnl (because some of them were defined without being declared in Solaris
++  dnl 2.5.1 but were removed in Solaris 2.6, whereas we want binaries built
++  dnl on Solaris 2.5.1 to run on Solaris 2.6).
++  dnl Don't use AC_CHECK_DECLS because it isn't supported in autoconf-2.13.
++  gt_CHECK_DECL(feof_unlocked, [#include <stdio.h>])
++  gt_CHECK_DECL(fgets_unlocked, [#include <stdio.h>])
++  gt_CHECK_DECL(getc_unlocked, [#include <stdio.h>])
++
++  case $gt_cv_func_printf_posix in
++    *yes) HAVE_POSIX_PRINTF=1 ;;
++    *) HAVE_POSIX_PRINTF=0 ;;
++  esac
++  AC_SUBST([HAVE_POSIX_PRINTF])
++  if test "$ac_cv_func_asprintf" = yes; then
++    HAVE_ASPRINTF=1
++  else
++    HAVE_ASPRINTF=0
++  fi
++  AC_SUBST([HAVE_ASPRINTF])
++  if test "$ac_cv_func_snprintf" = yes; then
++    HAVE_SNPRINTF=1
++  else
++    HAVE_SNPRINTF=0
++  fi
++  AC_SUBST([HAVE_SNPRINTF])
++  if test "$ac_cv_func_wprintf" = yes; then
++    HAVE_WPRINTF=1
++  else
++    HAVE_WPRINTF=0
++  fi
++  AC_SUBST([HAVE_WPRINTF])
++
++  AM_ICONV
++  AM_LANGINFO_CODESET
++  if test $ac_cv_header_locale_h = yes; then
++    AM_LC_MESSAGES
++  fi
++
++  dnl intl/plural.c is generated from intl/plural.y. It requires bison,
++  dnl because plural.y uses bison specific features. It requires at least
++  dnl bison-1.26 because earlier versions generate a plural.c that doesn't
++  dnl compile.
++  dnl bison is only needed for the maintainer (who touches plural.y). But in
++  dnl order to avoid separate Makefiles or --enable-maintainer-mode, we put
++  dnl the rule in general Makefile. Now, some people carelessly touch the
++  dnl files or have a broken "make" program, hence the plural.c rule will
++  dnl sometimes fire. To avoid an error, defines BISON to ":" if it is not
++  dnl present or too old.
++  AC_CHECK_PROGS([INTLBISON], [bison])
++  if test -z "$INTLBISON"; then
++    ac_verc_fail=yes
++  else
++    dnl Found it, now check the version.
++    AC_MSG_CHECKING([version of bison])
++changequote(<<,>>)dnl
++    ac_prog_version=`$INTLBISON --version 2>&1 | sed -n 's/^.*GNU Bison.* \([0-9]*\.[0-9.]*\).*$/\1/p'`
++    case $ac_prog_version in
++      '') ac_prog_version="v. ?.??, bad"; ac_verc_fail=yes;;
++      1.2[6-9]* | 1.[3-9][0-9]* | [2-9].*)
++changequote([,])dnl
++         ac_prog_version="$ac_prog_version, ok"; ac_verc_fail=no;;
++      *) ac_prog_version="$ac_prog_version, bad"; ac_verc_fail=yes;;
++    esac
++    AC_MSG_RESULT([$ac_prog_version])
++  fi
++  if test $ac_verc_fail = yes; then
++    INTLBISON=:
++  fi
++])
++
++
++dnl gt_CHECK_DECL(FUNC, INCLUDES)
++dnl Check whether a function is declared.
++AC_DEFUN([gt_CHECK_DECL],
++[
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([whether $1 is declared], ac_cv_have_decl_$1,
++    [AC_TRY_COMPILE([$2], [
++#ifndef $1
++  char *p = (char *) $1;
++#endif
++], ac_cv_have_decl_$1=yes, ac_cv_have_decl_$1=no)])
++  if test $ac_cv_have_decl_$1 = yes; then
++    gt_value=1
++  else
++    gt_value=0
++  fi
++  AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED([HAVE_DECL_]translit($1, [a-z], [A-Z]), [$gt_value],
++    [Define to 1 if you have the declaration of `$1', and to 0 if you don't.])
++])
++
++
++dnl Usage: AM_GNU_GETTEXT_VERSION([gettext-version])
++AC_DEFUN([AM_GNU_GETTEXT_VERSION], [])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/glibc21.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/glibc21.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.833675432 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,32 @@
++# glibc21.m4 serial 2 (fileutils-4.1.3, gettext-0.10.40)
++dnl Copyright (C) 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++# Test for the GNU C Library, version 2.1 or newer.
++# From Bruno Haible.
++
++AC_DEFUN([jm_GLIBC21],
++  [
++    AC_CACHE_CHECK(whether we are using the GNU C Library 2.1 or newer,
++      ac_cv_gnu_library_2_1,
++      [AC_EGREP_CPP([Lucky GNU user],
++	[
++#include <features.h>
++#ifdef __GNU_LIBRARY__
++ #if (__GLIBC__ == 2 && __GLIBC_MINOR__ >= 1) || (__GLIBC__ > 2)
++  Lucky GNU user
++ #endif
++#endif
++	],
++	ac_cv_gnu_library_2_1=yes,
++	ac_cv_gnu_library_2_1=no)
++      ]
++    )
++    AC_SUBST(GLIBC21)
++    GLIBC21="$ac_cv_gnu_library_2_1"
++  ]
++)
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/iconv.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/iconv.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.839674520 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,103 @@
++# iconv.m4 serial AM4 (gettext-0.11.3)
++dnl Copyright (C) 2000-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Bruno Haible.
++
++AC_DEFUN([AM_ICONV_LINKFLAGS_BODY],
++[
++  dnl Prerequisites of AC_LIB_LINKFLAGS_BODY.
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_LIB_PREPARE_PREFIX])
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_LIB_RPATH])
++
++  dnl Search for libiconv and define LIBICONV, LTLIBICONV and INCICONV
++  dnl accordingly.
++  AC_LIB_LINKFLAGS_BODY([iconv])
++])
++
++AC_DEFUN([AM_ICONV_LINK],
++[
++  dnl Some systems have iconv in libc, some have it in libiconv (OSF/1 and
++  dnl those with the standalone portable GNU libiconv installed).
++
++  dnl Search for libiconv and define LIBICONV, LTLIBICONV and INCICONV
++  dnl accordingly.
++  AC_REQUIRE([AM_ICONV_LINKFLAGS_BODY])
++
++  dnl Add $INCICONV to CPPFLAGS before performing the following checks,
++  dnl because if the user has installed libiconv and not disabled its use
++  dnl via --without-libiconv-prefix, he wants to use it. The first
++  dnl AC_TRY_LINK will then fail, the second AC_TRY_LINK will succeed.
++  am_save_CPPFLAGS="$CPPFLAGS"
++  AC_LIB_APPENDTOVAR([CPPFLAGS], [$INCICONV])
++
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK(for iconv, am_cv_func_iconv, [
++    am_cv_func_iconv="no, consider installing GNU libiconv"
++    am_cv_lib_iconv=no
++    AC_TRY_LINK([#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <iconv.h>],
++      [iconv_t cd = iconv_open("","");
++       iconv(cd,NULL,NULL,NULL,NULL);
++       iconv_close(cd);],
++      am_cv_func_iconv=yes)
++    if test "$am_cv_func_iconv" != yes; then
++      am_save_LIBS="$LIBS"
++      LIBS="$LIBS $LIBICONV"
++      AC_TRY_LINK([#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <iconv.h>],
++        [iconv_t cd = iconv_open("","");
++         iconv(cd,NULL,NULL,NULL,NULL);
++         iconv_close(cd);],
++        am_cv_lib_iconv=yes
++        am_cv_func_iconv=yes)
++      LIBS="$am_save_LIBS"
++    fi
++  ])
++  if test "$am_cv_func_iconv" = yes; then
++    AC_DEFINE(HAVE_ICONV, 1, [Define if you have the iconv() function.])
++  fi
++  if test "$am_cv_lib_iconv" = yes; then
++    AC_MSG_CHECKING([how to link with libiconv])
++    AC_MSG_RESULT([$LIBICONV])
++  else
++    dnl If $LIBICONV didn't lead to a usable library, we don't need $INCICONV
++    dnl either.
++    CPPFLAGS="$am_save_CPPFLAGS"
++    LIBICONV=
++    LTLIBICONV=
++  fi
++  AC_SUBST(LIBICONV)
++  AC_SUBST(LTLIBICONV)
++])
++
++AC_DEFUN([AM_ICONV],
++[
++  AM_ICONV_LINK
++  if test "$am_cv_func_iconv" = yes; then
++    AC_MSG_CHECKING([for iconv declaration])
++    AC_CACHE_VAL(am_cv_proto_iconv, [
++      AC_TRY_COMPILE([
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <iconv.h>
++extern
++#ifdef __cplusplus
++"C"
++#endif
++#if defined(__STDC__) || defined(__cplusplus)
++size_t iconv (iconv_t cd, char * *inbuf, size_t *inbytesleft, char * *outbuf, size_t *outbytesleft);
++#else
++size_t iconv();
++#endif
++], [], am_cv_proto_iconv_arg1="", am_cv_proto_iconv_arg1="const")
++      am_cv_proto_iconv="extern size_t iconv (iconv_t cd, $am_cv_proto_iconv_arg1 char * *inbuf, size_t *inbytesleft, char * *outbuf, size_t *outbytesleft);"])
++    am_cv_proto_iconv=`echo "[$]am_cv_proto_iconv" | tr -s ' ' | sed -e 's/( /(/'`
++    AC_MSG_RESULT([$]{ac_t:-
++         }[$]am_cv_proto_iconv)
++    AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(ICONV_CONST, $am_cv_proto_iconv_arg1,
++      [Define as const if the declaration of iconv() needs const.])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/intdiv0.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/intdiv0.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.845673608 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,72 @@
++# intdiv0.m4 serial 1 (gettext-0.11.3)
++dnl Copyright (C) 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Bruno Haible.
++
++AC_DEFUN([gt_INTDIV0],
++[
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_CC])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_CANONICAL_HOST])dnl
++
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([whether integer division by zero raises SIGFPE],
++    gt_cv_int_divbyzero_sigfpe,
++    [
++      AC_TRY_RUN([
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#include <signal.h>
++
++static void
++#ifdef __cplusplus
++sigfpe_handler (int sig)
++#else
++sigfpe_handler (sig) int sig;
++#endif
++{
++  /* Exit with code 0 if SIGFPE, with code 1 if any other signal.  */
++  exit (sig != SIGFPE);
++}
++
++int x = 1;
++int y = 0;
++int z;
++int nan;
++
++int main ()
++{
++  signal (SIGFPE, sigfpe_handler);
++/* IRIX and AIX (when "xlc -qcheck" is used) yield signal SIGTRAP.  */
++#if (defined (__sgi) || defined (_AIX)) && defined (SIGTRAP)
++  signal (SIGTRAP, sigfpe_handler);
++#endif
++/* Linux/SPARC yields signal SIGILL.  */
++#if defined (__sparc__) && defined (__linux__)
++  signal (SIGILL, sigfpe_handler);
++#endif
++
++  z = x / y;
++  nan = y / y;
++  exit (1);
++}
++], gt_cv_int_divbyzero_sigfpe=yes, gt_cv_int_divbyzero_sigfpe=no,
++        [
++          # Guess based on the CPU.
++          case "$host_cpu" in
++            alpha* | i[34567]86 | m68k | s390*)
++              gt_cv_int_divbyzero_sigfpe="guessing yes";;
++            *)
++              gt_cv_int_divbyzero_sigfpe="guessing no";;
++          esac
++        ])
++    ])
++  case "$gt_cv_int_divbyzero_sigfpe" in
++    *yes) value=1;;
++    *) value=0;;
++  esac
++  AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(INTDIV0_RAISES_SIGFPE, $value,
++    [Define if integer division by zero raises signal SIGFPE.])
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/intmax.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/intmax.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.855672088 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,32 @@
++# intmax.m4 serial 1 (gettext-0.12)
++dnl Copyright (C) 2002-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Bruno Haible.
++dnl Test whether the system has the 'intmax_t' type, but don't attempt to
++dnl find a replacement if it is lacking.
++
++AC_DEFUN([gt_TYPE_INTMAX_T],
++[
++  AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_HEADER_INTTYPES_H])
++  AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_HEADER_STDINT_H])
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK(for intmax_t, gt_cv_c_intmax_t,
++    [AC_TRY_COMPILE([
++#include <stddef.h> 
++#include <stdlib.h>
++#if HAVE_STDINT_H_WITH_UINTMAX
++#include <stdint.h>
++#endif
++#if HAVE_INTTYPES_H_WITH_UINTMAX
++#include <inttypes.h>
++#endif
++], [intmax_t x = -1;], gt_cv_c_intmax_t=yes, gt_cv_c_intmax_t=no)])
++  if test $gt_cv_c_intmax_t = yes; then
++    AC_DEFINE(HAVE_INTMAX_T, 1,
++      [Define if you have the 'intmax_t' type in <stdint.h> or <inttypes.h>.])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/inttypes_h.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/inttypes_h.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.868670112 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,28 @@
++# inttypes_h.m4 serial 5 (gettext-0.12)
++dnl Copyright (C) 1997-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Paul Eggert.
++
++# Define HAVE_INTTYPES_H_WITH_UINTMAX if <inttypes.h> exists,
++# doesn't clash with <sys/types.h>, and declares uintmax_t.
++
++AC_DEFUN([jm_AC_HEADER_INTTYPES_H],
++[
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([for inttypes.h], jm_ac_cv_header_inttypes_h,
++  [AC_TRY_COMPILE(
++    [#include <sys/types.h>
++#include <inttypes.h>],
++    [uintmax_t i = (uintmax_t) -1;],
++    jm_ac_cv_header_inttypes_h=yes,
++    jm_ac_cv_header_inttypes_h=no)])
++  if test $jm_ac_cv_header_inttypes_h = yes; then
++    AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(HAVE_INTTYPES_H_WITH_UINTMAX, 1,
++      [Define if <inttypes.h> exists, doesn't clash with <sys/types.h>,
++       and declares uintmax_t. ])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/inttypes.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/inttypes.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.861671176 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,27 @@
++# inttypes.m4 serial 1 (gettext-0.11.4)
++dnl Copyright (C) 1997-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Paul Eggert.
++
++# Define HAVE_INTTYPES_H if <inttypes.h> exists and doesn't clash with
++# <sys/types.h>.
++
++AC_DEFUN([gt_HEADER_INTTYPES_H],
++[
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([for inttypes.h], gt_cv_header_inttypes_h,
++  [
++    AC_TRY_COMPILE(
++      [#include <sys/types.h>
++#include <inttypes.h>],
++      [], gt_cv_header_inttypes_h=yes, gt_cv_header_inttypes_h=no)
++  ])
++  if test $gt_cv_header_inttypes_h = yes; then
++    AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(HAVE_INTTYPES_H, 1,
++      [Define if <inttypes.h> exists and doesn't clash with <sys/types.h>.])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/inttypes-pri.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/inttypes-pri.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.874669200 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,32 @@
++# inttypes-pri.m4 serial 1 (gettext-0.11.4)
++dnl Copyright (C) 1997-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Bruno Haible.
++
++# Define PRI_MACROS_BROKEN if <inttypes.h> exists and defines the PRI*
++# macros to non-string values.  This is the case on AIX 4.3.3.
++
++AC_DEFUN([gt_INTTYPES_PRI],
++[
++  AC_REQUIRE([gt_HEADER_INTTYPES_H])
++  if test $gt_cv_header_inttypes_h = yes; then
++    AC_CACHE_CHECK([whether the inttypes.h PRIxNN macros are broken],
++      gt_cv_inttypes_pri_broken,
++      [
++        AC_TRY_COMPILE([#include <inttypes.h>
++#ifdef PRId32
++char *p = PRId32;
++#endif
++], [], gt_cv_inttypes_pri_broken=no, gt_cv_inttypes_pri_broken=yes)
++      ])
++  fi
++  if test "$gt_cv_inttypes_pri_broken" = yes; then
++    AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(PRI_MACROS_BROKEN, 1,
++      [Define if <inttypes.h> exists and defines unusable PRI* macros.])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/isc-posix.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/isc-posix.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.885667528 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
++# isc-posix.m4 serial 2 (gettext-0.11.2)
++dnl Copyright (C) 1995-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++# This file is not needed with autoconf-2.53 and newer.  Remove it in 2005.
++
++# This test replaces the one in autoconf.
++# Currently this macro should have the same name as the autoconf macro
++# because gettext's gettext.m4 (distributed in the automake package)
++# still uses it.  Otherwise, the use in gettext.m4 makes autoheader
++# give these diagnostics:
++#   configure.in:556: AC_TRY_COMPILE was called before AC_ISC_POSIX
++#   configure.in:556: AC_TRY_RUN was called before AC_ISC_POSIX
++
++undefine([AC_ISC_POSIX])
++
++AC_DEFUN([AC_ISC_POSIX],
++  [
++    dnl This test replaces the obsolescent AC_ISC_POSIX kludge.
++    AC_CHECK_LIB(cposix, strerror, [LIBS="$LIBS -lcposix"])
++  ]
++)
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/lcmessage.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/lcmessage.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.902664944 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,32 @@
++# lcmessage.m4 serial 3 (gettext-0.11.3)
++dnl Copyright (C) 1995-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++dnl
++dnl This file can can be used in projects which are not available under
++dnl the GNU General Public License or the GNU Library General Public
++dnl License but which still want to provide support for the GNU gettext
++dnl functionality.
++dnl Please note that the actual code of the GNU gettext library is covered
++dnl by the GNU Library General Public License, and the rest of the GNU
++dnl gettext package package is covered by the GNU General Public License.
++dnl They are *not* in the public domain.
++
++dnl Authors:
++dnl   Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995.
++
++# Check whether LC_MESSAGES is available in <locale.h>.
++
++AC_DEFUN([AM_LC_MESSAGES],
++[
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([for LC_MESSAGES], am_cv_val_LC_MESSAGES,
++    [AC_TRY_LINK([#include <locale.h>], [return LC_MESSAGES],
++       am_cv_val_LC_MESSAGES=yes, am_cv_val_LC_MESSAGES=no)])
++  if test $am_cv_val_LC_MESSAGES = yes; then
++    AC_DEFINE(HAVE_LC_MESSAGES, 1,
++      [Define if your <locale.h> file defines LC_MESSAGES.])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/lib-ld.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/lib-ld.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.908664032 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,112 @@
++# lib-ld.m4 serial 3 (gettext-0.13)
++dnl Copyright (C) 1996-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl Subroutines of libtool.m4,
++dnl with replacements s/AC_/AC_LIB/ and s/lt_cv/acl_cv/ to avoid collision
++dnl with libtool.m4.
++
++dnl From libtool-1.4. Sets the variable with_gnu_ld to yes or no.
++AC_DEFUN([AC_LIB_PROG_LD_GNU],
++[AC_CACHE_CHECK([if the linker ($LD) is GNU ld], acl_cv_prog_gnu_ld,
++[# I'd rather use --version here, but apparently some GNU ld's only accept -v.
++case `$LD -v 2>&1 </dev/null` in
++*GNU* | *'with BFD'*)
++  acl_cv_prog_gnu_ld=yes ;;
++*)
++  acl_cv_prog_gnu_ld=no ;;
++esac])
++with_gnu_ld=$acl_cv_prog_gnu_ld
++])
++
++dnl From libtool-1.4. Sets the variable LD.
++AC_DEFUN([AC_LIB_PROG_LD],
++[AC_ARG_WITH(gnu-ld,
++[  --with-gnu-ld           assume the C compiler uses GNU ld [default=no]],
++test "$withval" = no || with_gnu_ld=yes, with_gnu_ld=no)
++AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_CC])dnl
++AC_REQUIRE([AC_CANONICAL_HOST])dnl
++# Prepare PATH_SEPARATOR.
++# The user is always right.
++if test "${PATH_SEPARATOR+set}" != set; then
++  echo "#! /bin/sh" >conf$$.sh
++  echo  "exit 0"   >>conf$$.sh
++  chmod +x conf$$.sh
++  if (PATH="/nonexistent;."; conf$$.sh) >/dev/null 2>&1; then
++    PATH_SEPARATOR=';'
++  else
++    PATH_SEPARATOR=:
++  fi
++  rm -f conf$$.sh
++fi
++ac_prog=ld
++if test "$GCC" = yes; then
++  # Check if gcc -print-prog-name=ld gives a path.
++  AC_MSG_CHECKING([for ld used by GCC])
++  case $host in
++  *-*-mingw*)
++    # gcc leaves a trailing carriage return which upsets mingw
++    ac_prog=`($CC -print-prog-name=ld) 2>&5 | tr -d '\015'` ;;
++  *)
++    ac_prog=`($CC -print-prog-name=ld) 2>&5` ;;
++  esac
++  case $ac_prog in
++    # Accept absolute paths.
++    [[\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\/]*)]
++      [re_direlt='/[^/][^/]*/\.\./']
++      # Canonicalize the path of ld
++      ac_prog=`echo $ac_prog| sed 's%\\\\%/%g'`
++      while echo $ac_prog | grep "$re_direlt" > /dev/null 2>&1; do
++	ac_prog=`echo $ac_prog| sed "s%$re_direlt%/%"`
++      done
++      test -z "$LD" && LD="$ac_prog"
++      ;;
++  "")
++    # If it fails, then pretend we aren't using GCC.
++    ac_prog=ld
++    ;;
++  *)
++    # If it is relative, then search for the first ld in PATH.
++    with_gnu_ld=unknown
++    ;;
++  esac
++elif test "$with_gnu_ld" = yes; then
++  AC_MSG_CHECKING([for GNU ld])
++else
++  AC_MSG_CHECKING([for non-GNU ld])
++fi
++AC_CACHE_VAL(acl_cv_path_LD,
++[if test -z "$LD"; then
++  IFS="${IFS= 	}"; ac_save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS="${IFS}${PATH_SEPARATOR-:}"
++  for ac_dir in $PATH; do
++    test -z "$ac_dir" && ac_dir=.
++    if test -f "$ac_dir/$ac_prog" || test -f "$ac_dir/$ac_prog$ac_exeext"; then
++      acl_cv_path_LD="$ac_dir/$ac_prog"
++      # Check to see if the program is GNU ld.  I'd rather use --version,
++      # but apparently some GNU ld's only accept -v.
++      # Break only if it was the GNU/non-GNU ld that we prefer.
++      case `"$acl_cv_path_LD" -v 2>&1 < /dev/null` in
++      *GNU* | *'with BFD'*)
++	test "$with_gnu_ld" != no && break ;;
++      *)
++	test "$with_gnu_ld" != yes && break ;;
++      esac
++    fi
++  done
++  IFS="$ac_save_ifs"
++else
++  acl_cv_path_LD="$LD" # Let the user override the test with a path.
++fi])
++LD="$acl_cv_path_LD"
++if test -n "$LD"; then
++  AC_MSG_RESULT($LD)
++else
++  AC_MSG_RESULT(no)
++fi
++test -z "$LD" && AC_MSG_ERROR([no acceptable ld found in \$PATH])
++AC_LIB_PROG_LD_GNU
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/lib-link.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/lib-link.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.914663120 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,551 @@
++# lib-link.m4 serial 4 (gettext-0.12)
++dnl Copyright (C) 2001-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Bruno Haible.
++
++dnl AC_LIB_LINKFLAGS(name [, dependencies]) searches for libname and
++dnl the libraries corresponding to explicit and implicit dependencies.
++dnl Sets and AC_SUBSTs the LIB${NAME} and LTLIB${NAME} variables and
++dnl augments the CPPFLAGS variable.
++AC_DEFUN([AC_LIB_LINKFLAGS],
++[
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_LIB_PREPARE_PREFIX])
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_LIB_RPATH])
++  define([Name],[translit([$1],[./-], [___])])
++  define([NAME],[translit([$1],[abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz./-],
++                               [ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ___])])
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([how to link with lib[]$1], [ac_cv_lib[]Name[]_libs], [
++    AC_LIB_LINKFLAGS_BODY([$1], [$2])
++    ac_cv_lib[]Name[]_libs="$LIB[]NAME"
++    ac_cv_lib[]Name[]_ltlibs="$LTLIB[]NAME"
++    ac_cv_lib[]Name[]_cppflags="$INC[]NAME"
++  ])
++  LIB[]NAME="$ac_cv_lib[]Name[]_libs"
++  LTLIB[]NAME="$ac_cv_lib[]Name[]_ltlibs"
++  INC[]NAME="$ac_cv_lib[]Name[]_cppflags"
++  AC_LIB_APPENDTOVAR([CPPFLAGS], [$INC]NAME)
++  AC_SUBST([LIB]NAME)
++  AC_SUBST([LTLIB]NAME)
++  dnl Also set HAVE_LIB[]NAME so that AC_LIB_HAVE_LINKFLAGS can reuse the
++  dnl results of this search when this library appears as a dependency.
++  HAVE_LIB[]NAME=yes
++  undefine([Name])
++  undefine([NAME])
++])
++
++dnl AC_LIB_HAVE_LINKFLAGS(name, dependencies, includes, testcode)
++dnl searches for libname and the libraries corresponding to explicit and
++dnl implicit dependencies, together with the specified include files and
++dnl the ability to compile and link the specified testcode. If found, it
++dnl sets and AC_SUBSTs HAVE_LIB${NAME}=yes and the LIB${NAME} and
++dnl LTLIB${NAME} variables and augments the CPPFLAGS variable, and
++dnl #defines HAVE_LIB${NAME} to 1. Otherwise, it sets and AC_SUBSTs
++dnl HAVE_LIB${NAME}=no and LIB${NAME} and LTLIB${NAME} to empty.
++AC_DEFUN([AC_LIB_HAVE_LINKFLAGS],
++[
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_LIB_PREPARE_PREFIX])
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_LIB_RPATH])
++  define([Name],[translit([$1],[./-], [___])])
++  define([NAME],[translit([$1],[abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz./-],
++                               [ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ___])])
++
++  dnl Search for lib[]Name and define LIB[]NAME, LTLIB[]NAME and INC[]NAME
++  dnl accordingly.
++  AC_LIB_LINKFLAGS_BODY([$1], [$2])
++
++  dnl Add $INC[]NAME to CPPFLAGS before performing the following checks,
++  dnl because if the user has installed lib[]Name and not disabled its use
++  dnl via --without-lib[]Name-prefix, he wants to use it.
++  ac_save_CPPFLAGS="$CPPFLAGS"
++  AC_LIB_APPENDTOVAR([CPPFLAGS], [$INC]NAME)
++
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([for lib[]$1], [ac_cv_lib[]Name], [
++    ac_save_LIBS="$LIBS"
++    LIBS="$LIBS $LIB[]NAME"
++    AC_TRY_LINK([$3], [$4], [ac_cv_lib[]Name=yes], [ac_cv_lib[]Name=no])
++    LIBS="$ac_save_LIBS"
++  ])
++  if test "$ac_cv_lib[]Name" = yes; then
++    HAVE_LIB[]NAME=yes
++    AC_DEFINE([HAVE_LIB]NAME, 1, [Define if you have the $1 library.])
++    AC_MSG_CHECKING([how to link with lib[]$1])
++    AC_MSG_RESULT([$LIB[]NAME])
++  else
++    HAVE_LIB[]NAME=no
++    dnl If $LIB[]NAME didn't lead to a usable library, we don't need
++    dnl $INC[]NAME either.
++    CPPFLAGS="$ac_save_CPPFLAGS"
++    LIB[]NAME=
++    LTLIB[]NAME=
++  fi
++  AC_SUBST([HAVE_LIB]NAME)
++  AC_SUBST([LIB]NAME)
++  AC_SUBST([LTLIB]NAME)
++  undefine([Name])
++  undefine([NAME])
++])
++
++dnl Determine the platform dependent parameters needed to use rpath:
++dnl libext, shlibext, hardcode_libdir_flag_spec, hardcode_libdir_separator,
++dnl hardcode_direct, hardcode_minus_L.
++AC_DEFUN([AC_LIB_RPATH],
++[
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_CC])                dnl we use $CC, $GCC, $LDFLAGS
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_LIB_PROG_LD])            dnl we use $LD, $with_gnu_ld
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_CANONICAL_HOST])         dnl we use $host
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR_DEFAULT]) dnl we use $ac_aux_dir
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([for shared library run path origin], acl_cv_rpath, [
++    CC="$CC" GCC="$GCC" LDFLAGS="$LDFLAGS" LD="$LD" with_gnu_ld="$with_gnu_ld" \
++    ${CONFIG_SHELL-/bin/sh} "$ac_aux_dir/config.rpath" "$host" > conftest.sh
++    . ./conftest.sh
++    rm -f ./conftest.sh
++    acl_cv_rpath=done
++  ])
++  wl="$acl_cv_wl"
++  libext="$acl_cv_libext"
++  shlibext="$acl_cv_shlibext"
++  hardcode_libdir_flag_spec="$acl_cv_hardcode_libdir_flag_spec"
++  hardcode_libdir_separator="$acl_cv_hardcode_libdir_separator"
++  hardcode_direct="$acl_cv_hardcode_direct"
++  hardcode_minus_L="$acl_cv_hardcode_minus_L"
++  dnl Determine whether the user wants rpath handling at all.
++  AC_ARG_ENABLE(rpath,
++    [  --disable-rpath         do not hardcode runtime library paths],
++    :, enable_rpath=yes)
++])
++
++dnl AC_LIB_LINKFLAGS_BODY(name [, dependencies]) searches for libname and
++dnl the libraries corresponding to explicit and implicit dependencies.
++dnl Sets the LIB${NAME}, LTLIB${NAME} and INC${NAME} variables.
++AC_DEFUN([AC_LIB_LINKFLAGS_BODY],
++[
++  define([NAME],[translit([$1],[abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz./-],
++                               [ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ___])])
++  dnl By default, look in $includedir and $libdir.
++  use_additional=yes
++  AC_LIB_WITH_FINAL_PREFIX([
++    eval additional_includedir=\"$includedir\"
++    eval additional_libdir=\"$libdir\"
++  ])
++  AC_LIB_ARG_WITH([lib$1-prefix],
++[  --with-lib$1-prefix[=DIR]  search for lib$1 in DIR/include and DIR/lib
++  --without-lib$1-prefix     don't search for lib$1 in includedir and libdir],
++[
++    if test "X$withval" = "Xno"; then
++      use_additional=no
++    else
++      if test "X$withval" = "X"; then
++        AC_LIB_WITH_FINAL_PREFIX([
++          eval additional_includedir=\"$includedir\"
++          eval additional_libdir=\"$libdir\"
++        ])
++      else
++        additional_includedir="$withval/include"
++        additional_libdir="$withval/lib"
++      fi
++    fi
++])
++  dnl Search the library and its dependencies in $additional_libdir and
++  dnl $LDFLAGS. Using breadth-first-seach.
++  LIB[]NAME=
++  LTLIB[]NAME=
++  INC[]NAME=
++  rpathdirs=
++  ltrpathdirs=
++  names_already_handled=
++  names_next_round='$1 $2'
++  while test -n "$names_next_round"; do
++    names_this_round="$names_next_round"
++    names_next_round=
++    for name in $names_this_round; do
++      already_handled=
++      for n in $names_already_handled; do
++        if test "$n" = "$name"; then
++          already_handled=yes
++          break
++        fi
++      done
++      if test -z "$already_handled"; then
++        names_already_handled="$names_already_handled $name"
++        dnl See if it was already located by an earlier AC_LIB_LINKFLAGS
++        dnl or AC_LIB_HAVE_LINKFLAGS call.
++        uppername=`echo "$name" | sed -e 'y|abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz./-|ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ___|'`
++        eval value=\"\$HAVE_LIB$uppername\"
++        if test -n "$value"; then
++          if test "$value" = yes; then
++            eval value=\"\$LIB$uppername\"
++            test -z "$value" || LIB[]NAME="${LIB[]NAME}${LIB[]NAME:+ }$value"
++            eval value=\"\$LTLIB$uppername\"
++            test -z "$value" || LTLIB[]NAME="${LTLIB[]NAME}${LTLIB[]NAME:+ }$value"
++          else
++            dnl An earlier call to AC_LIB_HAVE_LINKFLAGS has determined
++            dnl that this library doesn't exist. So just drop it.
++            :
++          fi
++        else
++          dnl Search the library lib$name in $additional_libdir and $LDFLAGS
++          dnl and the already constructed $LIBNAME/$LTLIBNAME.
++          found_dir=
++          found_la=
++          found_so=
++          found_a=
++          if test $use_additional = yes; then
++            if test -n "$shlibext" && test -f "$additional_libdir/lib$name.$shlibext"; then
++              found_dir="$additional_libdir"
++              found_so="$additional_libdir/lib$name.$shlibext"
++              if test -f "$additional_libdir/lib$name.la"; then
++                found_la="$additional_libdir/lib$name.la"
++              fi
++            else
++              if test -f "$additional_libdir/lib$name.$libext"; then
++                found_dir="$additional_libdir"
++                found_a="$additional_libdir/lib$name.$libext"
++                if test -f "$additional_libdir/lib$name.la"; then
++                  found_la="$additional_libdir/lib$name.la"
++                fi
++              fi
++            fi
++          fi
++          if test "X$found_dir" = "X"; then
++            for x in $LDFLAGS $LTLIB[]NAME; do
++              AC_LIB_WITH_FINAL_PREFIX([eval x=\"$x\"])
++              case "$x" in
++                -L*)
++                  dir=`echo "X$x" | sed -e 's/^X-L//'`
++                  if test -n "$shlibext" && test -f "$dir/lib$name.$shlibext"; then
++                    found_dir="$dir"
++                    found_so="$dir/lib$name.$shlibext"
++                    if test -f "$dir/lib$name.la"; then
++                      found_la="$dir/lib$name.la"
++                    fi
++                  else
++                    if test -f "$dir/lib$name.$libext"; then
++                      found_dir="$dir"
++                      found_a="$dir/lib$name.$libext"
++                      if test -f "$dir/lib$name.la"; then
++                        found_la="$dir/lib$name.la"
++                      fi
++                    fi
++                  fi
++                  ;;
++              esac
++              if test "X$found_dir" != "X"; then
++                break
++              fi
++            done
++          fi
++          if test "X$found_dir" != "X"; then
++            dnl Found the library.
++            LTLIB[]NAME="${LTLIB[]NAME}${LTLIB[]NAME:+ }-L$found_dir -l$name"
++            if test "X$found_so" != "X"; then
++              dnl Linking with a shared library. We attempt to hardcode its
++              dnl directory into the executable's runpath, unless it's the
++              dnl standard /usr/lib.
++              if test "$enable_rpath" = no || test "X$found_dir" = "X/usr/lib"; then
++                dnl No hardcoding is needed.
++                LIB[]NAME="${LIB[]NAME}${LIB[]NAME:+ }$found_so"
++              else
++                dnl Use an explicit option to hardcode DIR into the resulting
++                dnl binary.
++                dnl Potentially add DIR to ltrpathdirs.
++                dnl The ltrpathdirs will be appended to $LTLIBNAME at the end.
++                haveit=
++                for x in $ltrpathdirs; do
++                  if test "X$x" = "X$found_dir"; then
++                    haveit=yes
++                    break
++                  fi
++                done
++                if test -z "$haveit"; then
++                  ltrpathdirs="$ltrpathdirs $found_dir"
++                fi
++                dnl The hardcoding into $LIBNAME is system dependent.
++                if test "$hardcode_direct" = yes; then
++                  dnl Using DIR/libNAME.so during linking hardcodes DIR into the
++                  dnl resulting binary.
++                  LIB[]NAME="${LIB[]NAME}${LIB[]NAME:+ }$found_so"
++                else
++                  if test -n "$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec" && test "$hardcode_minus_L" = no; then
++                    dnl Use an explicit option to hardcode DIR into the resulting
++                    dnl binary.
++                    LIB[]NAME="${LIB[]NAME}${LIB[]NAME:+ }$found_so"
++                    dnl Potentially add DIR to rpathdirs.
++                    dnl The rpathdirs will be appended to $LIBNAME at the end.
++                    haveit=
++                    for x in $rpathdirs; do
++                      if test "X$x" = "X$found_dir"; then
++                        haveit=yes
++                        break
++                      fi
++                    done
++                    if test -z "$haveit"; then
++                      rpathdirs="$rpathdirs $found_dir"
++                    fi
++                  else
++                    dnl Rely on "-L$found_dir".
++                    dnl But don't add it if it's already contained in the LDFLAGS
++                    dnl or the already constructed $LIBNAME
++                    haveit=
++                    for x in $LDFLAGS $LIB[]NAME; do
++                      AC_LIB_WITH_FINAL_PREFIX([eval x=\"$x\"])
++                      if test "X$x" = "X-L$found_dir"; then
++                        haveit=yes
++                        break
++                      fi
++                    done
++                    if test -z "$haveit"; then
++                      LIB[]NAME="${LIB[]NAME}${LIB[]NAME:+ }-L$found_dir"
++                    fi
++                    if test "$hardcode_minus_L" != no; then
++                      dnl FIXME: Not sure whether we should use
++                      dnl "-L$found_dir -l$name" or "-L$found_dir $found_so"
++                      dnl here.
++                      LIB[]NAME="${LIB[]NAME}${LIB[]NAME:+ }$found_so"
++                    else
++                      dnl We cannot use $hardcode_runpath_var and LD_RUN_PATH
++                      dnl here, because this doesn't fit in flags passed to the
++                      dnl compiler. So give up. No hardcoding. This affects only
++                      dnl very old systems.
++                      dnl FIXME: Not sure whether we should use
++                      dnl "-L$found_dir -l$name" or "-L$found_dir $found_so"
++                      dnl here.
++                      LIB[]NAME="${LIB[]NAME}${LIB[]NAME:+ }-l$name"
++                    fi
++                  fi
++                fi
++              fi
++            else
++              if test "X$found_a" != "X"; then
++                dnl Linking with a static library.
++                LIB[]NAME="${LIB[]NAME}${LIB[]NAME:+ }$found_a"
++              else
++                dnl We shouldn't come here, but anyway it's good to have a
++                dnl fallback.
++                LIB[]NAME="${LIB[]NAME}${LIB[]NAME:+ }-L$found_dir -l$name"
++              fi
++            fi
++            dnl Assume the include files are nearby.
++            additional_includedir=
++            case "$found_dir" in
++              */lib | */lib/)
++                basedir=`echo "X$found_dir" | sed -e 's,^X,,' -e 's,/lib/*$,,'`
++                additional_includedir="$basedir/include"
++                ;;
++            esac
++            if test "X$additional_includedir" != "X"; then
++              dnl Potentially add $additional_includedir to $INCNAME.
++              dnl But don't add it
++              dnl   1. if it's the standard /usr/include,
++              dnl   2. if it's /usr/local/include and we are using GCC on Linux,
++              dnl   3. if it's already present in $CPPFLAGS or the already
++              dnl      constructed $INCNAME,
++              dnl   4. if it doesn't exist as a directory.
++              if test "X$additional_includedir" != "X/usr/include"; then
++                haveit=
++                if test "X$additional_includedir" = "X/usr/local/include"; then
++                  if test -n "$GCC"; then
++                    case $host_os in
++                      linux*) haveit=yes;;
++                    esac
++                  fi
++                fi
++                if test -z "$haveit"; then
++                  for x in $CPPFLAGS $INC[]NAME; do
++                    AC_LIB_WITH_FINAL_PREFIX([eval x=\"$x\"])
++                    if test "X$x" = "X-I$additional_includedir"; then
++                      haveit=yes
++                      break
++                    fi
++                  done
++                  if test -z "$haveit"; then
++                    if test -d "$additional_includedir"; then
++                      dnl Really add $additional_includedir to $INCNAME.
++                      INC[]NAME="${INC[]NAME}${INC[]NAME:+ }-I$additional_includedir"
++                    fi
++                  fi
++                fi
++              fi
++            fi
++            dnl Look for dependencies.
++            if test -n "$found_la"; then
++              dnl Read the .la file. It defines the variables
++              dnl dlname, library_names, old_library, dependency_libs, current,
++              dnl age, revision, installed, dlopen, dlpreopen, libdir.
++              save_libdir="$libdir"
++              case "$found_la" in
++                */* | *\\*) . "$found_la" ;;
++                *) . "./$found_la" ;;
++              esac
++              libdir="$save_libdir"
++              dnl We use only dependency_libs.
++              for dep in $dependency_libs; do
++                case "$dep" in
++                  -L*)
++                    additional_libdir=`echo "X$dep" | sed -e 's/^X-L//'`
++                    dnl Potentially add $additional_libdir to $LIBNAME and $LTLIBNAME.
++                    dnl But don't add it
++                    dnl   1. if it's the standard /usr/lib,
++                    dnl   2. if it's /usr/local/lib and we are using GCC on Linux,
++                    dnl   3. if it's already present in $LDFLAGS or the already
++                    dnl      constructed $LIBNAME,
++                    dnl   4. if it doesn't exist as a directory.
++                    if test "X$additional_libdir" != "X/usr/lib"; then
++                      haveit=
++                      if test "X$additional_libdir" = "X/usr/local/lib"; then
++                        if test -n "$GCC"; then
++                          case $host_os in
++                            linux*) haveit=yes;;
++                          esac
++                        fi
++                      fi
++                      if test -z "$haveit"; then
++                        haveit=
++                        for x in $LDFLAGS $LIB[]NAME; do
++                          AC_LIB_WITH_FINAL_PREFIX([eval x=\"$x\"])
++                          if test "X$x" = "X-L$additional_libdir"; then
++                            haveit=yes
++                            break
++                          fi
++                        done
++                        if test -z "$haveit"; then
++                          if test -d "$additional_libdir"; then
++                            dnl Really add $additional_libdir to $LIBNAME.
++                            LIB[]NAME="${LIB[]NAME}${LIB[]NAME:+ }-L$additional_libdir"
++                          fi
++                        fi
++                        haveit=
++                        for x in $LDFLAGS $LTLIB[]NAME; do
++                          AC_LIB_WITH_FINAL_PREFIX([eval x=\"$x\"])
++                          if test "X$x" = "X-L$additional_libdir"; then
++                            haveit=yes
++                            break
++                          fi
++                        done
++                        if test -z "$haveit"; then
++                          if test -d "$additional_libdir"; then
++                            dnl Really add $additional_libdir to $LTLIBNAME.
++                            LTLIB[]NAME="${LTLIB[]NAME}${LTLIB[]NAME:+ }-L$additional_libdir"
++                          fi
++                        fi
++                      fi
++                    fi
++                    ;;
++                  -R*)
++                    dir=`echo "X$dep" | sed -e 's/^X-R//'`
++                    if test "$enable_rpath" != no; then
++                      dnl Potentially add DIR to rpathdirs.
++                      dnl The rpathdirs will be appended to $LIBNAME at the end.
++                      haveit=
++                      for x in $rpathdirs; do
++                        if test "X$x" = "X$dir"; then
++                          haveit=yes
++                          break
++                        fi
++                      done
++                      if test -z "$haveit"; then
++                        rpathdirs="$rpathdirs $dir"
++                      fi
++                      dnl Potentially add DIR to ltrpathdirs.
++                      dnl The ltrpathdirs will be appended to $LTLIBNAME at the end.
++                      haveit=
++                      for x in $ltrpathdirs; do
++                        if test "X$x" = "X$dir"; then
++                          haveit=yes
++                          break
++                        fi
++                      done
++                      if test -z "$haveit"; then
++                        ltrpathdirs="$ltrpathdirs $dir"
++                      fi
++                    fi
++                    ;;
++                  -l*)
++                    dnl Handle this in the next round.
++                    names_next_round="$names_next_round "`echo "X$dep" | sed -e 's/^X-l//'`
++                    ;;
++                  *.la)
++                    dnl Handle this in the next round. Throw away the .la's
++                    dnl directory; it is already contained in a preceding -L
++                    dnl option.
++                    names_next_round="$names_next_round "`echo "X$dep" | sed -e 's,^X.*/,,' -e 's,^lib,,' -e 's,\.la$,,'`
++                    ;;
++                  *)
++                    dnl Most likely an immediate library name.
++                    LIB[]NAME="${LIB[]NAME}${LIB[]NAME:+ }$dep"
++                    LTLIB[]NAME="${LTLIB[]NAME}${LTLIB[]NAME:+ }$dep"
++                    ;;
++                esac
++              done
++            fi
++          else
++            dnl Didn't find the library; assume it is in the system directories
++            dnl known to the linker and runtime loader. (All the system
++            dnl directories known to the linker should also be known to the
++            dnl runtime loader, otherwise the system is severely misconfigured.)
++            LIB[]NAME="${LIB[]NAME}${LIB[]NAME:+ }-l$name"
++            LTLIB[]NAME="${LTLIB[]NAME}${LTLIB[]NAME:+ }-l$name"
++          fi
++        fi
++      fi
++    done
++  done
++  if test "X$rpathdirs" != "X"; then
++    if test -n "$hardcode_libdir_separator"; then
++      dnl Weird platform: only the last -rpath option counts, the user must
++      dnl pass all path elements in one option. We can arrange that for a
++      dnl single library, but not when more than one $LIBNAMEs are used.
++      alldirs=
++      for found_dir in $rpathdirs; do
++        alldirs="${alldirs}${alldirs:+$hardcode_libdir_separator}$found_dir"
++      done
++      dnl Note: hardcode_libdir_flag_spec uses $libdir and $wl.
++      acl_save_libdir="$libdir"
++      libdir="$alldirs"
++      eval flag=\"$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec\"
++      libdir="$acl_save_libdir"
++      LIB[]NAME="${LIB[]NAME}${LIB[]NAME:+ }$flag"
++    else
++      dnl The -rpath options are cumulative.
++      for found_dir in $rpathdirs; do
++        acl_save_libdir="$libdir"
++        libdir="$found_dir"
++        eval flag=\"$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec\"
++        libdir="$acl_save_libdir"
++        LIB[]NAME="${LIB[]NAME}${LIB[]NAME:+ }$flag"
++      done
++    fi
++  fi
++  if test "X$ltrpathdirs" != "X"; then
++    dnl When using libtool, the option that works for both libraries and
++    dnl executables is -R. The -R options are cumulative.
++    for found_dir in $ltrpathdirs; do
++      LTLIB[]NAME="${LTLIB[]NAME}${LTLIB[]NAME:+ }-R$found_dir"
++    done
++  fi
++])
++
++dnl AC_LIB_APPENDTOVAR(VAR, CONTENTS) appends the elements of CONTENTS to VAR,
++dnl unless already present in VAR.
++dnl Works only for CPPFLAGS, not for LIB* variables because that sometimes
++dnl contains two or three consecutive elements that belong together.
++AC_DEFUN([AC_LIB_APPENDTOVAR],
++[
++  for element in [$2]; do
++    haveit=
++    for x in $[$1]; do
++      AC_LIB_WITH_FINAL_PREFIX([eval x=\"$x\"])
++      if test "X$x" = "X$element"; then
++        haveit=yes
++        break
++      fi
++    done
++    if test -z "$haveit"; then
++      [$1]="${[$1]}${[$1]:+ }$element"
++    fi
++  done
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/lib-prefix.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/lib-prefix.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.921662056 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,155 @@
++# lib-prefix.m4 serial 3 (gettext-0.13)
++dnl Copyright (C) 2001-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Bruno Haible.
++
++dnl AC_LIB_ARG_WITH is synonymous to AC_ARG_WITH in autoconf-2.13, and
++dnl similar to AC_ARG_WITH in autoconf 2.52...2.57 except that is doesn't
++dnl require excessive bracketing.
++ifdef([AC_HELP_STRING],
++[AC_DEFUN([AC_LIB_ARG_WITH], [AC_ARG_WITH([$1],[[$2]],[$3],[$4])])],
++[AC_DEFUN([AC_][LIB_ARG_WITH], [AC_ARG_WITH([$1],[$2],[$3],[$4])])])
++
++dnl AC_LIB_PREFIX adds to the CPPFLAGS and LDFLAGS the flags that are needed
++dnl to access previously installed libraries. The basic assumption is that
++dnl a user will want packages to use other packages he previously installed
++dnl with the same --prefix option.
++dnl This macro is not needed if only AC_LIB_LINKFLAGS is used to locate
++dnl libraries, but is otherwise very convenient.
++AC_DEFUN([AC_LIB_PREFIX],
++[
++  AC_BEFORE([$0], [AC_LIB_LINKFLAGS])
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_CC])
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_CANONICAL_HOST])
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_LIB_PREPARE_PREFIX])
++  dnl By default, look in $includedir and $libdir.
++  use_additional=yes
++  AC_LIB_WITH_FINAL_PREFIX([
++    eval additional_includedir=\"$includedir\"
++    eval additional_libdir=\"$libdir\"
++  ])
++  AC_LIB_ARG_WITH([lib-prefix],
++[  --with-lib-prefix[=DIR] search for libraries in DIR/include and DIR/lib
++  --without-lib-prefix    don't search for libraries in includedir and libdir],
++[
++    if test "X$withval" = "Xno"; then
++      use_additional=no
++    else
++      if test "X$withval" = "X"; then
++        AC_LIB_WITH_FINAL_PREFIX([
++          eval additional_includedir=\"$includedir\"
++          eval additional_libdir=\"$libdir\"
++        ])
++      else
++        additional_includedir="$withval/include"
++        additional_libdir="$withval/lib"
++      fi
++    fi
++])
++  if test $use_additional = yes; then
++    dnl Potentially add $additional_includedir to $CPPFLAGS.
++    dnl But don't add it
++    dnl   1. if it's the standard /usr/include,
++    dnl   2. if it's already present in $CPPFLAGS,
++    dnl   3. if it's /usr/local/include and we are using GCC on Linux,
++    dnl   4. if it doesn't exist as a directory.
++    if test "X$additional_includedir" != "X/usr/include"; then
++      haveit=
++      for x in $CPPFLAGS; do
++        AC_LIB_WITH_FINAL_PREFIX([eval x=\"$x\"])
++        if test "X$x" = "X-I$additional_includedir"; then
++          haveit=yes
++          break
++        fi
++      done
++      if test -z "$haveit"; then
++        if test "X$additional_includedir" = "X/usr/local/include"; then
++          if test -n "$GCC"; then
++            case $host_os in
++              linux*) haveit=yes;;
++            esac
++          fi
++        fi
++        if test -z "$haveit"; then
++          if test -d "$additional_includedir"; then
++            dnl Really add $additional_includedir to $CPPFLAGS.
++            CPPFLAGS="${CPPFLAGS}${CPPFLAGS:+ }-I$additional_includedir"
++          fi
++        fi
++      fi
++    fi
++    dnl Potentially add $additional_libdir to $LDFLAGS.
++    dnl But don't add it
++    dnl   1. if it's the standard /usr/lib,
++    dnl   2. if it's already present in $LDFLAGS,
++    dnl   3. if it's /usr/local/lib and we are using GCC on Linux,
++    dnl   4. if it doesn't exist as a directory.
++    if test "X$additional_libdir" != "X/usr/lib"; then
++      haveit=
++      for x in $LDFLAGS; do
++        AC_LIB_WITH_FINAL_PREFIX([eval x=\"$x\"])
++        if test "X$x" = "X-L$additional_libdir"; then
++          haveit=yes
++          break
++        fi
++      done
++      if test -z "$haveit"; then
++        if test "X$additional_libdir" = "X/usr/local/lib"; then
++          if test -n "$GCC"; then
++            case $host_os in
++              linux*) haveit=yes;;
++            esac
++          fi
++        fi
++        if test -z "$haveit"; then
++          if test -d "$additional_libdir"; then
++            dnl Really add $additional_libdir to $LDFLAGS.
++            LDFLAGS="${LDFLAGS}${LDFLAGS:+ }-L$additional_libdir"
++          fi
++        fi
++      fi
++    fi
++  fi
++])
++
++dnl AC_LIB_PREPARE_PREFIX creates variables acl_final_prefix,
++dnl acl_final_exec_prefix, containing the values to which $prefix and
++dnl $exec_prefix will expand at the end of the configure script.
++AC_DEFUN([AC_LIB_PREPARE_PREFIX],
++[
++  dnl Unfortunately, prefix and exec_prefix get only finally determined
++  dnl at the end of configure.
++  if test "X$prefix" = "XNONE"; then
++    acl_final_prefix="$ac_default_prefix"
++  else
++    acl_final_prefix="$prefix"
++  fi
++  if test "X$exec_prefix" = "XNONE"; then
++    acl_final_exec_prefix='${prefix}'
++  else
++    acl_final_exec_prefix="$exec_prefix"
++  fi
++  acl_save_prefix="$prefix"
++  prefix="$acl_final_prefix"
++  eval acl_final_exec_prefix=\"$acl_final_exec_prefix\"
++  prefix="$acl_save_prefix"
++])
++
++dnl AC_LIB_WITH_FINAL_PREFIX([statement]) evaluates statement, with the
++dnl variables prefix and exec_prefix bound to the values they will have
++dnl at the end of the configure script.
++AC_DEFUN([AC_LIB_WITH_FINAL_PREFIX],
++[
++  acl_save_prefix="$prefix"
++  prefix="$acl_final_prefix"
++  acl_save_exec_prefix="$exec_prefix"
++  exec_prefix="$acl_final_exec_prefix"
++  $1
++  exec_prefix="$acl_save_exec_prefix"
++  prefix="$acl_save_prefix"
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/longdouble.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/longdouble.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.942658864 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,30 @@
++# longdouble.m4 serial 1 (gettext-0.12)
++dnl Copyright (C) 2002-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Bruno Haible.
++dnl Test whether the compiler supports the 'long double' type.
++dnl Prerequisite: AC_PROG_CC
++
++AC_DEFUN([gt_TYPE_LONGDOUBLE],
++[
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([for long double], gt_cv_c_long_double,
++    [if test "$GCC" = yes; then
++       gt_cv_c_long_double=yes
++     else
++       AC_TRY_COMPILE([
++         /* The Stardent Vistra knows sizeof(long double), but does not support it.  */
++         long double foo = 0.0;
++         /* On Ultrix 4.3 cc, long double is 4 and double is 8.  */
++         int array [2*(sizeof(long double) >= sizeof(double)) - 1];
++         ], ,
++         gt_cv_c_long_double=yes, gt_cv_c_long_double=no)
++     fi])
++  if test $gt_cv_c_long_double = yes; then
++    AC_DEFINE(HAVE_LONG_DOUBLE, 1, [Define if you have the 'long double' type.])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/longlong.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/longlong.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.949657800 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,25 @@
++# longlong.m4 serial 4
++dnl Copyright (C) 1999-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Paul Eggert.
++
++# Define HAVE_LONG_LONG if 'long long' works.
++
++AC_DEFUN([jm_AC_TYPE_LONG_LONG],
++[
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([for long long], ac_cv_type_long_long,
++  [AC_TRY_LINK([long long ll = 1LL; int i = 63;],
++    [long long llmax = (long long) -1;
++     return ll << i | ll >> i | llmax / ll | llmax % ll;],
++    ac_cv_type_long_long=yes,
++    ac_cv_type_long_long=no)])
++  if test $ac_cv_type_long_long = yes; then
++    AC_DEFINE(HAVE_LONG_LONG, 1,
++      [Define if you have the 'long long' type.])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/Makefile.am	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/Makefile.am	2004-09-12 14:40:35.048642752 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1 @@
++EXTRA_DIST = codeset.m4 gettext.m4 glibc21.m4 iconv.m4 intdiv0.m4 intmax.m4 inttypes.m4 inttypes_h.m4 inttypes-pri.m4 isc-posix.m4 lcmessage.m4 lib-ld.m4 lib-link.m4 lib-prefix.m4 longdouble.m4 longlong.m4 nls.m4 po.m4 printf-posix.m4 progtest.m4 signed.m4 size_max.m4 stdint_h.m4 uintmax_t.m4 ulonglong.m4 wchar_t.m4 wint_t.m4 xsize.m4
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/nls.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/nls.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.955656888 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,49 @@
++# nls.m4 serial 1 (gettext-0.12)
++dnl Copyright (C) 1995-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++dnl
++dnl This file can can be used in projects which are not available under
++dnl the GNU General Public License or the GNU Library General Public
++dnl License but which still want to provide support for the GNU gettext
++dnl functionality.
++dnl Please note that the actual code of the GNU gettext library is covered
++dnl by the GNU Library General Public License, and the rest of the GNU
++dnl gettext package package is covered by the GNU General Public License.
++dnl They are *not* in the public domain.
++
++dnl Authors:
++dnl   Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995-2000.
++dnl   Bruno Haible <haible@clisp.cons.org>, 2000-2003.
++
++AC_DEFUN([AM_NLS],
++[
++  AC_MSG_CHECKING([whether NLS is requested])
++  dnl Default is enabled NLS
++  AC_ARG_ENABLE(nls,
++    [  --disable-nls           do not use Native Language Support],
++    USE_NLS=$enableval, USE_NLS=yes)
++  AC_MSG_RESULT($USE_NLS)
++  AC_SUBST(USE_NLS)
++])
++
++AC_DEFUN([AM_MKINSTALLDIRS],
++[
++  dnl If the AC_CONFIG_AUX_DIR macro for autoconf is used we possibly
++  dnl find the mkinstalldirs script in another subdir but $(top_srcdir).
++  dnl Try to locate it.
++  MKINSTALLDIRS=
++  if test -n "$ac_aux_dir"; then
++    case "$ac_aux_dir" in
++      /*) MKINSTALLDIRS="$ac_aux_dir/mkinstalldirs" ;;
++      *) MKINSTALLDIRS="\$(top_builddir)/$ac_aux_dir/mkinstalldirs" ;;
++    esac
++  fi
++  if test -z "$MKINSTALLDIRS"; then
++    MKINSTALLDIRS="\$(top_srcdir)/mkinstalldirs"
++  fi
++  AC_SUBST(MKINSTALLDIRS)
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/po.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/po.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.961655976 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,426 @@
++# po.m4 serial 3 (gettext-0.14)
++dnl Copyright (C) 1995-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++dnl
++dnl This file can can be used in projects which are not available under
++dnl the GNU General Public License or the GNU Library General Public
++dnl License but which still want to provide support for the GNU gettext
++dnl functionality.
++dnl Please note that the actual code of the GNU gettext library is covered
++dnl by the GNU Library General Public License, and the rest of the GNU
++dnl gettext package package is covered by the GNU General Public License.
++dnl They are *not* in the public domain.
++
++dnl Authors:
++dnl   Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1995-2000.
++dnl   Bruno Haible <haible@clisp.cons.org>, 2000-2003.
++
++dnl Checks for all prerequisites of the po subdirectory.
++AC_DEFUN([AM_PO_SUBDIRS],
++[
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_MAKE_SET])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_INSTALL])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([AM_MKINSTALLDIRS])dnl
++  AC_REQUIRE([AM_NLS])dnl
++
++  dnl Perform the following tests also if --disable-nls has been given,
++  dnl because they are needed for "make dist" to work.
++
++  dnl Search for GNU msgfmt in the PATH.
++  dnl The first test excludes Solaris msgfmt and early GNU msgfmt versions.
++  dnl The second test excludes FreeBSD msgfmt.
++  AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(MSGFMT, msgfmt,
++    [$ac_dir/$ac_word --statistics /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1 &&
++     (if $ac_dir/$ac_word --statistics /dev/null 2>&1 >/dev/null | grep usage >/dev/null; then exit 1; else exit 0; fi)],
++    :)
++  AC_PATH_PROG(GMSGFMT, gmsgfmt, $MSGFMT)
++
++  dnl Search for GNU xgettext 0.12 or newer in the PATH.
++  dnl The first test excludes Solaris xgettext and early GNU xgettext versions.
++  dnl The second test excludes FreeBSD xgettext.
++  AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(XGETTEXT, xgettext,
++    [$ac_dir/$ac_word --omit-header --copyright-holder= --msgid-bugs-address= /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1 &&
++     (if $ac_dir/$ac_word --omit-header --copyright-holder= --msgid-bugs-address= /dev/null 2>&1 >/dev/null | grep usage >/dev/null; then exit 1; else exit 0; fi)],
++    :)
++  dnl Remove leftover from FreeBSD xgettext call.
++  rm -f messages.po
++
++  dnl Search for GNU msgmerge 0.11 or newer in the PATH.
++  AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(MSGMERGE, msgmerge,
++    [$ac_dir/$ac_word --update -q /dev/null /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1], :)
++
++  dnl This could go away some day; the PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST already does it.
++  dnl Test whether we really found GNU msgfmt.
++  if test "$GMSGFMT" != ":"; then
++    dnl If it is no GNU msgfmt we define it as : so that the
++    dnl Makefiles still can work.
++    if $GMSGFMT --statistics /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1 &&
++       (if $GMSGFMT --statistics /dev/null 2>&1 >/dev/null | grep usage >/dev/null; then exit 1; else exit 0; fi); then
++      : ;
++    else
++      GMSGFMT=`echo "$GMSGFMT" | sed -e 's,^.*/,,'`
++      AC_MSG_RESULT(
++        [found $GMSGFMT program is not GNU msgfmt; ignore it])
++      GMSGFMT=":"
++    fi
++  fi
++
++  dnl This could go away some day; the PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST already does it.
++  dnl Test whether we really found GNU xgettext.
++  if test "$XGETTEXT" != ":"; then
++    dnl If it is no GNU xgettext we define it as : so that the
++    dnl Makefiles still can work.
++    if $XGETTEXT --omit-header --copyright-holder= --msgid-bugs-address= /dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1 &&
++       (if $XGETTEXT --omit-header --copyright-holder= --msgid-bugs-address= /dev/null 2>&1 >/dev/null | grep usage >/dev/null; then exit 1; else exit 0; fi); then
++      : ;
++    else
++      AC_MSG_RESULT(
++        [found xgettext program is not GNU xgettext; ignore it])
++      XGETTEXT=":"
++    fi
++    dnl Remove leftover from FreeBSD xgettext call.
++    rm -f messages.po
++  fi
++
++  AC_OUTPUT_COMMANDS([
++    for ac_file in $CONFIG_FILES; do
++      # Support "outfile[:infile[:infile...]]"
++      case "$ac_file" in
++        *:*) ac_file=`echo "$ac_file"|sed 's%:.*%%'` ;;
++      esac
++      # PO directories have a Makefile.in generated from Makefile.in.in.
++      case "$ac_file" in */Makefile.in)
++        # Adjust a relative srcdir.
++        ac_dir=`echo "$ac_file"|sed 's%/[^/][^/]*$%%'`
++        ac_dir_suffix="/`echo "$ac_dir"|sed 's%^\./%%'`"
++        ac_dots=`echo "$ac_dir_suffix"|sed 's%/[^/]*%../%g'`
++        # In autoconf-2.13 it is called $ac_given_srcdir.
++        # In autoconf-2.50 it is called $srcdir.
++        test -n "$ac_given_srcdir" || ac_given_srcdir="$srcdir"
++        case "$ac_given_srcdir" in
++          .)  top_srcdir=`echo $ac_dots|sed 's%/$%%'` ;;
++          /*) top_srcdir="$ac_given_srcdir" ;;
++          *)  top_srcdir="$ac_dots$ac_given_srcdir" ;;
++        esac
++        if test -f "$ac_given_srcdir/$ac_dir/POTFILES.in"; then
++          rm -f "$ac_dir/POTFILES"
++          test -n "$as_me" && echo "$as_me: creating $ac_dir/POTFILES" || echo "creating $ac_dir/POTFILES"
++          cat "$ac_given_srcdir/$ac_dir/POTFILES.in" | sed -e "/^#/d" -e "/^[ 	]*\$/d" -e "s,.*,     $top_srcdir/& \\\\," | sed -e "\$s/\(.*\) \\\\/\1/" > "$ac_dir/POTFILES"
++          POMAKEFILEDEPS="POTFILES.in"
++          # ALL_LINGUAS, POFILES, UPDATEPOFILES, DUMMYPOFILES, GMOFILES depend
++          # on $ac_dir but don't depend on user-specified configuration
++          # parameters.
++          if test -f "$ac_given_srcdir/$ac_dir/LINGUAS"; then
++            # The LINGUAS file contains the set of available languages.
++            if test -n "$OBSOLETE_ALL_LINGUAS"; then
++              test -n "$as_me" && echo "$as_me: setting ALL_LINGUAS in configure.in is obsolete" || echo "setting ALL_LINGUAS in configure.in is obsolete"
++            fi
++            ALL_LINGUAS_=`sed -e "/^#/d" "$ac_given_srcdir/$ac_dir/LINGUAS"`
++            # Hide the ALL_LINGUAS assigment from automake.
++            eval 'ALL_LINGUAS''=$ALL_LINGUAS_'
++            POMAKEFILEDEPS="$POMAKEFILEDEPS LINGUAS"
++          else
++            # The set of available languages was given in configure.in.
++            eval 'ALL_LINGUAS''=$OBSOLETE_ALL_LINGUAS'
++          fi
++          # Compute POFILES
++          # as      $(foreach lang, $(ALL_LINGUAS), $(srcdir)/$(lang).po)
++          # Compute UPDATEPOFILES
++          # as      $(foreach lang, $(ALL_LINGUAS), $(lang).po-update)
++          # Compute DUMMYPOFILES
++          # as      $(foreach lang, $(ALL_LINGUAS), $(lang).nop)
++          # Compute GMOFILES
++          # as      $(foreach lang, $(ALL_LINGUAS), $(srcdir)/$(lang).gmo)
++          case "$ac_given_srcdir" in
++            .) srcdirpre= ;;
++            *) srcdirpre='$(srcdir)/' ;;
++          esac
++          POFILES=
++          UPDATEPOFILES=
++          DUMMYPOFILES=
++          GMOFILES=
++          for lang in $ALL_LINGUAS; do
++            POFILES="$POFILES $srcdirpre$lang.po"
++            UPDATEPOFILES="$UPDATEPOFILES $lang.po-update"
++            DUMMYPOFILES="$DUMMYPOFILES $lang.nop"
++            GMOFILES="$GMOFILES $srcdirpre$lang.gmo"
++          done
++          # CATALOGS depends on both $ac_dir and the user's LINGUAS
++          # environment variable.
++          INST_LINGUAS=
++          if test -n "$ALL_LINGUAS"; then
++            for presentlang in $ALL_LINGUAS; do
++              useit=no
++              if test "%UNSET%" != "$LINGUAS"; then
++                desiredlanguages="$LINGUAS"
++              else
++                desiredlanguages="$ALL_LINGUAS"
++              fi
++              for desiredlang in $desiredlanguages; do
++                # Use the presentlang catalog if desiredlang is
++                #   a. equal to presentlang, or
++                #   b. a variant of presentlang (because in this case,
++                #      presentlang can be used as a fallback for messages
++                #      which are not translated in the desiredlang catalog).
++                case "$desiredlang" in
++                  "$presentlang"*) useit=yes;;
++                esac
++              done
++              if test $useit = yes; then
++                INST_LINGUAS="$INST_LINGUAS $presentlang"
++              fi
++            done
++          fi
++          CATALOGS=
++          if test -n "$INST_LINGUAS"; then
++            for lang in $INST_LINGUAS; do
++              CATALOGS="$CATALOGS $lang.gmo"
++            done
++          fi
++          test -n "$as_me" && echo "$as_me: creating $ac_dir/Makefile" || echo "creating $ac_dir/Makefile"
++          sed -e "/^POTFILES =/r $ac_dir/POTFILES" -e "/^# Makevars/r $ac_given_srcdir/$ac_dir/Makevars" -e "s|@POFILES@|$POFILES|g" -e "s|@UPDATEPOFILES@|$UPDATEPOFILES|g" -e "s|@DUMMYPOFILES@|$DUMMYPOFILES|g" -e "s|@GMOFILES@|$GMOFILES|g" -e "s|@CATALOGS@|$CATALOGS|g" -e "s|@POMAKEFILEDEPS@|$POMAKEFILEDEPS|g" "$ac_dir/Makefile.in" > "$ac_dir/Makefile"
++          for f in "$ac_given_srcdir/$ac_dir"/Rules-*; do
++            if test -f "$f"; then
++              case "$f" in
++                *.orig | *.bak | *~) ;;
++                *) cat "$f" >> "$ac_dir/Makefile" ;;
++              esac
++            fi
++          done
++        fi
++        ;;
++      esac
++    done],
++   [# Capture the value of obsolete ALL_LINGUAS because we need it to compute
++    # POFILES, UPDATEPOFILES, DUMMYPOFILES, GMOFILES, CATALOGS. But hide it
++    # from automake.
++    eval 'OBSOLETE_ALL_LINGUAS''="$ALL_LINGUAS"'
++    # Capture the value of LINGUAS because we need it to compute CATALOGS.
++    LINGUAS="${LINGUAS-%UNSET%}"
++   ])
++])
++
++dnl Postprocesses a Makefile in a directory containing PO files.
++AC_DEFUN([AM_POSTPROCESS_PO_MAKEFILE],
++[
++  # When this code is run, in config.status, two variables have already been
++  # set:
++  # - OBSOLETE_ALL_LINGUAS is the value of LINGUAS set in configure.in,
++  # - LINGUAS is the value of the environment variable LINGUAS at configure
++  #   time.
++
++changequote(,)dnl
++  # Adjust a relative srcdir.
++  ac_dir=`echo "$ac_file"|sed 's%/[^/][^/]*$%%'`
++  ac_dir_suffix="/`echo "$ac_dir"|sed 's%^\./%%'`"
++  ac_dots=`echo "$ac_dir_suffix"|sed 's%/[^/]*%../%g'`
++  # In autoconf-2.13 it is called $ac_given_srcdir.
++  # In autoconf-2.50 it is called $srcdir.
++  test -n "$ac_given_srcdir" || ac_given_srcdir="$srcdir"
++  case "$ac_given_srcdir" in
++    .)  top_srcdir=`echo $ac_dots|sed 's%/$%%'` ;;
++    /*) top_srcdir="$ac_given_srcdir" ;;
++    *)  top_srcdir="$ac_dots$ac_given_srcdir" ;;
++  esac
++
++  # Find a way to echo strings without interpreting backslash.
++  if test "X`(echo '\t') 2>/dev/null`" = 'X\t'; then
++    gt_echo='echo'
++  else
++    if test "X`(printf '%s\n' '\t') 2>/dev/null`" = 'X\t'; then
++      gt_echo='printf %s\n'
++    else
++      echo_func () {
++        cat <<EOT
++$*
++EOT
++      }
++      gt_echo='echo_func'
++    fi
++  fi
++
++  # A sed script that extracts the value of VARIABLE from a Makefile.
++  sed_x_variable='
++# Test if the hold space is empty.
++x
++s/P/P/
++x
++ta
++# Yes it was empty. Look if we have the expected variable definition.
++/^[	 ]*VARIABLE[	 ]*=/{
++  # Seen the first line of the variable definition.
++  s/^[	 ]*VARIABLE[	 ]*=//
++  ba
++}
++bd
++:a
++# Here we are processing a line from the variable definition.
++# Remove comment, more precisely replace it with a space.
++s/#.*$/ /
++# See if the line ends in a backslash.
++tb
++:b
++s/\\$//
++# Print the line, without the trailing backslash.
++p
++tc
++# There was no trailing backslash. The end of the variable definition is
++# reached. Clear the hold space.
++s/^.*$//
++x
++bd
++:c
++# A trailing backslash means that the variable definition continues in the
++# next line. Put a nonempty string into the hold space to indicate this.
++s/^.*$/P/
++x
++:d
++'
++changequote([,])dnl
++
++  # Set POTFILES to the value of the Makefile variable POTFILES.
++  sed_x_POTFILES="`$gt_echo \"$sed_x_variable\" | sed -e '/^ *#/d' -e 's/VARIABLE/POTFILES/g'`"
++  POTFILES=`sed -n -e "$sed_x_POTFILES" < "$ac_file"`
++  # Compute POTFILES_DEPS as
++  #   $(foreach file, $(POTFILES), $(top_srcdir)/$(file))
++  POTFILES_DEPS=
++  for file in $POTFILES; do
++    POTFILES_DEPS="$POTFILES_DEPS "'$(top_srcdir)/'"$file"
++  done
++  POMAKEFILEDEPS=""
++
++  if test -n "$OBSOLETE_ALL_LINGUAS"; then
++    test -n "$as_me" && echo "$as_me: setting ALL_LINGUAS in configure.in is obsolete" || echo "setting ALL_LINGUAS in configure.in is obsolete"
++  fi
++  if test -f "$ac_given_srcdir/$ac_dir/LINGUAS"; then
++    # The LINGUAS file contains the set of available languages.
++    ALL_LINGUAS_=`sed -e "/^#/d" "$ac_given_srcdir/$ac_dir/LINGUAS"`
++    POMAKEFILEDEPS="$POMAKEFILEDEPS LINGUAS"
++  else
++    # Set ALL_LINGUAS to the value of the Makefile variable LINGUAS.
++    sed_x_LINGUAS="`$gt_echo \"$sed_x_variable\" | sed -e '/^ *#/d' -e 's/VARIABLE/LINGUAS/g'`"
++    ALL_LINGUAS_=`sed -n -e "$sed_x_LINGUAS" < "$ac_file"`
++  fi
++  # Hide the ALL_LINGUAS assigment from automake.
++  eval 'ALL_LINGUAS''=$ALL_LINGUAS_'
++  # Compute POFILES
++  # as      $(foreach lang, $(ALL_LINGUAS), $(srcdir)/$(lang).po)
++  # Compute UPDATEPOFILES
++  # as      $(foreach lang, $(ALL_LINGUAS), $(lang).po-update)
++  # Compute DUMMYPOFILES
++  # as      $(foreach lang, $(ALL_LINGUAS), $(lang).nop)
++  # Compute GMOFILES
++  # as      $(foreach lang, $(ALL_LINGUAS), $(srcdir)/$(lang).gmo)
++  # Compute PROPERTIESFILES
++  # as      $(foreach lang, $(ALL_LINGUAS), $(top_srcdir)/$(DOMAIN)_$(lang).properties)
++  # Compute CLASSFILES
++  # as      $(foreach lang, $(ALL_LINGUAS), $(top_srcdir)/$(DOMAIN)_$(lang).class)
++  # Compute QMFILES
++  # as      $(foreach lang, $(ALL_LINGUAS), $(srcdir)/$(lang).qm)
++  # Compute MSGFILES
++  # as      $(foreach lang, $(ALL_LINGUAS), $(srcdir)/$(frob $(lang)).msg)
++  # Compute RESOURCESDLLFILES
++  # as      $(foreach lang, $(ALL_LINGUAS), $(srcdir)/$(frob $(lang))/$(DOMAIN).resources.dll)
++  case "$ac_given_srcdir" in
++    .) srcdirpre= ;;
++    *) srcdirpre='$(srcdir)/' ;;
++  esac
++  POFILES=
++  UPDATEPOFILES=
++  DUMMYPOFILES=
++  GMOFILES=
++  PROPERTIESFILES=
++  CLASSFILES=
++  QMFILES=
++  MSGFILES=
++  RESOURCESDLLFILES=
++  for lang in $ALL_LINGUAS; do
++    POFILES="$POFILES $srcdirpre$lang.po"
++    UPDATEPOFILES="$UPDATEPOFILES $lang.po-update"
++    DUMMYPOFILES="$DUMMYPOFILES $lang.nop"
++    GMOFILES="$GMOFILES $srcdirpre$lang.gmo"
++    PROPERTIESFILES="$PROPERTIESFILES \$(top_srcdir)/\$(DOMAIN)_$lang.properties"
++    CLASSFILES="$CLASSFILES \$(top_srcdir)/\$(DOMAIN)_$lang.class"
++    QMFILES="$QMFILES $srcdirpre$lang.qm"
++    frobbedlang=`echo $lang | sed -e 's/\..*$//' -e 'y/ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ/abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz/'`
++    MSGFILES="$MSGFILES $srcdirpre$frobbedlang.msg"
++    frobbedlang=`echo $lang | sed -e 's/_/-/g'`
++    RESOURCESDLLFILES="$RESOURCESDLLFILES $srcdirpre$frobbedlang/\$(DOMAIN).resources.dll"
++  done
++  # CATALOGS depends on both $ac_dir and the user's LINGUAS
++  # environment variable.
++  INST_LINGUAS=
++  if test -n "$ALL_LINGUAS"; then
++    for presentlang in $ALL_LINGUAS; do
++      useit=no
++      if test "%UNSET%" != "$LINGUAS"; then
++        desiredlanguages="$LINGUAS"
++      else
++        desiredlanguages="$ALL_LINGUAS"
++      fi
++      for desiredlang in $desiredlanguages; do
++        # Use the presentlang catalog if desiredlang is
++        #   a. equal to presentlang, or
++        #   b. a variant of presentlang (because in this case,
++        #      presentlang can be used as a fallback for messages
++        #      which are not translated in the desiredlang catalog).
++        case "$desiredlang" in
++          "$presentlang"*) useit=yes;;
++        esac
++      done
++      if test $useit = yes; then
++        INST_LINGUAS="$INST_LINGUAS $presentlang"
++      fi
++    done
++  fi
++  CATALOGS=
++  JAVACATALOGS=
++  QTCATALOGS=
++  TCLCATALOGS=
++  CSHARPCATALOGS=
++  if test -n "$INST_LINGUAS"; then
++    for lang in $INST_LINGUAS; do
++      CATALOGS="$CATALOGS $lang.gmo"
++      JAVACATALOGS="$JAVACATALOGS \$(DOMAIN)_$lang.properties"
++      QTCATALOGS="$QTCATALOGS $lang.qm"
++      frobbedlang=`echo $lang | sed -e 's/\..*$//' -e 'y/ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ/abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz/'`
++      TCLCATALOGS="$TCLCATALOGS $frobbedlang.msg"
++      frobbedlang=`echo $lang | sed -e 's/_/-/g'`
++      CSHARPCATALOGS="$CSHARPCATALOGS $frobbedlang/\$(DOMAIN).resources.dll"
++    done
++  fi
++
++  sed -e "s|@POTFILES_DEPS@|$POTFILES_DEPS|g" -e "s|@POFILES@|$POFILES|g" -e "s|@UPDATEPOFILES@|$UPDATEPOFILES|g" -e "s|@DUMMYPOFILES@|$DUMMYPOFILES|g" -e "s|@GMOFILES@|$GMOFILES|g" -e "s|@PROPERTIESFILES@|$PROPERTIESFILES|g" -e "s|@CLASSFILES@|$CLASSFILES|g" -e "s|@QMFILES@|$QMFILES|g" -e "s|@MSGFILES@|$MSGFILES|g" -e "s|@RESOURCESDLLFILES@|$RESOURCESDLLFILES|g" -e "s|@CATALOGS@|$CATALOGS|g" -e "s|@JAVACATALOGS@|$JAVACATALOGS|g" -e "s|@QTCATALOGS@|$QTCATALOGS|g" -e "s|@TCLCATALOGS@|$TCLCATALOGS|g" -e "s|@CSHARPCATALOGS@|$CSHARPCATALOGS|g" -e 's,^#distdir:,distdir:,' < "$ac_file" > "$ac_file.tmp"
++  if grep -l '@TCLCATALOGS@' "$ac_file" > /dev/null; then
++    # Add dependencies that cannot be formulated as a simple suffix rule.
++    for lang in $ALL_LINGUAS; do
++      frobbedlang=`echo $lang | sed -e 's/\..*$//' -e 'y/ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ/abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz/'`
++      cat >> "$ac_file.tmp" <<EOF
++$frobbedlang.msg: $lang.po
++	@echo "\$(MSGFMT) -c --tcl -d \$(srcdir) -l $lang $srcdirpre$lang.po"; \
++	\$(MSGFMT) -c --tcl -d "\$(srcdir)" -l $lang $srcdirpre$lang.po || { rm -f "\$(srcdir)/$frobbedlang.msg"; exit 1; }
++EOF
++    done
++  fi
++  if grep -l '@CSHARPCATALOGS@' "$ac_file" > /dev/null; then
++    # Add dependencies that cannot be formulated as a simple suffix rule.
++    for lang in $ALL_LINGUAS; do
++      frobbedlang=`echo $lang | sed -e 's/_/-/g'`
++      cat >> "$ac_file.tmp" <<EOF
++$frobbedlang/\$(DOMAIN).resources.dll: $lang.po
++	@echo "\$(MSGFMT) -c --csharp -d \$(srcdir) -l $lang $srcdirpre$lang.po -r \$(DOMAIN)"; \
++	\$(MSGFMT) -c --csharp -d "\$(srcdir)" -l $lang $srcdirpre$lang.po -r "\$(DOMAIN)" || { rm -f "\$(srcdir)/$frobbedlang.msg"; exit 1; }
++EOF
++    done
++  fi
++  if test -n "$POMAKEFILEDEPS"; then
++    cat >> "$ac_file.tmp" <<EOF
++Makefile: $POMAKEFILEDEPS
++EOF
++  fi
++  mv "$ac_file.tmp" "$ac_file"
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/printf-posix.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/printf-posix.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.974654000 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,46 @@
++# printf-posix.m4 serial 2 (gettext-0.13.1)
++dnl Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Bruno Haible.
++dnl Test whether the printf() function supports POSIX/XSI format strings with
++dnl positions.
++
++AC_DEFUN([gt_PRINTF_POSIX],
++[
++  AC_REQUIRE([AC_PROG_CC])
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([whether printf() supports POSIX/XSI format strings],
++    gt_cv_func_printf_posix,
++    [
++      AC_TRY_RUN([
++#include <stdio.h>
++#include <string.h>
++/* The string "%2$d %1$d", with dollar characters protected from the shell's
++   dollar expansion (possibly an autoconf bug).  */
++static char format[] = { '%', '2', '$', 'd', ' ', '%', '1', '$', 'd', '\0' };
++static char buf[100];
++int main ()
++{
++  sprintf (buf, format, 33, 55);
++  return (strcmp (buf, "55 33") != 0);
++}], gt_cv_func_printf_posix=yes, gt_cv_func_printf_posix=no,
++      [
++        AC_EGREP_CPP(notposix, [
++#if defined __NetBSD__ || defined _MSC_VER || defined __MINGW32__ || defined __CYGWIN__
++  notposix
++#endif
++        ], gt_cv_func_printf_posix="guessing no",
++           gt_cv_func_printf_posix="guessing yes")
++      ])
++    ])
++  case $gt_cv_func_printf_posix in
++    *yes)
++      AC_DEFINE(HAVE_POSIX_PRINTF, 1,
++        [Define if your printf() function supports format strings with positions.])
++      ;;
++  esac
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/progtest.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/progtest.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.990651568 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,91 @@
++# progtest.m4 serial 3 (gettext-0.12)
++dnl Copyright (C) 1996-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++dnl
++dnl This file can can be used in projects which are not available under
++dnl the GNU General Public License or the GNU Library General Public
++dnl License but which still want to provide support for the GNU gettext
++dnl functionality.
++dnl Please note that the actual code of the GNU gettext library is covered
++dnl by the GNU Library General Public License, and the rest of the GNU
++dnl gettext package package is covered by the GNU General Public License.
++dnl They are *not* in the public domain.
++
++dnl Authors:
++dnl   Ulrich Drepper <drepper@cygnus.com>, 1996.
++
++# Search path for a program which passes the given test.
++
++dnl AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST(VARIABLE, PROG-TO-CHECK-FOR,
++dnl   TEST-PERFORMED-ON-FOUND_PROGRAM [, VALUE-IF-NOT-FOUND [, PATH]])
++AC_DEFUN([AM_PATH_PROG_WITH_TEST],
++[
++# Prepare PATH_SEPARATOR.
++# The user is always right.
++if test "${PATH_SEPARATOR+set}" != set; then
++  echo "#! /bin/sh" >conf$$.sh
++  echo  "exit 0"   >>conf$$.sh
++  chmod +x conf$$.sh
++  if (PATH="/nonexistent;."; conf$$.sh) >/dev/null 2>&1; then
++    PATH_SEPARATOR=';'
++  else
++    PATH_SEPARATOR=:
++  fi
++  rm -f conf$$.sh
++fi
++
++# Find out how to test for executable files. Don't use a zero-byte file,
++# as systems may use methods other than mode bits to determine executability.
++cat >conf$$.file <<_ASEOF
++#! /bin/sh
++exit 0
++_ASEOF
++chmod +x conf$$.file
++if test -x conf$$.file >/dev/null 2>&1; then
++  ac_executable_p="test -x"
++else
++  ac_executable_p="test -f"
++fi
++rm -f conf$$.file
++
++# Extract the first word of "$2", so it can be a program name with args.
++set dummy $2; ac_word=[$]2
++AC_MSG_CHECKING([for $ac_word])
++AC_CACHE_VAL(ac_cv_path_$1,
++[case "[$]$1" in
++  [[\\/]]* | ?:[[\\/]]*)
++    ac_cv_path_$1="[$]$1" # Let the user override the test with a path.
++    ;;
++  *)
++    ac_save_IFS="$IFS"; IFS=$PATH_SEPARATOR
++    for ac_dir in ifelse([$5], , $PATH, [$5]); do
++      IFS="$ac_save_IFS"
++      test -z "$ac_dir" && ac_dir=.
++      for ac_exec_ext in '' $ac_executable_extensions; do
++        if $ac_executable_p "$ac_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"; then
++          if [$3]; then
++            ac_cv_path_$1="$ac_dir/$ac_word$ac_exec_ext"
++            break 2
++          fi
++        fi
++      done
++    done
++    IFS="$ac_save_IFS"
++dnl If no 4th arg is given, leave the cache variable unset,
++dnl so AC_PATH_PROGS will keep looking.
++ifelse([$4], , , [  test -z "[$]ac_cv_path_$1" && ac_cv_path_$1="$4"
++])dnl
++    ;;
++esac])dnl
++$1="$ac_cv_path_$1"
++if test ifelse([$4], , [-n "[$]$1"], ["[$]$1" != "$4"]); then
++  AC_MSG_RESULT([$]$1)
++else
++  AC_MSG_RESULT(no)
++fi
++AC_SUBST($1)dnl
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/signed.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/signed.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:34.996650656 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,19 @@
++# signed.m4 serial 1 (gettext-0.10.40)
++dnl Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Bruno Haible.
++
++AC_DEFUN([bh_C_SIGNED],
++[
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([for signed], bh_cv_c_signed,
++   [AC_TRY_COMPILE(, [signed char x;], bh_cv_c_signed=yes, bh_cv_c_signed=no)])
++  if test $bh_cv_c_signed = no; then
++    AC_DEFINE(signed, ,
++              [Define to empty if the C compiler doesn't support this keyword.])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/size_max.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/size_max.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:35.003649592 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,61 @@
++# size_max.m4 serial 2
++dnl Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Bruno Haible.
++
++AC_DEFUN([gl_SIZE_MAX],
++[
++  AC_CHECK_HEADERS(stdint.h)
++  dnl First test whether the system already has SIZE_MAX.
++  AC_MSG_CHECKING([for SIZE_MAX])
++  result=
++  AC_EGREP_CPP([Found it], [
++#include <limits.h>
++#if HAVE_STDINT_H
++#include <stdint.h>
++#endif
++#ifdef SIZE_MAX
++Found it
++#endif
++], result=yes)
++  if test -z "$result"; then
++    dnl Define it ourselves. Here we assume that the type 'size_t' is not wider
++    dnl than the type 'unsigned long'.
++    dnl The _AC_COMPUTE_INT macro works up to LONG_MAX, since it uses 'expr',
++    dnl which is guaranteed to work from LONG_MIN to LONG_MAX.
++    _AC_COMPUTE_INT([~(size_t)0 / 10], res_hi,
++      [#include <stddef.h>], result=?)
++    _AC_COMPUTE_INT([~(size_t)0 % 10], res_lo,
++      [#include <stddef.h>], result=?)
++    _AC_COMPUTE_INT([sizeof (size_t) <= sizeof (unsigned int)], fits_in_uint,
++      [#include <stddef.h>], result=?)
++    if test "$fits_in_uint" = 1; then
++      dnl Even though SIZE_MAX fits in an unsigned int, it must be of type
++      dnl 'unsigned long' if the type 'size_t' is the same as 'unsigned long'.
++      AC_TRY_COMPILE([#include <stddef.h>
++        extern size_t foo;
++        extern unsigned long foo;
++        ], [], fits_in_uint=0)
++    fi
++    if test -z "$result"; then
++      if test "$fits_in_uint" = 1; then
++        result="$res_hi$res_lo"U
++      else
++        result="$res_hi$res_lo"UL
++      fi
++    else
++      dnl Shouldn't happen, but who knows...
++      result='~(size_t)0'
++    fi
++  fi
++  AC_MSG_RESULT([$result])
++  if test "$result" != yes; then
++    AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED([SIZE_MAX], [$result],
++      [Define as the maximum value of type 'size_t', if the system doesn't define it.])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/stdint_h.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/stdint_h.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:35.009648680 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,28 @@
++# stdint_h.m4 serial 3 (gettext-0.12)
++dnl Copyright (C) 1997-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Paul Eggert.
++
++# Define HAVE_STDINT_H_WITH_UINTMAX if <stdint.h> exists,
++# doesn't clash with <sys/types.h>, and declares uintmax_t.
++
++AC_DEFUN([jm_AC_HEADER_STDINT_H],
++[
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([for stdint.h], jm_ac_cv_header_stdint_h,
++  [AC_TRY_COMPILE(
++    [#include <sys/types.h>
++#include <stdint.h>],
++    [uintmax_t i = (uintmax_t) -1;],
++    jm_ac_cv_header_stdint_h=yes,
++    jm_ac_cv_header_stdint_h=no)])
++  if test $jm_ac_cv_header_stdint_h = yes; then
++    AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(HAVE_STDINT_H_WITH_UINTMAX, 1,
++      [Define if <stdint.h> exists, doesn't clash with <sys/types.h>,
++       and declares uintmax_t. ])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/uintmax_t.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/uintmax_t.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:35.021646856 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,32 @@
++# uintmax_t.m4 serial 7 (gettext-0.12)
++dnl Copyright (C) 1997-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Paul Eggert.
++
++AC_PREREQ(2.13)
++
++# Define uintmax_t to 'unsigned long' or 'unsigned long long'
++# if it is not already defined in <stdint.h> or <inttypes.h>.
++
++AC_DEFUN([jm_AC_TYPE_UINTMAX_T],
++[
++  AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_HEADER_INTTYPES_H])
++  AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_HEADER_STDINT_H])
++  if test $jm_ac_cv_header_inttypes_h = no && test $jm_ac_cv_header_stdint_h = no; then
++    AC_REQUIRE([jm_AC_TYPE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG])
++    test $ac_cv_type_unsigned_long_long = yes \
++      && ac_type='unsigned long long' \
++      || ac_type='unsigned long'
++    AC_DEFINE_UNQUOTED(uintmax_t, $ac_type,
++      [Define to unsigned long or unsigned long long
++       if <stdint.h> and <inttypes.h> don't define.])
++  else
++    AC_DEFINE(HAVE_UINTMAX_T, 1,
++      [Define if you have the 'uintmax_t' type in <stdint.h> or <inttypes.h>.])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/ulonglong.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/ulonglong.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:35.028645792 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,25 @@
++# ulonglong.m4 serial 3
++dnl Copyright (C) 1999-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Paul Eggert.
++
++# Define HAVE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG if 'unsigned long long' works.
++
++AC_DEFUN([jm_AC_TYPE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG],
++[
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([for unsigned long long], ac_cv_type_unsigned_long_long,
++  [AC_TRY_LINK([unsigned long long ull = 1ULL; int i = 63;],
++    [unsigned long long ullmax = (unsigned long long) -1;
++     return ull << i | ull >> i | ullmax / ull | ullmax % ull;],
++    ac_cv_type_unsigned_long_long=yes,
++    ac_cv_type_unsigned_long_long=no)])
++  if test $ac_cv_type_unsigned_long_long = yes; then
++    AC_DEFINE(HAVE_UNSIGNED_LONG_LONG, 1,
++      [Define if you have the 'unsigned long long' type.])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/wchar_t.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/wchar_t.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:35.034644880 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,22 @@
++# wchar_t.m4 serial 1 (gettext-0.12)
++dnl Copyright (C) 2002-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Bruno Haible.
++dnl Test whether <stddef.h> has the 'wchar_t' type.
++dnl Prerequisite: AC_PROG_CC
++
++AC_DEFUN([gt_TYPE_WCHAR_T],
++[
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([for wchar_t], gt_cv_c_wchar_t,
++    [AC_TRY_COMPILE([#include <stddef.h>
++       wchar_t foo = (wchar_t)'\0';], ,
++       gt_cv_c_wchar_t=yes, gt_cv_c_wchar_t=no)])
++  if test $gt_cv_c_wchar_t = yes; then
++    AC_DEFINE(HAVE_WCHAR_T, 1, [Define if you have the 'wchar_t' type.])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/wint_t.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/wint_t.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:35.040643968 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,22 @@
++# wint_t.m4 serial 1 (gettext-0.12)
++dnl Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++dnl From Bruno Haible.
++dnl Test whether <wchar.h> has the 'wint_t' type.
++dnl Prerequisite: AC_PROG_CC
++
++AC_DEFUN([gt_TYPE_WINT_T],
++[
++  AC_CACHE_CHECK([for wint_t], gt_cv_c_wint_t,
++    [AC_TRY_COMPILE([#include <wchar.h>
++       wint_t foo = (wchar_t)'\0';], ,
++       gt_cv_c_wint_t=yes, gt_cv_c_wint_t=no)])
++  if test $gt_cv_c_wint_t = yes; then
++    AC_DEFINE(HAVE_WINT_T, 1, [Define if you have the 'wint_t' type.])
++  fi
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/m4/xsize.m4	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/m4/xsize.m4	2004-09-12 14:40:35.047642904 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,14 @@
++# xsize.m4 serial 2
++dnl Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++dnl This file is free software, distributed under the terms of the GNU
++dnl General Public License.  As a special exception to the GNU General
++dnl Public License, this file may be distributed as part of a program
++dnl that contains a configuration script generated by Autoconf, under
++dnl the same distribution terms as the rest of that program.
++
++AC_DEFUN([gl_XSIZE],
++[
++  dnl Prerequisites of lib/xsize.h.
++  AC_REQUIRE([gl_SIZE_MAX])
++  AC_CHECK_HEADERS(stdint.h)
++])
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/Makefile.am	1998-12-30 06:19:40.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/Makefile.am	2004-09-12 14:40:35.121631656 -0400
+@@ -1,5 +1,5 @@
+ SUBDIRS = lib intl src po man testsuite
+-EXTRA_DIST = check.lrzsz COMPATABILITY README.cvs README.isdn4linux \
++EXTRA_DIST = config.rpath  check.lrzsz COMPATABILITY README.cvs README.isdn4linux \
+ 	README.gettext rpmrc buildrpm systype.in fastcheck.sh README.tests \
+ 	beos-runpiped.c fastcheck.beos
+ noinst_SCRIPTS=systype
+@@ -83,3 +83,5 @@
+ rpm: $(PR).tar.gz Specfile
+ 	$(srcdir)/buildrpm $(srcdir)
+ 
++
++ACLOCAL_AMFLAGS = -I m4
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/Makefile.in	1998-12-30 11:31:40.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/Makefile.in	2004-09-12 14:40:35.109633480 -0400
+@@ -125,7 +125,7 @@
+ 	  && CONFIG_FILES=$@ CONFIG_HEADERS= $(SHELL) ./config.status
+ 
+ $(ACLOCAL_M4):  configure.in  acinclude.m4
+-	cd $(srcdir) && $(ACLOCAL)
++	cd $(srcdir) && $(ACLOCAL) -I m4
+ 
+ config.status: $(srcdir)/configure
+ 	$(SHELL) ./config.status --recheck
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/mkinstalldirs	1998-04-26 09:20:52.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/mkinstalldirs	2004-09-12 14:40:34.337750824 -0400
+@@ -1,34 +1,150 @@
+ #! /bin/sh
+ # mkinstalldirs --- make directory hierarchy
+-# Author: Noah Friedman <friedman@prep.ai.mit.edu>
++
++scriptversion=2004-02-15.20
++
++# Original author: Noah Friedman <friedman@prep.ai.mit.edu>
+ # Created: 1993-05-16
+-# Last modified: 1995-03-05
+-# Public domain
++# Public domain.
++#
++# This file is maintained in Automake, please report
++# bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org> or send patches to
++# <automake-patches@gnu.org>.
+ 
+ errstatus=0
++dirmode=""
+ 
+-for file in ${1+"$@"} ; do
+-   set fnord `echo ":$file" | sed -ne 's/^:\//#/;s/^://;s/\// /g;s/^#/\//;p'`
+-   shift
++usage="\
++Usage: mkinstalldirs [-h] [--help] [--version] [-m MODE] DIR ...
+ 
+-   pathcomp=
+-   for d in ${1+"$@"} ; do
+-     pathcomp="$pathcomp$d"
+-     case "$pathcomp" in
+-       -* ) pathcomp=./$pathcomp ;;
+-     esac
++Create each directory DIR (with mode MODE, if specified), including all
++leading file name components.
+ 
+-     if test ! -d "$pathcomp"; then
+-        echo "mkdir $pathcomp" 1>&2
+-        mkdir "$pathcomp" > /dev/null 2>&1 || lasterr=$?
+-     fi
++Report bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org>."
+ 
+-     if test ! -d "$pathcomp"; then
++# process command line arguments
++while test $# -gt 0 ; do
++  case $1 in
++    -h | --help | --h*)         # -h for help
++      echo "$usage"
++      exit 0
++      ;;
++    -m)                         # -m PERM arg
++      shift
++      test $# -eq 0 && { echo "$usage" 1>&2; exit 1; }
++      dirmode=$1
++      shift
++      ;;
++    --version)
++      echo "$0 $scriptversion"
++      exit 0
++      ;;
++    --)                         # stop option processing
++      shift
++      break
++      ;;
++    -*)                         # unknown option
++      echo "$usage" 1>&2
++      exit 1
++      ;;
++    *)                          # first non-opt arg
++      break
++      ;;
++  esac
++done
++
++for file
++do
++  if test -d "$file"; then
++    shift
++  else
++    break
++  fi
++done
++
++case $# in
++  0) exit 0 ;;
++esac
++
++# Solaris 8's mkdir -p isn't thread-safe.  If you mkdir -p a/b and
++# mkdir -p a/c at the same time, both will detect that a is missing,
++# one will create a, then the other will try to create a and die with
++# a "File exists" error.  This is a problem when calling mkinstalldirs
++# from a parallel make.  We use --version in the probe to restrict
++# ourselves to GNU mkdir, which is thread-safe.
++case $dirmode in
++  '')
++    if mkdir -p --version . >/dev/null 2>&1 && test ! -d ./--version; then
++      echo "mkdir -p -- $*"
++      exec mkdir -p -- "$@"
++    else
++      # On NextStep and OpenStep, the `mkdir' command does not
++      # recognize any option.  It will interpret all options as
++      # directories to create, and then abort because `.' already
++      # exists.
++      test -d ./-p && rmdir ./-p
++      test -d ./--version && rmdir ./--version
++    fi
++    ;;
++  *)
++    if mkdir -m "$dirmode" -p --version . >/dev/null 2>&1 &&
++       test ! -d ./--version; then
++      echo "mkdir -m $dirmode -p -- $*"
++      exec mkdir -m "$dirmode" -p -- "$@"
++    else
++      # Clean up after NextStep and OpenStep mkdir.
++      for d in ./-m ./-p ./--version "./$dirmode";
++      do
++        test -d $d && rmdir $d
++      done
++    fi
++    ;;
++esac
++
++for file
++do
++  set fnord `echo ":$file" | sed -ne 's/^:\//#/;s/^://;s/\// /g;s/^#/\//;p'`
++  shift
++
++  pathcomp=
++  for d
++  do
++    pathcomp="$pathcomp$d"
++    case $pathcomp in
++      -*) pathcomp=./$pathcomp ;;
++    esac
++
++    if test ! -d "$pathcomp"; then
++      echo "mkdir $pathcomp"
++
++      mkdir "$pathcomp" || lasterr=$?
++
++      if test ! -d "$pathcomp"; then
+ 	errstatus=$lasterr
+-     fi
++      else
++	if test ! -z "$dirmode"; then
++	  echo "chmod $dirmode $pathcomp"
++	  lasterr=""
++	  chmod "$dirmode" "$pathcomp" || lasterr=$?
+ 
+-     pathcomp="$pathcomp/"
+-   done
++	  if test ! -z "$lasterr"; then
++	    errstatus=$lasterr
++	  fi
++	fi
++      fi
++    fi
++
++    pathcomp="$pathcomp/"
++  done
+ done
+ 
+ exit $errstatus
++
++# Local Variables:
++# mode: shell-script
++# sh-indentation: 2
++# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
++# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
++# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
++# time-stamp-end: "$"
++# End:
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/po/boldquot.sed	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/po/boldquot.sed	2004-09-12 14:40:34.723692152 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,10 @@
++s/"\([^"]*\)"/“\1”/g
++s/`\([^`']*\)'/‘\1’/g
++s/ '\([^`']*\)' / ‘\1’ /g
++s/ '\([^`']*\)'$/ ‘\1’/g
++s/^'\([^`']*\)' /‘\1’ /g
++s/“”/""/g
++s/“/“/g
++s/”/”/g
++s/‘/‘/g
++s/’/’/g
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/po/cat-id-tbl.c	1998-12-29 04:24:24.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/po/cat-id-tbl.c	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
+@@ -1,234 +0,0 @@
+-/* Automatically generated by po2tbl.sed from lrzsz.pot.  */
+-
+-#if HAVE_CONFIG_H
+-# include <config.h>
+-#endif
+-
+-#include "libgettext.h"
+-
+-const struct _msg_ent _msg_tbl[] = {
+-  {"", 1},
+-  {"io_mode(,2) in rbsb.c not implemented\n", 2},
+-  {"caught signal %d; exiting", 3},
+-  {"command tries", 4},
+-  {"packetlength", 5},
+-  {"packetlength out of range 24..%ld", 6},
+-  {"framelength", 7},
+-  {"framelength out of range 32..%ld", 8},
+-  {"min_bps", 9},
+-  {"min_bps must be >= 0", 10},
+-  {"min_bps_time", 11},
+-  {"min_bps_time must be > 1", 12},
+-  {"hour to large (0..23)", 13},
+-  {"unparsable stop time\n", 14},
+-  {"minute to large (0..59)", 15},
+-  {"stop time to small", 16},
+-  {"stop-at", 17},
+-  {"timeout", 18},
+-  {"timeout out of range 10..1000", 19},
+-  {"security violation: can't do that under restricted shell\n", 20},
+-  {"window size", 21},
+-  {"cannot turnoff syslog", 22},
+-  {"startup delay", 23},
+-  {"out of memory", 24},
+-  {"this program was never intended to be used setuid\n", 25},
+-  {"need at least one file to send", 26},
+-  {"Can't send command in restricted mode\n", 27},
+-  {"hostname too long\n", 28},
+-  {"illegal server address\n", 29},
+-  {"can read only one file from stdin", 30},
+-  {"Transfer incomplete\n", 31},
+-  {"Transfer complete\n", 32},
+-  {"send_pseudo %s: cannot open tmpfile %s: %s", 33},
+-  {"send_pseudo %s: cannot lstat tmpfile %s: %s", 34},
+-  {"send_pseudo %s: avoiding symlink trap", 35},
+-  {"send_pseudo %s: cannot write to tmpfile %s: %s", 36},
+-  {"send_pseudo %s: failed", 37},
+-  {"send_pseudo %s: ok", 38},
+-  {"tcp protocol init failed\n", 39},
+-  {"Answering TIMESYNC at %s", 40},
+-  {"timezone", 41},
+-  {"timezone unknown", 42},
+-  {"Can't open any requested files.", 43},
+-  {"security violation: not allowed to upload from %s", 44},
+-  {"cannot open %s", 45},
+-  {"is not a file: %s", 46},
+-  {"%s/%s: error occured", 47},
+-  {"skipped: %s", 48},
+-  {"%s/%s: skipped", 49},
+-  {"Bytes Sent:%7ld   BPS:%-8ld                        \n", 50},
+-  {"Sending %s, %ld blocks: ", 51},
+-  {"Give your local XMODEM receive command now.", 52},
+-  {"Sending: %s\n", 53},
+-  {"Timeout on pathname", 54},
+-  {"Receiver Cancelled", 55},
+-  {"No ACK on EOT", 56},
+-  {"Xmodem sectors/kbytes sent: %3d/%2dk", 57},
+-  {"Ymodem sectors/kbytes sent: %3d/%2dk", 58},
+-  {"Cancelled", 59},
+-  {"Timeout on sector ACK", 60},
+-  {"NAK on sector", 61},
+-  {"Got burst for sector ACK", 62},
+-  {"Got %02x for sector ACK", 63},
+-  {"Retry Count Exceeded", 64},
+-  {"Try `%s --help' for more information.\n", 65},
+-  {"%s version %s\n", 66},
+-  {"Usage: %s [options] file ...\n", 67},
+-  {"   or: %s [options] -{c|i} COMMAND\n", 68},
+-  {"Send file(s) with ZMODEM/YMODEM/XMODEM protocol\n", 69},
+-  {"\
+-    (X) = option applies to XMODEM only\n\
+-    (Y) = option applies to YMODEM only\n\
+-    (Z) = option applies to ZMODEM only\n", 70},
+-  {"\
+-  -+, --append                append to existing destination file (Z)\n\
+-  -2, --twostop               use 2 stop bits\n\
+-  -4, --try-4k                go up to 4K blocksize\n\
+-      --start-4k              start with 4K blocksize (doesn't try 8)\n\
+-  -8, --try-8k                go up to 8K blocksize\n\
+-      --start-8k              start with 8K blocksize\n\
+-  -a, --ascii                 ASCII transfer (change CR/LF to LF)\n\
+-  -b, --binary                binary transfer\n\
+-  -B, --bufsize N             buffer N bytes (N==auto: buffer whole file)\n\
+-  -c, --command COMMAND       execute remote command COMMAND (Z)\n\
+-  -C, --command-tries N       try N times to execute a command (Z)\n\
+-  -d, --dot-to-slash          change '.' to '/' in pathnames (Y/Z)\n\
+-      --delay-startup N       sleep N seconds before doing anything\n\
+-  -e, --escape                escape all control characters (Z)\n\
+-  -E, --rename                force receiver to rename files it already has\n\
+-  -f, --full-path             send full pathname (Y/Z)\n\
+-  -i, --immediate-command CMD send remote CMD, return immediately (Z)\n\
+-  -h, --help                  print this usage message\n\
+-  -k, --1k                    send 1024 byte packets (X)\n\
+-  -L, --packetlen N           limit subpacket length to N bytes (Z)\n\
+-  -l, --framelen N            limit frame length to N bytes (l>=L) (Z)\n\
+-  -m, --min-bps N             stop transmission if BPS below N\n\
+-  -M, --min-bps-time N          for at least N seconds (default: 120)\n", 71},
+-  {"\
+-  -n, --newer                 send file if source newer (Z)\n\
+-  -N, --newer-or-longer       send file if source newer or longer (Z)\n\
+-  -o, --16-bit-crc            use 16 bit CRC instead of 32 bit CRC (Z)\n\
+-  -O, --disable-timeouts      disable timeout code, wait forever\n\
+-  -p, --protect               protect existing destination file (Z)\n\
+-  -r, --resume                resume interrupted file transfer (Z)\n\
+-  -R, --restricted            restricted, more secure mode\n\
+-  -q, --quiet                 quiet (no progress reports)\n\
+-  -s, --stop-at {HH:MM|+N}    stop transmission at HH:MM or in N seconds\n\
+-      --tcp                   build a TCP connection to transmit files\n\
+-      --tcp-server            open socket, wait for connection\n\
+-  -u, --unlink                unlink file after transmission\n\
+-  -U, --unrestrict            turn off restricted mode (if allowed to)\n\
+-  -v, --verbose               be verbose, provide debugging information\n\
+-  -w, --windowsize N          Window is N bytes (Z)\n\
+-  -X, --xmodem                use XMODEM protocol\n\
+-  -y, --overwrite             overwrite existing files\n\
+-  -Y, --overwrite-or-skip     overwrite existing files, else skip\n\
+-      --ymodem                use YMODEM protocol\n\
+-  -Z, --zmodem                use ZMODEM protocol\n\
+-\n\
+-short options use the same arguments as the long ones\n", 72},
+-  {"got ZRQINIT", 73},
+-  {"got ZCAN", 74},
+-  {"blklen now %d\n", 75},
+-  {"zsendfdata: bps rate %ld below min %ld", 76},
+-  {"zsendfdata: reached stop time", 77},
+-  {"Bytes Sent:%7ld/%7ld   BPS:%-8ld ETA %02d:%02d  ", 78},
+-  {"calc_blklen: reduced to %d due to error\n", 79},
+-  {"calc_blklen: returned old value %d due to low bpe diff\n", 80},
+-  {"calc_blklen: old %ld, new %ld, d %ld\n", 81},
+-  {"calc_blklen: calc total_bytes=%ld, bpe=%ld, ec=%ld\n", 82},
+-  {"calc_blklen: blklen %d, ok %ld, failed %ld -> %lu\n", 83},
+-  {"calc_blklen: returned %d as best\n", 84},
+-  {"\
+-\n\
+-countem: Total %d %ld\n", 85},
+-  {"Bad escape sequence %x", 86},
+-  {"Sender Canceled", 87},
+-  {"TIMEOUT", 88},
+-  {"Bad data subpacket", 89},
+-  {"Data subpacket too long", 90},
+-  {"Garbage count exceeded", 91},
+-  {"Got %s", 92},
+-  {"Retry %d: ", 93},
+-  {"don't have settimeofday, will not set time\n", 94},
+-  {"not running as root (this is good!), can not set time\n", 95},
+-  {"bytes_per_error", 96},
+-  {"bytes-per-error should be >100", 97},
+-  {"O_SYNC not supported by the kernel", 98},
+-  {"garbage on commandline", 99},
+-  {"Usage: %s [options] [filename.if.xmodem]\n", 100},
+-  {"Receive files with ZMODEM/YMODEM/XMODEM protocol\n", 101},
+-  {"\
+-  -+, --append                append to existing files\n\
+-  -a, --ascii                 ASCII transfer (change CR/LF to LF)\n\
+-  -b, --binary                binary transfer\n\
+-  -B, --bufsize N             buffer N bytes (N==auto: buffer whole file)\n\
+-  -c, --with-crc              Use 16 bit CRC (X)\n\
+-  -C, --allow-remote-commands allow execution of remote commands (Z)\n\
+-  -D, --null                  write all received data to /dev/null\n\
+-      --delay-startup N       sleep N seconds before doing anything\n\
+-  -e, --escape                Escape control characters (Z)\n\
+-  -E, --rename                rename any files already existing\n\
+-      --errors N              generate CRC error every N bytes (debugging)\n\
+-  -h, --help                  Help, print this usage message\n\
+-  -m, --min-bps N             stop transmission if BPS below N\n\
+-  -M, --min-bps-time N          for at least N seconds (default: 120)\n\
+-  -O, --disable-timeouts      disable timeout code, wait forever for data\n\
+-      --o-sync                open output file(s) in synchronous write mode\n\
+-  -p, --protect               protect existing files\n\
+-  -q, --quiet                 quiet, no progress reports\n\
+-  -r, --resume                try to resume interrupted file transfer (Z)\n\
+-  -R, --restricted            restricted, more secure mode\n\
+-  -s, --stop-at {HH:MM|+N}    stop transmission at HH:MM or in N seconds\n\
+-  -S, --timesync              request remote time (twice: set local time)\n\
+-      --syslog[=off]          turn syslog on or off, if possible\n\
+-  -t, --timeout N             set timeout to N tenths of a second\n\
+-  -u, --keep-uppercase        keep upper case filenames\n\
+-  -U, --unrestrict            disable restricted mode (if allowed to)\n\
+-  -v, --verbose               be verbose, provide debugging information\n\
+-  -w, --windowsize N          Window is N bytes (Z)\n\
+-  -X  --xmodem                use XMODEM protocol\n\
+-  -y, --overwrite             Yes, clobber existing file if any\n\
+-      --ymodem                use YMODEM protocol\n\
+-  -Z, --zmodem                use ZMODEM protocol\n\
+-\n\
+-short options use the same arguments as the long ones\n", 102},
+-  {"%s waiting to receive.", 103},
+-  {"\rBytes received: %7ld/%7ld   BPS:%-6ld                \r\n", 104},
+-  {"%s: ready to receive %s", 105},
+-  {"\rBytes received: %7ld   BPS:%-6ld                \r\n", 106},
+-  {"\
+-\r\n\
+-%s: %s removed.\r\n", 107},
+-  {"Pathname fetch returned EOT", 108},
+-  {"Received dup Sector", 109},
+-  {"Sync Error", 110},
+-  {"CRC", 111},
+-  {"Checksum", 112},
+-  {"Sector number garbled", 113},
+-  {"Sender Cancelled", 114},
+-  {"Got 0%o sector header", 115},
+-  {"file name ends with a /, skipped: %s\n", 116},
+-  {"zmanag=%d, Lzmanag=%d\n", 117},
+-  {"zconv=%d\n", 118},
+-  {"file exists, skipped: %s\n", 119},
+-  {"TIMESYNC: here %ld, remote %ld, diff %ld seconds\n", 120},
+-  {"TIMESYNC: cannot set time: %s\n", 121},
+-  {"cannot tmpfile() for tcp protocol synchronization", 122},
+-  {"Topipe", 123},
+-  {"Receiving: %s\n", 124},
+-  {"Blocks received: %d", 125},
+-  {"%s: %s exists\n", 126},
+-  {"%s:\tSecurity Violation", 127},
+-  {"remote command execution requested", 128},
+-  {"not executed", 129},
+-  {"got ZRINIT", 130},
+-  {"Skipped", 131},
+-  {"rzfile: bps rate %ld below min %ld", 132},
+-  {"rzfile: reached stop time", 133},
+-  {"\rBytes received: %7ld/%7ld   BPS:%-6ld ETA %02d:%02d  ", 134},
+-  {"fgets for tcp protocol synchronization failed: ", 135},
+-  {"file close error", 136},
+-};
+-
+-int _msg_tbl_length = 136;
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/po/ChangeLog	1998-04-26 09:20:52.000000000 -0400
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/po/ChangeLog	2004-09-12 14:40:34.793681512 -0400
+@@ -1,3 +1,15 @@
++2004-09-12  gettextize  <bug-gnu-gettext@gnu.org>
++
++	* boldquot.sed: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* en@boldquot.header: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* en@quot.header: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* insert-header.sin: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* quot.sed: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* remove-potcdate.sin: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* Rules-quot: New file, from gettext-0.14.1.
++	* cat-id-tbl.c: Remove file.
++	* stamp-cat-id: Remove file.
++
+ /* Automatically generated by po2tbl.sed from lrzsz.pot.  */
+ 
+ #if HAVE_CONFIG_H
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/po/en@boldquot.header	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/po/en@boldquot.header	2004-09-12 14:40:34.731690936 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,25 @@
++# All this catalog "translates" are quotation characters.
++# The msgids must be ASCII and therefore cannot contain real quotation
++# characters, only substitutes like grave accent (0x60), apostrophe (0x27)
++# and double quote (0x22). These substitutes look strange; see
++# http://www.cl.cam.ac.uk/~mgk25/ucs/quotes.html
++#
++# This catalog translates grave accent (0x60) and apostrophe (0x27) to
++# left single quotation mark (U+2018) and right single quotation mark (U+2019).
++# It also translates pairs of apostrophe (0x27) to
++# left single quotation mark (U+2018) and right single quotation mark (U+2019)
++# and pairs of quotation mark (0x22) to
++# left double quotation mark (U+201C) and right double quotation mark (U+201D).
++#
++# When output to an UTF-8 terminal, the quotation characters appear perfectly.
++# When output to an ISO-8859-1 terminal, the single quotation marks are
++# transliterated to apostrophes (by iconv in glibc 2.2 or newer) or to
++# grave/acute accent (by libiconv), and the double quotation marks are
++# transliterated to 0x22.
++# When output to an ASCII terminal, the single quotation marks are
++# transliterated to apostrophes, and the double quotation marks are
++# transliterated to 0x22.
++#
++# This catalog furthermore displays the text between the quotation marks in
++# bold face, assuming the VT100/XTerm escape sequences.
++#
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/po/en@quot.header	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/po/en@quot.header	2004-09-12 14:40:34.737690024 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,22 @@
++# All this catalog "translates" are quotation characters.
++# The msgids must be ASCII and therefore cannot contain real quotation
++# characters, only substitutes like grave accent (0x60), apostrophe (0x27)
++# and double quote (0x22). These substitutes look strange; see
++# http://www.cl.cam.ac.uk/~mgk25/ucs/quotes.html
++#
++# This catalog translates grave accent (0x60) and apostrophe (0x27) to
++# left single quotation mark (U+2018) and right single quotation mark (U+2019).
++# It also translates pairs of apostrophe (0x27) to
++# left single quotation mark (U+2018) and right single quotation mark (U+2019)
++# and pairs of quotation mark (0x22) to
++# left double quotation mark (U+201C) and right double quotation mark (U+201D).
++#
++# When output to an UTF-8 terminal, the quotation characters appear perfectly.
++# When output to an ISO-8859-1 terminal, the single quotation marks are
++# transliterated to apostrophes (by iconv in glibc 2.2 or newer) or to
++# grave/acute accent (by libiconv), and the double quotation marks are
++# transliterated to 0x22.
++# When output to an ASCII terminal, the single quotation marks are
++# transliterated to apostrophes, and the double quotation marks are
++# transliterated to 0x22.
++#
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/po/insert-header.sin	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/po/insert-header.sin	2004-09-12 14:40:34.743689112 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,23 @@
++# Sed script that inserts the file called HEADER before the header entry.
++#
++# At each occurrence of a line starting with "msgid ", we execute the following
++# commands. At the first occurrence, insert the file. At the following
++# occurrences, do nothing. The distinction between the first and the following
++# occurrences is achieved by looking at the hold space.
++/^msgid /{
++x
++# Test if the hold space is empty.
++s/m/m/
++ta
++# Yes it was empty. First occurrence. Read the file.
++r HEADER
++# Output the file's contents by reading the next line. But don't lose the
++# current line while doing this.
++g
++N
++bb
++:a
++# The hold space was nonempty. Following occurrences. Do nothing.
++x
++:b
++}
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/po/Makevars	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/po/Makevars	2004-09-12 14:40:34.748688352 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,41 @@
++# Makefile variables for PO directory in any package using GNU gettext.
++
++# Usually the message domain is the same as the package name.
++DOMAIN = $(PACKAGE)
++
++# These two variables depend on the location of this directory.
++subdir = po
++top_builddir = ..
++
++# These options get passed to xgettext.
++XGETTEXT_OPTIONS = --keyword=_ --keyword=N_
++
++# This is the copyright holder that gets inserted into the header of the
++# $(DOMAIN).pot file.  Set this to the copyright holder of the surrounding
++# package.  (Note that the msgstr strings, extracted from the package's
++# sources, belong to the copyright holder of the package.)  Translators are
++# expected to transfer the copyright for their translations to this person
++# or entity, or to disclaim their copyright.  The empty string stands for
++# the public domain; in this case the translators are expected to disclaim
++# their copyright.
++COPYRIGHT_HOLDER = Free Software Foundation, Inc.
++
++# This is the email address or URL to which the translators shall report
++# bugs in the untranslated strings:
++# - Strings which are not entire sentences, see the maintainer guidelines
++#   in the GNU gettext documentation, section 'Preparing Strings'.
++# - Strings which use unclear terms or require additional context to be
++#   understood.
++# - Strings which make invalid assumptions about notation of date, time or
++#   money.
++# - Pluralisation problems.
++# - Incorrect English spelling.
++# - Incorrect formatting.
++# It can be your email address, or a mailing list address where translators
++# can write to without being subscribed, or the URL of a web page through
++# which the translators can contact you.
++MSGID_BUGS_ADDRESS =
++
++# This is the list of locale categories, beyond LC_MESSAGES, for which the
++# message catalogs shall be used.  It is usually empty.
++EXTRA_LOCALE_CATEGORIES =
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/po/quot.sed	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/po/quot.sed	2004-09-12 14:40:34.754687440 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
++s/"\([^"]*\)"/“\1”/g
++s/`\([^`']*\)'/‘\1’/g
++s/ '\([^`']*\)' / ‘\1’ /g
++s/ '\([^`']*\)'$/ ‘\1’/g
++s/^'\([^`']*\)' /‘\1’ /g
++s/“”/""/g
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/po/remove-potcdate.sin	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/po/remove-potcdate.sin	2004-09-12 14:40:34.762686224 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,19 @@
++# Sed script that remove the POT-Creation-Date line in the header entry
++# from a POT file.
++#
++# The distinction between the first and the following occurrences of the
++# pattern is achieved by looking at the hold space.
++/^"POT-Creation-Date: .*"$/{
++x
++# Test if the hold space is empty.
++s/P/P/
++ta
++# Yes it was empty. First occurrence. Remove the line.
++g
++d
++bb
++:a
++# The hold space was nonempty. Following occurrences. Do nothing.
++x
++:b
++}
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/po/Rules-quot	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/po/Rules-quot	2004-09-12 14:40:34.778683792 -0400
+@@ -0,0 +1,47 @@
++# Special Makefile rules for English message catalogs with quotation marks.
++
++DISTFILES.common.extra1 = quot.sed boldquot.sed en@quot.header en@boldquot.header insert-header.sin Rules-quot
++
++.SUFFIXES: .insert-header .po-update-en
++
++en@quot.po-create:
++	$(MAKE) en@quot.po-update
++en@boldquot.po-create:
++	$(MAKE) en@boldquot.po-update
++
++en@quot.po-update: en@quot.po-update-en
++en@boldquot.po-update: en@boldquot.po-update-en
++
++.insert-header.po-update-en:
++	@lang=`echo $@ | sed -e 's/\.po-update-en$$//'`; \
++	if test "$(PACKAGE)" = "gettext"; then PATH=`pwd`/../src:$$PATH; GETTEXTLIBDIR=`cd $(top_srcdir)/src && pwd`; export GETTEXTLIBDIR; fi; \
++	tmpdir=`pwd`; \
++	echo "$$lang:"; \
++	ll=`echo $$lang | sed -e 's/@.*//'`; \
++	LC_ALL=C; export LC_ALL; \
++	cd $(srcdir); \
++	if $(MSGINIT) -i $(DOMAIN).pot --no-translator -l $$ll -o - 2>/dev/null | sed -f $$tmpdir/$$lang.insert-header | $(MSGCONV) -t UTF-8 | $(MSGFILTER) sed -f `echo $$lang | sed -e 's/.*@//'`.sed 2>/dev/null > $$tmpdir/$$lang.new.po; then \
++	  if cmp $$lang.po $$tmpdir/$$lang.new.po >/dev/null 2>&1; then \
++	    rm -f $$tmpdir/$$lang.new.po; \
++	  else \
++	    if mv -f $$tmpdir/$$lang.new.po $$lang.po; then \
++	      :; \
++	    else \
++	      echo "creation of $$lang.po failed: cannot move $$tmpdir/$$lang.new.po to $$lang.po" 1>&2; \
++	      exit 1; \
++	    fi; \
++	  fi; \
++	else \
++	  echo "creation of $$lang.po failed!" 1>&2; \
++	  rm -f $$tmpdir/$$lang.new.po; \
++	fi
++
++en@quot.insert-header: insert-header.sin
++	sed -e '/^#/d' -e 's/HEADER/en@quot.header/g' $(srcdir)/insert-header.sin > en@quot.insert-header
++
++en@boldquot.insert-header: insert-header.sin
++	sed -e '/^#/d' -e 's/HEADER/en@boldquot.header/g' $(srcdir)/insert-header.sin > en@boldquot.insert-header
++
++mostlyclean: mostlyclean-quot
++mostlyclean-quot:
++	rm -f *.insert-header
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/po/stamp-cat-id	1998-12-30 02:50:01.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/po/stamp-cat-id	1969-12-31 19:00:00.000000000 -0500
+@@ -1 +0,0 @@
+-timestamp
+--- lrzsz-0.12.20.safe/src/Makefile.am	1998-12-28 03:38:47.000000000 -0500
++++ lrzsz-0.12.20/src/Makefile.am	2004-09-12 14:40:53.665812512 -0400
+@@ -2,12 +2,12 @@
+ lrz_SOURCES=lrz.c timing.c zperr.c zreadline.c crctab.c rbsb.c zm.c protname.c tcp.c lsyslog.c canit.c
+ lsz_SOURCES=lsz.c timing.c zperr.c zreadline.c crctab.c rbsb.c zm.c protname.c tcp.c lsyslog.c canit.c
+ noinst_HEADERS = timing.h zglobal.h zmodem.h
+-datadir = $(prefix)/@DATADIRNAME@
++datadir = $(prefix)/share
+ localedir = $(datadir)/locale
+ CFLAGS=@CFLAGS@
+ DISTCLEAN_FILES=lrzszbug
+ 
+-LDADD = ../lib/libzmodem.a @INTLLIBS@
++LDADD = ../lib/libzmodem.a @LIBINTL@
+ AUTOMAKE_OPTIONS=ansi2knr
+ EXTRA_DIST = ansi2knr.1 ansi2knr.c lrzszbug.in
+ INCLUDES = -I.. -I$(srcdir) -I$(top_srcdir)/src -I../intl -I$(top_srcdir)/lib